As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 21, 2025
Securities Act File No. 333-
Investment Company Act File No. 811-21349
U.S. SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
FORM N-2
Registration Statement
Under
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
the Securities Act of 1933 |
|
☒ |
|
|
Pre-Effective Amendment No. |
|
☐ |
|
|
Post-Effective Amendment No. |
|
☐ |
|
|
|
|
|
and/or |
|
|
|
|
Registration Statement |
|
|
|
|
Under
the Investment Company Act of 1940 |
|
☒ |
|
|
Amendment No. 11 |
|
☒ |
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust
(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Charter)
100 Bellevue Parkway
Wilmington, Delaware 19809
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)
Registrants Telephone Number, including Area Code: (800) 882-0052
John M. Perlowski, President
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust
50 Hudson Yards
New
York, New York 10001
(Name and Address of Agent for Service)
Copies of information to:
Margery K. Neale, Esq.
Elliot J. Gluck, Esq.
Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP
787 Seventh Avenue
New
York, New York 10019
Approximate Date of Commencement of Proposed Public Offering: From time to time after the effective date of this Registration Statement.
If the only securities being registered on this Form are being offered pursuant to dividend or interest reinvestment plans, check the following
box ☐
If any securities being registered on this Form will be offered on a delayed or continuous basis in reliance on
Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933 (Securities Act), other than securities offered in connection with a dividend reinvestment plan, check the following box ☒
If this Form is a registration statement pursuant to General Instruction A.2 or a post-effective amendment thereto, check the following box ☒
If this Form is a registration statement pursuant to General Instruction B or a post-effective amendment thereto that will become effective upon filing with
the Commission pursuant to Rule 462(e) under the Securities Act, check the following box ☐
If this Form is a post-effective amendment to a
registration statement filed pursuant to General Instruction B to register additional securities or additional classes of securities pursuant to Rule 413(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box ☐
It is proposed that this filing will become effective (check appropriate box):
☐ |
when declared effective pursuant to Section 8(c) of the Securities Act. |
If appropriate, check the following box:
☐ |
This [post-effective] amendment designates a new effective date for a previously filed [post-effective
amendment] [registration statement]. |
☐ |
This Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the
Securities Act, and the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering is: . |
☐ |
This Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, and the
Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering is: . |
☐ |
This Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, and the
Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering is: . |
Check each box that appropriately characterizes the Registrant:
☒ |
Registered Closed-End Fund
(closed-end company that is registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940 (the Investment Company Act)). |
☐ |
Business Development Company (closed-end company that intends or has
elected to be regulated as a business development company under the Investment Company Act). |
☐ |
Interval Fund (Registered Closed-End Fund or a Business Development
Company that makes periodic repurchase offers under Rule 23c-3 under the Investment Company Act). |
☒ |
A.2 Qualified (qualified to register securities pursuant to General Instruction A.2 of this Form).
|
☐ |
Well-Known Seasoned Issuer (as defined by Rule 405 under the Securities Act). |
☐ |
Emerging Growth Company (as defined by Rule 12b-2 under the Securities
and Exchange Act of 1934). |
☐ |
If an Emerging Growth Company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended
transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act. |
☐ |
New Registrant (registered or regulated under the Investment Company Act for less than 12 calendar months
preceding this filing). |
- 2 -
THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR DATES AS MAY BE
NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT SHALL FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(a) OF THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933 OR
UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL BECOME EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(a), MAY DETERMINE.
The information in this Preliminary Prospectus is not complete and may
be changed. BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This Preliminary Prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities
and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.
SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED MARCH 21, 2025
PRELIMINARY BASE PROSPECTUS
12,000,000 Shares
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust
Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
Rights to Purchase Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust (the
Trust, we, us or our) is a diversified, closed-end management investment company. The Trusts investment objective is to provide current income and capital
appreciation. The Trusts portfolio normally has an average portfolio duration of less than five years (including the effect of anticipated leverage), although it may be longer from time to time depending on market conditions.
We may offer, from time to time, in one or more offerings, up to 12,000,000 of our common shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.001 per share
(common shares). We may also offer subscription rights to purchase our common shares. Common shares may be offered at prices and on terms to be set forth in one or more supplements to this Prospectus (each, a Prospectus
Supplement). You should read this Prospectus and the applicable Prospectus Supplement carefully before you invest in our common shares.
Our common
shares may be offered directly to one or more purchasers, including existing shareholders in a rights offering, through agents designated from time to time by us, or to or through underwriters or dealers. The Prospectus Supplement relating to the
offering will identify any agents or underwriters involved in the sale of our common shares, and will set forth any applicable purchase price, fee, commission or discount arrangement between us and our agents or underwriters, or among our
underwriters, or the basis upon which such amount may be calculated. The Prospectus Supplement relating to any offering of rights will set forth the number of common shares issuable upon the exercise of each right (or number of rights) and the other
terms of such rights offering. We may not sell any of our common shares through agents, underwriters or dealers without delivery of a Prospectus Supplement describing the method and terms of the particular offering of our common shares.
Our common shares are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) under the symbol BLW. The last reported sale price of our common
shares, as reported by the NYSE on [●], 2025 was $[●] per common share. The net asset value of our common shares at the close of business on [●], 2025 was $[●] per common share. Rights issued by the Trust may also be listed
on a securities exchange.
Investing in the Trusts common shares involves certain risks, including risks of leverage, that are described in the
Risks section beginning on page 49 of this Prospectus and the Leverage section beginning on page 46 of this Prospectus.
Shares of closed-end management investment companies frequently trade at a discount to their net asset value. The
Trusts common shares have traded at a discount to net asset value, including during recent periods. If the Trusts common shares trade at a discount to their net asset value, the risk of loss may increase for purchasers in a public
offering.
Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) nor any state securities commission has
approved or disapproved these securities or passed upon the adequacy of this Prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.
This Prospectus is part of a registration statement that we have filed with the SEC using the shelf registration process. Under the shelf
registration process, we may offer, from time to time, separately or together in one or more offerings, the securities described in this Prospectus. The securities may be offered at prices and on terms described in one or more supplements to this
Prospectus. This Prospectus provides you with a general description of the securities that we may offer. Each time we use this Prospectus to offer securities, we will provide a Prospectus Supplement that will contain specific information about the
terms of that offering. The Prospectus Supplement may also add, update or change information contained in this Prospectus. This Prospectus, together with any Prospectus Supplement, sets forth concisely the information about the Trust that a
prospective investor should know before investing. You should read this Prospectus and applicable Prospectus Supplement, which contain important information, before deciding whether to invest in the common shares. You should retain the Prospectus
and Prospectus Supplement for future reference. A Statement of Additional Information (SAI), dated [●], 2025, containing additional information about the Trust, has been filed with the SEC and, as amended from time to time, is
incorporated by reference in its entirety into this Prospectus. You may call (800) 882-0052, visit the Trusts website (http://www.blackrock.com) or write to the Trust to obtain, free of charge, copies of
the SAI and the Trusts semi-annual and annual reports, as well as to obtain other information about the Trust or to make shareholder inquiries. The SAI, as well as the Trusts semi-annual and annual reports, are also available for free on
the SECs website (http://www.sec.gov). You may also e-mail requests for these documents to publicinfo@sec.gov. Information contained in, or that can be accessed through, the Trusts website is not
part of this Prospectus.
You should not construe the contents of this Prospectus as legal, tax or financial advice. You should consult with your own
professional advisors as to the legal, tax, financial or other matters relevant to the suitability of an investment in the Trust.
The Trusts
common shares do not represent a deposit or an obligation of, and are not guaranteed or endorsed by, any bank or other insured depository institution, and are not federally insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the Federal Reserve
Board or any other government agency.
Prospectus dated [●], 2025
TABLE OF CONTENTS
You should rely only on the information contained in, or incorporated by reference into, this Prospectus and any related
Prospectus Supplement in making your investment decisions. The Trust has not authorized any person to provide you with different information. If anyone provides you with different or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it. The Trust is
not making an offer to sell the common shares in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted. You should assume that the information in this Prospectus and any Prospectus Supplement is accurate only as of the dates on their covers. The
Trusts business, financial condition and prospects may have changed since the date of its description in this Prospectus or the date of its description in any Prospectus Supplement.
PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
This is only a summary of certain information relating to BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust. This summary may not contain all of the information that
you should consider before investing in our common shares. You should consider the more detailed information contained in the Prospectus and in any related Prospectus Supplement and in the Statement of Additional Information (SAI) before
purchasing common shares.
The Trust |
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust is a diversified, closed-end management investment company. Throughout this Prospectus, we refer to BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust simply as the
Trust or as we, us or our. See The Trust. |
|
The Trusts common shares are listed for trading on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) under the symbol BLW. As of [●], 2025, the net assets of the Trust were $[●], the total assets of the Trust were
$[●] and the Trust had [●] common shares outstanding. The last reported sale price of the Trusts common shares, as reported by the NYSE on [●], 2025 was $[●] per common share. The net asset value
(NAV) of the Trusts common shares at the close of business on [●], 2025 was $[●] per common share. See Description of Shares. Rights issued by the Trust may also be listed on a securities exchange.
|
The Offering |
We may offer, from time to time, in one or more offerings, up to 12,000,000 of our common shares on terms to be determined at the time of the offering. We may also offer subscription rights to purchase our common shares. The common
shares may be offered at prices and on terms to be set forth in one or more Prospectus Supplements. You should read this Prospectus and the applicable Prospectus Supplement carefully before you invest in our common shares. Our common
shares may be offered directly to one or more purchasers, through agents designated from time to time by us, or to or through underwriters or dealers. The offering price per common share will not be less than the NAV per common share at the
time we make the offering, exclusive of any underwriting commissions or discounts, provided that rights offerings that meet certain conditions may be offered at a price below the then current NAV. See Rights Offerings. The
Prospectus Supplement relating to the offering will identify any agents, underwriters or dealers involved in the sale of our common shares, and will set forth any applicable purchase price, fee, commission or discount arrangement between us and our
agents or underwriters, or among our underwriters, or the basis upon which such amount may be calculated. See Plan of Distribution. The Prospectus Supplement relating to any offering of rights will set forth the number of common
shares issuable upon the exercise of each right (or number of rights) and the other terms of such rights offering. We may not sell any of our common shares through agents, underwriters or dealers without delivery of a Prospectus Supplement
describing the method and terms of the particular offering of our common shares. |
Use of Proceeds |
The net proceeds from the issuance of common shares hereunder will be invested in accordance with our investment objective and policies as appropriate investment opportunities are identified, which is expected to be substantially completed in
approximately three months from the date on which the proceeds from an offering are received by the Trust; however, the identification of appropriate investment opportunities pursuant to the Trusts investment style or changes in market
conditions could result in the Trusts |
- 1 -
anticipated investment period extending to as long as six months. See Use of
Proceeds.
Investment Objective and Policies |
Please refer to the section of the Trusts most recent annual report on Form N-CSR entitled Investment Objectives, Policies and RisksInvestment Objectives and PoliciesBlackRock
Limited Duration Income Trust (BLW), which is incorporated by reference herein, for a discussion of the Trusts investment objective and policies. |
Leverage |
The Trust currently utilizes leverage for investment purposes in the form of reverse repurchase agreements. As of [●], 2025, this leverage represented approximately [●]% of the Trusts Managed Assets (approximately [●]% of
the Trusts net assets). Managed Assets means the total assets of the Trust (including any assets attributable to money borrowed for investment purposes) minus the sum of the Trusts accrued liabilities (other than money
borrowed for investment purposes). The Trust may borrow from banks and other financial institutions and may also borrow additional funds using such investment techniques as the Advisors (as defined below) may from time to time determine. Of
these investment techniques, the Trust expects primarily to use reverse repurchase agreements and dollar rolls. The Trust has the ability to utilize leverage through borrowings in an amount up to 33 1/3% of the value of its Managed Assets (which
includes the amount obtained from such borrowings). |
|
The Trust also has the ability to utilize leverage through the issuance of preferred shares in an amount up to 50% of the value of its Managed Assets (which includes the amount obtained from such issuance). The Trust does not currently
anticipate issuing any preferred shares; thus, the Trust will limit its borrowing to 33 1/3% of the Trusts Managed Assets. If preferred shares are issued, however, the Trusts borrowing limit will be proportionately reduced so that the
Trusts aggregate leverage will not exceed 33 1/3% of the Trusts Managed Assets. See Leverage. |
|
The use of leverage is subject to numerous risks. When leverage is employed, the NAV and market price of the common shares and the yield to holders of common shares will be more volatile than if leverage were not used. For example, a rise in
short-term interest rates will cause the Trusts NAV to decline more than if the Trust had not used leverage. A reduction in the Trusts NAV may cause a reduction in the market price of its common shares. The Trust cannot assure you that
the use of leverage will result in a higher yield on the common shares. When the Trust uses leverage, the management fee payable to the Advisor will be higher than if the Trust did not use leverage because these fees are calculated on the basis of
the Trusts Managed Assets, which include the proceeds of leverage. The Trusts leveraging strategy may not be successful. |
|
|
|
Investment Advisor and Sub-Advisors |
|
BlackRock Advisors, LLC (the Advisor) is the Trusts investment adviser. The Advisor receives an annual fee, payable monthly, in an amount equal to 0.55% of the average weekly value of the Trusts Managed
Assets. BlackRock International Limited (BIL) and BlackRock (Singapore) Limited (BSL and together with BIL, the Sub-Advisors and collectively with the Advisor, the
Advisors) serve as the Trusts sub-advisors. The Advisor, and not the Trust, pays an annual sub-advisory fee to the
Sub-Advisors. For that portion of the Trust for which each Sub-Advisor acts as |
- 2 -
sub-advisor, the Advisor will pay to such Sub-Advisor, an annual sub-advisory fee equal to a percentage of the management fee received by the Advisor from the Trust with respect to the average daily value of the
Managed Assets of the Trust allocated to such Sub-Advisor. See Management of the TrustInvestment Advisor and Sub-Advisors.
Distributions |
The Trust intends to make regular monthly cash distributions of all or a portion of its net investment income to holders of the Trusts common shares. |
|
The Trust has, with the approval of the Board, adopted a managed distribution plan, consistent with its investment objectives and policies, to support a level distribution of income, capital gains and/or return of capital (the Distribution
Plan). Under the Distribution Plan, the Trust will distribute all available investment income to its shareholders as required by the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the Code). If sufficient income (inclusive of net
investment income and short-term capital gains) is not earned on a monthly basis, the Trust will distribute long-term capital gains and/or return of capital to shareholders in order to maintain a level distribution. A return of capital distribution
may involve a return of the shareholders original investment. Though not currently taxable, such a distribution may lower a shareholders basis in the Trust, thus potentially subjecting the shareholder to future tax consequences in
connection with the sale of Trust shares, even if sold at a loss to the shareholders original investment. Each monthly distribution to shareholders is expected to be at a fixed amount established by the Board; however, the Trust may make
additional distributions from time to time, including additional capital gain distributions at the end of the taxable year, if required to meet requirements imposed by the Code and/or the Investment Company Act. Shareholders should not draw any
conclusions about the Trusts investment performance from the amount of these distributions or from the terms of the Distribution Plan. |
|
Various factors will affect the level of the Trusts income, including the asset mix and the Trusts use of options and hedging. To permit the Trust to maintain a more stable monthly distribution, the Trust
may from time to time distribute less than the entire amount of income earned in a particular period. The undistributed income would be available to supplement future distributions. As a result, the distributions paid by the Trust for any particular
monthly period may be more or less than the amount of income actually earned by the Trust during that period. Undistributed income will add to the Trusts NAV (and indirectly benefits the Advisor by increasing its fee) and, correspondingly,
distributions from undistributed income will reduce the Trusts NAV. The Trust intends to distribute any long-term capital gains not distributed under the Distribution Plan annually. |
|
Under normal market conditions, the Advisors seek to manage the Trust in a manner such that the Trusts distributions are reflective of the Trusts current and projected income and gains. The distribution
level of the Trust is subject to change based upon a number of factors, including the current and projected level of the Trusts income and gains, and may fluctuate over time. |
|
The Trusts Board may amend, suspend or terminate the Distribution Plan at any time without prior notice to the Trusts shareholders if it deems such |
- 3 -
actions to be in the best interests of the Trust or its shareholders. See
Distributions.
|
Shareholders will automatically have all dividends and distributions reinvested in common shares of the Trust in accordance with the Trusts dividend reinvestment plan, unless an election is made to receive cash by contacting the
Reinvestment Plan Agent (as defined herein), at (800) 699-1236. See Dividend Reinvestment Plan. |
Listing |
The Trusts common shares are listed on the NYSE under the symbol BLW. See Description of SharesCommon Shares. |
Custodian and Transfer Agent |
State Street Bank and Trust Company serves as the Trusts custodian, and Computershare Trust Company, N.A. serves as the Trusts transfer agent. |
Administrator |
State Street Bank and Trust Company serves as the Trusts administrator and fund accountant. |
Market Price of Shares |
Common shares of closed-end investment companies frequently trade at prices lower than their NAV. The Trust cannot assure you that its common shares will trade at a price higher than or equal to NAV. See
Use of Proceeds. The Trusts common shares trade in the open market at market prices that are a function of several factors, including dividend levels (which are in turn affected by expenses), NAV, call protection for portfolio
securities, portfolio credit quality, liquidity, dividend stability, relative demand for and supply of the common shares in the market, general market and economic conditions and other factors. See Leverage, Risks,
Description of Shares and Repurchase of Common Shares. The common shares are designed primarily for long-term investors and you should not purchase common shares of the Trust if you intend to sell them shortly after purchase.
|
Special Risk Considerations |
An investment in common shares of the Trust involves risk. Please refer to the section of the Trusts most recent annual report on Form N-CSR entitled Investment Objectives, Policies and
RisksRisk Factors, which is incorporated by reference herein, for a discussion of the risks of investing in the Trust. You should carefully consider those risks, which are described in more detail under Risks beginning on
page 49 of this Prospectus, along with additional risks relating to investments in the Trust. |
- 4 -
SUMMARY OF TRUST EXPENSES
|
|
|
|
|
Shareholder Transaction Expenses |
|
|
|
|
Sales load paid by you (as a percentage of offering price)(1) |
|
|
1.00% |
|
Offering expenses borne by the Trust (as a percentage of offering price)(1) |
|
|
0.02% |
|
Dividend reinvestment plan fees |
|
|
$0.02(2) per share for open-market purchases of common shares(2) |
|
Dividend reinvestment plan sale transaction fee |
|
|
$2.50(2) |
|
Estimated Annual Expenses (as a percentage of net assets attributable to common
shares) |
|
|
|
|
Management Fees(3)(4) |
|
|
0.90% |
|
Interest Payments on Borrowed
Funds(5) |
|
|
3.46% |
|
Other Expenses |
|
|
0.11% |
|
Acquired Fund Fees and
Expenses(6) |
|
|
0.01% |
|
Total Annual Expenses |
|
|
4.48% |
|
Fee Waivers(4) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total Annual Expenses after Fee Waivers(4)(6) |
|
|
4.48% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
If the common shares are sold to or through underwriters, the Prospectus Supplement will set forth any
applicable sales load and the estimated offering expenses. Trust shareholders will pay all offering expenses involved with an offering. |
(2) |
The Reinvestment Plan Agents (as defined below under Dividend Reinvestment Plan) fees for the
handling of the reinvestment of dividends will be paid by the Trust. However, you will pay a $0.02 per share fee incurred in connection with open-market purchases, which will be deducted from the value of the dividend. You will also be charged a
$2.50 sales fee and pay a $0.15 per share fee if you direct the Reinvestment Plan Agent to sell your common shares held in a dividend reinvestment account. Per share fees include any applicable brokerage commissions the Reinvestment Plan Agent is
required to pay. |
(3) |
The Trust currently pays the Advisor a monthly fee at an annual contractual investment management fee rate of
0.55% of the average weekly value of the Trusts Managed Assets, plus the proceeds of ay debt securities or outstanding borrowings used for leverage. |
(4) |
The Trust and the Advisor have entered into a fee waiver agreement (the Fee Waiver Agreement),
pursuant to which the Advisor has contractually agreed to waive the management fee with respect to any portion of the Trusts assets attributable to investments in any equity and fixed-income mutual funds and exchange-traded funds
(ETFs) managed by the Advisor or its affiliates that have a contractual management fee, through June 30, 2026. In addition, pursuant to the Fee Waiver Agreement, the Advisor has contractually agreed to waive its management fees by
the amount of investment advisory fees the Trust pays to the Advisor indirectly through its investment in money market funds managed by the Advisor or its affiliates, through June 30, 2026. The Fee Waiver Agreement may be terminated at any
time, without the payment of any penalty, only by the Trust (upon the vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as defined in the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the Investment Company
Act), of the Trust (the Independent Trustees)) or a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Trust), upon 90 days written notice by the Trust to the Advisor. |
(5) |
The Trust uses leverage in the form of reverse repurchase agreements representing 39.6% of Managed Assets at an
annual interest expense to the Trust of 5.42%, which is based on current market conditions. The actual amount of interest expense borne by the Trust will vary over time in accordance with the level of the Trusts use of reverse repurchase
agreements and variations. |
(6) |
The total annual expenses do not correlate to the ratios to average net assets shown in the Trusts
Financial Highlights for the year ended December 31, 2024, which do not include acquired fund fees and expenses. |
The following
example illustrates the expenses (including the sales load of $10.00 and offering costs of $0.19) that you would pay on a $1,000 investment in common shares, assuming (i) total net annual expenses of 4.48% of net assets attributable to common
shares, and (ii) a 5% annual return:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
One Year |
|
|
Three Years |
|
|
Five Years |
|
|
Ten Years |
|
Total expenses incurred |
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
55 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
144 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
234 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
465 |
|
The example should not be considered a representation of future expenses. The example assumes that the Other
Expenses set forth in the Estimated Annual Expenses table are accurate and that all dividends and distributions are reinvested at NAV. Actual expenses may be greater or less than those assumed. Moreover, the Trusts actual rate of return
may be greater or less than the hypothetical 5% return shown in the example.
- 5 -
FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
The financial highlights table is intended to help you understand the Trusts financial performance for the periods presented. Certain information
reflects financial results for a single common share of the Trust. The information for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2024, 2023, 2022, 2021 and 2020 has been audited by [ ], independent registered public accounting firm for the
Trust. The report of [ ] is included in the Trusts December 31, 2024 annual report, is incorporated by reference into the Prospectus and SAI and can be obtained by shareholders. The information in the table below for the fiscal
period ended December 31, 20191 and the fiscal years ended August 31, 2019, 2018, 2017, 2016 and 2015 is derived from the Trusts financial statements for the fiscal period ended
December 31, 2019. The Trusts financial statements are included in the Trusts annual report and are incorporated by reference into the Prospectus and SAI.
1 Following the Trusts fiscal year ended August 31, 2019, the Trust changed its fiscal year
end from August 31 to December 31.
(For a share outstanding throughout each period)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
BLW |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/24 |
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/23 |
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/22 |
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/21 |
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/20 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net asset value, beginning of year |
|
|
$14.11 |
|
|
|
$13.51 |
|
|
|
$16.44 |
|
|
|
$16.93 |
|
|
|
$17.05 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net investment income(a) |
|
|
1.14 |
|
|
|
1.11 |
|
|
|
0.97 |
|
|
|
1.00 |
|
|
|
0.98 |
|
Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) |
|
|
0.12 |
|
|
|
0.70 |
|
|
|
(2.82) |
|
|
|
(0.31) |
|
|
|
0.08 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net increase (decrease) from investment operations |
|
|
1.26 |
|
|
|
1.81 |
|
|
|
(1.85) |
|
|
|
0.69 |
|
|
|
1.06 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Distributions(b) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
From net investment income |
|
|
(1.18) |
|
|
|
(1.07) |
|
|
|
(0.92) |
|
|
|
(1.02) |
|
|
|
(1.03) |
|
Return of capital |
|
|
(0.15) |
|
|
|
(0.14) |
|
|
|
(0.16) |
|
|
|
(0.16) |
|
|
|
(0.15) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total distributions |
|
|
(1.33) |
|
|
|
(1.21) |
|
|
|
(1.08) |
|
|
|
(1.18) |
|
|
|
(1.18) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net asset value, end of year |
|
|
$14.04 |
|
|
|
$14.11 |
|
|
|
$13.51 |
|
|
|
$16.44 |
|
|
|
$16.93 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Market price, end of year |
|
|
$14.13 |
|
|
|
$13.98 |
|
|
|
$13.07 |
|
|
|
$16.85 |
|
|
|
$15.92 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total Return(c) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Based on net asset value |
|
|
9.34% |
|
|
|
14.41% |
|
|
|
(10.96)% |
|
|
|
4.18%(d) |
|
|
|
7.58% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Based on market price |
|
|
11.06% |
|
|
|
17.17% |
|
|
|
(15.96)% |
|
|
|
13.55% |
|
|
|
5.24% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Ratios to Average Net Assets(e) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total expenses |
|
|
4.47% |
|
|
|
3.64% |
|
|
|
2.04% |
|
|
|
1.18% |
|
|
|
1.39% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total expenses after fees waived and/or reimbursed |
|
|
4.47% |
|
|
|
3.64% |
|
|
|
2.04% |
|
|
|
1.18% |
|
|
|
1.39% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total expenses after fees waived and/or reimbursed and excluding interest expense |
|
|
1.01% |
|
|
|
0.94% |
|
|
|
0.96% |
|
|
|
0.92% |
|
|
|
0.90% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net investment income |
|
|
8.13% |
|
|
|
8.10% |
|
|
|
6.70% |
|
|
|
5.90% |
|
|
|
6.07% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Supplemental Data |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net assets, end of year (000) |
|
|
$514,291 |
|
|
|
$503,770 |
|
|
|
$482,587 |
|
|
|
$587,146 |
|
|
|
$603,933 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Borrowings outstanding, end of year (000) |
|
|
$337,676 |
|
|
|
$276,235 |
|
|
|
$275,639 |
|
|
|
$312,356 |
|
|
|
$275,105 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Portfolio turnover rate(f) |
|
|
95% |
|
|
|
106% |
|
|
|
77% |
|
|
|
66% |
|
|
|
65% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(a) |
Based on average shares outstanding. |
|
(b) |
Distributions for annual periods determined in accordance with U.S. federal income tax regulations. |
|
(c) |
Total returns based on market price, which can be significantly greater or less than the net asset value, may result in
substantially different returns. Where applicable, excludes the effects of any sales charges and assumes the reinvestment of distributions at actual reinvestment prices. |
- 6 -
|
(d) |
Includes payment from an affiliate, which had no impact on the Funds total return. |
|
(e) |
Excludes fees and expenses incurred indirectly as a result of investments in underlying funds. |
|
(f) |
Includes mortgage dollar roll transactions (MDRs). Additional information regarding portfolio turnover
rate is as follows: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/24 |
|
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/23 |
|
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/22 |
|
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/21 |
|
|
|
Year Ended 12/31/20 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Portfolio turnover rate (excluding MDRs) |
|
|
75% |
|
|
|
70% |
|
|
|
58% |
|
|
|
52% |
|
|
|
58% |
|
- 7 -
(For a share outstanding throughout each period)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
BLW |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Period from 09/01/19 to 12/31/19 |
|
|
Year Ended August 31, |
|
|
|
2019 |
|
|
2018 |
|
|
2017 |
|
|
2016 |
|
|
2015 (a) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net asset value, beginning of period |
|
$ |
17.03 |
|
|
$ |
16.71 |
|
|
$ |
17.02 |
|
|
$ |
16.84 |
|
|
$ |
17.04 |
|
|
$ |
18.09 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net investment income(b) |
|
|
0.31 |
|
|
|
0.94 |
|
|
|
0.95 |
|
|
|
1.01 |
|
|
|
1.32 |
|
|
|
1.16 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) |
|
|
0.18 |
|
|
|
0.33 |
|
|
|
(0.31 |
) |
|
|
0.44 |
|
|
|
(0.22 |
) |
|
|
(0.92 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net increase from investment operations |
|
|
0.49 |
|
|
|
1.27 |
|
|
|
0.64 |
|
|
|
1.45 |
|
|
|
1.10 |
|
|
|
0.24 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Distributions from net investment income(c) |
|
|
(0.47 |
) |
|
|
(0.95 |
) |
|
|
(0.95 |
) |
|
|
(1.27 |
) |
|
|
(1.30 |
) |
|
|
(1.29 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net asset value, end of period |
|
$ |
17.05 |
|
|
$ |
17.03 |
|
|
$ |
16.71 |
|
|
$ |
17.02 |
|
|
$ |
16.84 |
|
|
$ |
17.04 |
(d) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Market price, end of period |
|
$ |
16.39 |
|
|
$ |
15.44 |
|
|
$ |
15.06 |
|
|
$ |
15.99 |
|
|
$ |
15.74 |
|
|
$ |
14.60 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total Return(e) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Based on net asset value |
|
|
3.11 |
%(f) |
|
|
8.77 |
% |
|
|
4.42 |
% |
|
|
9.62 |
% |
|
|
7.78 |
% |
|
|
2.23 |
%(d) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Based on market price |
|
|
9.32 |
%(f) |
|
|
9.41 |
% |
|
|
0.18 |
% |
|
|
10.18 |
% |
|
|
17.59 |
% |
|
|
(5.74 |
)% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Ratios to Average Net Assets(g) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total expenses |
|
|
1.64 |
%(h)(i) |
|
|
1.81 |
% |
|
|
1.73 |
% |
|
|
1.45 |
% |
|
|
1.21 |
% |
|
|
1.15 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total expenses after fees waived and/or reimbursed |
|
|
1.64 |
%(h)(i) |
|
|
1.81 |
% |
|
|
1.73 |
% |
|
|
1.45 |
% |
|
|
1.21 |
% |
|
|
1.15 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total expenses after fees waived and/or reimbursed and excluding interest expense |
|
|
0.89 |
%(h) |
|
|
0.84 |
% |
|
|
0.89 |
% |
|
|
0.89 |
% |
|
|
0.89 |
% |
|
|
0.92 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net investment income |
|
|
5.32 |
%(h) |
|
|
5.69 |
% |
|
|
5.60 |
% |
|
|
6.00 |
% |
|
|
8.04 |
% |
|
|
6.65 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Supplemental Data |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net assets, end of period (000) |
|
$ |
611,068 |
|
|
$ |
610,251 |
|
|
$ |
612,048 |
|
|
$ |
629,728 |
|
|
$ |
623,219 |
|
|
$ |
630,388 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Borrowings outstanding, end of period (000) |
|
$ |
213,399 |
|
|
$ |
202,539 |
|
|
$ |
234,622 |
|
|
$ |
252,280 |
|
|
$ |
263,445 |
|
|
$ |
264,036 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Portfolio turnover rate |
|
|
14 |
% |
|
|
50 |
% |
|
|
50 |
% |
|
|
55 |
% |
|
|
54 |
% |
|
|
47 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(a) |
Consolidated Financial Highlights. |
(b) |
Based on average shares outstanding. |
(c) |
Distributions for annual periods determined in accordance with U.S. federal income tax regulations. |
(d) |
For financial reporting purposes, the market value of certain investments were adjusted as of report date. Accordingly,
the net asset value per share and total return performance presented herein are different than the information previously published on August 31, 2015. |
(e) |
Total returns based on market price, which can be significantly greater or less than the net asset value, may result in
substantially different returns. Where applicable, excludes the effects of any sales charges and assumes the reinvestment of distributions at actual reinvestment prices. |
(f) |
Aggregate total return. |
(g) |
Excludes expenses incurred indirectly as a result of investments in underlying funds as follows: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Period from 09/01/19 to 12/31/19 |
|
|
Year Ended August 31, |
|
|
|
2019 |
|
|
2018 |
|
|
2017 |
|
|
2016 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investments in underlying funds |
|
|
0.02 |
% |
|
|
0.02 |
% |
|
|
|
% |
|
|
|
% |
|
|
|
% |
|
|
|
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(i) |
Audit costs were not annualized in the calculation of the expense ratios. If these expenses were annualized, the total
expenses and total expenses after fees waived and/or reimbursed would have been 1.66%. |
- 8 -
USE OF PROCEEDS
The net proceeds from the issuance of common shares hereunder will be invested in accordance with the Trusts investment objective and policies as stated
below. We currently anticipate that we will be able to invest all of the net proceeds in accordance with our investment objective and policies within approximately three months from the date on which the proceeds from an offering are received by the
Trust. Pending such investment, it is anticipated that the proceeds will be invested in short-term, tax-exempt or taxable investment grade securities or in high quality, short-term money market instruments.
THE TRUST
The Trust is a diversified, closed-end management investment company registered under the Investment Company Act. The
Trust was formed as a Delaware statutory trust on May 16, 2003, pursuant to an Agreement and Declaration of Trust, as subsequently amended and restated, governed by the laws of the State of Delaware and the Certificate of Trust filed with the
Secretary of State of the State of Delaware. The Trusts principal office is located at 100 Bellevue Parkway, Wilmington, Delaware 19809, and its telephone number is (800) 882-0052.
The Trust commenced operations on July 30, 2003, upon the initiation of an initial public offering of 34,300,000 of its common shares. The proceeds of
such offering were approximately $653.758 million after the payment of organizational and offering expenses. The Trusts common shares are traded on the NYSE under the symbol BLW.
DESCRIPTION OF SHARES
Common Shares
The Trust is a statutory trust formed
under the laws of Delaware and governed by an Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust dated as of June 10, 2003 (the Agreement and Declaration of Trust). The Trust is authorized to issue an unlimited number of
common shares of beneficial interest, par value $0.001 per share. Each common share has one vote and, when issued and paid for in accordance with the terms of this offering, will be fully paid and, under the Delaware Statutory Trust Act, the
purchasers of the common shares will have no obligation to make further payments for the purchase of the common shares or contributions to the Trust solely by reason of their ownership of the common shares, except that the Trustees shall have the
power to cause shareholders to pay certain expenses of the Trust by setting off charges due from shareholders from declared but unpaid dividends or distributions owed the shareholders and/or by reducing the number of common shares owned by each
respective shareholder. When preferred shares are outstanding, the holders of common shares will not be entitled to receive any distributions from the Trust unless all accrued dividends on preferred shares have been paid, unless asset coverage (as
defined in the Investment Company Act) with respect to preferred shares would be at least 200% after giving effect to the distributions and unless certain other requirements imposed by any rating agencies rating the preferred shares have been met.
See Description of SharesPreferred Shares in the SAI. All common shares are equal as to dividends, assets and voting privileges and have no conversion, preemptive or other subscription rights. The Trust will send annual and
semi-annual reports, including financial statements, to all holders of its shares.
Unlike open-end funds, closed-end funds like the Trust do not continuously offer shares and do not provide daily redemptions. Rather, if a shareholder determines to buy additional common shares or sell shares already held, the shareholder
may do so by trading through a broker on the NYSE or otherwise. Shares of closed-end investment companies frequently trade on an exchange at prices lower than NAV. Shares of
closed-end investment companies like the Trust have during some periods traded at prices higher than NAV and during other periods have traded at prices lower than NAV. Because the market value of the common
shares may be influenced by such factors as dividend levels (which are in turn affected by expenses), call protection on its portfolio securities, dividend stability, portfolio credit quality, the Trusts NAV, relative demand for and supply of
such shares in the market, general market and economic conditions and other factors beyond the control of the Trust, the Trust cannot assure you that its common shares will trade at a price equal to or higher than NAV in the future. The common
shares are designed primarily for long-term investors and you should not purchase the common shares if you intend to sell them soon after purchase. See Repurchase of Common Shares below and Repurchase of Common Shares in the
SAI.
- 9 -
The Trusts outstanding common shares are, and when issued, the common shares offered by this Prospectus
will be, publicly held and listed and traded on the NYSE under the symbol BLW. The Trust determines its NAV on a daily basis. The following table sets forth, for the quarters indicated, the highest and lowest daily closing prices on the
NYSE per common share, and the NAV per common share and the premium to or discount from NAV, on the date of each of the high and low market prices. The table also sets forth the number of common shares traded on the NYSE during the respective
quarters.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
During Quarter Ended |
|
NYSE Market Price Per Common Share |
|
NAV per Common Share on Date of Market Price |
|
Premium/ (Discount) on Date of Market Price |
|
|
Trading Volume |
|
High |
|
Low |
|
High |
|
Low |
|
High |
|
|
Low |
|
|
|
March 31, 2025 |
|
$[●] |
|
$[●] |
|
$[●] |
|
$[●] |
|
|
[●]% |
|
|
|
[●]% |
|
|
[●] |
December 31, 2024 |
|
$14.51 |
|
$13.98 |
|
$14.31 |
|
$13.99 |
|
|
1.40% |
|
|
|
(0.07)% |
|
|
[●] |
September 30, 2024 |
|
$14.61 |
|
$13.87 |
|
$14.33 |
|
$13.96 |
|
|
1.95% |
|
|
|
(0.64)% |
|
|
[●] |
June 30, 2024 |
|
$14.05 |
|
$13.30 |
|
$14.05 |
|
$13.83 |
|
|
0.00% |
|
|
|
(3.83)% |
|
|
[●] |
March 31, 2024 |
|
$14.22 |
|
$13.56 |
|
$14.12 |
|
$13.97 |
|
|
0.71% |
|
|
|
(2.93)% |
|
|
[●] |
December 31, 2023 |
|
$13.98 |
|
$12.38 |
|
$14.11 |
|
$13.23 |
|
|
(0.92)% |
|
|
|
(6.42)% |
|
|
[●] |
September 30, 2023 |
|
$13.29 |
|
$12.73 |
|
$13.74 |
|
$13.51 |
|
|
(3.28)% |
|
|
|
(5.77)% |
|
|
[●] |
June 30, 2023 |
|
$13.25 |
|
$12.46 |
|
$13.78 |
|
$13.41 |
|
|
(3.85)% |
|
|
|
(7.08)% |
|
|
[●] |
As of [●], 2025, the NAV per common share of the Trust was $[●] and the market price per common share was
$[●], representing a [premium/discount] to NAV of [●]%. Common shares of the Trust have historically traded at both a premium and discount to NAV.
As of [●], 2025, the Trust has [●] common shares outstanding.
Preferred Shares
The Agreement and Declaration of Trust
provides that the Board may authorize and issue preferred shares, with rights as determined by the Board, by action of the Board without the approval of the holders of the common shares. Holders of common shares have no preemptive right to purchase
any preferred shares that might be issued. The Trust does not currently intend to issue preferred shares. Under the Investment Company Act, the Trust is not permitted to issue preferred shares unless immediately after such issuance the value of the
Trusts total assets is at least 200% of the liquidation value of the outstanding preferred shares (i.e., the liquidation value may not exceed 50% of the Trusts total assets). In addition, the Trust is not permitted to declare any
cash dividend or other distribution on its common shares unless, at the time of such declaration, the value of the Trusts total assets is at least 200% of such liquidation value. If the Trust issues preferred shares, it may be subject to
restrictions imposed by the guidelines of one or more rating agencies that may issue ratings for preferred shares issued by the Trust. These guidelines may impose asset coverage or portfolio composition requirements that are more stringent than
those imposed on the Trust by the Investment Company Act. It is not anticipated that these covenants or guidelines would impede the Advisors from managing the Trusts portfolio in accordance with the Trusts investment objective and
policies. Please see Description of Shares in the SAI for more information.
Authorized Shares
The following table provides the Trusts authorized shares and common shares outstanding as of March 18, 2025.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Title of Class |
|
Amount Authorized |
|
Amount Held by Trust or for its Account |
|
|
Amount Outstanding Exclusive of Amount held by Trust |
|
Common Shares |
|
Unlimited |
|
|
0 |
|
|
|
37,849,616 |
|
- 10 -
THE TRUSTS INVESTMENTS
Investment Objective and Policies
Please refer to the
section of the Trusts most recent annual report on Form N-CSR entitled Investment Objectives, Policies and RisksInvestment Objectives and PoliciesBlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust
(BLW), which is incorporated by reference herein, for a discussion of the Trusts investment objective and policies.
Investment Process
In selecting securities for the Trust, the Advisors will seek to identify issuers and industries that the Advisors believe are likely to experience
stable or improving financial conditions. The Advisors analysis will include:
|
|
|
credit research on the issuers financial strength; |
|
|
|
assessment of the issuers ability to meet principal and interest payments; |
|
|
|
general industry trends; |
|
|
|
the issuers managerial strength; |
|
|
|
changing financial conditions; |
|
|
|
borrowing requirements or debt maturity schedules; and |
|
|
|
the issuers responsiveness to changes in business conditions and interest rates. |
The Advisors will consider relative values among issuers based on anticipated cash flow, interest or dividend coverage, asset coverage and earnings prospects.
Using these tools, the Advisors will seek to add consistent value and control performance volatility consistent with the Trusts investment objective and policies. The Advisors believe this strategy should enhance the Trusts ability to
achieve its investment objective. In managing the assets of the Trust, the Advisors will utilize an active management approach that stresses the flexibility to reallocate investments as appropriate. The Advisors will diversify the Trusts
portfolio of assets in an effort to minimize exposure to individual securities, issuers and industries.
The Advisors analysis continues on an
ongoing basis for any securities in which the Trust has invested. Although the Advisors use due care in making such analysis, there can be no assurance that such analysis will reveal factors that may impair the value of such securities.
Portfolio Contents and Techniques
The Trust may invest
in the following instruments and use the following investment techniques, subject to any limitations set forth herein. There is no guarantee the Trust will buy all of the types of securities or use all of the investment techniques that are described
herein.
Corporate Bonds. Corporate bonds are debt obligations issued by corporations. Corporate bonds may be either secured or unsecured.
Collateral used for secured debt includes real property, machinery, equipment, accounts receivable, stocks, bonds or notes. If a bond is unsecured, it is known as a debenture. Bondholders, as creditors, have a prior legal claim over common and
preferred stockholders as to both income and assets of the corporation for the principal and interest due them and may have a prior claim over other creditors if liens or mortgages are involved. Interest on corporate bonds may be fixed or floating,
or the bonds may be zero coupons. Interest on corporate bonds is typically paid semi-annually and is fully taxable to the bondholder. Corporate bonds contain elements of both interest rate risk and credit risk. The market value of a corporate bond
generally may be expected to rise and fall inversely with interest rates and may also be affected by the credit rating of the corporation, the corporations performance and perceptions of the corporation in the marketplace. Corporate bonds
usually yield more than government or agency bonds due to the presence of credit risk.
High Yield Securities (Junk Bonds). The Trust
may invest in securities rated, at the time of investment, below investment grade quality such as those rated Ba or below by Moodys Investors Service, Inc. (Moodys) or BB or below by S&P Global Ratings
(S&P), or securities comparably rated by other rating agencies or in unrated securities determined by the Advisors to be of comparable quality. Such securities, sometimes referred to as high
- 11 -
yield or junk bonds, are predominantly speculative with respect to the capacity to pay interest and repay principal in accordance with the terms of the security and generally
involve greater price volatility than securities in higher rating categories. Often the protection of interest and principal payments with respect to such securities may be very moderate and issuers of such securities face major ongoing
uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial or economic conditions which could lead to inadequate capacity to meet timely interest and principal payments.
Lower grade securities, though high yielding, are characterized by high risk. They may be subject to certain risks with respect to the issuing entity and to
greater market fluctuations than certain lower yielding, higher rated securities. The secondary market for lower grade securities may be less liquid than that of higher rated securities. Adverse conditions could make it difficult at times for the
Trust to sell certain securities or could result in lower prices than those used in calculating the Trusts NAV.
The prices of fixed income
securities generally are inversely related to interest rate changes; however, the price volatility caused by fluctuating interest rates of securities also is inversely related to the coupons of such securities. Accordingly, below investment grade
securities may be relatively less sensitive to interest rate changes than higher quality securities of comparable maturity because of their higher coupon. The investor receives this higher coupon in return for bearing greater credit risk. The higher
credit risk associated with below investment grade securities potentially can have a greater effect on the value of such securities than may be the case with higher quality issues of comparable maturity.
Lower grade securities may be particularly susceptible to economic downturns. It is likely that an economic recession could severely disrupt the market for
such securities and may have an adverse impact on the value of such securities. In addition, it is likely that any such economic downturn could adversely affect the ability of the issuers of such securities to repay principal and pay interest
thereon and increase the incidence of default for such securities.
The ratings of Moodys, S&P and other rating agencies represent their
opinions as to the quality of the obligations which they undertake to rate. Ratings are relative and subjective and, although ratings may be useful in evaluating the safety of interest and principal payments, they do not evaluate the market value
risk of such obligations. Although these ratings may be an initial criterion for selection of portfolio investments, the Advisors also will independently evaluate these securities and the ability of the issuers of such securities to pay interest and
principal. To the extent that the Trust invests in lower grade securities that have not been rated by a rating agency, the Trusts ability to achieve its investment objective will be more dependent on the Advisors credit analysis than
would be the case when the Trust invests in rated securities.
Distressed and Defaulted Securities. The Trust may invest in securities of
financially distressed and bankrupt issuers, including debt obligations that are in covenant or payment default. Such investments generally trade significantly below par and are considered speculative. The repayment of defaulted obligations is
subject to significant uncertainties. Defaulted obligations might be repaid only after lengthy workout or bankruptcy proceedings, during which the issuer might not make any interest or other payments. Typically such workout or bankruptcy proceedings
result in only partial recovery of cash payments or an exchange of the defaulted obligation for other debt or equity securities of the issuer or its affiliates, which may in turn be illiquid or speculative.
Senior Loans. The senior loans in which the Trust invests may consist of direct obligations of a borrower undertaken to finance the growth of the
borrowers business, internally or externally, or to finance a capital restructuring. Senior loans may also include debtor in possession financings pursuant to Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code and obligations of a borrower issued in
connection with a restructuring pursuant to Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. A significant portion of such senior loans are highly leveraged loans such as leveraged buy-out loans, leveraged
recapitalization loans and other types of acquisition loans. Such senior loans may be structured to include both term loans, which are generally fully funded at the time of the Trusts investment, and revolving credit facilities or delayed draw
term loans, which would require the Trust to make additional investments in the senior loans as required under the terms of the credit facility. Such senior loans may also include receivables purchase facilities, which are similar to revolving
credit facilities secured by a borrowers receivables, senior loans designed to provide bridge financing to a borrower pending the sale of identified assets or the arrangement of longer-term loans or the issuance and sale of debt
obligations or senior loans of borrowers that have obtained bridge loans from other parties. Senior loans generally are issued in the form of senior syndicated loans, but the Trust also may invest from time to time in privately placed notes, credit
linked notes, structured notes or other instruments with
- 12 -
credit and pricing terms which are, in the opinion of the Advisors, consistent with investments in senior loan obligations.
The senior loans in which the Trust invests typically have stated maturities ranging from five to nine years, though such stated maturities could vary from
this range and the Trust is not subject to any restrictions with respect to the maturity of senior loans held in its portfolio. As a result, as short-term interest rates increase, interest payable to the Trust from its investments in senior loans
should increase, and as short-term interest rates decrease, interest payable to the Trust from its investments in senior loans should decrease. Because of prepayments, the Advisors expect the average life of the senior loans in which the Trust
invests to be shorter than the stated maturity.
The senior loans in which the Trust invests generally hold a senior position in the capital structure of
the borrower. Such loans may include loans that hold the most senior position, loans that hold an equal ranking with other senior debt, or loans that are, in the judgment of the Advisors, in the category of senior debt. A senior position in the
borrowers capital structure generally gives the holder of the senior loan a claim on some or all of the borrowers assets that is senior to that of subordinated debt, preferred stock and common stock in the event the borrower defaults or
becomes bankrupt. The senior loans in which the Trust invests may be wholly or partially secured by collateral, or may be unsecured. In the event of a default, the ability of an investor to have access to any collateral may be limited by bankruptcy
and other insolvency laws. The value of the collateral also may decline subsequent to the Trusts investment in the senior loan. Under certain circumstances, the collateral may be released with the consent of the Agent Bank and Co-Lenders (each as defined below), or pursuant to the terms of the underlying credit agreement with the borrower. There is no assurance that the liquidation of the collateral will satisfy the borrowers
obligation in the event of nonpayment of scheduled interest or principal, or that the collateral could be readily liquidated. As a result, the Trust might not receive payments to which it is entitled and thereby may experience a decline in the value
of the investment, and possibly, its NAV.
In the case of highly leveraged senior loans, a borrower is often required to pledge collateral that may
include (i) working capital assets, such as accounts receivable and inventory, (ii) tangible fixed assets, such as real property, buildings and equipment, (iii) intangible assets, such as trademarks, copyrights and patent rights
and/or (iv) security interests in securities of subsidiaries or affiliates. Collateral also may include guarantees or other credit support by subsidiaries or affiliates. In some cases the only collateral for the senior loan is the stock of the
borrower and/or its subsidiaries and affiliates. To the extent a senior loan is secured by stock of the borrower and/or its subsidiaries and affiliates, such stock may lose all of its value in the event of a bankruptcy or insolvency of the borrower.
In the case of senior loans to privately held companies, the companies owners may provide additional credit support in the form of guarantees and/or pledges of other securities that they own.
In the case of project finance loans, the borrower is generally a special purpose entity that pledges undeveloped land and other non-income producing assets as collateral and obtains construction completion guaranties from third parties, such as the project sponsor. Project finance credit facilities typically provide for payment of interest
from escrowed funds during a scheduled construction period, and for the pledge of current and fixed assets after the project is constructed and becomes operational. During the construction period, however, the lenders bear the risk that the project
will not be constructed in a timely manner, or will exhaust project funds prior to completion. In such an event, the lenders may need to take legal action to enforce the completion guaranties, or may need to lend more money to the project on less
favorable financing terms, or may need to liquidate the undeveloped project assets. There can be no assurance in any of such cases that the lenders will recover all of their invested capital.
The rate of interest payable on senior floating rate loans is established as the sum of a base lending rate plus a specified margin. These base lending rates
generally are the prime rate (Prime Rate) of a designated U.S. bank, London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR), the Certificate of Deposit (CD) rate or another base lending rate used by commercial lenders. The
interest rate on Prime Rate-based senior loans floats daily as the Prime Rate changes, while the interest rate on LIBOR-based and CD-based senior loans is reset periodically, typically every one, two, three or
six months. Certain of the senior floating rate loans in which the Trust invests permit the borrower to select an interest rate reset period of up to one year. A portion of the Trusts portfolio may be invested in senior loans with interest
rates that are fixed for the term of the loan. Investment in senior loans with longer interest rate reset periods or fixed interest rates may increase fluctuations in the Trusts NAV, and potentially the market price of the Trusts common
shares, as a result of changes in interest rates.
- 13 -
The Trust may receive and/or pay certain fees in connection with its lending activities. These fees are in
addition to interest payments received and may include facility fees, commitment fees, amendment and waiver fees, commissions and prepayment fees. In certain circumstances, the Trust may receive a prepayment fee on the prepayment of a senior loan by
a borrower. In connection with the acquisition of senior loans or other debt securities, the Trust also may acquire warrants and other debt and equity securities of the borrower or issuer or its affiliates. The Trust may also acquire other debt and
equity securities of the borrower or issuer in connection with an amendment, waiver, conversion or exchange of a senior loan or in connection with a bankruptcy or workout of the borrower or issuer.
In making an investment in a senior loan, the Advisors will consider factors deemed by it to be appropriate to the analysis of the borrower and the senior
loan. The Advisors perform their own independent credit analysis of the borrower in addition to utilizing information prepared and supplied by the Agent Bank, Co-Lender or Participant (each defined below) from
whom the Trust purchases its interest in a senior loan. Such factors include, but are not limited to, the legal/protective features associated with the securities (such as their position in the borrowers capital structure and any security
through collateral), financial ratios of the borrower such as pre-tax interest coverage, leverage ratios, and the ratios of cash flows to total debts and the ratio of tangible assets to debt. In its analysis
of these factors, the Advisors also will be influenced by the nature of the industry in which the borrower is engaged, the nature of the borrowers assets and the Advisors assessments of the general quality of the borrower. The
Advisors analysis continues on an ongoing basis for any senior loans in which the Trust has invested. Although the Advisors use due care in making such analysis, there can be no assurance that such analysis will disclose factors that may
impair the value of the senior loan.
Senior loans made in connection with highly leveraged transactions are subject to greater credit risks than other
senior loans in which each Trust may invest. These credit risks include a greater possibility of default or bankruptcy of the borrower and the assertion that the pledging of collateral to secure the loan constituted a fraudulent conveyance or
preferential transfer which can be nullified or subordinated to the rights of other creditors of the borrower under applicable law.
Many senior loans in
which the Trust invests may not be rated by a rating agency, are not registered with the SEC, or any state securities commission, and are not listed on any national securities exchange. Borrowers may have outstanding debt obligations that are rated
below investment grade by a rating agency. Many of the senior loans in which the Trust invests will have been assigned below investment grade ratings by independent rating agencies. In the event senior loans are not rated, they are likely to be the
equivalent of below investment grade quality. The Advisors do not view ratings as the determinative factor in its investment decisions and relies more upon its credit analysis abilities than upon ratings.
The Trust has no policy with regard to minimum ratings for senior loans in which it may invest. The Trust may purchase and retain in its portfolio senior
loans where the borrower has experienced, or may be perceived to be likely to experience, credit problems, including involvement in or recent emergence from bankruptcy reorganization proceedings or other forms of debt restructuring. Such investments
may provide opportunities for enhanced income as well as capital appreciation, although they also will be subject to greater risk of loss. At times, in connection with the restructuring of a senior loan either outside of bankruptcy court or in the
context of bankruptcy court proceedings, the Trust may determine or be required to accept equity securities or junior fixed income securities in exchange for all or a portion of a senior loan.
The secondary market for trading of senior loans continues to develop and mature. One of the effects of a more active and liquid secondary market, however, is
that a senior loan may trade at a premium or discount to the principal amount, or par value, of the loan. There are many factors that influence the market value of a senior loan, including technical factors relating to the operation of the loan
market, supply and demand conditions, market perceptions about the credit quality or financial condition of the borrower or more general concerns about the industry in which the borrower operates. The Trust participates in this secondary market for
senior loans, purchasing and selling loans that may trade at a premium or discount to the par value of the loan. However, no active trading market may exist for some senior loans and some loans may be subject to restrictions on resale. A secondary
market may be subject to irregular trading activity, wide bid/ask spreads and extended trade settlement periods, which may impair the ability to realize full value and thus cause a material decline in the Trusts NAV. In addition, the Trust may
not be able to readily dispose of its senior loans at prices that approximate those at which the Trust could sell
- 14 -
such loans if they were more widely-traded and, as a result of such illiquidity, the Trust may have to sell other investments or engage in borrowing transactions if necessary to raise cash to
meet its obligations. During periods of limited supply and liquidity of senior loans, the Trusts yield may be lower.
When interest rates decline,
the value of a fund invested in fixed rate obligations can be expected to rise. Conversely, when interest rates rise, the value of a fund invested in fixed rate obligations can be expected to decline. Although changes in prevailing interest rates
can be expected to cause some fluctuations in the value of floating rate senior loans (due to the fact that floating rates on senior loans only reset periodically), the value of floating rate senior loans is substantially less sensitive to changes
in market interest rates than fixed rate instruments. As a result, to the extent the Trust invests in floating rate senior loans, the Trusts portfolio may be less volatile and less sensitive to changes in market interest rates than if the
Trust invested in fixed rate obligations. Similarly, a sudden and significant increase in market interest rates may cause a decline in the value of these investments and in the Trusts NAV. Other factors (including, but not limited to, rating
downgrades, credit deterioration, a large downward movement in stock prices, a disparity in supply and demand of certain securities or market conditions that reduce liquidity) can reduce the value of senior loans and other debt obligations,
impairing the Trusts NAV.
A borrower must comply with various restrictive covenants contained in any credit agreement between the borrower and the
lending syndicate. Such covenants, in addition to requiring the scheduled payment of interest and principal, may include restrictions on dividend payments and other distributions to stockholders, provisions requiring the borrower to maintain
specific financial ratios or relationships, limits on total debt and restrictions on the borrowers ability to pledge its assets. In addition, the loan agreement may contain a covenant requiring the borrower to prepay the senior loan with any
excess cash flow. Excess cash flow generally includes net cash flow after scheduled debt service payments and permitted capital expenditures, among other things, as well as the proceeds from asset dispositions or sales of securities. A breach of a
covenant (after giving effect to any cure period) which is not waived by the Agent Bank and the lending syndicate normally is an event of default (i.e., the Agent Bank has the right to call the outstanding senior loan).
Senior loans usually require, in addition to scheduled payments of interest and principal, the prepayment of the senior loan from excess cash flow, as
discussed above, and typically permit the borrower to prepay at its election. The degree to which borrowers prepay senior loans, whether as a contractual requirement or at their election, may be affected by general business conditions, the financial
condition of the borrower and competitive conditions among lenders, among other factors. Accordingly, prepayments cannot be predicted with accuracy. Upon a prepayment, the Trust may receive both a prepayment fee from the prepaying borrower and a
facility fee on the purchase of a new senior loan with the proceeds from the prepayment of the former. Such fees may mitigate any adverse impact on the yield on the Trusts portfolio which may arise as a result of prepayments and the
reinvestment of such proceeds in senior loans bearing lower interest rates.
A senior loan in which the Trust may invest typically is originated,
negotiated and structured by a syndicate of lenders (Co-Lenders) consisting of commercial banks, thrift institutions, insurance companies, finance companies, investment banking firms, securities
brokerage houses or other financial institutions or institutional investors, one or more of which administers the loan on behalf of the syndicate (the Agent Bank). Co-Lenders may sell senior loans
to third parties (Participants). The Trust invests in a senior loan either by participating in the primary distribution as a Co-Lender at the time the loan is originated or by buying an assignment
or participation interest in the senior loan in the secondary market from a Co-Lender or a Participant.
The Trust
may invest in a senior loan at origination as a Co-Lender or by acquiring an assignment or participation interest in the secondary market from a Co-Lender or
Participant. If the Trust purchases an assignment, the Trust typically accepts all of the rights of the assigning lender in a senior loan, including the right to receive payments of principal and interest and other amounts directly from the borrower
and to enforce its rights as a lender directly against the borrower and assumes all of the obligations of the assigning lender, including any obligations to make future advances to the borrower. As a result, therefore, the Trust has the status of a Co-Lender. In some cases, the rights and obligations acquired by a purchaser of an assignment may differ from, and may be more limited than, the rights and obligations of the assigning lender. The Trust also may
purchase a participation in a portion of the rights of a Co-Lender or Participant in a senior loan by means of a participation agreement. A participation is similar to an assignment in that the Co-Lender or Participant transfers to the Trust all or a portion of an interest in a senior loan. Unlike an assignment, however, a participation does not establish any direct relationship between the Trust and the
- 15 -
borrower. In such a case, the Trust is required to rely on the Co-Lender or Participant that sold the participation not only for the enforcement of the
Trusts rights against the borrower but also for the receipt and processing of payments due to the Trust under the senior loans.
Because it may be
necessary to assert through a Co-Lender or Participant such rights as may exist against the borrower, in the event the borrower fails to pay principal and interest when due, the Trust may be subject to delays,
expenses and risks that are greater than those that would be involved if the Trust could enforce its rights directly against the borrower. Moreover, under the terms of a participation, the Trust may be regarded as a creditor of the Co-Lender or Participant that sold the participation (rather than of the borrower), so that the Trust may also be subject to the risk that the Co-Lender or Participant may
become insolvent. Similar risks may arise with respect to the Agent Bank, as described below. Further, in the event of the bankruptcy or insolvency of the borrower, the obligation of the borrower to repay the senior loan may be subject to certain
defenses that can be asserted by such borrower as a result of improper conduct by the Agent Bank, Co-Lender or Participant.
In a typical senior loan, the Agent Bank administers the terms of the credit agreement and is responsible for the collection of principal and interest and fee
payments from the borrower and the apportionment of these payments to the credit of all lenders which are parties to the credit agreement. The Trust generally relies on the Agent Bank (or the Co-Lender or
Participant that sold the Trust a participation interest) to collect its portion of the payments on the senior loan. Furthermore, the Trust generally relies on the Agent Bank to use appropriate creditor remedies against the borrower. Typically,
under credit agreements, the Agent Bank is given broad discretion in enforcing the credit agreement, and is obligated to use only the same care it would use in the management of its own property. The borrower compensates the Agent Bank for these
services. Such compensation may include special fees paid on structuring and funding the senior loan and other fees paid on a continuing basis.
In the
event that an Agent Bank becomes insolvent, or has a receiver, conservator, or similar official appointed for it by the appropriate bank regulatory authority or becomes a debtor in a bankruptcy proceeding, assets held by the Agent Bank under the
credit agreement should remain available to holders of senior loans.
If, however, assets held by the Agent Bank for the benefit of the Trust were
determined by an appropriate regulatory authority or court to be subject to the claims of the Agent Banks general or secured creditors, the Trust might incur certain costs and delays in realizing payment on a senior loan or suffer a loss of
principal and/or interest. In situations involving a Co-Lender or Participant that sold the Trust a participation interest, similar risks may arise, as described above.
The Trust may have certain obligations pursuant to a credit agreement, which may include the obligation to make future advances to the borrower in connection
with revolving credit facilities in certain circumstances. These commitments may have the effect of requiring the Trust to increase its investment in a borrower at a time it might not be desirable to do so (including at a time when the
borrowers financial condition makes it unlikely that such amounts will be repaid). The Trust currently intends to reserve against such contingent obligations by designating sufficient investments in liquid assets on its books and records.
The Trust may obtain exposure to senior loans through the use of derivative instruments, which have recently become increasingly available. The Advisors may
utilize these instruments and similar instruments that may be available in the future. The Trust may invest in a derivative instrument known as a Select Aggregate Market Index (SAMI), which provides investors with exposure to a reference
basket of senior loans. SAMIs are structured as floating rate instruments. SAMIs consist of a basket of credit default swaps whose underlying reference securities are senior secured loans. While investing in SAMIs will increase the universe of
floating rate fixed income securities to which the Trust is exposed, such investments entail risks that are not typically associated with investments in other floating rate fixed income securities. The liquidity of the market for SAMIs will be
subject to liquidity in the secured loan and credit derivatives markets. Investment in SAMIs involves many of the risks associated with investments in derivative instruments discussed generally herein.
Second Lien Loans. The Trust may invest in second lien or other subordinated or unsecured floating rate and fixed rate loans or debt. Second
lien loans have the same characteristics as senior loans except that such loans are second in lien property rather than first. Second lien loans typically have adjustable floating rate interest payments. Accordingly, the risks associated with second
lien loans are higher than the risk of loans with first priority over the
- 16 -
collateral. In the event of default on a second lien loan, the first priority lien holder has first claim to the underlying collateral of the loan. It is possible that no collateral value would
remain for the second priority lien holder, which may result in a loss of investment to the Trust.
Mezzanine Loans. The Trust may invest in
mezzanine loans. Structurally, mezzanine loans usually rank subordinate in priority of payment to senior debt, such as senior bank debt, and are often unsecured. However, mezzanine loans rank senior to common and preferred equity in a
borrowers capital structure. Mezzanine debt is often used in leveraged buyout and real estate finance transactions. Typically, mezzanine loans have elements of both debt and equity instruments, offering the fixed returns in the form of
interest payments associated with senior debt, while providing lenders an opportunity to participate in the capital appreciation of a borrower, if any, through an equity interest. This equity interest typically takes the form of warrants. Due to
their higher risk profile and often less restrictive covenants as compared to senior loans, mezzanine loans generally earn a higher return than senior secured loans. The warrants associated with mezzanine loans are typically detachable, which allows
lenders to receive repayment of their principal on an agreed amortization schedule while retaining their equity interest in the borrower. Mezzanine loans also may include a put feature, which permits the holder to sell its equity
interest back to the borrower at a price determined through an agreed-upon formula. Mezzanine investments may be issued with or without registration rights. Similar to other high yield securities, maturities of mezzanine investments are typically
seven to ten years, but the expected average life is significantly shorter at three to five years; however, maturities and expected average lives could vary from these ranges and the Trust is not subject to any restrictions with respect to the
maturities or expected average lives of mezzanine loans held in its portfolio. Mezzanine investments are usually unsecured and subordinate to other obligations of the issuer.
Debtor-In-Possession Financings. The Trust may invest in debtor-in-possession or DIP financings newly issued in connection with special situation restructuring and refinancing transactions. DIP
financings are loans to a debtor-in-possession in a proceeding under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code that has been approved by the bankruptcy court. These financings allow the
entity to continue its business operations while reorganizing under Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. DIP financings are typically fully secured by a lien on the debtors otherwise unencumbered assets or secured by a junior lien on the
debtors encumbered assets (so long as the loan is fully secured based on the most recent current valuation or appraisal report of the debtor). DIP financings are often required to close with certainty and in a rapid manner in order to satisfy
existing creditors and to enable the issuer to emerge from bankruptcy or to avoid a bankruptcy proceeding.
Mortgage Related
Securities. Mortgage-backed securities (MBS) include structured debt obligations collateralized by pools of commercial (CMBS) or residential (RMBS) mortgages. Pools of mortgage loans and mortgage-backed
loans, such as mezzanine loans, are assembled as securities for sale to investors by various governmental, government-related and private organizations. MBS include complex instruments such as collateralized mortgage obligations (CMOs),
stripped MBS, mortgage pass-through securities and interests in Real Estate Mortgage Investment Conduits (REMICs). The MBS in which the Trust may invest include those with fixed, floating or variable interest rates, those with interest
rates that change based on multiples of changes in a specified reference interest rate or index of interest rates and those with interest rates that change inversely to changes in interest rates, as well as those that do not bear interest. The Trust
may invest in RMBS and CMBS issued by governmental entities and private issuers, including subordinated MBS and residual interests. The Trust may invest in sub-prime mortgages or MBS that are backed by sub-prime mortgages.
In general, losses on a mortgaged property securing a mortgage loan included in a securitization
will be borne first by the equity holder of the property, then by a cash reserve fund or letter of credit, if any, then by the holder of a mezzanine loan or B-Note, if any, then by the first loss
subordinated security holder (generally, the B-Piece buyer) and then by the holder of a higher rated security. The Trust may invest in any class of security included in a securitization. In the
event of default and the exhaustion of any equity support, reserve fund, letter of credit, mezzanine loans or B-Notes, and any classes of securities junior to those in which the Trust invests, the Trust will
not be able to recover all of its investment in the MBS it purchases. MBS in which the Trust invests may not contain reserve funds, letters of credit, mezzanine loans and/or junior classes of securities. The prices of lower credit quality securities
are generally less sensitive to interest rate changes than more highly rated investments, but more sensitive to adverse economic downturns or individual issuer developments.
- 17 -
Mortgage Pass-Through Securities. Mortgage pass-through securities differ from other
forms of fixed income securities, which normally provide for periodic payment of interest in fixed amounts with principal payments at maturity or specified call dates. Instead, these securities provide a monthly payment which consists of both
interest and principal payments. In effect, these payments are a pass through of the monthly payments made by the individual borrowers on their residential or commercial mortgage loans, net of any fees paid to the issuer or guarantor of
such securities. Additional payments are caused by repayments of principal resulting from the sale of the underlying property, refinancing or foreclosure, net of fees or costs that may be incurred. Some mortgage related securities (such as
securities issued by the Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA)) are described as modified pass-through. These securities entitle the holder to receive all interest and principal payments owed on the mortgage pool,
net of certain fees, at the scheduled payment dates regardless of whether or not the mortgagor actually makes the payment.
RMBS. RMBS are securities the payments on which depend primarily on the cash flow from residential mortgage loans made to
borrowers that are secured, on a first priority basis or second priority basis, subject to permitted liens, easements and other encumbrances, by residential real estate (one- to four-family properties), the
proceeds of which are used to purchase real estate and purchase or construct dwellings thereon or to refinance indebtedness previously used for such purposes. Non-agency residential mortgage loans are
obligations of the borrowers thereunder only and are not typically insured or guaranteed by any other person or entity. The ability of a borrower to repay a loan secured by residential property is dependent upon the income or assets of the borrower.
A number of factors, including a general economic downturn, acts of God, terrorism, social unrest and civil disturbances, may impair a borrowers ability to repay its loans.
Agency RMBS. The principal U.S. governmental guarantor of mortgage related securities is GNMA, which is a wholly owned U.S.
government corporation. GNMA is authorized to guarantee, with the full faith and credit of the U.S. government, the timely payment of principal and interest on securities issued by institutions approved by GNMA (such as savings and loan
institutions, commercial banks and mortgage bankers) and backed by pools of mortgages insured by the Federal Housing Administration (the FHA) or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs (the VA). MBS issued by
GNMA include GNMA Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates (also known as Ginnie Maes) which are guaranteed as to the timely payment of principal and interest by GNMA and such guarantees are backed by the full faith and credit of the United
States. GNMA certificates also are supported by the authority of GNMA to borrow funds from the U.S. Treasury to make payments under its guarantee.
Government-related guarantors (i.e., not backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. government) include the Federal National Mortgage
Association (FNMA) and the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (FHLMC). FNMA is a government-sponsored corporation the common stock of which is owned entirely by private stockholders. FNMA purchases conventional (i.e., not
insured or guaranteed by any government agency) residential mortgages from a list of approved seller/servicers which include state and federally chartered savings and loan associations, mutual savings banks, commercial banks and credit unions and
mortgage bankers. Pass-through securities issued by FNMA (also known as Fannie Maes) are guaranteed as to timely payment of principal and interest by FNMA, but are not backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S.
government. FHLMC was created by Congress in 1970 for the purpose of increasing the availability of mortgage credit for residential housing. It is a government-sponsored corporation that issues FHLMC Guaranteed Mortgage Pass-Through
Certificates (also known as Freddie Macs or PCs), which are pass-through securities, each representing an undivided interest in a pool of residential mortgages. FHLMC guarantees the timely payment of interest and ultimate
collection of principal, but PCs are not backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. government.
In 2008, the Federal Housing Finance
Agency (FHFA) placed FNMA and FHLMC into conservatorship. FNMA and FHLMC are continuing to operate as going concerns while in conservatorship and each remains liable for all of its obligations, including its guaranty obligations,
associated with its MBS.
As the conservator, FHFA succeeded to all rights, titles, powers and privileges of FNMA and FHLMC and of any
stockholder, officer or director of FNMA and FHLMC with respect to FNMA and FHLMC and the assets of FNMA and FHLMC. In connection with the conservatorship, the U.S. Treasury entered into a Senior Preferred Stock Purchase Agreement with each of FNMA
and FHLMC pursuant to which the U.S. Treasury would purchase up to an aggregate of $100 billion of each of FNMA and FHLMC to maintain a positive net worth in each enterprise. This agreement contains various covenants that severely limit each
enterprises operations. In exchange
- 18 -
for entering into these agreements, the U.S. Treasury received $1 billion of each enterprises senior preferred stock and warrants to purchase 79.9% of each enterprises common
stock. In February 2009, the U.S. Treasury doubled the size of its commitment to each enterprise under the Senior Preferred Stock Program to $200 billion. The U.S. Treasurys obligations under the Senior Preferred Stock Program are for an
indefinite period of time for a maximum amount of $200 billion per enterprise. In December 2009, the U.S. Treasury announced further amendments to the Senior Preferred Stock Purchase Agreements which included additional financial support to
certain governmentally supported entities, including the Federal Home Loan Banks (FHLBs), FNMA and FHLMC. It is difficult, if not impossible, to predict the future political, regulatory or economic changes that could impact FNMA, FHLMC
and the FHLBs, and the values of their related securities or obligations. There is no assurance that the obligations of such entities will be satisfied in full, or that such obligations will not decrease in value or default.
Under the Federal Housing Finance Regulatory Reform Act of 2008 (the Reform Act), which was included as part of the Housing and
Economic Recovery Act of 2008, FHFA, as conservator or receiver, has the power to repudiate any contract entered into by FNMA or FHLMC prior to FHFAs appointment as conservator or receiver, as applicable, if FHFA determines, in its sole
discretion, that performance of the contract is burdensome and that repudiation of the contract promotes the orderly administration of FNMAs or FHLMCs affairs. The Reform Act requires FHFA to exercise its right to repudiate any contract
within a reasonable period of time after its appointment as conservator or receiver. FHFA, in its capacity as conservator, has indicated that it has no intention to repudiate the guaranty obligations of FNMA or FHLMC because FHFA views repudiation
as incompatible with the goals of the conservatorship. However, in the event that FHFA, as conservator or if it is later appointed as receiver for FNMA or FHLMC, were to repudiate any such guaranty obligation, the conservatorship or receivership
estate, as applicable, would be liable for actual direct compensatory damages in accordance with the provisions of the Reform Act. Any such liability could be satisfied only to the extent of FNMAs or FHLMCs assets available therefor. In
the event of repudiation, the payments of interest to holders of FNMA or FHLMC MBS would be reduced if payments on the mortgage loans represented in the mortgage loan groups related to such MBS are not made by the borrowers or advanced by the
servicer. Any actual direct compensatory damages for repudiating these guaranty obligations may not be sufficient to offset any shortfalls experienced by such MBS holders. Further, in its capacity as conservator or receiver, FHFA has the right to
transfer or sell any asset or liability of FNMA or FHLMC without any approval, assignment or consent. Although FHFA has stated that it has no present intention to do so, if FHFA, as conservator or receiver, were to transfer any such guaranty
obligation to another party, holders of FNMA or FHLMC MBS would have to rely on that party for satisfaction of the guaranty obligation and would be exposed to the credit risk of that party. In addition, certain rights provided to holders of MBS
issued by FNMA and FHLMC under the operative documents related to such securities may not be enforced against FHFA, or enforcement of such rights may be delayed, during the conservatorship or any future receivership. The operative documents for FNMA
and FHLMC MBS may provide (or with respect to securities issued prior to the date of the appointment of the conservator may have provided) that upon the occurrence of an event of default on the part of FNMA or FHLMC, in its capacity as guarantor,
which includes the appointment of a conservator or receiver, holders of such MBS have the right to replace FNMA or FHLMC as trustee if the requisite percentage of MBS holders consent. The Reform Act prevents MBS holders from enforcing such rights if
the event of default arises solely because a conservator or receiver has been appointed.
Non-Agency RMBS. Non-agency RMBS are issued
by commercial banks, savings and loan institutions, mortgage bankers, private mortgage insurance companies and other non-governmental issuers. Timely payment of principal and interest on RMBS backed by pools
created by non-governmental issuers often is supported partially by various forms of insurance or guarantees, including individual loan, title, pool and hazard insurance. The insurance and guarantees are
issued by government entities, private insurers and the mortgage poolers. There can be no assurance that the private insurers or mortgage poolers can meet their obligations under the policies, so that if the issuers default on their obligations, the
holders of the security could sustain a loss. No insurance or guarantee covers the Trust or the price of the Trusts shares. RMBS issued by non-governmental issuers generally offer a higher rate of
interest than government agency and government-related securities because there are no direct or indirect government guarantees of payment.
CMBS. CMBS generally are multi-class debt or pass-through certificates secured or backed by mortgage loans on commercial
properties. CMBS generally are structured to provide protection to the senior class investors against potential losses on the underlying mortgage loans. This protection generally is provided by having the holders of subordinated classes of
securities (Subordinated CMBS) take the first loss if there are defaults on the
- 19 -
underlying commercial mortgage loans. Other protection, which may benefit all of the classes or particular classes, may include issuer guarantees, reserve funds, additional Subordinated CMBS,
cross-collateralization and over-collateralization.
The Trust may invest in Subordinated CMBS, which are subordinated in some manner as
to the payment of principal and/or interest to the holders of more senior CMBS arising out of the same pool of mortgages and which are often referred to as B-Pieces. The holders of Subordinated
CMBS typically are compensated with a higher stated yield than are the holders of more senior CMBS. On the other hand, Subordinated CMBS typically subject the holder to greater risk than senior CMBS and tend to be rated in a lower rating category
(frequently a substantially lower rating category) than the senior CMBS issued in respect of the same mortgage pool. Subordinated CMBS generally are likely to be more sensitive to changes in prepayment and interest rates and the market for such
securities may be less liquid than is the case for traditional income securities and senior CMBS.
CMOs. A CMO is a multi-class
bond backed by a pool of mortgage pass-through certificates or mortgage loans. CMOs may be collateralized by (i) GNMA, FNMA or FHLMC pass-through certificates, (ii) unsecuritized mortgage loans insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA,
(iii) unsecuritized conventional mortgages, (iv) other MBS or (v) any combination thereof. Each class of a CMO, often referred to as a tranche, is issued at a specific coupon rate and has a stated maturity or final
distribution date. Principal prepayments on collateral underlying a CMO may cause it to be retired substantially earlier than its stated maturity or final distribution date. The principal and interest on the underlying mortgages may be allocated
among the several classes of a series of a CMO in many ways. One or more tranches of a CMO may have coupon rates which reset periodically at a specified increment over an index, such as LIBOR (or sometimes more than one index). These floating rate
CMOs typically are issued with lifetime caps on the coupon rate thereon. CMO residuals represent the interest in any excess cash flow remaining after making the payments of interest and principal on the tranches issued by the CMO and the payment of
administrative expenses and management fees.
The Trust may invest in inverse floating rate CMOs. Inverse floating rate CMOs constitute a
tranche of a CMO with a coupon rate that moves in the reverse direction relative to an applicable index such as LIBOR. Accordingly, the coupon rate thereon will increase as interest rates decrease. Inverse floating rate CMOs are typically more
volatile than fixed or floating rate tranches of CMOs. Many inverse floating rate CMOs have coupons that move inversely to a multiple of an index. The effect of the coupon varying inversely to a multiple of an applicable index creates a leverage
factor. Inverse floating rate debt instruments (inverse floaters) based on multiples of a stated index are designed to be highly sensitive to changes in interest rates and can subject the holders thereof to extreme reductions of yield
and loss of principal. The market for inverse floating rate CMOs with highly leveraged characteristics at times may be very thin. The Trusts ability to dispose of its positions in such securities will depend on the degree of liquidity in the
markets for such securities. It is impossible to predict the amount of trading interest that may exist in such securities, and therefore the future degree of liquidity.
Stripped MBS. Stripped MBS are created by segregating the cash flows from underlying mortgage loans or mortgage securities to create
two or more new securities, each receiving a specified percentage of the underlying securitys principal or interest payments. Mortgage securities may be partially stripped so that each investor class receives some interest and some principal.
When securities are completely stripped, however, all of the interest is distributed to holders of one type of security, known as an interest-only security (or IO), and all of the principal is distributed to holders of another type of
security, known as a principal-only security (or PO). Strips can be created in a pass-through structure or as tranches of a CMO. The yields to maturity on IOs and POs are very sensitive to the rate of principal payments (including
prepayments) on the related underlying mortgage assets. If the underlying mortgage assets experience greater than anticipated prepayments of principal, the Trust may not fully recoup its initial investment in IOs. Conversely, if the underlying
mortgage assets experience less than anticipated prepayments of principal, the yield on POs could be materially and adversely affected.
Adjustable Rate Mortgage Securities. Adjustable rate mortgages (ARMs) have interest rates that reset at periodic
intervals. Acquiring ARMs permits the Trust to participate in increases in prevailing current interest rates through periodic adjustments in the coupons of mortgages underlying the pool on which ARMs are based. Such ARMs generally have higher
current yield and lower price fluctuations than is the case with more traditional fixed income securities of comparable rating and maturity. In addition, when prepayments of principal are made on the underlying mortgages during periods of rising
interest rates, the Trust may potentially reinvest the proceeds of such
- 20 -
prepayments at rates higher than those at which they were previously invested. Mortgages underlying most ARMs, however, have limits on the allowable annual or lifetime increases that can be made
in the interest rate that the mortgagor pays. Therefore, if current interest rates rise above such limits over the period of the limitation, the Trust, when holding an ARM, does not benefit from further increases in interest rates. Moreover, when
interest rates are in excess of the coupon rates (i.e., the rates being paid by mortgagors) of the mortgages, ARMs behave more like fixed income securities and less like adjustable-rate securities and are subject to the risks associated with fixed
income securities. In addition, during periods of rising interest rates, increases in the coupon rate of ARMs generally lag current market interest rates slightly, thereby creating the potential for capital depreciation on such securities.
Sub-Prime Mortgages. Sub-prime mortgages are mortgages
rated below A by S&P or Moodys. Historically, sub-prime mortgage loans have been made to borrowers with blemished (or non-existent) credit records,
and the borrower is charged a higher interest rate to compensate for the greater risk of delinquency and the higher costs of loan servicing and collection. Sub-prime mortgages are subject to both state and
federal anti-predatory lending statutes that carry potential liability to secondary market purchasers such as the Trust. Sub-prime mortgages have certain characteristics and associated risks similar to below
investment grade securities, including a higher degree of credit risk, and certain characteristics and associated risks similar to MBS, including prepayment risk.
Mortgage Related ABS. Asset-backed securities (ABS) are bonds backed by pools of loans or other receivables. ABS are
created from many types of assets, including in some cases mortgage related asset classes, such as home equity loan ABS. Home equity loan ABS are subject to many of the same risks as RMBS, including interest rate risk and prepayment risk.
Mortgage REITs. A real estate investment trust (REIT) is a corporation, or a business trust that would otherwise be taxed
as a corporation, that meets the definitional requirements applicable to REITs under the Code. The Code permits a qualifying REIT to deduct dividends paid, thereby generally eliminating corporate level U.S. federal income tax and effectively making
the REIT a pass-through vehicle for U.S. federal income tax purposes. To meet the definitional requirements of the Code, a REIT must, among other things, invest substantially all of its assets in interests in real estate (including mortgages and
other REITs) or cash and government securities, derive most of its income from rents from real property or interest on loans secured by mortgages on real property, and distribute to shareholders annually substantially all of its otherwise taxable
income. Mortgage REITs invest mostly in mortgages on real estate, which may secure construction, development or long-term loans, and the main source of their income is mortgage interest payments. The value of securities issued by REITs is
affected by tax and regulatory requirements and by perceptions of management skill. They also are subject to heavy cash flow dependency and the possibility of failing to qualify for REIT status under the Code or to maintain exemption from the 1940
Act.
Mortgage Related Derivative Instruments. The Trust may invest in MBS credit default swaps. MBS credit default swaps
include swaps the reference obligation for which is an MBS or related index, such as the CMBX Index (a tradeable index referencing a basket of CMBS), the TRX Index (a tradeable index referencing total return swaps based on CMBS) or the ABX Index (a
tradeable index referencing a basket of sub-prime MBS). The Trust may engage in other derivative transactions related to MBS, including purchasing and selling exchange-listed and
over-the-counter put and call options, futures and forwards on mortgages and MBS. The Trust may invest in newly developed mortgage related derivatives that may
hereafter become available.
Net Interest Margin (NIM) Securities. The Trust may invest in net interest margin
(NIM) securities. These securities are derivative interest-only mortgage securities structured off home equity loan transactions. NIM securities receive any excess interest computed after paying coupon costs, servicing costs
and fees and any credit losses associated with the underlying pool of home equity loans. Like traditional stripped MBS, the yield to maturity on a NIM security is sensitive not only to changes in prevailing interest rates but also to the rate of
principal payments (including prepayments) on the underlying home equity loans. NIM securities are highly sensitive to credit losses on the underlying collateral and the timing in which those losses are taken.
Tiered Index Bonds. Tiered index bonds are relatively new forms of mortgage-related securities. The interest rate on a tiered
index bond is tied to a specified index or market rate. So long as this index or market rate is below a predetermined strike rate, the interest rate on the tiered index bond remains fixed. If, however, the specified index or market rate
rises above the strike rate, the interest rate of the tiered index bond will decrease.
- 21 -
Thus, under these circumstances, the interest rate on a tiered index bond, like an inverse floater, will move in the opposite direction of prevailing interest rates, with the result that the
price of the tiered index bond may be considerably more volatile than that of a fixed-rate bond.
TBA Commitments. The Trust
may enter into to be announced or TBA commitments. TBA commitments are forward agreements for the purchase or sale of securities, including MBS, for a fixed price, with payment and delivery on an agreed upon future settlement
date. The specific securities to be delivered are not identified at the trade date. However, delivered securities must meet specified terms, including issuer, rate and mortgage terms.
Other Mortgage Related Securities. Other mortgage related securities include securities other than those described above that directly
or indirectly represent a participation in, or are secured by and payable from, mortgage loans on real property. Other mortgage related securities may be equity or debt securities issued by agencies or instrumentalities of the U.S. government or by
private originators of, or investors in, mortgage loans, including savings and loan associations, homebuilders, mortgage banks, commercial banks, investment banks, partnerships, trusts and special purpose entities of the foregoing.
Asset-Backed Securities. ABS are a form of structured debt obligation. The securitization techniques used for ABS are similar to those used for
MBS. ABS are bonds backed by pools of loans or other receivables. The collateral for these securities may include home equity loans, automobile and credit card receivables, boat loans, computer leases, airplane leases, mobile home loans,
recreational vehicle loans and hospital account receivables. The Trust may invest in these and other types of ABS that may be developed in the future. ABS present certain risks that are not presented by mortgage related securities. Primarily, these
securities may provide the Trust with a less effective security interest in the related collateral than do mortgage related securities. Therefore, there is the possibility that recoveries on the underlying collateral may not, in some cases, be
available to support payments on these securities.
REITs. REITs are subject to certain risks which differ from an investment in common
stocks. REITs are financial vehicles that pool investors capital to purchase or finance real estate. REITs may concentrate their investments in specific geographic areas or in specific property types (e.g., hotels, shopping malls, residential
complexes and office buildings). The market value of REIT shares and the ability of REITs to distribute income may be adversely affected by several factors, including rising interest rates, changes in the national, state and local economic climate
and real estate conditions, perceptions of prospective tenants of the safety, convenience and attractiveness of the properties, the ability of the owners to provide adequate management, maintenance and insurance, the cost of complying with the
Americans with Disabilities Act, increased competition from new properties, the impact of present or future environmental legislation and compliance with environmental laws, changes in real estate taxes and other operating expenses, adverse changes
in governmental rules and fiscal policies, adverse changes in zoning laws and other factors beyond the control of the REIT issuers. In addition, distributions received by the Trust from REITs may consist of dividends, capital gains and/or return of
capital. As REITs generally pay a higher rate of dividends (on a pre-tax basis) than operating companies, to the extent application of the Trusts investment strategy results in the Trust investing in
REIT shares, the percentage of the Trusts dividend income received from REIT shares will likely exceed the percentage of the Trusts portfolio which is comprised of REIT shares. There are three general categories of REITs: equity REITs,
mortgage REITs and hybrid REITs. Equity REITs invest primarily in direct fee ownership or leasehold ownership of real property; they derive most of their income from rents. Mortgage REITs invest mostly in mortgages on real estate, which may secure
construction, development or long-term loans, and the main source of their income is mortgage interest payments. Hybrid REITs hold both ownership and mortgage interests in real estate.
Collateralized Debt Obligations. The Trust may invest in collateralized debt obligations (CDOs), which include collateralized bond
obligations (CBOs), collateralized loan obligations (CLOs) and other similarly structured securities. CDOs are types of asset-backed securities. A CBO is ordinarily issued by a fund or other special purpose entity
(SPE) and is typically backed by a diversified pool of fixed income securities (which may include high risk, below investment grade securities) held by such issuer. A CLO is ordinarily issued by a trust or other SPE and is typically
collateralized by a pool of loans, which may include, among others, domestic and non-U.S. senior secured loans, senior unsecured loans, and subordinate corporate loans, including loans that may be rated below
investment grade or equivalent unrated loans, held by such issuer. Although certain CDOs may benefit from credit enhancement in the form of a senior-subordinate structure, over-collateralization or bond insurance, such enhancement may not always be
present, and may fail to protect the Trust against the risk of loss on default of the collateral. Certain CDO
- 22 -
issuers may use derivatives contracts to create synthetic exposure to assets rather than holding such assets directly, which entails the risks of derivative instruments described
elsewhere in this Prospectus. CDOs may charge management fees and administrative expenses, which are in addition to those of the Trust.
For both CBOs and
CLOs, the cash flows from the SPE are split into two or more portions, called tranches, varying in risk and yield. The riskiest portion is the equity tranche, which bears the first loss from defaults from the bonds or loans in the SPE
and serves to protect the other, more senior tranches from default (though such protection is not complete). Since it is partially protected from defaults, a senior tranche from a CBO or CLO typically has higher ratings and lower yields than its
underlying securities, and may be rated investment grade. Despite the protection from the equity tranche, CBO or CLO tranches can experience substantial losses due to actual defaults, downgrades of the underlying collateral by rating agencies,
forced liquidation of the collateral pool due to a failure of coverage tests, increased sensitivity to defaults due to collateral default and disappearance of protecting tranches, market anticipation of defaults as well as investor aversion to CBO
or CLO securities as a class. Interest on certain tranches of a CDO may be paid in kind or deferred and capitalized (paid in the form of obligations of the same type rather than cash), which involves continued exposure to default risk with respect
to such payments.
Delayed Funding Loans and Revolving Credit Facilities. The Trust may enter into, or acquire participations in, delayed
funding loans and revolving credit facilities, in which a bank or other lender agrees to make loans up to a maximum amount upon demand by the borrower during a specified term. These commitments may have the effect of requiring the Trust to increase
its investment in a company at a time when it might not be desirable to do so (including at a time when the companys financial condition makes it unlikely that such amounts will be repaid). Delayed funding loans and revolving credit facilities
are subject to credit, interest rate and liquidity risk and the risks of being a lender.
Zero-Coupon Bonds,
Step-Ups and Pay-In-Kind Securities. Zero-coupon bonds pay interest only at maturity rather than at intervals during the life
of the security. Like zero-coupon bonds, step up bonds pay no interest initially but eventually begin to pay a coupon rate prior to maturity, which rate may increase at stated intervals during the
life of the security. Pay-in-kind securities (PIKs) are debt obligations that pay interest in the form of other debt obligations, instead of in
cash. Each of these instruments is normally issued and traded at a deep discount from face value. Zero-coupon bonds, step-ups and PIKs allow an issuer to avoid or delay the need to generate cash to meet
current interest payments and, as a result, may involve greater credit risk than bonds that pay interest currently or in cash. The Trust would be required to distribute the income on these instruments as it accrues, even though the Trust will not
receive the income on a current basis or in cash. Thus, the Trust may have to sell other investments, including when it may not be advisable to do so, to make income distributions to its shareholders.
Premium Securities. The Trust may invest in income securities bearing coupon rates higher than prevailing market rates. Such premium
securities are typically purchased at prices greater than the principal amounts payable on maturity. The Trust will not amortize the premium paid for such securities in calculating its net investment income. As a result, in such cases the purchase
of such securities provides the Trust a higher level of investment income distributable to shareholders on a current basis than if the Trust purchased securities bearing current market rates of interest. Although such securities bear coupon rates
higher than prevailing market rates, because they are purchased at a price in excess of par value, the yield earned by the Trust on such investments may not exceed prevailing market yields. If an issuer were to redeem securities held by the Trust
during a time of declining interest rates, the Trust may not be able to reinvest the proceeds in securities providing the same investment return as the securities redeemed. If securities purchased by the Trust at a premium are called or sold prior
to maturity, the Trust will recognize a capital loss to the extent the call or sale price is less than the purchase price. Additionally, the Trust will recognize a capital loss if it holds such securities to maturity.
U.S. Government Debt Securities. The Trust may invest in debt securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or
instrumentalities, including U.S. Treasury obligations, which differ in their interest rates, maturities and times of issuance. Such obligations include U.S. Treasury bills (maturity of one year or less), U.S. Treasury notes (maturity of one to
ten years) and U.S. Treasury bonds (generally maturities of greater than ten years), including the principal components or the interest components issued by the U.S. government under the separate trading of registered interest and principal
securities program (i.e., STRIPS), all of which are backed by the full faith and credit of the United States.
- 23 -
Municipal Securities. Set forth below is a detailed description of the municipal securities in which the
Trust invests. Information with respect to ratings assigned to tax-exempt obligations that the Trust may purchase is set forth in Appendix ARatings of Investments in the SAI.
Obligations are included within the term municipal securities if the interest paid thereon is excluded from gross income for federal income tax purposes in the opinion of bond counsel to the issuer.
Municipal securities include debt obligations issued to obtain funds for various public purposes, including the construction of a wide range of public
facilities, refunding of outstanding obligations and obtaining funds for general operating expenses and loans to other public institutions and facilities. In addition, certain types of PABs are issued by or on behalf of public authorities to finance
various privately owned or operated facilities, including among other things, airports, public ports, mass commuting facilities, multi-family housing projects, as well as facilities for water supply, gas, electricity, sewage or solid waste disposal
and other specialized facilities. Other types of PABs, the proceeds of which are used for the construction, equipment or improvement of privately operated industrial or commercial facilities, may constitute municipal securities. The interest on
municipal securities may bear a fixed rate or be payable at a variable or floating rate. The two principal classifications of municipal securities are general obligation bonds and revenue bonds, which latter category includes
PABs and, for bonds issued on or before August 15, 1986, industrial development bonds. Municipal securities typically are issued to finance public projects, such as roads or public buildings, to pay general operating expenses or to refinance
outstanding debt. Municipal securities may also be issued for private activities, such as housing, medical and educational facility construction, or for privately owned industrial development and pollution control projects. General obligation bonds
are backed by the full faith and credit, or taxing authority, of the issuer and may be repaid from any revenue source. Revenue bonds may be repaid only from the revenues of a specific facility or source. Municipal securities may be issued on a
long-term basis to provide permanent financing. The repayment of such debt may be secured generally by a pledge of the full faith and credit taxing power of the issuer, a limited or special tax, or any other revenue source, including project
revenues, which may include tolls, fees and other user charges, lease payments and mortgage payments. Municipal securities may also be issued to finance projects on a short-term interim basis, anticipating repayment with the proceeds of the later
issuance of long-term debt.
The municipal securities in which the Trust invests pay interest or income that, in the opinion of bond counsel to the
issuer, is exempt from regular Federal income tax. The Advisors do not conduct its own analysis of the tax status of the interest paid by municipal securities held by the Trust, but will rely on the opinion of counsel to the issuer of each such
instrument. The Trust may also invest in municipal securities issued by United States Territories (such as Puerto Rico or Guam) that are exempt from regular Federal income tax. In addition to the types of municipal securities described in this
Prospectus, the Trust may invest in other securities that pay interest or income that is, or make other distributions that are, exempt from regular Federal income tax and/or state and local personal taxes, regardless of the technical structure of
the issuer of the instrument. The Trust treats all of such tax-exempt securities as municipal securities.
The yields on municipal securities are dependent on a variety of factors, including prevailing interest rates and the condition of the general money market
and the municipal security market, the size of a particular offering, the maturity of the obligation and the rating of the issue. The market value of municipal securities will vary with changes in interest rate levels and as a result of changing
evaluations of the ability of bond issuers to meet interest and principal payments.
The Trust has not established any limit on the percentage of its
portfolio that may be invested in PABs. The Trust may not be a suitable investment for investors who are already subject to the federal alternative minimum tax or who would become subject to the federal alternative minimum tax as a result of an
investment in the Trusts common shares.
General Obligation Bonds. General obligation bonds are typically secured by the
issuers pledge of its faith, credit and taxing power for the repayment of principal and the payment of interest. The taxing power of any governmental entity may be limited, however, by provisions of its state constitution or laws, and an
entitys creditworthiness will depend on many factors, including potential erosion of its tax base due to population declines, natural disasters, declines in the states industrial base or inability to attract new industries, economic
limits on the ability to tax without eroding the tax base, state legislative proposals or voter initiatives to limit ad valorem real property taxes and the extent to which the entity relies on federal or state aid, access to capital markets or other
- 24 -
factors beyond the states or entitys control. Accordingly, the capacity of the issuer of a general obligation bond as to the timely payment of interest and the repayment of principal
when due is affected by the issuers maintenance of its tax base.
Revenue Bonds. Revenue or special obligation bonds are
typically payable only from the revenues derived from a particular facility or class of facilities or, in some cases, from the proceeds of a special excise tax or other specific revenue sources such as payments from the user of the facility being
financed. Accordingly, the timely payment of interest and the repayment of principal in accordance with the terms of the revenue or special obligation bond is a function of the economic viability of such facility or such revenue source. Revenue
bonds issued by state or local agencies to finance the development of low-income, multi-family housing involve special risks in addition to those associated with municipal securities generally,
including that the underlying properties may not generate sufficient income to pay expenses and interest costs. Such bonds are generally non-recourse against the property owner, may be junior to the
rights of others with an interest in the properties, may pay interest that changes based in part on the financial performance of the property, may be prepayable without penalty and may be used to finance the construction of housing developments
which, until completed and rented, do not generate income to pay interest. Increases in interest rates payable on senior obligations may make it more difficult for issuers to meet payment obligations on subordinated bonds.
Municipal Notes. Municipal notes are shorter term municipal debt obligations. They may provide interim financing in anticipation of tax
collection, bond sales or revenue receipts. If there is a shortfall in the anticipated proceeds, repayment on the note may be delayed or the note may not be fully repaid, and the Trust may lose money.
Municipal Commercial Paper. Municipal commercial paper is generally unsecured and issued to meet short-term financing needs. The lack
of security presents some risk of loss to the Trust since, in the event of an issuers bankruptcy, unsecured creditors are repaid only after the secured creditors out of the assets, if any, that remain.
PABs. The Trust may purchase municipal securities classified as PABs. Interest received on certain PABs is treated as an item of
tax preference for purposes of the federal alternative minimum tax and may impact the overall tax liability of certain investors in the Trust. PABs, formerly referred to as industrial development bonds, are issued by, or on behalf of,
states, municipalities or public authorities to obtain funds to provide privately operated housing facilities, airport, mass transit or port facilities, sewage disposal, solid waste disposal or hazardous waste treatment or disposal facilities and
certain local facilities for water supply, gas or electricity. Other types of PABs, the proceeds of which are used for the construction, equipment, repair or improvement of privately operated industrial or commercial facilities, may constitute
municipal securities, although the federal tax laws may place substantial limitations on the size of such issues. Such bonds are secured primarily by revenues derived from loan repayments or lease payments due from the entity which may or may not be
guaranteed by a parent company or otherwise secured. PABs generally are not secured by a pledge of the taxing power of the issuer of such bonds. Therefore, an investor should be aware that repayment of such bonds generally depends on the revenues of
a private entity and be aware of the risks that such an investment may entail. The continued ability of an entity to generate sufficient revenues for the payment of principal and interest on such bonds will be affected by many factors including the
size of the entity, capital structure, demand for its products or services, competition, general economic conditions, government regulation and the entitys dependence on revenues for the operation of the particular facility being financed.
Moral Obligation Bonds. Municipal securities may also include moral obligation bonds, which are normally issued by
special purpose public authorities. If an issuer of moral obligation bonds is unable to meet its obligations, the repayment of such bonds becomes a moral commitment but not a legal obligation of the state or municipality in question.
Municipal Lease Obligations. Also included within the general category of municipal securities are certificates of participation
(COPs) issued by government authorities or entities to finance the acquisition or construction of equipment, land and/or facilities. COPs represent participations in a lease, an installment purchase contract or a conditional sales
contract (hereinafter collectively called lease obligations) relating to such equipment, land or facilities. Municipal leases, like other municipal debt obligations, are subject to the risk of
non-payment. Although lease obligations do not constitute general obligations of the issuer for which the issuers
- 25 -
unlimited taxing power is pledged, a lease obligation is frequently backed by the issuers covenant to budget for, appropriate and make the payments due under the lease obligation. However,
certain lease obligations contain non-appropriation clauses which provide that the issuer has no obligation to make lease or installment purchase payments in future years unless money is
appropriated for such purpose on a yearly basis. Although non-appropriation lease obligations are secured by the leased property, disposition of the property in the event of foreclosure might prove
difficult and the value of the property may be insufficient to issue lease obligations. Certain investments in lease obligations may be illiquid.
The ability of issuers of municipal leases to make timely lease payments may be adversely impacted in general economic downturns and as
relative governmental cost burdens are allocated and reallocated among federal, state and local governmental units. Such non-payment would result in a reduction of income to the Trust, and could result in a
reduction in the value of the municipal lease experiencing non-payment and a potential decrease in the NAV of the Trust. Issuers of municipal lease obligations might seek protection under the bankruptcy laws.
In the event of bankruptcy of such an issuer, the Trust could experience delays and limitations with respect to the collection of principal and interest on such municipal leases and the Trust may not, in all circumstances, be able to collect all
principal and interest to which it is entitled. To enforce its rights in the event of a default in lease payments, the Trust might take possession of and manage the assets securing the issuers obligations on such securities, which may increase
the Trusts operating expenses and adversely affect the NAV of the Trust. When the lease contains a non-appropriation clause, however, the failure to pay would not be a default and the Trust would not
have the right to take possession of the assets. Any income derived from the Trusts ownership or operation of such assets may not be tax-exempt or may fail to generate qualifying income for purposes of
the income tests applicable to regulated investment companies. In addition, the Trusts intention to qualify as a regulated investment company under the Code may limit the extent to which the Trust may exercise its rights by taking possession
of such assets, because as a regulated investment company the Trust is subject to certain limitations on its investments and on the nature of its income.
Zero-Coupon Bonds. Municipal securities may include zero-coupon bonds. Zero-coupon bonds are
securities that are sold at a discount to par value and do not pay interest during the life of the security. The discount approximates the total amount of interest the security will accrue and compound over the period until maturity at a rate of
interest reflecting the market rate of the security at the time of issuance. Upon maturity, the holder of a zero-coupon bond is entitled to receive the par value of the security.
While interest payments are not made on such securities, holders of such securities are deemed to have received income (phantom
income) annually, notwithstanding that cash may not be received currently. The effect of owning instruments that do not make current interest payments is that a fixed yield is earned not only on the original investment but also, in effect, on
all discount accretion during the life of the obligations. This implicit reinvestment of earnings at a fixed rate eliminates the risk of being unable to invest distributions at a rate as high as the implicit yield on the zero-coupon bond, but at the same time eliminates the holders ability to reinvest at higher rates in the future. For this reason, some of these securities may be subject to substantially greater price
fluctuations during periods of changing market interest rates than are comparable securities that pay interest currently. Longer term zero-coupon bonds are more exposed to interest rate risk than shorter term zero-coupon bonds. These investments benefit the issuer by mitigating its need for cash to meet debt service, but also require a higher rate of return to attract investors who are willing to defer receipt of cash.
The Trust accrues income with respect to these securities for U.S. federal income tax and accounting purposes prior to the receipt of
cash payments. Zero-coupon bonds may be subject to greater fluctuation in value and less liquidity in the event of adverse market conditions than comparably rated securities that pay cash interest at regular intervals.
Further, to maintain its qualification for pass-through treatment under the federal tax laws, the Trust is required to distribute income to
its shareholders and, consequently, may have to dispose of other, more liquid portfolio securities under disadvantageous circumstances or may have to leverage itself by borrowing in order to generate the cash to satisfy these distributions. The
required distributions may result in an increase in the Trusts exposure to zero-coupon bonds.
- 26 -
In addition to the above-described risks, there are certain other risks related to investing in zero-coupon bonds. During a period of severe market conditions, the market for such securities may become even less liquid. In addition, as these securities do not pay cash interest, the Trusts investment
exposure to these securities and their risks, including credit risk, will increase during the time these securities are held in the Trusts portfolio.
Pre-Refunded Municipal Securities. The principal of, and interest on, pre-refunded municipal securities are no longer paid from the original revenue source for the securities. Instead, the source of such payments is typically an escrow fund consisting of U.S. Government securities.
The assets in the escrow fund are derived from the proceeds of refunding bonds issued by the same issuer as the pre-refunded municipal securities. Issuers of municipal securities use this advance refunding
technique to obtain more favorable terms with respect to securities that are not yet subject to call or redemption by the issuer. For example, advance refunding enables an issuer to refinance debt at lower market interest rates, restructure debt to
improve cash flow or eliminate restrictive covenants in the indenture or other governing instrument for the pre-refunded municipal securities.
However, except for a change in the revenue source from which principal and interest payments are made, the
pre-refunded municipal securities remain outstanding on their original terms until they mature or are redeemed by the issuer.
Special Taxing Districts. Special taxing districts are organized to plan and finance infrastructure developments to induce residential,
commercial and industrial growth and redevelopment. The bond financing methods such as tax increment finance, tax assessment, special services district and Mello-Roos bonds (a type of municipal security established by the Mello-Roos Community
Facilities Act of 1982), are generally payable solely from taxes or other revenues attributable to the specific projects financed by the bonds without recourse to the credit or taxing power of related or overlapping municipalities. They often are
exposed to real estate development-related risks and can have more taxpayer concentration risk than general tax-supported bonds, such as general obligation bonds. Further, the fees, special taxes, or tax
allocations and other revenues that are established to secure such financings are generally limited as to the rate or amount that may be levied or assessed and are not subject to increase pursuant to rate covenants or municipal or corporate
guarantees. The bonds could default if development failed to progress as anticipated or if larger taxpayers failed to pay the assessments, fees and taxes as provided in the financing plans of the districts.
Indexed and Inverse Floating Rate Securities. The Trust may invest in municipal securities (and
Non-Municipal Tax-Exempt Securities) that yield a return based on a particular index of value or interest rates. For example, the Trust may invest in municipal
securities that pay interest based on an index of municipal security interest rates. The principal amount payable upon maturity of certain municipal securities also may be based on the value of the index. To the extent the Trust invests in these
types of municipal securities, the Trusts return on such municipal securities will be subject to risk with respect to the value of the particular index. Interest and principal payable on the municipal securities may also be based on relative
changes among particular indices. Also, the Trust may invest in so-called inverse floating rate bonds or residual interest bonds on which the interest rates vary inversely with a
short-term floating rate (which may be reset periodically by a Dutch auction, a remarketing agent, or by reference to a short-term tax-exempt interest rate index). The Trust may purchase synthetically created
inverse floating rate bonds evidenced by custodial or trust receipts. Generally, income on inverse floating rate bonds will decrease when short-term interest rates increase, and will increase when short-term interest rates decrease. Such securities
have the effect of providing a degree of investment leverage, since they may increase or decrease in value in response to changes, as an illustration, in market interest rates at a rate which is a multiple (typically two) of the rate at which fixed
rate long-term tax-exempt securities increase or decrease in response to such changes. As a result, the market values of such securities will generally be more volatile than the market values of fixed rate tax-exempt securities. To seek to limit the volatility of these securities, the Trust may purchase inverse floating rate bonds with shorter-term maturities or limitations on the extent to which the interest rate may
vary. Certain investments in such obligations may be illiquid.
When-Issued Securities, Delayed Delivery Securities and Forward
Commitments. The Trust may purchase or sell securities that it is entitled to receive on a when-issued basis. The Trust may also purchase or sell securities on a delayed delivery basis. The Trust may also purchase or sell securities through a
forward commitment. These transactions involve the purchase or sale of securities by the Trust at an established price with payment and delivery taking place in the future. The purchase will be recorded on the date the Trust enters into the
commitment and the
- 27 -
value of the securities will thereafter be reflected in the Trusts NAV. The Trust has not established any limit on the percentage of its assets that may be committed in connection with
these transactions.
There can be no assurance that a security purchased on a when-issued basis will be issued or that a security
purchased or sold through a forward commitment will be delivered. A default by a counterparty may result in the Trust missing the opportunity of obtaining a price considered to be advantageous. The value of securities in these transactions on the
delivery date may be more or less than the Trusts purchase price. The Trust may bear the risk of a decline in the value of the security in these transactions and may not benefit from an appreciation in the value of the security during the
commitment period.
If deemed advisable as a matter of investment strategy, the Trust may dispose of or renegotiate a commitment after it
has been entered into, and may sell securities it has committed to purchase before those securities are delivered to the Trust on the settlement date. In these cases the Trust may realize a taxable capital gain or loss.
When the Trust engages in when-issued, delayed delivery or forward commitment transactions, it relies on the other party to consummate the
trade. Failure of such party to do so may result in the Trusts incurring a loss or missing an opportunity to obtain a price considered to be advantageous.
The market value of the securities underlying a commitment to purchase securities, and any subsequent fluctuations in their market value, is
taken into account when determining the market value of the Trust starting on the day the Trust agrees to purchase the securities. The Trust does not earn interest on the securities it has committed to purchase until they are paid for and delivered
on the settlement date.
Yields. Yields on municipal securities are dependent on a variety of factors, including the general
condition of the money market and of the municipal security market, the size of a particular offering, the financial condition of the issuer, the maturity of the obligation and the rating of the issue. The ability of the Trust to achieve its
investment objective is also dependent on the continuing ability of the issuers of the securities in which the Trust invests to meet their obligations for the payment of interest and principal when due. There are variations in the risks involved in
holding municipal securities, both within a particular classification and between classifications, depending on numerous factors. Furthermore, the rights of owners of municipal securities and the obligations of the issuer of such municipal
securities may be subject to applicable bankruptcy, insolvency and similar laws and court decisions affecting the rights of creditors generally and to general equitable principles, which may limit the enforcement of certain remedies.
Preferred Securities. The Trust may invest in preferred securities. There are two basic types of preferred securities. The first type, sometimes
referred to as traditional preferred securities, consists of preferred stock issued by an entity taxable as a corporation. The second type, sometimes referred to as trust preferred securities, are usually issued by a trust or limited partnership and
represent preferred interests in deeply subordinated debt instruments issued by the corporation for whose benefit the trust or partnership was established.
Traditional Preferred Securities. Traditional preferred securities generally pay fixed or adjustable rate dividends to investors
and generally have a preference over common stock in the payment of dividends and the liquidation of a companys assets. This means that a company must pay dividends on preferred stock before paying any dividends on its common
stock. In order to be payable, distributions on such preferred securities must be declared by the issuers board of directors. Income payments on typical preferred securities currently outstanding are cumulative, causing dividends and
distributions to accumulate even if not declared by the board of directors or otherwise made payable. In such a case all accumulated dividends must be paid before any dividend on the common stock can be paid. However, some traditional preferred
stocks are non-cumulative, in which case dividends do not accumulate and need not ever be paid. A portion of the portfolio may include investments in non-cumulative
preferred securities, whereby the issuer does not have an obligation to make up any arrearages to its shareholders. Should an issuer of a non-cumulative preferred stock held by the Trust determine not to pay
dividends on such stock, the amount of dividends the Trust pays may be adversely affected. There is no assurance that dividends or distributions on the preferred securities in which the Trust invests will be declared or otherwise made payable.
- 28 -
Preferred stockholders usually have no right to vote for corporate directors or on other matters. Shares of
preferred stock have a liquidation value that generally equals the original purchase price at the date of issuance. The market value of preferred securities may be affected by favorable and unfavorable changes impacting companies in the utilities
and financial services sectors, which are prominent issuers of preferred securities, and by actual and anticipated changes in tax laws, such as changes in corporate income tax rates or the Dividends Received Deduction. Because the claim
on an issuers earnings represented by preferred securities may become onerous when interest rates fall below the rate payable on such securities, the issuer may redeem the securities. Thus, in declining interest rate environments in
particular, the Trusts holdings, if any, of higher rate-paying fixed rate preferred securities may be reduced and the Trust may be unable to acquire securities of comparable credit quality paying comparable rates with the redemption proceeds.
Trust Preferred Securities. Trust preferred securities are typically issued by corporations, generally in the form of
interest-bearing notes with preferred security characteristics, or by an affiliated business trust of a corporation, generally in the form of beneficial interests in subordinated debentures or similarly structured securities. The trust preferred
securities market consists of both fixed and adjustable coupon rate securities that are either perpetual in nature or have stated maturity dates.
Trust
preferred securities are typically junior and fully subordinated liabilities of an issuer or the beneficiary of a guarantee that is junior and fully subordinated to the other liabilities of the guarantor. In addition, trust preferred securities
typically permit an issuer to defer the payment of income for eighteen months or more without triggering an event of default. Generally, the deferral period is five years or more. Because of their subordinated position in the capital structure of an
issuer, the ability to defer payments for extended periods of time without default consequences to the issuer, and certain other features (such as restrictions on common dividend payments by the issuer or ultimate guarantor when full cumulative
payments on the trust preferred securities have not been made), these trust preferred securities are often treated as close substitutes for traditional preferred securities, both by issuers and investors. Trust preferred securities have many of the
key characteristics of equity due to their subordinated position in an issuers capital structure and because their quality and value are heavily dependent on the profitability of the issuer rather than on any legal claims to specific assets or
cash flows.
Convertible Securities. A convertible security is a bond, debenture, note, preferred stock or other security that may be
converted into or exchanged for a prescribed amount of common stock or other equity security of the same or a different issuer within a particular period of time at a specified price or formula. A convertible security entitles the holder to receive
interest paid or accrued on debt or the dividend paid on preferred stock until the convertible security matures or is redeemed, converted or exchanged. Before conversion, convertible securities have characteristics similar to nonconvertible income
securities in that they ordinarily provide a stable stream of income with generally higher yields than those of common stocks of the same or similar issuers, but lower yields than comparable nonconvertible securities. The value of a convertible
security is influenced by changes in interest rates, with investment value declining as interest rates increase and increasing as interest rates decline. The credit standing of the issuer and other factors also may have an effect on the convertible
securitys investment value. Convertible securities rank senior to common stock in a corporations capital structure but are usually subordinated to comparable nonconvertible securities. Convertible securities may be subject to redemption
at the option of the issuer at a price established in the convertible securitys governing instrument.
A synthetic or
manufactured convertible security may be created by the Trust or by a third party by combining separate securities that possess the two principal characteristics of a traditional convertible security: an income producing component and a
convertible component. The income-producing component is achieved by investing in non-convertible, income-producing securities such as bonds, preferred stocks and money market instruments. The convertible
component is achieved by investing in securities or instruments such as warrants or options to buy common stock at a certain exercise price, or options on a stock index. Unlike a traditional convertible security, which is a single security having a
single market value, a synthetic convertible comprises two or more separate securities, each with its own market value. Because the market value of a synthetic convertible security is the sum of the values of its income-producing
component and its convertible component, the value of a synthetic convertible security may respond differently to market fluctuations than a traditional convertible security. The Trust also may purchase synthetic convertible securities created by
other parties, including convertible structured notes. Convertible structured notes are income-producing debentures linked to equity. Convertible structured notes have the attributes of a convertible security; however, the issuer of the convertible
note (typically an investment bank), rather than the
- 29 -
issuer of the underlying common stock into which the note is convertible, assumes credit risk associated with the underlying investment and the Trust in turn assumes credit risk associated with
the issuer of the convertible note.
Contingent Convertible Securities. One type of convertible security in which the Trust may invest is
contingent convertible securities, sometimes referred to as CoCos. CoCos are a form of hybrid debt security issued by banking institutions that are intended to either automatically convert into equity or have their principal written down
upon the occurrence of certain trigger events, which may include a decline in the issuers capital below a specified threshold level, increase in the issuers risk weighted assets, the share price of the issuer falling to a
particular level for a certain period of time and certain regulatory events. CoCos unique equity conversion or principal write-down features are tailored to the issuing banking institution and its regulatory requirements. CoCos are a newer
form of instrument and the regulatory environment for these instruments continues to evolve.
Restricted and Illiquid Securities. The Trust
may invest in restricted, illiquid or less liquid securities or securities in which no secondary trading market is readily available or which are otherwise illiquid, including private placement securities.
The liquidity of a security relates to the ability to dispose easily of the security and the price to be obtained upon disposition of the security, which may
be less than would be obtained for a comparable more liquid security. Illiquid securities are securities which cannot be sold within seven days in the ordinary course of business at approximately the value used by the Trust in
determining its NAV. Illiquid securities may trade at a discount from comparable, more liquid investments. Investment of the Trusts assets in illiquid securities may restrict the ability of the Trust to dispose of its investments in a
timely fashion and for a fair price as well as its ability to take advantage of market opportunities. The risks associated with illiquidity will be particularly acute where the Trusts operations require cash, such as when the Trust pays
dividends, and could result in the Trust borrowing to meet short-term cash requirements or incurring capital losses on the sale of illiquid investments.
Restricted securities are securities that are not registered under the Securities Act. Restricted securities may be sold in private placement
transactions between issuers and their purchasers and may be neither listed on an exchange nor traded in other established markets. In many cases, privately placed securities may not be freely transferable under the laws of the applicable
jurisdiction or due to contractual restrictions on resale. As a result of the absence of a public trading market, privately placed securities may be less liquid and more difficult to value than publicly traded securities. To the extent that
privately placed securities may be resold in privately negotiated transactions, the prices realized from the sales, due to restrictions on resale, could be less than those originally paid by the Trust or less than their fair market value. In
addition, issuers whose securities are not publicly traded may not be subject to the disclosure and other investor protection requirements that may be applicable if their securities were publicly traded. If any privately placed securities held by
the Trust are required to be registered under the securities laws of one or more jurisdictions before being resold, the Trust may be required to bear the expenses of registration. Certain of the Trusts investments in private placements may
consist of direct investments and may include investments in smaller, less seasoned issuers, which may involve greater risks. These issuers may have limited product lines, markets or financial resources, or they may be dependent on a limited
management group. In making investments in such securities, the Trust may obtain access to material nonpublic information, which may restrict the Trusts ability to conduct portfolio transactions in such securities.
Some of these securities are new and complex, and trade only among institutions; the markets for these securities are still developing, and may not function
as efficiently as established markets. Also, because there may not be an established market price for these securities, the Trust may have to estimate their value, which means that their valuation (and thus the valuation of the Trust) may have a
subjective element.
Transactions in restricted or illiquid securities may entail registration expense and other transaction costs that are higher than
those for transactions in unrestricted or liquid securities eligible for trading on national securities exchanges or in the over-the-counter markets. Where registration
is required for restricted or illiquid securities a considerable time period may elapse between the time the Trust decides to sell the security and the time it is actually permitted to sell the security under an effective registration statement. If
during such period, adverse market conditions were to develop, the Trust may obtain less favorable pricing terms then when it decided to sell the security.
- 30 -
Non-U.S. Securities. The Trust may invest in securities of non-U.S. issuers (Non-U.S. Securities). Subject to the Trusts investment policies, these securities may be U.S. dollar-denominated or non-U.S. dollar-denominated. Some Non-U.S. Securities may be less liquid and more volatile than securities of comparable U.S. issuers. Similarly, there is less volume and
liquidity in most foreign securities markets than in the United States and, at times, greater price volatility than in the United States. Because evidence of ownership of such securities usually is held outside the United States, the Trust will be
subject to additional risks if it invests in Non-U.S. Securities, which include adverse political and economic developments, seizure or nationalization of foreign deposits and adoption of governmental
restrictions which might adversely affect or restrict the payment of principal and interest on the foreign securities to investors located outside the country of the issuer, whether from currency blockage or otherwise.
Non-U.S. Securities may trade on days when the common shares are not priced or traded.
Emerging Markets
Investments. The Trust may invest in securities of issuers located in emerging market countries, including securities denominated in currencies of emerging market countries. Emerging market countries generally include every nation in
the world except the United States, Canada, Japan, Australia, New Zealand and most countries located in Western Europe. These issuers may be subject to risks that do not apply to issuers in larger, more developed countries. These risks are more
pronounced to the extent the Trust invests significantly in one country. Less information about non-U.S. issuers or markets may be available due to less rigorous disclosure and accounting standards or
regulatory practices. Many non-U.S. markets are smaller, less liquid and more volatile than U.S. markets. In a changing market, the Advisors may not be able to sell the Trusts portfolio securities in
amounts and at prices it considers reasonable. The U.S. dollar may appreciate against non-U.S. currencies or an emerging market government may impose restrictions on currency conversion or trading. The
economies of non-U.S. countries may grow at a slower rate than expected or may experience a downturn or recession. Economic, political and social developments may adversely affect non-U.S. securities markets.
Equity Securities. The Trust may invest in equity securities, including common
stocks and warrants. Common stock represents an equity ownership interest in a company. The Trust may hold or have exposure to common stocks of issuers of any size, including small and medium capitalization stocks. Warrants are privileges issued by
corporations enabling the owners to subscribe to and purchase a specified number of shares of the corporation at a specified price during a specified period of time. Warrants normally have a short life span to expiration. The purchase of warrants
involves the risk that the Trust could lose the purchase value of a right or warrant if the right to subscribe to additional shares is not exercised prior to the warrants expiration. Also, the purchase of warrants involves the risk that the
effective price paid for the warrant added to the subscription price of the related security may exceed the value of the subscribed securitys market price such as when there is no movement in the level of the underlying security. Buying a
warrant does not make the Trust a shareholder of the underlying stock.
Sovereign Governmental and Supranational Debt. The Trust may invest in all
types of debt securities of governmental issuers in all countries, including emerging market countries. These sovereign debt securities may include without limitation: debt securities issued or guaranteed by governments, governmental agencies or
instrumentalities and political subdivisions; debt securities issued by government owned, controlled or sponsored entities; interests in entities organized and operated for the purpose of restructuring the investment characteristics of instruments
issued by any of the above issuers; Brady Bonds, which are debt securities issued under the framework of the Brady Plan as a means for debtor nations to restructure their outstanding external indebtedness; participations in loans between governments
and financial institutions; or debt securities issued by supranational entities such as the World Bank. A supranational entity is a bank, commission or company established or financially supported by the national governments of one or more countries
to promote reconstruction or development. Sovereign government and supranational debt involve all the risks described herein regarding foreign and emerging markets investments as well as the risk of debt moratorium, repudiation or renegotiation.
Brady Bonds are debt securities, generally denominated in U.S. dollars, issued under the framework of the Brady Plan as a means for debtor nations to
restructure their outstanding external indebtedness. In restructuring its external debt under the Brady Plan framework, a debtor nation negotiates with its existing bank lenders as well as multilateral institutions such as the World Bank and the
International Monetary Fund (the IMF). The Brady Plan framework, as it has developed, contemplates the exchange of external commercial bank debt for newly issued bonds known as Brady Bonds. Brady Bonds may also be issued in
respect of new money being advanced by existing lenders in connection with the debt restructuring. The World Bank and/or the IMF support the restructuring by providing funds pursuant to loan agreements or other arrangements which enable the debtor
nation to
- 31 -
collateralize the new Brady Bonds or to repurchase outstanding bank debt at a discount. Under these arrangements with the World Bank and/or the IMF, debtor nations have been required to agree to
the implementation of certain domestic monetary and fiscal reforms. Such reforms have included the liberalization of trade and foreign investment, the privatization of state-owned enterprises and the setting of targets for public spending and
borrowing. These policies and programs seek to promote the debtor countrys economic growth and development. Investors should also recognize that the Brady Plan only sets forth general guiding principles for economic reform and debt reduction,
emphasizing that solutions must be negotiated on a case-by-case basis between debtor nations and their creditors.
Brady Bonds involve various risk factors described elsewhere associated with investing in foreign securities, including the history of defaults with respect
to commercial bank loans by public and private entities of countries issuing Brady Bonds. In light of the residual risk of Brady Bonds and, among other factors, the history of defaults, investments in Brady Bonds are considered speculative. There
can be no assurance that Brady Bonds in which the Trust may invest will not be subject to restructuring arrangements or to requests for new credit, which may cause the Trust to suffer a loss of interest or principal on any of its holdings.
Inflation-Indexed Bonds. Inflation-indexed bonds (other than municipal inflation-indexed bonds and certain corporate inflation-indexed bonds) are
fixed income securities the principal value of which is periodically adjusted according to the rate of inflation. If the index measuring inflation falls, the principal value of inflation-indexed bonds (other than municipal inflation-indexed bonds
and certain corporate inflation-indexed bonds) will be adjusted downward, and consequently the interest payable on these securities (calculated with respect to a smaller principal amount) will be reduced. Repayment of the original bond principal
upon maturity (as adjusted for inflation) is guaranteed in the case of U.S. Treasury inflation-indexed bonds (TIPs). For bonds that do not provide a similar guarantee, the adjusted principal value of the bond repaid at maturity may be
less than the original principal. With regard to municipal inflation-indexed bonds and certain corporate inflation-indexed bonds, the inflation adjustment is typically reflected in the semi-annual coupon payment. As a result, the principal value of
municipal inflation-indexed bonds and such corporate inflation-indexed bonds does not adjust according to the rate of inflation.
Variable and Floating
Rate Instruments. Variable and floating rate securities provide for a periodic adjustment in the interest rate paid on the obligations. The terms of such obligations provide that interest rates are adjusted periodically based upon an interest
rate adjustment index as provided in the respective obligations. The adjustment intervals may be regular, and range from daily up to annually, or may be event-based, such as based on a change in the prime rate.
The interest rate on a floating rate security is a variable rate which is tied to another interest rate, such as a money-market index or Treasury bill
rate. The interest rate on a floating rate security resets periodically, typically every six months. Because of the interest rate reset feature, floating rate securities provide the Trust with a certain degree of protection
against rises in interest rates, although the Trust will participate in any declines in interest rates as well.
Inverse Floating Rate Securities.
An inverse floater is a type of debt instrument that bears a floating or variable interest rate that moves in the opposite direction to interest rates generally or the interest rate on another security or index. Changes in interest rates generally,
or the interest rate of the other security or index, inversely affect the interest rate paid on the inverse floater, with the result that the inverse floaters price will be considerably more volatile than that of a fixed rate bond. The Trust
may invest in inverse floaters, which brokers typically create by depositing an income-producing instrument, including a mortgage related security, in a trust. The trust in turn issues a variable rate security and inverse floaters. The interest rate
for the variable rate security is typically determined by an index or an auction process, while the inverse floater holder receives the balance of the income from the underlying income-producing instrument less an auction fee. The market prices of
inverse floaters may be highly sensitive to changes in interest rates and prepayment rates on the underlying securities, and may decrease significantly when interest rates increase or prepayment rates change. In a transaction in which the Trust
purchases an inverse floater from a trust, and the underlying security was held by the Trust prior to being deposited into the trust, the Trust typically treats the transaction as a secured borrowing for financial reporting purposes. As a result,
for financial reporting purposes, the Trust will generally incur a non-cash interest expense with respect to interest paid by the trust on the variable rate securities and will recognize additional interest
income in an amount directly corresponding to the non-cash interest expense. Therefore, the Trusts NAV per common share and performance are
- 32 -
not affected by the non-cash interest expense. This accounting treatment does not apply to inverse floaters acquired by the Trust when the Trust did not
previously own the underlying bond.
Strategic Transactions and Other Management Techniques. The Trust may engage in various strategic transactions
for hedging and risk management purposes or to enhance total return (Strategic Transactions). Strategic Transactions involve the use of derivative instruments. Such instruments may include, but are not limited to, financial futures
contracts, swap contracts (including, but not limited to, credit default swaps), options on financial futures, options on swap contracts and other derivative instruments. If the Trust engages in Strategic Transactions for hedging and risk management
purposes, it primarily intends to use strategies that include swaps (including interest rate swaps), financial futures contracts, options on financial futures or options based either on an index of long-term securities or on taxable debt securities
whose prices, in the opinion of the Advisors, correlate with the prices of the Trusts investments. If the Trust engages in Strategic Transactions to enhance total return, it primarily intends to use the same strategies as discussed above for
hedging and risk management purposes and, in addition, to engage in credit derivative transactions, including credit default swaps. There is no assurance that these derivative strategies will be available at any time or that the Advisors will
determine to use them for hedging or risk management purposes or to enhance total return or, if used, that the strategies will be successful.
There is no
particular strategy that requires use of one technique rather than another as the decision to use any particular strategy or instrument is a function of market conditions and the composition of the portfolio. The ability of the Trust to use
Strategic Transactions successfully will depend on the Advisors ability to predict pertinent market movements as well as sufficient correlation among the instruments, which cannot be assured. Strategic Transactions subject the Trust to the
risk that, if the Advisors incorrectly forecasts market values, interest rates or other applicable factors, the Trusts performance could suffer. Certain of these Strategic Transactions, such as investments in inverse floating rate securities
and credit default swaps, may provide investment leverage to the Trusts portfolio. The Trust is not required to use derivatives or other portfolio strategies to seek to hedge its portfolio and may choose not to do so.
The use of Strategic Transactions may result in losses greater than if they had not been used, may require the Trust to sell or purchase portfolio securities
at inopportune times or for prices other than current market values, may limit the amount of appreciation the Trust can realize on an investment or may cause the Trust to hold a security that it might otherwise sell. Furthermore, the Trust may only
engage in Strategic Transactions from time to time and may not necessarily be engaging in hedging activities when movements in interest rates occur.
The
SAI contains further information about the characteristics, risks and possible benefits of Strategic Transactions and the Trusts other policies and limitations (which are not fundamental policies) relating to Strategic Transactions. Certain
provisions of the Code may restrict or affect the ability of the Trust to engage in Strategic Transactions. In addition, the use of certain Strategic Transactions may give rise to taxable income and have certain other consequences.
Swaps. The Trust may enter into swap agreements, including interest rate and index swap agreements. Swap agreements are two party contracts entered
into primarily by institutional investors for periods ranging from a few weeks to more than one year. In a standard swap transaction, two parties agree to exchange the returns (or differentials in rates of return) earned or realized on
particular predetermined investments or instruments. The gross returns to be exchanged or swapped between the parties are calculated with respect to a notional amount, i.e., the dollar amount invested at a particular interest
rate, in a particular foreign currency, or in a basket of securities representing a particular index. The notional amount of the swap agreement is only a fictive basis on which to calculate the obligations that the parties to
a swap agreement have agreed to exchange. The Trusts obligations (or rights) under a swap agreement will generally be equal only to the net amount to be paid or received under the agreement based on the relative values of the positions held by
each party to the agreement (the net amount).
Whether the Trusts use of swap agreements will be successful in furthering its investment
objective will depend on the Advisors ability to correctly predict whether certain types of investments are likely to produce greater returns than other investments. Moreover, the Trust bears the risk of loss of the amount expected to be
received under a swap agreement in the event of the default or bankruptcy of a swap agreement counterparty. Swap agreements also bear the risk that the Trust will not be able to meet its payment obligations to the counterparty. Restrictions imposed
by the tax rules applicable to regulated investment companies may limit the Trusts ability to use swap agreements.
- 33 -
It is possible that developments in the swap market, including government regulation, could adversely affect the Trusts ability to terminate existing swap agreements or to realize amounts
to be received under such agreements.
Swaptions. A swaption is a contract that gives a counterparty the right (but not the obligation) to enter
into a new swap agreement or to shorten, extend, cancel or otherwise modify an existing swap agreement, at some designated future time on specified terms. The Trust may write (sell) and purchase put and call swaptions. Depending on the terms of the
particular option agreement, the Trust may incur a greater degree of risk when it writes a swaption than it would incur when it purchases a swaption with the same terms. When the Trust purchases a swaption, it risks losing only the amount of the
premium it has paid should it decide to let the option expire unexercised. However, when the Trust writes a swaption, upon exercise of the option the Trust will become obligated according to the terms of the underlying agreement, and the Trust could
be exposed to losses in excess of the amount of premium it received from the purchaser of the swaption.
Credit Default Swaps. The Trust may
enter into credit default swap agreements. The credit default swap agreement may have as reference obligations one or more securities that are not currently held by the Trust. The protection buyer in a credit default contract may be
obligated to pay the protection seller an upfront or a periodic stream of payments over the term of the contract, provided that no credit event on the reference obligation occurs. If a credit event occurs, the seller generally must pay
the buyer the par value (full notional amount) of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity described in the swap, or if the swap is cash settled the seller may be required to
deliver the related net cash amount (the difference between the market value of the reference obligation and its par value). The Trust may be either the buyer or seller in the transaction. If the Trust is a buyer and no credit event occurs, the
Trust will generally receive no payments from its counterparty under the swap if the swap is held through its termination date. However, if a credit event occurs, the buyer generally may elect to receive the full notional amount of the swap in
exchange for an equal face amount of deliverable obligations of the reference entity, the value of which may have significantly decreased. As a seller, the Trust generally receives an upfront payment or a fixed rate of income throughout the term of
the swap, which typically is between six months and three years, provided that there is no credit event. If a credit event occurs, generally the seller must pay the buyer the full notional amount of the swap in exchange for an equal face amount of
deliverable obligations of the reference entity, the value of which may have significantly decreased. As the seller, the Trust would effectively add leverage to its portfolio because, in addition to its Managed Assets, the Trust would be subject to
investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap in excess of any premium and margin required to establish and maintain the position.
Credit
default swap agreements involve greater risks than if the Trust had taken a position in the reference obligation directly (either by purchasing or selling) since, in addition to general market risks, credit default swaps are subject to illiquidity
risk, counterparty risk and credit risks. A buyer generally will also lose its upfront payment or any periodic payments it makes to the seller counterparty and receive no payments from its counterparty should no credit event occur and the swap is
held to its termination date. If a credit event were to occur, the value of any deliverable obligation received by the seller, coupled with the upfront or periodic payments previously received, may be less than the full notional amount it pays to
the buyer, resulting in a loss of value to the seller. A seller of a credit default swap or similar instrument is exposed to many of the same risks of leverage since, if a credit event occurs, the seller generally will be required to pay the buyer
the full notional amount of the contract net of any amounts owed by the buyer related to its delivery of deliverable obligations. The Trusts obligations under a credit default swap agreement will be accrued daily (offset against any amounts
owed to the Trust).
In addition, the credit derivatives market is subject to a changing regulatory environment. It is possible that regulatory or other
developments in the credit derivatives market could adversely affect the Trusts ability to successfully use credit derivatives.
Total Return
Swaps. Total return swap agreements are contracts in which one party agrees to make periodic payments to another party based on the change in market value of the assets underlying the contract, which may include a specified security, basket
of securities or securities indices during the specified period, in return for periodic payments based on a fixed or variable interest rate or the total return from other underlying assets. Total return swap agreements may be used to obtain exposure
to a security or market without owning or taking physical custody of such security or investing directly in such market. Total return swap agreements may effectively add leverage to the Trusts portfolio because, in addition to its Managed
Assets, the Trust would be subject to investment
- 34 -
exposure on the notional amount of the swap in excess of any premium and margin required to establish and maintain the position.
Total return swap agreements are subject to market risk as well as the risk that a counterparty will default on its payment obligations to the Trust
thereunder. Swap agreements also bear the risk that the Trust will not be able to meet its obligation to the counterparty. Generally, the Trust will enter into total return swaps on a net basis (i.e., the two payment streams are netted against one
another with the Trust receiving or paying, as the case may be, only the net amount of the two payments).
Interest Rate Transactions. The
Trust may enter into interest rate swaps and purchase or sell interest rate caps and floors primarily to preserve a return or spread on a particular investment or portion of its portfolio as a duration management technique or to protect against any
increase in the price of securities the Trust anticipates purchasing at a later date. The Trust intends to use these transactions for duration and risk management purposes and not as a speculative investment. The Trust will not sell interest rate
caps or floors that it does not own. Interest rate swaps involve the exchange by the Trust with another party of their respective commitments to pay or receive interest, e.g., an exchange of floating rate payments for fixed rate payments with
respect to a notional amount of principal. The purchase of an interest rate cap entitles the purchaser, to the extent that a specified index exceeds a predetermined interest rate, to receive payments of interest on a notional principal amount from
the party selling such interest rate cap. The purchase of an interest rate floor entitles the purchaser, to the extent that a specified index falls below a predetermined interest rate, to receive payments of interest on a notional principal amount
from the party selling such interest rate floor.
The Trust may enter into interest rate swaps, caps and floors on either an asset-based or
liability-based basis, depending on whether it is offsetting volatility with respect to its assets or liabilities, and will usually enter into interest rate swaps on a net basis, i.e., the two payment streams are netted out, with the Trust receiving
or paying, as the case may be, only the net amount of the two payments on the payment dates. In as much as these Strategic Transactions are entered into for good faith risk management purposes, the Advisors and the Trust believe such obligations do
not constitute senior securities and, accordingly, will not treat them as being subject to its borrowing restrictions. The Trust will accrue the net amount of the excess, if any, of the Trusts obligations over its entitlements with respect to
each interest rate swap on a daily basis and will designate on its books and records with a custodian an amount of cash or liquid high grade securities having an aggregate net asset value at all times at least equal to the accrued excess. The Trust
will not enter into any interest rate swap, cap or floor transaction unless the unsecured senior debt or the claims-paying ability of the other party thereto is rated in the highest rating category of at least one nationally recognized statistical
rating organization at the time of entering into such transaction. If there is a default by the other party to such a transaction, the Trust will have contractual remedies pursuant to the agreements related to the transaction. The swap market has
grown substantially in recent years with a large number of banks and investment banking firms acting both as principals and as agents utilizing standardized swap documentation. Caps and floors are more recent innovations for which standardized
documentation has not yet been developed and, accordingly, they are less liquid than swaps.
Foreign Currency Transactions. The Trusts common
shares are priced in U.S. dollars and the distributions paid by the Trust to common shareholders are paid in U.S. dollars. However, a portion of the Trusts assets may be denominated
in non-U.S. currencies and the income received by the Trust from such securities will be paid in non-U.S. currencies. The Trust also may invest in or
gain exposure to non-U.S. currencies for investment or hedging purposes. The Trusts investments in securities that trade in, or receive revenues
in, non-U.S. currencies will be subject to currency risk, which is the risk that fluctuations in the exchange rates between the U.S. dollar and foreign currencies may negatively affect an investment.
The Trust may (but is not required to) hedge some or all of its exposure to non-U.S. currencies through the use of derivative strategies, including forward foreign currency exchange contracts,
foreign currency futures contracts and options on foreign currencies and foreign currency futures. Suitable hedging transactions may not be available in all circumstances and there can be no assurance that the Trust will engage in such transactions
at any given time or from time to time when they would be beneficial. Although the Trust has the flexibility to engage in such transactions, the Advisors may determine not to do so or to do so only in unusual circumstances or market conditions.
These transactions may not be successful and may eliminate any chance for the Trust to benefit from favorable fluctuations in relevant foreign currencies. The Trust may also use derivatives contracts for purposes of increasing exposure to a foreign
currency or to shift exposure to foreign currency fluctuations from one currency to another.
- 35 -
Foreign Exchange Transactions. The Trust may engage in spot and forward foreign
exchange transactions and currency swaps, purchase and sell options on currencies and purchase and sell currency futures and related options thereon (collectively, Currency Instruments). Such transactions could be effected with respect
to hedges on foreign dollar denominated securities owned by the Trust, sold by the Trust but not yet delivered, or committed or anticipated to be purchased by the Trust. As an illustration, the Trust may use such techniques to hedge the stated value
in U.S. dollars of an investment in a yen-denominated security. In such circumstances, for example, the Trust may purchase a foreign currency put option enabling it to sell a specified amount of yen
for dollars at a specified price by a future date. To the extent the hedge is successful, a loss in the value of the yen relative to the dollar will tend to be offset by an increase in the value of the put option. To offset, in whole or in part, the
cost of acquiring such a put option, the Trust may also sell a call option which, if exercised, requires it to sell a specified amount of yen for dollars at a specified price by a future date (a technique called a straddle). By selling
such a call option in this illustration, the Trust gives up the opportunity to profit without limit from increases in the relative value of the yen to the dollar. Straddles of the type that may be used by the Trust are considered to
constitute hedging transactions. The Trust may not attempt to hedge any or all of its foreign portfolio positions.
Forward Foreign
Currency Contracts. The Trust may enter into forward currency contracts to purchase or sell foreign currencies for a fixed amount of U.S. dollars or another foreign currency. A forward currency contract involves an obligation to purchase or
sell a specific currency at a future date, which may be any fixed number of days (term) from the date of the forward currency contract agreed upon by the parties, at a price set at the time the forward currency contract is entered into. Forward
currency contracts are traded directly between currency traders (usually large commercial banks) and their customers. The Trust may purchase a forward currency contract to lock in the U.S. dollar price of a security denominated in a foreign currency
that the Trust intends to acquire. The Trust may sell a forward currency contract to lock in the U.S. dollar equivalent of the proceeds from the anticipated sale of a security or a dividend or interest payment denominated in a foreign currency. The
Trust may also use forward currency contracts to shift the Trusts exposure to foreign currency exchange rate changes from one currency to another. For example, if the Trust owns securities denominated in a foreign currency and the Advisors
believe that currency will decline relative to another currency, the Trust might enter into a forward currency contract to sell the appropriate amount of the first foreign currency with payment to be made in the second currency. The Trust may also
purchase forward currency contracts to enhance income when the Advisors anticipate that the foreign currency will appreciate in value but securities denominated in that currency do not present attractive investment opportunities. The Trust may also
use forward currency contracts to hedge against a decline in the value of existing investments denominated in a foreign currency. Such a hedge would tend to offset both positive and negative currency fluctuations, but would not offset changes in
security values caused by other factors. The Trust could also hedge the position by entering into a forward currency contract to sell another currency expected to perform similarly to the currency in which the Trusts existing investments are
denominated. This type of transaction could offer advantages in terms of cost, yield or efficiency, but may not hedge currency exposure as effectively as a simple forward currency transaction to sell U.S. dollars. This type of transaction may result
in losses if the currency used to hedge does not perform similarly to the currency in which the hedged securities are denominated. The Trust may also use forward currency contracts in one currency or a basket of currencies to attempt to hedge
against fluctuations in the value of securities denominated in a different currency if the Advisors anticipate that there will be a correlation between the two currencies.
The cost to the Trust of engaging in forward currency contracts varies with factors such as the currency involved, the length of the contract period and the
market conditions then prevailing. Because forward currency contracts are usually entered into on a principal basis, no fees or commissions are usually involved. When the Trust enters into a forward currency contract, it relies on the counterparty
to make or take delivery of the underlying currency at the maturity of the contract. Failure by the counterparty to do so would result in the loss of some or all of any expected benefit of the transaction. Secondary markets generally do not exist
for forward currency contracts, with the result that closing transactions generally can be made for forward currency contracts only by negotiating directly with the counterparty. Thus, there can be no assurance that the Trust will in fact be able to
close out a forward currency contract at a favorable price prior to maturity. In addition, in the event of insolvency of the counterparty, the Trust might be unable to close out a forward currency contract. In either event, the Trust would continue
to be subject to market risk with respect to the position. The precise matching of forward currency contract amounts and the value of the securities involved generally will not be possible because the value of such securities, measured in the
foreign currency, will change after the forward currency contract has been established. Thus, the Trust might need to
- 36 -
purchase or sell foreign currencies in the spot (cash) market to the extent such foreign currencies are not covered by forward currency contracts. The projection of short-term currency market
movements is extremely difficult and the successful execution of a short-term hedging strategy is highly uncertain.
Put and Call Options on Securities
and Indices. The Trust may purchase and sell put and call options on securities and indices. A put option gives the purchaser of the option the right to sell and the writer the obligation to buy the underlying security at the exercise price
during the option period. The Trust may also purchase and sell options on bond indices (index options). Index options are similar to options on securities except that, rather than taking or making delivery of securities underlying the
option at a specified price upon exercise, an index option gives the holder the right to receive cash upon exercise of the option if the level of the bond index upon which the option is based is greater, in the case of a call, or less, in the case
of a put, than the exercise price of the option. The purchase of a put option on a debt security could protect the Trusts holdings in a security or a number of securities against a substantial decline in the market value. A call option gives
the purchaser of the option the right to buy and the seller the obligation to sell the underlying security or index at the exercise price during the option period or for a specified period prior to a fixed date. The purchase of a call option on a
security could protect the Trust against an increase in the price of a security that it intended to purchase in the future.
Writing Covered Call
Options. The Trust is authorized to write (i.e., sell) covered call options with respect to municipal securities it owns, thereby giving the holder of the option the right to buy the underlying security covered by the option from the Trust at
the stated exercise price until the option expires. The Trust writes only covered call options, which means that so long as the Trust is obligated as the writer of a call option, it will own the underlying securities subject to the option.
The Trust receives a premium from writing a call option, which increases the Trusts return on the underlying security in the event the option expires
unexercised or is closed out at a profit. By writing a call, the Trust limits its opportunity to profit from an increase in the market value of the underlying security above the exercise price of the option for as long as the Trusts obligation
as a writer continues. Covered call options serve as a partial hedge against a decline in the price of the underlying security. The Trust may engage in closing transactions in order to terminate outstanding options that it has written.
Financial Futures Transactions and Options. The Trust is authorized to purchase and sell certain exchange traded financial futures contracts
(financial futures contracts) in order to hedge its investments against declines in value, and to hedge against increases in the cost of securities it intends to purchase or to seek to enhance the Trusts return. However, any
transactions involving financial futures or options (including puts and calls associated therewith) will be in accordance with the Trusts investment policies and limitations. A financial futures contract obligates the seller of a contract to
deliver and the purchaser of a contract to take delivery of the type of financial instrument covered by the contract, or in the case of index-based futures contracts to make and accept a cash settlement, at a specific future time for a specified
price. To hedge its portfolio, the Trust may take an investment position in a futures contract which will move in the opposite direction from the portfolio position being hedged. A sale of financial futures contracts may provide a hedge against a
decline in the value of portfolio securities because such depreciation may be offset, in whole or in part, by an increase in the value of the position in the financial futures contracts. A purchase of financial futures contracts may provide a hedge
against an increase in the cost of securities intended to be purchased because such appreciation may be offset, in whole or in part, by an increase in the value of the position in the futures contracts.
Distributions, if any, of net long-term capital gains from certain transactions in futures or options are taxable at long-term capital gains rates for U.S.
federal income tax purposes.
Futures Contracts. A futures contract is an agreement between two parties to buy and sell a security or, in the case
of an index-based futures contract, to make and accept a cash settlement for a set price on a future date. A majority of transactions in futures contracts, however, do not result in the actual delivery of the underlying instrument or cash
settlement, but are settled through liquidation, i.e., by entering into an offsetting transaction. Futures contracts have been designed by boards of trade which have been designated contracts markets by the Commodity Futures Trading
Commission (the CFTC).
- 37 -
The purchase or sale of a futures contract differs from the purchase or sale of a security in that no price or
premium is paid or received. Instead, an amount of cash or securities acceptable to the broker and the relevant contract market, which varies, but is generally about 5% of the contract amount, must be deposited with the broker. This amount is known
as initial margin and represents a good faith deposit assuring the performance of both the purchaser and seller under the futures contract. Subsequent payments to and from the broker, called variation margin, are
required to be made on a daily basis as the price of the futures contract fluctuates making the long and short positions in the futures contract more or less valuable, a process known as marking to the market. At any time prior to the
settlement date of the futures contract, the position may be closed out by taking an opposite position that will operate to terminate the position in the futures contract. A final determination of variation margin is then made, additional cash is
required to be paid to or released by the broker and the purchaser realizes a loss or gain. In addition, a nominal commission is paid on each completed sale transaction.
The Trust may also purchase and sell financial futures contracts on U.S. Government securities as a hedge against adverse changes in interest rates as
described below. With respect to U.S. Government securities, currently there are financial futures contracts based on long-term U.S. Treasury bonds, U.S. Treasury notes, Government National Mortgage Association Certificates and three-month U.S.
Treasury bills. The Trust may purchase and write call and put options on futures contracts on U.S. Government securities and purchase and sell municipal security index futures contracts in connection with its hedging strategies.
The Trust also may engage in other futures contracts transactions such as futures contracts on other municipal bond indices that may become available if the
Advisors should determine that there is normally a sufficient correlation between the prices of such futures contracts and the municipal securities in which the Trust invests to make such hedging appropriate.
Futures Strategies. The Trust may sell a financial futures contract (i.e., assume a short position) in anticipation of a decline in the value of its
investments resulting from an increase in interest rates or otherwise. The risk of decline could be reduced without employing futures as a hedge by selling investments and either reinvesting the proceeds in securities with shorter maturities or by
holding assets in cash. This strategy, however, entails increased transaction costs in the form of dealer spreads and typically would reduce the average yield of the Trusts portfolio securities as a result of the shortening of maturities. The
sale of futures contracts provides an alternative means of hedging against declines in the value of its investments. As such values decline, the value of the Trusts positions in the futures contracts will tend to increase, thus offsetting all
or a portion of the depreciation in the market value of the Trusts investments that are being hedged. While the Trust will incur commission expenses in selling and closing out futures positions, commissions on futures transactions are
typically lower than transaction costs incurred in the purchase and sale of the Trusts investments being hedged. In addition, the ability of the Trust to trade in the standardized contracts available in the futures markets may offer a more
effective defensive position than a program to reduce the average maturity of the portfolio securities due to the unique and varied credit and technical characteristics of the instruments available to the Trust. Employing futures as a hedge also may
permit the Trust to assume a defensive posture without reducing the yield on its investments beyond any amounts required to engage in futures trading.
When the Trust intends to purchase a security, the Trust may purchase futures contracts as a hedge against any increase in the cost of such security resulting
from a decrease in interest rates or otherwise, that may occur before such purchase can be effected. Subject to the degree of correlation between such securities and the futures contracts, subsequent increases in the cost of such securities should
be reflected in the value of the futures held by the Trust. As such purchases are made, an equivalent amount of futures contracts will be closed out. Due to changing market conditions and interest rate forecasts, however, a futures position may be
terminated without a corresponding purchase of portfolio securities.
Call Options on Futures Contracts. The Trust may also purchase and sell
exchange traded call and put options on financial futures contracts. The purchase of a call option on a futures contract is analogous to the purchase of a call option on an individual security. Depending on the pricing of the option compared to
either the futures contract upon which it is based or the price of the underlying securities, it may or may not be less risky than ownership of the futures contract or underlying securities. Like the purchase of a futures contract, the Trust may
purchase a call option on a futures contract to hedge against a market advance when the Trust is not fully invested.
- 38 -
The writing of a call option on a futures contract constitutes a partial hedge against declining prices of the
securities which are deliverable upon exercise of the futures contract. If the futures price at expiration is below the exercise price, the Trust will retain the full amount of the option premium, which provides a partial hedge against any decline
that may have occurred in the Trusts portfolio holdings.
Put Options on Futures Contracts. The purchase of a put option on a futures
contract is analogous to the purchase of a protective put option on portfolio securities. The Trust may purchase a put option on a futures contract to hedge the Trusts portfolio against the risk of rising interest rates.
The writing of a put option on a futures contract constitutes a partial hedge against increasing prices of the securities which are deliverable upon exercise
of the futures contract. If the futures price at expiration is higher than the exercise price, the Trust will retain the full amount of the option premium, which provides a partial hedge against any increase in the price of securities which the
Trust intends to purchase.
The writer of an option on a futures contract is required to deposit initial and variation margin pursuant to requirements
similar to those applicable to futures contracts. Premiums received from the writing of an option will be included in initial margin. The writing of an option on a futures contract involves risks similar to those relating to futures contracts.
The CFTC subjects advisers to registered investment companies to regulation by the CFTC if a fund that is advised by the investment adviser either
(i) invests, directly or indirectly, more than a prescribed level of its liquidation value in CFTC-regulated futures, options and swaps (CFTC Derivatives), or (ii) markets itself as providing investment exposure to such
instruments. To the extent the Trust uses CFTC Derivatives, it intends to do so below such prescribed levels and will not market itself as a commodity pool or a vehicle for trading such instruments. Accordingly, the Advisor has claimed
an exclusion from the definition of the term commodity pool operator under the Commodity Exchange Act (CEA) pursuant to Rule 4.5 under the CEA. The Advisor is not, therefore, subject to registration or regulation as a
commodity pool operator under the CEA in respect of the Trust.
Additional Information About Options. The Trusts ability to
close out its position as a purchaser or seller of an exchange-listed put or call option is dependent upon the existence of a liquid secondary market on option exchanges. Among the possible reasons for the absence of a liquid secondary market on an
exchange are: (i) insufficient trading interest in certain options; (ii) restrictions on transactions imposed by an exchange; (iii) trading halts, suspensions or other restrictions imposed with respect to particular classes or series
of options or underlying securities; (iv) interruption of the normal operations on an exchange; (v) inadequacy of the facilities of an exchange or the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (the OCC) to handle current
trading volume; or (vi) a decision by one or more exchanges to discontinue the trading of options (or a particular class or series of options), in which event the secondary market on that exchange (or in that class or series of options) would
cease to exist, although outstanding options on that exchange that had been listed by the OCC as a result of trades on that exchange would generally continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms. Over-the-counter (OTC) options are purchased from or sold to dealers, financial institutions or other counterparties which have entered into direct agreements with the Trust. With OTC options,
such variables as expiration date, exercise price and premium will be agreed upon between the Trust and the counterparty, without the intermediation of a third party such as the OCC. If the counterparty fails to make or take delivery of the
securities underlying an option it has written, or otherwise settle the transaction in accordance with the terms of that option as written, the Trust would lose the premium paid for the option as well as any anticipated benefit of the transaction.
OTC options and assets used to cover OTC options written by the Trust are considered by the staff of the SEC to be illiquid. The illiquidity of such options or assets may prevent a successful sale of such options or assets, result in a delay of
sale, or reduce the amount of proceeds that might otherwise be realized.
The Trust may engage in options and futures transactions on exchanges and
options in the over-the-counter markets. The Trust will only enter into OTC options with counterparties the Advisors believe to be creditworthy at the time they enter
into such transactions.
The hours of trading for options on debt securities may not conform to the hours during which the underlying securities are
traded. To the extent that the option markets close before the markets for the underlying securities,
- 39 -
significant price and rate movements can take place in the underlying markets that cannot be reflected in the option markets.
Structured Instruments. The Trust may invest in structured instruments. While structured instruments may offer the potential for a favorable rate of
return from time to time, they also entail certain risks. Structured instruments may be less liquid than other securities and the price of structured instruments may be more volatile. In some cases, depending on the terms of the embedded index, a
structured instrument may provide that the principal and/or interest payments may be adjusted below zero. Structured instruments also may involve significant credit risk and risk of default by the counterparty. Structured instruments may also be
illiquid. Like other sophisticated strategies, the Trusts use of structured instruments may not work as intended.
Structured
Notes. The Trust may invest in structured notes and other related instruments, which are privately negotiated debt obligations in which the principal and/or interest is determined by reference to the performance of a benchmark
asset, market or interest rate (an embedded index), such as selected securities, an index of securities or specified interest rates, or the differential performance of two assets or markets. Structured instruments may be issued by
corporations, including banks, as well as by governmental agencies. Structured instruments frequently are assembled in the form of medium-term notes, but a variety of forms are available and may be used in particular circumstances. The terms of such
structured instruments normally provide that their principal and/or interest payments are to be adjusted upwards or downwards (but ordinarily not below zero) to reflect changes in the embedded index while the structured instruments are outstanding.
As a result, the interest and/or principal payments that may be made on a structured product may vary widely, depending on a variety of factors, including the volatility of the embedded index and the effect of changes in the embedded index on
principal and/or interest payments. The rate of return on structured notes may be determined by applying a multiplier to the performance or differential performance of the referenced index(es) or other asset(s). Application of a multiplier involves
leverage that will serve to magnify the potential for gain and the risk of loss.
Event-Linked Securities. The Trust may
obtain event-linked exposure by investing in event-linked bonds or event-linked swaps or by implementing event-linked strategies. Event-linked exposure results in gains or losses that typically are contingent
upon, or formulaically related to, defined trigger events. Examples of trigger events include hurricanes, earthquakes, weather-related phenomena or statistics relating to such events. Some event-linked bonds are commonly referred to as
catastrophe bonds. If a trigger event occurs, the Trust may lose a portion of or its entire principal invested in the bond or the entire notional amount of a swap. Event-linked exposure often provides for an extension of maturity to
process and audit loss claims when a trigger event has, or possibly has, occurred. An extension of maturity may increase volatility. Event-linked exposure may also expose the Trust to certain other risks including credit risk, counterparty risk,
adverse regulatory or jurisdictional interpretations and adverse tax consequences. Event-linked exposures may also be subject to liquidity risk.
Equity-Linked Notes. Equity-linked notes are hybrid securities with characteristics of both fixed income and equity securities. An
equity-linked note is a debt instrument, usually a bond, that pays interest based upon the performance of an underlying equity, which can be a single stock, basket of stocks or an equity index. Instead of paying a predetermined coupon, equity-linked
notes link the interest payment to the performance of a particular equity market index or basket of stocks or commodities. The interest payment is typically based on the percentage increase in an index from a predetermined level, but alternatively
may be based on a decrease in the index. The interest payment may in some cases be leveraged so that, in percentage terms, it exceeds the relative performance of the market. Equity-linked notes generally are subject to the risks associated with the
securities of equity issuers, default risk and counterparty risk.
Credit Linked Notes. A credit-linked note (CLN) is a
derivative instrument. It is a synthetic obligation between two or more parties where the payment of principal and/or interest is based on the performance of some obligation (a reference obligation). In addition to the credit risk of the reference
obligations and interest rate risk, the buyer/seller of the CLN is subject to counterparty risk.
Hybrid Instruments. A hybrid instrument is a
type of potentially high-risk derivative that combines a traditional bond, stock or commodity with an option or forward contract. Generally, the principal amount, amount payable upon maturity or redemption, or interest rate of a hybrid is tied
(positively or negatively) to the price of some commodity, currency or securities index or another interest rate or some other economic factor (each a
- 40 -
benchmark). The interest rate or (unlike most fixed income securities) the principal amount payable at maturity of a hybrid security may be increased or decreased, depending on
changes in the value of the benchmark. An example of a hybrid could be a bond issued by an oil company that pays a small base level of interest with additional interest that accrues in correlation to the extent to which oil prices exceed a certain
predetermined level. Such a hybrid instrument would be a combination of a bond and a call option on oil. Hybrids can be used as an efficient means of pursuing a variety of investment goals, including currency hedging, duration management and
increased total return. Hybrids may not bear interest or pay dividends. The value of a hybrid or its interest rate may be a multiple of a benchmark and, as a result, may be leveraged and move (up or down) more steeply and rapidly than the benchmark.
These benchmarks may be sensitive to economic and political events, such as commodity shortages and currency devaluations, which cannot be readily foreseen by the purchaser of a hybrid. Under certain conditions, the redemption value of a hybrid
could be zero. Thus, an investment in a hybrid may entail significant market risks that are not associated with a similar investment in a traditional, U.S. dollar-denominated bond that has a fixed principal amount and pays a fixed rate or floating
rate of interest. The purchase of hybrids also exposes the Trust to the credit risk of the issuer of the hybrids. These risks may cause significant fluctuations in the NAV of the Trusts common shares if the Trust invests in hybrid instruments.
Other Investment Companies. The Trust may invest in securities of other investment companies (including exchange-traded funds (ETFs)
and business development companies (BDCs), subject to applicable regulatory limits. As a shareholder in an investment company, the Trust will bear its ratable share of that investment companys expenses and will remain subject
to payment of the Trusts advisory and other fees and expenses with respect to assets so invested. Holders of common shares will therefore be subject to duplicative expenses to the extent the Trust invests in other investment companies. The
Advisors will take expenses into account when evaluating the investment merits of an investment in an investment company relative to available equity and/or fixed income securities investments. In addition, the securities of other investment
companies may be leveraged and will therefore be subject to the same leverage risks to which the Trust may be subject to the extent it employs a leverage strategy. The NAV and market value of securities of leveraged shares will be more volatile and
the yield to shareholders will tend to fluctuate more than the yield generated by unleveraged shares. Investment companies may have investment policies that differ from those of the Trust. In addition, to the extent the Trust invests in other
investment companies, the Trust will be dependent upon the investment and research abilities of persons other than the Advisors.
The Trust may invest in
ETFs, which are investment companies that typically aim to track or replicate a desired index, such as a sector, market or global segment. ETFs are typically passively managed and their shares are traded on a national exchange or The NASDAQ Stock
Market, Inc. ETFs do not sell individual shares directly to investors and only issue their shares in large blocks known as creation units. The investor purchasing a creation unit may sell the individual shares on a secondary market.
Therefore, the liquidity of ETFs depends on the adequacy of the secondary market. There can be no assurance that an ETFs investment objective will be achieved, as ETFs based on an index may not replicate and maintain exactly the composition
and relative weightings of securities in the index. ETFs are subject to the risks of investing in the underlying securities. The Trust, as a holder of the securities of the ETF, will bear its pro rata portion of the ETFs expenses, including
advisory fees. These expenses are in addition to the direct expenses of the Trusts own operations.
Repurchase Agreements and Purchase and Sale
Contracts. The Trust may invest in repurchase agreements. A repurchase agreement is a contractual agreement whereby the seller of securities agrees to repurchase the same security at a specified price on a future date agreed upon by the parties.
The agreed upon repurchase price determines the yield during the Trusts holding period. Repurchase agreements are considered to be loans collateralized by the underlying security that is the subject of the repurchase contract. Income generated
from transactions in repurchase agreements will be taxable. The risk to the Trust is limited to the ability of the issuer to pay the agreed upon repurchase price on the delivery date; however, although the value of the underlying collateral at the
time the transaction is entered into always equals or exceeds the agreed upon repurchase price, if the value of the collateral declines there is a risk of loss of both principal and interest. In the event of default, the collateral may be sold but
the Trust might incur a loss if the value of the collateral declines, and might incur disposition costs or experience delays in connection with liquidating the collateral. In addition, if bankruptcy proceedings are commenced with respect to the
seller of the security, realization upon the collateral by the Trust may be delayed or limited. The Advisors will monitor the value of the collateral at the time the transaction is entered into and at all times subsequent during the term of the
repurchase agreement in an effort to determine that such value always
- 41 -
equals or exceeds the agreed upon repurchase price. In the event the value of the collateral declines below the repurchase price, the Advisors will demand additional collateral from the issuer to
increase the value of the collateral to at least that of the repurchase price, including interest.
A purchase and sale contract is similar to a
repurchase agreement, but differs from a repurchase agreement in that the contract arrangements stipulate that the securities are owned by the Trust. In the event of a default under such a repurchase agreement or a purchase and sale contract,
instead of the contractual fixed rate of return, the rate of return to the Trust shall be dependent upon intervening fluctuations of the market value of such security and the accrued interest on the security. In such event, the Trust would have
rights against the seller for breach of contract with respect to any losses arising from market fluctuations following the failure of the seller to perform.
Short Sales. The Trust may make short sales of securities. A short sale is a transaction in which the Trust sells a security it does not own in
anticipation that the market price of that security will decline. The Trust may make short sales to hedge positions, for duration and risk management, in order to maintain portfolio flexibility or, to the extent applicable, to enhance income or
gain. When the Trust makes a short sale, it must borrow the security sold short and deliver it to the broker-dealer through which it made the short sale as collateral for its obligation to deliver the security upon conclusion of the sale. The Trust
may have to pay a fee to borrow particular securities and is often obligated to pay over to the securities lender any income, distributions or dividends received on such borrowed securities until it returns the security to the securities lender. The
Trusts obligation to replace the borrowed security will be secured by collateral deposited with the securities lender, usually cash, U.S. government securities or other liquid assets. Depending on arrangements made with the securities lender
regarding payment over of any income, distributions or dividends received by the Trust on such security, the Trust may not receive any payments (including interest) on its collateral deposited with such securities lender. If the price of the
security sold short increases between the time of the short sale and the time the Trust replaces the borrowed security, the Trust will incur a loss; conversely, if the price declines, the Trust will realize a gain. Any gain will be decreased, and
any loss increased, by the transaction costs described above. Although the Trusts gain is limited to the price at which it sold the security short, its potential loss is theoretically unlimited. The Trust may also make short sales
against the box. In this type of short sale, at the time of the sale, the Trust owns or has the immediate and unconditional right to acquire at no additional cost the identical security. The Trust must comply with Rule 18f-4 under the Investment Company Act with respect to its short sale borrowings, which are considered derivatives transactions under the Rule. See Additional Risk FactorsRisk Factors in Strategic
Transactions and DerivativesRule 18f-4 Under the Investment Company Act in the SAI.
Bank
Obligations. Bank obligations may include certificates of deposit, bankers acceptances and fixed time deposits. Certificates of deposit are negotiable certificates issued against funds deposited in a commercial bank for a definite
period of time and earning a specified return. Bankers acceptances are negotiable drafts or bills of exchange, normally drawn by an importer or exporter to pay for specific merchandise, which are accepted by a bank, meaning, in
effect, that the bank unconditionally agrees to pay the face value of the instrument on maturity. Fixed time deposits are bank obligations payable at a stated maturity date and bearing interest at a fixed rate. Fixed time deposits may be withdrawn
on demand by the investor, but may be subject to early withdrawal penalties, which vary depending upon market conditions and the remaining maturity of the obligation. There are no contractual restrictions on the right to transfer a beneficial
interest in a fixed time deposit to a third party, although there is no market for such deposits.
Obligations of foreign banks involve somewhat different
investment risks than those affecting obligations of U.S. banks, including the possibilities that their liquidity could be impaired because of future political and economic developments, that their obligations may be less marketable than comparable
obligations of U.S. banks, that a foreign jurisdiction might impose withholding taxes on interest income payable on those obligations, that foreign deposits may be seized or nationalized, that foreign governmental restrictions such as exchange
controls may be adopted which might adversely affect the payment of principal and interest on those obligations and that the selection of those obligations may be more difficult because there may be less publicly available information concerning
foreign banks or the accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards, practices and requirements applicable to foreign banks may differ from those applicable to U.S. banks. Foreign banks are not generally subject to examination by any U.S.
government agency or instrumentality.
- 42 -
Participation Notes. The Trust may buy participation notes from a bank or broker-dealer
(issuer) that entitle the Trust to a return measured by the change in value of an identified underlying security or basket of securities (collectively, the underlying security). Participation notes are typically used when a
direct investment in the underlying security is restricted due to country-specific regulations.
The Trust is subject to counterparty risk associated with
each issuer. Investment in a participation note is not the same as investment in the constituent shares of the company. A participation note represents only an obligation of the issuer to provide the Trust the economic performance equivalent to
holding shares of an underlying security. A participation note does not provide any beneficial or equitable entitlement or interest in the relevant underlying security. In other words, shares of the underlying security are not in any way owned by
the Trust. However each participation note synthetically replicates the economic benefit of holding shares in the underlying security. Because a participation note is an obligation of the issuer, rather than a direct investment in shares of the
underlying security, the Trust may suffer losses potentially equal to the full value of the participation note if the issuer fails to perform its obligations.
The counterparty may, but is not required to, purchase the shares of the underlying security to hedge its obligation. The Trust may, but is not required to,
purchase credit protection against the default of the issuer. When the participation note expires or the Trust exercises the participation note and closes its position, the Trust receives a payment that is based upon the then-current value of the
underlying security converted into U.S. dollars (less transaction costs). The price, performance and liquidity of the participation note are all linked directly to the underlying security. The Trusts ability to redeem or exercise a
participation note generally is dependent on the liquidity in the local trading market for the security underlying the participation note.
When-Issued, Delayed Delivery and Forward Commitment Securities. The Trust may purchase securities on a when-issued basis and may
purchase or sell securities on a forward commitment basis (including on a TBA (to be announced) basis) or on a delayed delivery basis. When such transactions are negotiated, the price, which is generally expressed
in yield terms, is fixed at the time the commitment is made, but delivery and payment for the securities take place at a later date. When-issued securities and forward commitments may be sold prior to the settlement date. If the Trust disposes of
the right to acquire a when-issued security prior to its acquisition or disposes of its right to deliver or receive against a forward commitment, it might incur a gain or loss. There is always a risk that the securities may not be delivered and that
the Trust may incur a loss. Settlements in the ordinary course are not treated by the Trust as when-issued or forward commitment transactions and accordingly are not subject to the foregoing restrictions.
Rule 18f-4 under the Investment Company Act permits the Trust to enter into when-issued or forward-settling securities
(e.g., firm and standby commitments, including TBA commitments, and dollar rolls) and non-standard settlement cycle securities notwithstanding the limitation on the issuance of senior securities in
Section 18 of the Investment Company Act, provided that the Trust intends to physically settle the transaction and the transaction will settle within 35 days of its trade date (the Delayed-Settlement Securities Provision). If a
when-issued, forward-settling or non-standard settlement cycle security does not satisfy the Delayed-Settlement Securities Provision, then it is treated as a derivatives transaction under Rule 18f-4. See Additional Risk FactorsRisk Factors in Strategic Transactions and DerivativesRule 18f-4 Under the Investment Company Act below.
Standby Commitment Agreements. The Trust from time to time may enter into standby commitment agreements. Such agreements commit the Trust, for a stated
period of time, to purchase a stated amount of a fixed income security that may be issued and sold to the Trust at the option of the issuer. The price and coupon of the security is fixed at the time of the commitment. At the time of entering into
the agreement the Trust may be paid a commitment fee, regardless of whether or not the security ultimately is issued. The Trust will enter into such agreements only for the purpose of investing in the security underlying the commitment at a yield
and price which is considered advantageous to the Trust. The Trust at all times will designate on its books and records cash or other liquid assets with a value equal to the purchase price of the securities underlying the commitment.
There can be no assurance that the securities subject to a standby commitment will be issued and the value of the security, if issued, on the delivery date
may be more or less than its purchase price. Since the issuance of the security underlying the commitment is at the option of the issuer, the Trust may bear the risk of decline in the value of such security and may not benefit from an appreciation
in the value of the security during the commitment period.
- 43 -
The purchase of a security subject to a standby commitment agreement and the related commitment fee will be
recorded on the date on which the security reasonably can be expected to be issued and the value of the security thereafter will be reflected in the calculation of the Trusts NAV. The cost basis of the security will be adjusted by the amount
of the commitment fee. In the event the security is not issued, the commitment fee will be recorded as income on the expiration date of the standby commitment.
Temporary Defensive Positions. During temporary defensive periods, if the Advisors determine that market conditions warrant, and also during the
period in which the net proceeds of this offering of common shares (or preferred shares, should the Trust determine to issue preferred shares in the future) are being invested, the Trust may invest any percentage of its assets without limitation in
cash, cash equivalents, money market securities, such as U.S. Treasury and agency obligations, other U.S. government securities, short-term debt obligations of corporate issuers, certificates of deposit, bankers acceptances, commercial paper
(short-term, unsecured, negotiable promissory notes of a domestic or foreign issuer), repurchase agreements, obligations of supranational organizations, bank obligations, including U.S. subsidiaries and branches of foreign banks, or other high
quality fixed income securities. Temporary defensive positions may affect the Trusts ability to achieve its investment objective. Generally, such obligations will mature within one year from the date of settlement, but may mature within
two years from the date of settlement.
Short-Term Debt Securities. Short-term debt securities are defined to include, without limitation:
|
● |
|
U.S. government securities, including bills, notes and bonds differing as to maturity and rates of interest that
are either issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Treasury or by U.S. government agencies or instrumentalities. U.S. government securities include securities issued by (a) the FHA, Farmers Home Administration, Export-Import Bank of the United States,
Small Business Administration and GNMA, whose securities are supported by the full faith and credit of the United States; (b) the FHLBs, Federal Intermediate Credit Banks, and Tennessee Valley Authority, whose securities are supported by the
right of the agency to borrow from the U.S. Treasury; (c) FNMA, whose securities are supported by the discretionary authority of the U.S. government to purchase certain obligations of the agency or instrumentality; and (d) the Student Loan
Marketing Association, whose securities are supported only by its credit. While the U.S. government provides financial support to such U.S. government-sponsored agencies or instrumentalities, no assurance can be given that it always will do so since
it is not so obligated by law. The U.S. government, its agencies and instrumentalities do not guarantee the market value of their securities. Consequently, the value of such securities may fluctuate. |
|
● |
|
Certificates of deposit issued against funds deposited in a bank or a savings and loan association. Such
certificates are for a definite period of time, earn a specified rate of return, and are normally negotiable. The issuer of a certificate of deposit agrees to pay the amount deposited plus interest to the bearer of the certificate on the date
specified thereon. Certificates of deposit purchased by the Trust may not be fully insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation. |
|
● |
|
Repurchase agreements, which involve purchases of debt securities. |
|
● |
|
Commercial paper, which consists of short-term unsecured promissory notes, including variable rate master demand
notes issued by corporations to finance their current operations. Master demand notes are direct lending arrangements between the Trust and a corporation. There is no secondary market for such notes. However, they are redeemable by the Trust at any
time. The Advisors will consider the financial condition of the corporation (e.g., earning power, cash flow and other liquidity ratios) and will continuously monitor the corporations ability to meet all of its financial obligations, because
the Trusts liquidity might be impaired if the corporation were unable to pay principal and interest on demand. |
New
Products. The financial markets continue to evolve and financial products continue to be developed. The Trust reserves the right to invest in new financial products as they are developed or become more widely accepted. As with any new
financial product, these products will entail risks, including risks to which the Trust currently is not subject.
- 44 -
Securities Lending. The Trust may lend portfolio securities to certain borrowers determined to be
creditworthy by the Advisor, including to borrowers affiliated with the Advisor. The borrowers provide collateral that is maintained in an amount at least equal to the current market value of the securities loaned. No securities loan will be made on
behalf of the Trust if, as a result, the aggregate value of all securities loans of the Trust exceeds one-third of the value of the Trusts total assets (including the value of the collateral received).
The Trust may terminate a loan at any time and obtain the return of the securities loaned. The Trust receives the value of any interest or cash or non-cash distributions paid on the loaned securities.
With respect to loans that are collateralized by cash, the borrower may be entitled to receive a fee based on the amount of cash collateral. The Trust is
compensated by the difference between the amount earned on the reinvestment of cash collateral and the fee paid to the borrower. In the case of collateral other than cash, the Trust is compensated by a fee paid by the borrower equal to a percentage
of the market value of the loaned securities. Any cash collateral received by the Trust for such loans, and uninvested cash, may be invested, among other things, in a private investment company managed by an affiliate of the Advisor or in registered
money market funds advised by the Advisor or their affiliates; such investments are subject to investment risk.
The Trust conducts its securities lending
pursuant to an exemptive order from the SEC permitting it to lend portfolio securities to borrowers affiliated with the Trust and to retain an affiliate of the Trust as lending agent. To the extent that the Trust engages in securities lending,
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC (BIM), an affiliate of the Advisor, acts as securities lending agent for the Trust, subject to the overall supervision of the Advisor. BIM administers the lending program in accordance with guidelines
approved by the Board.
To the extent the Trust engages in securities lending, the Trust retains a portion of securities lending income and remits a
remaining portion to BIM as compensation for its services as securities lending agent. Securities lending income is equal to the total of income earned from the reinvestment of cash collateral (and excludes collateral investment expenses as defined
below), and any fees or other payments to and from borrowers of securities. As securities lending agent, BIM bears all operational costs directly related to securities lending. The Trust is responsible for expenses in connection with the investment
of cash collateral received for securities on loan (the collateral investment expenses). The cash collateral is invested in a private investment company managed by the Advisor or its affiliates. However, BIM has agreed to cap the
collateral investment expenses of the private investment company to an annual rate of 0.04%. In addition, in accordance with the exemptive order, the investment adviser to the private investment company will not charge any advisory fees with respect
to shares purchased by the Trust. Such shares also will not be subject to a sales load, distribution fee or service fee. If the private investment companys weekly liquid assets fall below 30% of its total assets, BIM, as managing member of the
private investment company, is permitted at any time, if it determines it to be in the best interests of the private investment company, to impose a liquidity fee of up to 2% of the value of units withdrawn or impose a redemption gate that
temporarily suspends the right of withdrawal out of the private investment company. In addition, if the private investment companys weekly liquid assets fall below 10% of its total assets at the end of any business day, the private investment
company will impose a liquidity fee in the default amount of 1% of the amount withdrawn, generally effective as of the next business day, unless BIM determines that a higher (not to exceed 2%) or lower fee level or not imposing a liquidity fee is in
the best interests of the private investment company. The shares of the private investment company purchased by the Trust would be subject to any such liquidity fee or redemption gate imposed.
Under the securities lending program, the Trust is categorized into a specific asset class. The determination of the Trusts asset class category (fixed
income, domestic equity, international equity, or fund of funds), each of which may be subject to a different fee arrangement, is based on a methodology agreed to between the Trust and BIM.
Pursuant to the current securities lending agreement: (i) if the Trust were to engage in securities lending, the Trust retains 82% of securities lending
income (which excludes collateral investment expenses), and (ii) this amount can never be less than 70% of the sum of securities lending income plus collateral investment expenses.
In addition, commencing the business day following the date that the aggregate securities lending income earned across the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex in a
calendar year exceeds a specified threshold, the Trust, pursuant to the current securities lending agreement, will receive for the remainder of that calendar year securities lending
- 45 -
income as follows: (i) if the Trust were to engage in securities lending, 85% of securities lending income (which excludes collateral investment expenses); and (ii) this amount can
never be less than 70% of the sum of securities lending income plus collateral investment expenses.
Other Investment Policies
Project Loans. The Trust may invest in project loans, which are fixed income securities of issuers whose revenues are primarily derived from mortgage
loans to multi-family, nursing home and other real estate development projects.
Guaranteed Investment Contracts. The Trust may make investments in
guaranteed investment contracts issued by highly rated U.S. insurance companies. Under these contracts, the Trust makes cash contributions to a deposit fund of the insurance companys general account. The insurance company then credits to the
Trust, on a monthly basis, interest which is based on an index, but is guaranteed not to be less than a certain minimum rate.
Rights
Offerings. The Trust may participate in rights offerings. Subscription rights normally have a short life span to expiration. The purchase of rights involves the risk that the Trust could lose the purchase value of a right if the right to
subscribe to additional shares is not exercised prior to the rights expiration. Also, the purchase of rights involves the risk that the effective price paid for the right added to the subscription price of the related security may exceed the
value of the subscribed securitys market price such as when there is no movement in the level of the underlying security.
LEVERAGE
The Trust currently utilizes leverage for investment purposes in the form of reverse repurchase agreements. As of [●], 2025, this
leverage represented approximately [●]% of the Trusts Managed Assets (approximately [●]% of the Trusts net assets). The Trust may borrow from banks and other financial institutions and may also borrow additional funds
using such investment techniques as the Advisors may from time to time determine. Of these investment techniques, the Trust expects primarily to use reverse repurchase agreements and dollar rolls. The Trust has the ability to utilize leverage
through borrowings in an amount up to 33 1/3% of the value of its Managed Assets (which includes the amount obtained from such borrowings).
The use of
leverage, including investments in reverse repurchase agreements, can create risks. When leverage is employed, the NAV and market price of the common shares and the yield to holders of common shares will be more volatile than if leverage were not
used. Changes in the value of the Trusts portfolio, including securities bought with the proceeds of leverage, will be borne entirely by the holders of common shares. If there is a net decrease or increase in the value of the Trusts
investment portfolio, leverage will decrease or increase, as the case may be, the NAV per common share to a greater extent than if the Trust did not utilize leverage. A reduction in the Trusts NAV may cause a reduction in the market price of
its shares. During periods in which the Trust is using leverage, the fee paid to the Advisors for advisory services will be higher than if the Trust did not use leverage, because the fees paid will be calculated on the basis of the Trusts
Managed Assets, which includes the proceeds from leverage. The Trusts leveraging strategy may not be successful.
Certain types of leverage the
Trust may use may result in the Trust being subject to covenants relating to asset coverage and portfolio composition requirements. The Trust may be subject to certain restrictions on investments imposed by one or more lenders or by guidelines of
one or more rating agencies, which may issue ratings for any short-term debt securities or preferred shares issued by the Trust. The terms of any borrowings or rating agency guidelines may impose asset coverage or portfolio composition requirements
that are more stringent than those imposed by the Investment Company Act. The Advisors do not believe that these covenants or guidelines will impede it from managing the Trusts portfolio in accordance with its investment objective and policies
if the Trust were to utilize leverage.
Under the Investment Company Act, the Trust is not permitted to issue senior securities if, immediately after the
issuance of such senior securities, the Trust would have an asset coverage ratio (as defined in the Investment Company Act) of less than 300% with respect to senior securities representing indebtedness (i.e., for every dollar of indebtedness
outstanding, the Trust is required to have at least three dollars of assets) or less than 200% with respect to senior securities representing preferred shares (i.e., for every dollar of preferred shares outstanding, the Trust is
- 46 -
required to have at least two dollars of assets). The Investment Company Act also provides that the Trust may not declare distributions, or purchase its stock (including through tender offers)
if, immediately after doing so, it will have an asset coverage ratio of less than 300% or 200%, as applicable. Under the Investment Company Act, certain short-term borrowings (such as for cash management purposes) are not subject to these
limitations if (i) repaid within 60 days, (ii) not extended or renewed, and (iii) not in excess of 5% of the total assets of the Trust.
Effects of Leverage
Assuming that leverage will
represent approximately [●]% of the Trusts Managed Assets and that the Trust will bear expenses relating to that leverage at an average annual rate of [●]%, the income generated by the Trusts portfolio (net of estimated
expenses) must exceed [●]% in order to cover the expenses specifically related to the Trusts use of leverage. Of course, these numbers are merely estimates used for illustration. Actual leverage expenses will vary frequently and may be
significantly higher or lower than the rate estimated above.
The following table is furnished in response to requirements of the SEC. It is designed to
illustrate the effect of leverage on common share total return, assuming investment portfolio total returns (comprised of income and changes in the value of investments held in the Trusts portfolio) of (10)%, (5)%, 0%, 5% and 10%. These
assumed investment portfolio returns are hypothetical figures and are not necessarily indicative of the investment portfolio returns experienced or expected to be experienced by the Trust. The table further reflects the use of leverage representing
[●]% of the Trusts Managed Assets and an assumed annual cost of leverage of [●]%.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assumed Portfolio Total Return (Net of Expenses) |
|
|
(10.00)% |
|
|
|
(5.00)% |
|
|
|
0% |
|
|
|
5.00% |
|
|
|
10.00% |
|
|
|
Common Share Total Return |
|
|
([●])% |
|
|
|
([●])% |
|
|
|
([●])% |
|
|
|
[●]% |
|
|
|
[●]% |
|
Common share total return is composed of two elements: the common share dividends paid by the Trust (the amount of which is
largely determined by the net investment income of the Trust after paying for any leverage used by the Trust) and gains or losses on the value of the securities the Trust owns. As required by SEC rules, the table assumes that the Trust is more
likely to suffer capital losses than to enjoy capital appreciation. For example, to assume a total return of 0% the Trust must assume that the interest it receives on its investments is entirely offset by losses in the value of those securities.
Reverse Repurchase Agreements
The Trust may enter
into reverse repurchase agreements with respect to its portfolio investments subject to the investment restrictions set forth herein. Reverse repurchase agreements involve the sale of securities held by the Trust with an agreement by the Trust to
repurchase the securities at an agreed upon price, date and interest payment. Reverse repurchase agreements involve the risk that the market value of the securities acquired in connection with the reverse repurchase agreement may decline below the
price of the securities the Trust has sold but is obligated to repurchase. Also, reverse repurchase agreements involve the risk that the market value of the securities retained in lieu of sale by the Trust in connection with the reverse repurchase
agreement may decline in price.
If the buyer of securities under a reverse repurchase agreement files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, such buyer or
its trustee or receiver may receive an extension of time to determine whether to enforce the Trusts obligation to repurchase the securities and the Trusts use of the proceeds of the reverse repurchase agreement may effectively be
restricted pending such decision. Also, the Trust would bear the risk of loss to the extent that the proceeds of the reverse repurchase agreement are less than the value of the securities subject to such agreement.
The Trust also may effect simultaneous purchase and sale transactions that are known as sale-buybacks. A sale-buyback is similar to a reverse
repurchase agreement, except that in a sale-buyback, the counterparty that purchases the security is entitled to receive any principal or interest payments made on the underlying security pending settlement of the Trusts repurchase of the
underlying security.
In accordance with Rule 18f-4 under the Investment Company Act, when the Trust engages in
reverse repurchase agreements and similar financing transactions, the Trust may either (i) maintain asset coverage of at least 300% with respect to such transactions and any other borrowings in the aggregate, or (ii) treat such
transactions as derivatives
- 47 -
transactions and comply with Rule 18f-4 with respect to such transactions. See Additional Risk FactorsRisk Factors in Strategic
Transactions and DerivativesRule 18f-4 Under the Investment Company Act in the SAI.
Dollar Roll
Transactions
The Trust may enter into dollar roll transactions. In a dollar roll transaction, the Trust sells a mortgage related
security or other security to a dealer and simultaneously agrees to repurchase a similar security (but not the same security) in the future at a pre-determined price. A dollar roll transaction can be viewed,
like a reverse repurchase agreement, as a collateralized borrowing in which the Trust pledges a mortgage related security to a dealer to obtain cash. However, unlike reverse repurchase agreements, the dealer with which the Trust enters into a dollar
roll transaction is not obligated to return the same securities as those originally sold by the Trust, but rather only securities which are substantially identical, which generally means that the securities repurchased will bear the same
interest rate and a similar maturity as those sold, but pools of mortgages collateralizing those securities may have different prepayment histories than those sold.
During the period between the sale and repurchase, the Trust will not be entitled to receive interest and principal payments of the securities sold. Proceeds
of the sale will be invested in additional instruments for the Trust and the income from these investments will generate income for the Trust. If such income does not exceed the income, capital appreciation and gain that would have been realized on
the securities sold as part of the dollar roll, the use of this technique will diminish the investment performance of the Trust compared with what the performance would have been without the use of dollar rolls.
Dollar roll transactions involve the risk that the market value of the securities the Trust is required to purchase may decline below the agreed upon
repurchase price of those securities. The Trusts right to purchase or repurchase securities may be restricted. Successful use of mortgage dollar rolls may depend upon the investment managers ability to correctly predict interest rates
and prepayments. There is no assurance that dollar rolls can be successfully employed.
Rule 18f-4 under the
Investment Company Act permits the Trust to enter into when-issued or forward-settling securities (e.g., firm and standby commitments, including TBA commitments, and dollar rolls) and non-standard settlement
cycle securities notwithstanding the limitation on the issuance of senior securities in Section 18 of the Investment Company Act, provided that the Trust intends to physically settle the transaction and the transaction will settle within 35
days of its trade date (the Delayed-Settlement Securities Provision). If a when-issued, forward-settling or non-standard settlement cycle security does not satisfy the Delayed-Settlement Securities
Provision, then it is treated as a derivatives transaction under Rule 18f-4. See Additional Risk FactorsRisk Factors in Strategic Transactions and DerivativesRule 18f-4 Under the Investment Company Act below.
Credit Facility
The Trust is permitted to leverage its portfolio by entering into one or more credit facilities. If the Trust enters into a credit facility, the Trust may be
required to prepay outstanding amounts or incur a penalty rate of interest upon the occurrence of certain events of default. The Trust would also likely have to indemnify the lenders under the credit facility against liabilities they may incur in
connection therewith. In addition, the Trust expects that any credit facility would contain covenants that, among other things, likely would limit the Trusts ability to pay distributions in certain circumstances, incur additional debt, change
certain of its investment policies and engage in certain transactions, including mergers and consolidations, and require asset coverage ratios in addition to those required by the Investment Company Act. The Trust may be required to pledge its
assets and to maintain a portion of its assets in cash or high-grade securities as a reserve against interest or principal payments and expenses. The Trust expects that any credit facility would have customary covenant, negative covenant and default
provisions. There can be no assurance that the Trust will enter into an agreement for a credit facility or one on terms and conditions representative of the foregoing, or that additional material terms will not apply. In addition, if entered into, a
credit facility may in the future be replaced or refinanced by one or more credit facilities having substantially different terms or by the issuance of preferred shares.
- 48 -
Preferred Shares
The Trust also has the ability to utilize leverage through the issuance of preferred shares in an amount up to 50% of the value of its Managed Assets (which
includes the amount obtained from such issuance). The Trust does not currently anticipate issuing any preferred shares; thus, the Trust will limit its borrowing to 33 1/3% of the Trusts Managed Assets. If preferred shares are issued,
however, the Trusts borrowing limit will be proportionately reduced so that the Trusts aggregate leverage will not exceed 33 1/3% of the Trusts Managed Assets.
Derivatives
The Trust may enter into derivative
transactions that have leverage embedded in them. Derivative transactions that the Trust may enter into and the risks associated with them are described elsewhere in this Prospectus and are also referred to as Strategic Transactions. The
Trust cannot assure you that investments in derivative transactions that have leverage embedded in them will result in a higher return on its common shares.
Under Rule 18f-4 under the Investment Company Act, among other things, the Trust must either use derivatives in a
limited manner or comply with an outer limit on fund leverage risk based on value-at-risk. See Additional Risk FactorsRisk Factors in Strategic Transactions
and DerivativesRule 18f-4 Under the Investment Company Act in the SAI.
Temporary Borrowings
The Trust may also borrow money as a temporary measure for extraordinary or emergency purposes, including the payment of dividends and the settlement
of securities transactions which otherwise might require untimely dispositions of Trust securities.
RISKS
The NAV and market price of, and dividends paid on, the common shares will fluctuate with and be affected by, among other things, the risks of
investing in the Trust.
General Risks
Please refer
to the section of the Trusts most recent annual report on Form N-CSR entitled
Trust Investment Objectives, Policies and RisksRisk Factors, which is incorporated by reference herein, for a discussion of the general risks of investing in the Trust.
Other Risks
Second Lien Loans Risk
Second lien loans generally are subject to similar risks as those associated with investments in senior loans. Because second lien loans are subordinated or
unsecured and thus lower in priority of payment to senior loans, they are subject to the additional risk that the cash flow of the borrower and property securing the loan or debt, if any, may be insufficient to meet scheduled payments after giving
effect to the senior secured obligations of the borrower. This risk is generally higher for subordinated unsecured loans or debt, which are not backed by a security interest in any specific collateral. Second lien loans generally have greater price
volatility and may be less liquid than senior loans.
There is also a possibility that originators will not be able to sell participations in second lien
loans, which would create greater credit risk exposure for the holders of such loans. Second lien loans share the same risks as other below investment grade securities.
- 49 -
Mezzanine Securities Risk
Mezzanine securities generally are rated below investment grade and frequently are unrated and present many of the same risks as senior loans, second lien
loans and non-investment grade bonds. However, unlike senior loans and second lien loans, mezzanine securities are not a senior or secondary secured obligation of the related borrower. They typically are the
most subordinated debt obligation in an issuers capital structure. Mezzanine securities also may often be unsecured. Mezzanine securities therefore are subject to the additional risk that the cash flow of the related borrower and the property
securing the loan may be insufficient to repay the scheduled obligation after giving effect to any senior obligations of the related borrower. Mezzanine securities will be subject to certain additional risks to the extent that such loans may not be
protected by financial covenants or limitations upon additional indebtedness. Investment in mezzanine securities is a highly specialized investment practice that depends more heavily on independent credit analysis than investments in other types of
debt obligations.
Bank Loans Risk
The market for
bank loans may not be highly liquid and the Trust may have difficulty selling them. These investments are subject to both interest rate risk and credit risk. These investments expose the Trust to the credit risk of both the financial
institution and the underlying borrower.
Corporate Bonds Risk
The market value of a corporate bond generally may be expected to rise and fall inversely with interest rates. The market value of intermediate and
longer-term corporate bonds is generally more sensitive to changes in interest rates than is the market value of shorter-term corporate bonds. The market value of a corporate bond also may be affected by factors directly related to the issuer, such
as investors perceptions of the creditworthiness of the issuer, the issuers financial performance, perceptions of the issuer in the market place, performance of management of the issuer, the issuers capital structure and use of
financial leverage and demand for the issuers goods and services. Certain risks associated with investments in corporate bonds are described elsewhere in this Prospectus in further detail. There is a risk that the issuers of corporate bonds
may not be able to meet their obligations on interest or principal payments at the time called for by an instrument. Corporate bonds of below investment grade quality are often high risk and have speculative characteristics and may be particularly
susceptible to adverse issuer-specific developments.
Distressed Securities Risk
Distressed securities are speculative and involve substantial risks in addition to the risks of investing in junk bonds. The Trust will generally not receive
interest payments on the distressed securities and may incur costs to protect its investment. In addition, distressed securities involve the substantial risk that principal will not be repaid. These securities may present a substantial risk of
default or may be in default at the time of investment. The Trust may incur additional expenses to the extent it is required to seek recovery upon a default in the payment of principal of or interest on its portfolio holdings. In any reorganization
or liquidation proceeding relating to a portfolio company, the Trust may lose its entire investment or may be required to accept cash or securities with a value less than its original investment. Distressed securities and any securities received in
an exchange for such securities may be subject to restrictions on resale.
Yield and Ratings Risk
The yields on certain debt obligations are dependent on a variety of factors, including general market conditions, conditions in the particular market for the
obligation, the financial condition of the issuer, the size of the offering, the maturity of the obligation and the ratings of the issue. The ratings of Moodys and S&P, which are described in Appendix A, represent their respective opinions
as to the quality of the obligations they undertake to rate. Ratings, however, are general and are not absolute standards of quality. Consequently, obligations with the same rating, maturity and interest rate may have different market prices.
Subsequent to its purchase by the Trust, a rated security may cease to be rated. The Advisors will consider such an event in determining whether the Trust should continue to hold the security.
- 50 -
Unrated Securities Risk
Because the Trust may purchase securities that are not rated by any rating organization, the Advisors may, after assessing their credit quality, internally
assign ratings to certain of those securities in categories similar to those of rating organizations. Some unrated securities may not have an active trading market or may be difficult to value, which means the Trust might have difficulty
selling them promptly at an acceptable price. To the extent that the Trust invests in unrated securities, the Trusts ability to achieve its investment objective will be more dependent on the Advisors credit analysis than would be the
case when the Trust invests in rated securities.
Debtor-in-Possession
(DIP) Financing Risk
The Trusts participation in DIP financings is subject to risks. DIP financings are arranged when an entity seeks the
protections of the bankruptcy court under Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code and must be approved by the bankruptcy court. These financings allow the entity to continue its business operations while reorganizing under Chapter 11. DIP financings
are typically fully secured by a lien on the debtors otherwise unencumbered assets or secured by a junior lien on the debtors encumbered assets (so long as the loan is fully secured based on the most recent current valuation or appraisal
report of the debtor). DIP financings are often required to close with certainty and in a rapid manner in order to satisfy existing creditors and to enable the issuer to emerge from bankruptcy or to avoid a bankruptcy proceeding. There is a risk
that the borrower will not emerge from Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceedings and be forced to liquidate its assets under Chapter 7 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. In the event of liquidation, the Trusts only recourse will be against the property
securing the DIP financing.
Mortgage Related Securities Risks
Investing in MBS entails various risks. MBS represent an interest in a pool of mortgages. The risks associated with MBS include: credit risk associated with
the performance of the underlying mortgage properties and of the borrowers owning these properties; risks associated with their structure and execution (including the collateral, the process by which principal and interest payments are allocated and
distributed to investors and how credit losses affect issuing vehicles and the return to investors in such MBS); whether the collateral represents a fixed set of specific assets or accounts, whether the underlying collateral assets are revolving or closed-end, under what terms (including maturity of the MBS) any remaining balance in the accounts may revert to the issuing entity and the extent to which the entity that is the actual source of the
collateral assets is obligated to provide support to the issuing vehicle or to the investors in such MBS; risks associated with the servicer of the underlying mortgages; adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances, which are more likely
to have an adverse impact on MBS secured by loans on certain types of commercial properties than on those secured by loans on residential properties; prepayment risk, which can lead to significant fluctuations in the value of the MBS; loss of all or
part of the premium, if any, paid; and decline in the market value of the security, whether resulting from changes in interest rates, prepayments on the underlying mortgage collateral or perceptions of the credit risk associated with the underlying
mortgage collateral. In addition, the Trusts level of investment in MBS of a particular type or in MBS issued or guaranteed by affiliated obligors, serviced by the same servicer or backed by underlying collateral located in a specific
geographic region, may subject the Trust to additional risk. To the extent the Trust invests in junior tranches of MBS, it will be subject to additional risks, such as the risk that the proceeds that would otherwise be distributed to the Trust will
be used to pay down more senior tranches.
When market interest rates decline, more mortgages are refinanced and the securities are paid off earlier than
expected. Prepayments may also occur on a scheduled basis or due to foreclosure. During such periods, the reinvestment of prepayment proceeds by the Trust will generally be at lower rates than the rates that were carried by the obligations that have
been prepaid. When market interest rates increase, the market values of MBS decline. At the same time, however, mortgage refinancings and prepayments slow, lengthening the effective maturities of these securities. As a result, the negative effect of
the rate increase on the market value of MBS is usually more pronounced than it is for other types of fixed-income securities. Moreover, the relationship between borrower prepayments and changes in interest rates may mean some high-yielding mortgage
related and other asset-backed securities have less potential for increases in value if market interest rates were to fall than conventional bonds with comparable maturities.
- 51 -
In general, losses on a mortgaged property securing a mortgage loan included in a securitization will be borne
first by the equity holder of the property, then by a cash reserve fund or letter of credit, if any, then by the holder of a mezzanine loan or B-Note, if any, then by the first loss
subordinated security holder (generally, the B-Piece buyer) and then by the holder of a higher rated security. The Trust could invest in any class of security included in a
securitization. In the event of default and the exhaustion of any equity support, reserve fund, letter of credit, mezzanine loans or B-Notes, and any classes of securities junior to those in which
the Trust invests, the Trust will not be able to recover all of its investment in the MBS it purchases. MBS in which the Trust invests may not contain reserve funds, letters of credit, mezzanine loans and/or junior classes of securities. The prices
of lower credit quality securities are generally less sensitive to interest rate changes than more highly rated investments, but more sensitive to adverse economic downturns or individual issuer developments.
MBS generally are classified as either RMBS or CMBS, each of which are subject to certain specific risks as further described below.
RMBS Risks. RMBS are securities the payments on which depend primarily on the cash flow from residential mortgage loans made to borrowers that
are secured by residential real estate. Non-agency residential mortgage loans are obligations of the borrowers thereunder only and are not typically insured or guaranteed by any other person or
entity. The ability of a borrower to repay a loan secured by residential property is dependent upon the income or assets of the borrower. A number of factors, including a general economic downturn, acts of God, terrorism, social unrest and civil
disturbances, may impair a borrowers ability to repay its loans.
Agency RMBS Risks. MBS issued by FNMA or FHLMC are guaranteed as to
timely payment of principal and interest by FNMA or FHLMC, but are not backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. In 2008, the FHFA placed FNMA and FHLMC into conservatorship. FNMA and FHLMC are continuing to operate as going
concerns while in conservatorship and each remains liable for all of its obligations, including its guaranty obligations, associated with its MBS. As the conservator, FHFA succeeded to all rights, titles, powers and privileges of FNMA and FHLMC and
of any stockholder, officer or director of FNMA and FHLMC with respect to FNMA and FHLMC and the assets of FNMA and FHLMC. In connection with the conservatorship, the U.S. Treasury entered into an agreement with each of FNMA and FHLMC that contains
various covenants that severely limit each enterprises operations. There is no assurance that the obligations of such entities will be satisfied in full, or that such obligations will not decrease in value or default.
Under the Reform Act, FHFA, as conservator or receiver, has the power to repudiate any contract entered into by FNMA or FHLMC prior to FHFAs appointment
as conservator or receiver, as applicable, if FHFA determines, in its sole discretion, that performance of the contract is burdensome and that repudiation of the contract promotes the orderly administration of FNMAs or FHLMCs affairs. In
the event that FHFA, as conservator of, or if it is later appointed as receiver for, FNMA or FHLMC, were to repudiate any such guaranty obligation, the conservatorship or receivership estate, as applicable, would be liable for actual direct
compensatory damages in accordance with the provisions of the Reform Act. Any such liability could be satisfied only to the extent of FNMAs or FHLMCs assets available therefor. In the event of repudiation, the payments of interest to
holders of FNMA or FHLMC MBS would be reduced if payments on the mortgage loans represented in the mortgage loan groups related to such MBS are not made by the borrowers or advanced by the servicer. Any actual direct compensatory damages for
repudiating these guaranty obligations may not be sufficient to offset any shortfalls experienced by such MBS holders. Further, in its capacity as conservator or receiver, FHFA has the right to transfer or sell any asset or liability of FNMA or
FHLMC without any approval, assignment or consent. If FHFA, as conservator or receiver, were to transfer any such guaranty obligation to another party, holders of FNMA or FHLMC MBS would have to rely on that party for satisfaction of the guaranty
obligation and would be exposed to the credit risk of that party. In addition, certain rights provided to holders of MBS issued by FNMA and FHLMC under the operative documents related to such securities may not be enforced against FHFA, or
enforcement of such rights may be delayed, during the conservatorship or any future receivership. The operative documents for FNMA and FHLMC MBS may provide (or with respect to securities issued prior to the date of the appointment of the
conservator may have provided) that upon the occurrence of an event of default on the part of FNMA or FHLMC, in its capacity as guarantor, which includes the appointment of a conservator or receiver, holders of such MBS have the right to replace
FNMA or FHLMC as trustee if the requisite percentage of MBS holders consent. The Reform Act prevents MBS holders from enforcing such rights if the event of default arises solely because a conservator or receiver has been appointed.
- 52 -
RMBS Legal Risks. Legal risks associated with RMBS can arise as a result of the procedures followed
in connection with the origination of the mortgage loans or the servicing thereof, which may be subject to various federal and state laws (including, without limitation, predatory lending laws), public policies and principles of equity that regulate
interest rates and other charges, require certain disclosures, require licensing of originators, prohibit discriminatory lending practices, regulate the use of consumer credit information and debt collection practices and may limit the
servicers ability to collect all or part of the principal of or interest on a residential mortgage loan, entitle the borrower to a refund of amounts previously paid by it or subject the servicer to damages and sanctions. Specifically,
provisions of federal predatory lending laws, such as the federal Truth-in-Lending Act (as supplemented by the Home Ownership and Equity Protection Act of
1994) and Regulation Z, and various recently enacted state predatory lending laws provide that a purchaser or assignee of specified types of residential mortgage loans (including an issuer of RMBS) may be held liable for violations by the originator
of such mortgage loans. Under such assignee liability provisions, a borrower is generally given the right to assert against a purchaser of its mortgage loan any affirmative claims and defenses to payment that such borrower could assert against the
originator of the loan or, where applicable, the home improvement contractor that arranged the loan. Liability under such assignee liability provisions could, therefore, result in a disruption of cash flows allocated to the holders of RMBS where
either the issuer of such RMBS is liable for damages or is unable to enforce payment by the borrower.
In most but not all cases, the amount recoverable
against a purchaser or assignee under such assignee liability provisions is limited to amounts previously paid and still owed by the borrower. Moreover, sellers of residential mortgage loans to an issuer of RMBS typically represent that the loans
have been originated in accordance with all applicable laws and in the event such representation is breached, the seller typically must repurchase the offending loan. Notwithstanding these protections, an issuer of RMBS may be exposed to an
unquantifiable amount of potential assignee liability because, first, the amount of potential assignee liability under certain predatory lending laws is unclear and has yet to be litigated, and, second, in the event a predatory lending law does not
prohibit class action lawsuits, it is possible that an issuer of RMBS could be liable for damages for more than the original principal amount of the offending loans held by it. In such circumstances the issuer of RMBS may be forced to seek
contribution from other parties, who may no longer exist or have adequate funds available to fund such contribution.
In addition, structural and legal
risks of RMBS include the possibility that, in a bankruptcy or similar proceeding involving the originator or the servicer (often the same entity or affiliates), the assets of the issuer could be treated as never having been truly sold by the
originator to the issuer and could be substantively consolidated with those of the originator, or the transfer of such assets to the issuer could be voided as a fraudulent transfer. Challenges based on such doctrines could result also in cash flow
delays and losses on the related issue of RMBS.
Non-Agency RMBS
Risks. Non-agency RMBS are securities issued by non-governmental issuers. Non-agency RMBS
have no direct or indirect government guarantees of payment and are subject to various risks as described herein.
Borrower Credit Risk.
Credit-related risk on RMBS arises from losses due to delinquencies and defaults by the borrowers in payments on the underlying mortgage loans and breaches by originators and servicers of their obligations under the underlying documentation pursuant
to which the RMBS are issued. Non-agency residential mortgage loans are obligations of the borrowers thereunder only and are not typically insured or guaranteed by any other person or entity. The
rate of delinquencies and defaults on residential mortgage loans and the aggregate amount of the resulting losses will be affected by a number of factors, including general economic conditions, particularly those in the area where the related
mortgaged property is located, the level of the borrowers equity in the mortgaged property and the individual financial circumstances of the borrower. If a residential mortgage loan is in default, foreclosure on the related residential
property may be a lengthy and difficult process involving significant legal and other expenses. The net proceeds obtained by the holder on a residential mortgage loan following the foreclosure on the related property may be less than the total
amount that remains due on the loan. The prospect of incurring a loss upon the foreclosure of the related property may lead the holder of the residential mortgage loan to restructure the residential mortgage loan or otherwise delay the foreclosure
process.
Mortgage Loan Market Risk. In the recent past, the residential mortgage market in the United States experienced difficulties that
adversely affected the performance and market value of certain mortgages and mortgage related securities. Delinquencies and losses on residential mortgage loans (especially sub-prime and second lien
mortgage loans) generally increased during this period and declines in or flattening of housing values in many housing
- 53 -
markets were generally viewed as exacerbating such delinquencies and losses. Borrowers with ARMs are more sensitive to changes in interest rates, which affect their monthly mortgage payments, and
may be unable to secure replacement mortgages at comparably low interest rates.
At any one time, a portfolio of RMBS may be backed by residential
mortgage loans that are highly concentrated in only a few states or regions. As a result, the performance of such residential mortgage loans may be more susceptible to a downturn in the economy, including in particular industries that are highly
represented in such states or regions, natural calamities and other adverse conditions affecting such areas. The economic downturn experienced in the recent past at the national level, and the more serious economic downturn experienced in the recent
past in certain geographic areas of the United States, including in particular areas of the United States where rates of delinquencies and defaults on residential mortgage loans were particularly high, is generally viewed as having contributed to
the higher rates of delinquencies and defaults on the residential mortgage loans underlying RMBS during this period. There also can be no assurance that areas of the United States that mostly avoided higher rates of delinquencies and defaults on
residential mortgage loans during this period would continue to do so if an economic downturn were to reoccur at the national level.
Another factor that
may contribute to, and may in the future result in, higher delinquency and default rates is the increase in monthly payments on ARMs. Any increase in prevailing market interest rates, which are currently at historical lows, may result in
increased payments for borrowers who have ARMs. Moreover, with respect to hybrid mortgage loans (which are mortgage loans combining fixed and adjustable rate features) after their initial fixed rate period or other adjustable-rate mortgage
loans, interest-only products or products having a lower rate, and with respect to mortgage loans with a negative amortization feature which reach their negative amortization cap, borrowers may experience a substantial increase in their monthly
payment even without an increase in prevailing market interest rates. Increases in payments for borrowers may result in increased rates of delinquencies and defaults on residential mortgage loans underlying
the non-agency RMBS.
As a result of rising concerns about increases in delinquencies and defaults on
residential mortgage loans (particularly on sub-prime and adjustable-rate mortgage loans) and as a result of increasing concerns about the financial strength of originators and servicers and their
ability to perform their obligations with respect to non-agency RMBS, there may be an adverse change in the market sentiments of investors about the market values and volatility and the degree of
risk of non-agency RMBS generally. Some or all of the underlying residential mortgage loans in an issue of non-agency RMBS may have balloon payments
due on their respective maturity dates. Balloon residential mortgage loans involve a greater risk to a lender than fully amortizing loans, because the ability of a borrower to pay such amount will normally depend on its ability to obtain refinancing
of the related mortgage loan or sell the related mortgaged property at a price sufficient to permit the borrower to make the balloon payment, which will depend on a number of factors prevailing at the time such refinancing or sale is required,
including, without limitation, the strength of the local or national residential real estate markets, interest rates and general economic conditions and the financial condition of the borrower. If borrowers are unable to make such balloon payments,
the related issue of non-agency RMBS may experience losses.
The Trust may acquire RMBS backed by
collateral pools of mortgage loans that have been originated using underwriting standards that are less restrictive than those used in underwriting prime mortgage loans
and Alt-A mortgage loans. These lower standards include mortgage loans made to borrowers having imperfect or impaired credit histories, mortgage loans where the amount of the loan at
origination is 80% or more of the value of the mortgage property, mortgage loans made to borrowers with low credit scores, mortgage loans made to borrowers who have other debt that represents a large portion of their income and mortgage loans made
to borrowers whose income is not required to be disclosed or verified and are commonly referred to as sub-prime mortgage
loans. Sub-prime mortgage loans have in recent periods experienced increased rates of delinquency, foreclosure, bankruptcy and loss, and they are likely to continue to experience delinquency,
foreclosure, bankruptcy and loss rates that are higher, and that may be substantially higher, than those experienced by mortgage loans underwritten in a more traditional manner. Certain categories of RMBS, such as option ARM RMBS and sub-prime RMBS, have been referred to by the financial media as toxic assets.
Although the
United States economy has been slowly improving in recent years, the impact of the coronavirus pandemic on the United States has caused the economy to deteriorate again and led to a high incidence of missed
- 54 -
mortgage payments, which could result in the incidence of mortgage foreclosures, especially sub-prime mortgages, beginning to increase again,
which could adversely affect the value of any RMBS owned by the Trust.
CMBS Risks. CMBS are, generally, securities
backed by obligations (including certificates of participation in obligations) that are principally secured by mortgages on real property or interests therein having a multifamily or commercial use, such as regional malls, other retail space, office
buildings, industrial or warehouse properties, hotels, nursing homes and senior living centers. The market for CMBS developed more recently and, in terms of total outstanding principal amount of issues, is relatively small compared to the market for
single-family RMBS.
CMBS are subject to particular risks, including lack of standardized terms, shorter maturities than residential mortgage loans and
payment of all or substantially all of the principal only at maturity rather than regular amortization of principal. Additional risks may be presented by the type and use of a particular commercial property. Special risks are presented by hospitals,
nursing homes, hospitality properties and certain other property types. Commercial property values and net operating income are subject to volatility, which may result in net operating income becoming insufficient to cover debt service on the
related mortgage loan. The repayment of loans secured by income-producing properties is typically dependent upon the successful operation of the related real estate project rather than upon the liquidation value of the underlying real estate.
Furthermore, the net operating income from and value of any commercial property is subject to various risks, including changes in general or local economic conditions and/or specific industry segments; the solvency of the related tenants; declines
in real estate values; declines in rental or occupancy rates; increases in interest rates, real estate tax rates and other operating expenses; changes in governmental rules, regulations and fiscal policies; acts of God; new and ongoing epidemics and
pandemics of infectious diseases and other global health events; natural/environmental disasters; terrorist threats and attacks and social unrest and civil disturbances. Consequently, adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances are more
likely to have an adverse impact on MBS secured by loans on commercial properties than on those secured by loans on residential properties. In addition, commercial lending generally is viewed as exposing the lender to a greater risk of loss than one- to four- family residential lending. Commercial lending, for example, typically involves larger loans to single borrowers or groups of related borrowers than
residential one- to four- family mortgage loans. In addition, the repayment of loans secured by income producing properties typically is dependent upon the successful operation of the related real
estate project and the cash flow generated therefrom. The coronavirus pandemic in the United States has had a severe adverse effect on many commercial businesses, resulting in them not paying rent, which in turn will likely result in the owners of
the underlying properties being impaired in their ability to make mortgage payments.
The exercise of remedies and successful realization of liquidation
proceeds relating to CMBS is also highly dependent on the performance of the servicer or special servicer. In many cases, overall control over the special servicing of related underlying mortgage loans will be held by a directing
certificateholder or a controlling class representative, which is appointed by the holders of the most subordinate class of CMBS in such series.
The Trust may not have the right to appoint the directing certificateholder. In connection with the servicing of the specially serviced mortgage loans, the
related special servicer may, at the direction of the directing certificateholder, take actions with respect to the specially serviced mortgage loans that could adversely affect the Trusts interests. There may be a limited number of special
servicers available, particularly those that do not have conflicts of interest.
The Trust may invest in Subordinated CMBS issued or sponsored by
commercial banks, savings and loan institutions, mortgage bankers, private mortgage insurance companies and other non-governmental issuers. Subordinated CMBS have no governmental guarantee and are
subordinated in some manner as to the payment of principal and/or interest to the holders of more senior CMBS arising out of the same pool of mortgages.
Subordinated CMBS are often referred to
as B-Pieces. The holders of Subordinated CMBS typically are compensated with a higher stated yield than are the holders of more senior CMBS. On the
other hand, Subordinated CMBS typically subject the holder to greater risk than senior CMBS and tend to be rated in a lower rating category (frequently a substantially lower rating category) than the senior CMBS issued in respect of the same
mortgage pool. Subordinated CMBS generally are likely to be more sensitive to changes in prepayment and interest rates and the market for such securities may be less liquid than is the case for traditional income securities and senior CMBS.
- 55 -
Stripped MBS Risk. Stripped MBS may be subject to additional risks. One type of stripped MBS
pays to one class all of the interest from the mortgage assets (the IO class), while the other class will receive all of the principal (the PO class). The yield to maturity on an IO class is extremely sensitive to the rate of
principal payments (including prepayments) on the underlying mortgage assets and a rapid rate of principal payments may have a material adverse effect on the Trusts yield to maturity from these securities. If the assets underlying the IO class
experience greater than anticipated prepayments of principal, the Trust may fail to recoup fully, or at all, its initial investment in these securities. Conversely, PO class securities tend to decline in value if prepayments are slower than
anticipated.
CMO Risk. There are certain risks associated specifically with CMOs. CMOs are debt obligations collateralized by mortgage
loans or mortgage pass-through securities. The average life of a CMO is determined using mathematical models that incorporate prepayment assumptions and other factors that involve estimates of future economic and market conditions. Actual future
results may vary from these estimates, particularly during periods of extreme market volatility. Further, under certain market conditions, such as those that occurred during the recent downturn in the mortgage markets, the weighted average life of
certain CMOs may not accurately reflect the price volatility of such securities. For example, in periods of supply and demand imbalances in the market for such securities and/or in periods of sharp interest rate movements, the prices of CMOs may
fluctuate to a greater extent than would be expected from interest rate movements alone. CMOs issued by private entities are not obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its agencies or instrumentalities and are not guaranteed by any
government agency, although the securities underlying a CMO may be subject to a guarantee. Therefore, if the collateral securing the CMO, as well as any third party credit support or guarantees, is insufficient to make payments when due, the holder
could sustain a loss.
Inverse floating rate CMOs are typically more volatile than fixed or floating rate tranches of CMOs. Many inverse floating rate
CMOs have coupons that move inversely to a multiple of an index. The effect of the coupon varying inversely to a multiple of an applicable index creates a leverage factor. Inverse floaters based on multiples of a stated index are designed to be
highly sensitive to changes in interest rates and can subject the holders thereof to extreme reductions of yield and loss of principal. The market for inverse floating rate CMOs with highly leveraged characteristics at times may be very thin. The
Trusts ability to dispose of its positions in such securities will depend on the degree of liquidity in the markets for such securities. It is impossible to predict the amount of trading interest that may exist in such securities, and
therefore the future degree of liquidity.
The Trust may also invest in REMICs, which are CMOs that qualify for special tax treatment under the Code and
invest in certain mortgages principally secured by interests in real property and other permitted investments.
Credit Risk Associated With
Originators and Servicers of Mortgage Loans. A number of originators and servicers of residential and commercial mortgage loans, including some of the largest originators and servicers in the residential and commercial mortgage loan market,
have experienced serious financial difficulties, including some that are now or were subject to federal insolvency proceedings. These difficulties have resulted from many factors, including increased competition among originators for borrowers,
decreased originations by such originators of mortgage loans and increased delinquencies and defaults on such mortgage loans, as well as from increases in claims for repurchases of mortgage loans previously sold by them under agreements that require
repurchase in the event of breaches of representations regarding loan quality and characteristics. Such difficulties may affect the performance of MBS backed by mortgage loans. Furthermore, the inability of the originator to repurchase such mortgage
loans in the event of loan representation breaches or the servicer to repurchase such mortgage loans upon a breach of its servicing obligations also may affect the performance of related MBS. Delinquencies and losses on, and, in some cases, claims
for repurchase by the originator of, mortgage loans originated by some mortgage lenders have recently increased as a result of inadequate underwriting procedures and policies, including inadequate due diligence, failure to comply with predatory and
other lending laws and, particularly in the case of any no documentation or limited documentation mortgage loans that may support non-agency RMBS, inadequate verification of
income and employment history. Delinquencies and losses on, and claims for repurchase of, mortgage loans originated by some mortgage lenders have also resulted from fraudulent activities of borrowers, lenders, appraisers, and other residential
mortgage industry participants such as mortgage brokers, including misstatements of income and employment history, identity theft and overstatements of the appraised value of mortgaged properties. Many of these originators and servicers are very
highly leveraged. These difficulties may also increase the chances that these entities may default on their warehousing or other credit lines or become insolvent or
- 56 -
bankrupt and thereby increase the likelihood that repurchase obligations will not be fulfilled and the potential for loss to holders
of non-agency MBS and subordinated security holders.
The servicers
of non-agency MBS are often the same entities as, or affiliates of, the originators of these mortgage loans. Accordingly, the financial risks relating to originators of MBS described immediately
above also may affect the servicing of MBS. In the case of such servicers, and other servicers, financial difficulties may have a negative effect on the ability of servicers to pursue collection on mortgage loans that are experiencing increased
delinquencies and defaults and to maximize recoveries on sale of underlying properties following foreclosure. In recent years, a number of lenders specializing in residential mortgages have sought bankruptcy protection, shut down or been refused
further financings from their lenders.
MBS typically provide that the servicer is required to make advances in respect of delinquent mortgage loans.
However, servicers experiencing financial difficulties may not be able to perform these obligations or obligations that they may have to other parties of transactions involving these securities. Like originators, these entities are typically very
highly leveraged. Such difficulties may cause servicers to default under their financing arrangements. In certain cases, such entities may be forced to seek bankruptcy protection. Due to the application of the provisions of bankruptcy law, servicers
who have sought bankruptcy protection may not be required to advance such amounts. Even if a servicer were able to advance amounts in respect of delinquent mortgage loans, its obligation to make such advances may be limited to the extent that it
does not expect to recover such advances due to the deteriorating credit of the delinquent mortgage loans or declining value of the related mortgaged properties. Moreover, servicers may overadvance against a particular mortgage loan or charge too
many costs of resolution or foreclosure of a mortgage loan to a securitization, which could increase the potential losses to holders of MBS. In such transactions, a servicers obligation to make such advances may also be limited to the amount
of its servicing fee. In addition, if an issue of MBS provides for interest on advances made by the servicer, in the event that foreclosure proceeds or payments by borrowers are not sufficient to cover such interest, such interest will be paid to
the servicer from available collections or other mortgage income, thereby reducing distributions made on the MBS and, in the case of senior-subordinated MBS described below, first from distributions that would otherwise be made on the most
subordinated MBS of such issue. Any such financial difficulties may increase the possibility of a servicer termination and the need for a transfer of servicing and any such liabilities or inability to assess such liabilities may increase the
difficulties and costs in affecting such transfer and the potential loss, through the allocation of such increased cost of such transfer, to subordinated security holders.
There can be no assurance that originators and servicers of mortgage loans will not continue to experience serious financial difficulties or experience such
difficulties in the future, including becoming subject to bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings, or that underwriting procedures and policies and protections against fraud will be sufficient in the future to prevent such financial difficulties or
significant levels of default or delinquency on mortgage loans. Because the recent financial difficulties experienced by such originators and servicers is unprecedented and unpredictable, the past performance of the residential and commercial
mortgage loans originated and serviced by them (and the corresponding performance of the related MBS) is not a reliable indicator of the future performance of such residential mortgage loans (or the related MBS).
In some cases, servicers of MBS have been the subject of legal proceedings involving the origination and/or servicing practices of such servicers. Large
groups of private litigants and states attorneys general have brought such proceedings. Because of the large volume of mortgage loans originated and serviced by such servicers, such litigation can cause heightened financial strain on
servicers. In other cases, origination and servicing practices may cause or contribute to such strain, because of representation and warranty repurchase liability arising in MBS and mortgage loan sale transactions. Any such financial strain could
cause servicers to service below required standards, causing delinquencies and losses in any related MBS transaction to rise, and in extreme cases could cause the servicer to seek the protection of any applicable bankruptcy or insolvency law. In any
such proceeding, it is unclear whether the fees that the servicer charges in such transactions would be sufficient to permit that servicer or a successor servicer to service the mortgage loans in such transaction adequately. If such fees had to be
increased, it is likely that the most subordinated security holders in such transactions would be effectively required to pay such increased fees. Finally, these entities may be the subject of future laws designed to protect consumers from
defaulting on their mortgage loans. Such laws may have an adverse effect on the cash flows paid under such MBS.
Additional Risks of Mortgage
Related Securities. Additional risks associated with investments in MBS include:
- 57 -
Interest Rate Risk. In addition to the interest rate risks described above, certain MBS may be
subject to additional risks as the rate of interest payable on certain MBS may be set or effectively capped at the weighted average net coupon of the underlying mortgage loans themselves, often referred to as an available funds cap. As a
result of this cap, the return to the holder of such MBS is dependent on the relative timing and rate of delinquencies and prepayments of mortgage loans bearing a higher rate of interest. In general, early prepayments will have a greater negative
impact on the yield to the holder of such MBS.
Structural Risk. Because MBS generally are ownership or participation interests in pools of
mortgage loans secured by a pool of properties underlying the mortgage loan pool, the MBS are entitled to payments provided for in the underlying agreement only when and if funds are generated by the underlying mortgage loan pool. This likelihood of
the return of interest and principal may be assessed as a credit matter. However, the holders of MBS do not have the legal status of secured creditors, and cannot accelerate a claim for payment on their securities, or force a sale of the mortgage
loan pool in the event that insufficient funds exist to pay such amounts on any date designated for such payment. The holders of MBS do not typically have any right to remove a servicer solely as a result of a failure of the mortgage pool to perform
as expected.
Subordination Risk. MBS may be subordinated to one or more other senior classes of securities of the same series for purposes
of, among other things, offsetting losses and other shortfalls with respect to the related underlying mortgage loans. For example, in the case of certain MBS, no distributions of principal will generally be made with respect to any class until the
aggregate principal balances of the corresponding senior classes of securities have been reduced to zero. As a result, MBS may be more sensitive to risk of loss, writedowns, the non-fulfillment of
repurchase obligations, overadvancing on a pool of loans and the costs of transferring servicing than senior classes of securities.
Prepayment,
Extension and Redemption Risks. MBS may reflect an interest in monthly payments made by the borrowers who receive the underlying mortgage loans. Although the underlying mortgage loans are for specified periods of time, such as 20 or 30
years, the borrowers can, and historically have paid them off sooner. When a prepayment happens, a portion of the MBS which represents an interest in the underlying mortgage loan will be prepaid. A borrower is more likely to prepay a mortgage which
bears a relatively high rate of interest. This means that in times of declining interest rates, a portion of the Trusts higher yielding securities are likely to be redeemed and the Trust will probably be unable to replace them with securities
having as great a yield. In addition to reductions in the level of market interest rates and the prepayment provisions of the mortgage loans, repayments on the residential mortgage loans underlying an issue of RMBS may also be affected by a variety
of economic, geographic and other factors, including the size difference between the interest rates on the underlying residential mortgage loans (giving consideration to the cost of refinancing) and prevailing mortgage rates and the availability of
refinancing. Prepayments can result in lower yields to shareholders. The increased likelihood of prepayment when interest rates decline also limits market price appreciation of MBS. This is known as prepayment risk.
Except in the case of certain types of RMBS, the mortgage loans underlying RMBS generally do not contain prepayment penalties and a reduction in market
interest rates will increase the likelihood of prepayments on the related RMBS. In the case of certain home equity loan securities and certain types of RMBS, even though the underlying mortgage loans often contain prepayment premiums, such
prepayment premiums may not be sufficient to discourage borrowers from prepaying their mortgage loans in the event of a reduction in market interest rates, resulting in a reduction in the yield to maturity for holders of the related RMBS. RMBS
typically contain provisions that require repurchase of mortgage loans by the originator or other seller in the event of a breach of a representation or warranty regarding loan quality and characteristics of such loan. Any repurchase of a mortgage
loan as a result of a breach has the same effect on the yield received on the related issue of RMBS as a prepayment of such mortgage loan. Any increase in breaches of representations and the consequent repurchases of mortgage loans that result from
inadequate underwriting procedures and policies and protections against fraud will have the same effect on the yield on the related RMBS as an increase in prepayment rates.
Risk of prepayment may be reduced for commercial real estate property loans containing significant prepayment penalties or prohibitions on principal payments
for a period of time following origination.
- 58 -
MBS also are subject to extension risk. Extension risk is the possibility that rising interest rates may cause
prepayments to occur at a slower than expected rate. This particular risk may effectively change a security which was considered short or intermediate term into a long-term security. The values of long-term securities generally fluctuate more widely
in response to changes in interest rates than short or intermediate-term securities.
In addition, MBS may be subject to redemption at the option of the
issuer. If a MBS held by the Trust is called for redemption, the Trust will be required to permit the issuer to redeem or pay-off the security, which could have an adverse effect on the
Trusts ability to achieve its investment objective.
Spread Widening Risk. The prices of MBS may decline substantially, for reasons
that may not be attributable to any of the other risks described in the prospectus. In particular, purchasing assets at what may appear to be undervalued levels is no guarantee that these assets will not be trading at even more
undervalued levels at a time of valuation or at the time of sale. It may not be possible to predict, or to protect against, such spread widening risk.
Illiquidity Risk. The liquidity of MBS varies by type of security; at certain times the Trust may encounter difficulty in disposing of such
investments. Because MBS have the potential to be less liquid than other securities, the Trust may be more susceptible to illiquidity risk than funds that invest in other securities. In the past, in stressed markets, certain types of MBS suffered
periods of illiquidity when disfavored by the market. Due to increased instability in the credit markets, the market for some MBS has experienced reduced liquidity and greater volatility with respect to the value of such securities, making it more
difficult to value such securities.
Asset-Backed Securities Risks
ABS involve certain risks in addition to those presented by MBS. There is the possibility that recoveries on the underlying collateral may not, in some cases,
be available to support payments on these securities. Relative to MBS, ABS may provide the Trust with a less effective security interest in the underlying collateral and are more dependent on the borrowers ability to pay. If many borrowers on
the underlying loans default, losses could exceed the credit enhancement level and result in losses to investors in an ABS transaction. Finally, ABS have structure risk due to a unique characteristic known as early amortization, or early payout,
risk. Built into the structure of most ABS are triggers for early payout, designed to protect investors from losses. These triggers are unique to each transaction and can include a significant rise in defaults on the underlying loans, a sharp drop
in the credit enhancement level or the bankruptcy of the originator. Once early amortization begins, all incoming loan payments (after expenses are paid) are used to pay investors as quickly as possible based upon a predetermined priority of
payment. As a result, proceeds that would otherwise be distributed to holders of a junior tranche may be diverted to pay down more senior tranches.
The
collateral underlying ABS may constitute assets related to a wide range of industries and sectors, such as credit card and automobile receivables. Credit card receivables are generally unsecured and the debtors are entitled to the protection of a
number of state and federal consumer credit laws, many of which give debtors the right to set off certain amounts owed on the credit cards, thereby reducing the balance due. Most issuers of automobile receivables permit the servicers to retain
possession of the underlying obligations. If the servicer were to sell these obligations to another party, there is a risk that the purchaser would acquire an interest superior to that of the holders of the related automobile receivables. In
addition, because of the large number of vehicles involved in a typical issuance and technical requirements under state laws, the trustee for the holders of the automobile receivables may not have an effective security interest in all of the
obligations backing such receivables. If the economy of the United States deteriorates, defaults on securities backed by credit card, automobile and other receivables may increase, which may adversely affect the value of any ABS owned by Trust.
There is the possibility that recoveries on the underlying collateral may not, in some cases, be available to support payments on these securities. In the past, certain automobile manufacturers have been granted access to emergency loans from the
U.S. Government and have experienced bankruptcy. These events may adversely affect the value of securities backed by receivables from the sale or lease of automobiles
Some ABS, particularly home equity loan transactions, are subject to interest rate risk and prepayment risk. A change in interest rates can affect the pace of
payments on the underlying loans, which in turn, affects total return on the securities.
- 59 -
Zero Coupon Securities Risk
While interest payments are not made on such securities, holders of such securities are deemed to have received income (phantom income) annually,
notwithstanding that cash may not be received currently. The effect of owning instruments that do not make current interest payments is that a fixed yield is earned not only on the original investment but also, in effect, on all discount accretion
during the life of the obligations. This implicit reinvestment of earnings at a fixed rate eliminates the risk of being unable to invest distributions at a rate as high as the implicit yield on the zero coupon bond, but at the same time eliminates
the holders ability to reinvest at higher rates in the future. For this reason, some of these securities may be subject to substantially greater price fluctuations during periods of changing market interest rates than are comparable securities
that pay interest currently. Longer term zero coupon bonds are more exposed to interest rate risk than shorter term zero coupon bonds. These investments benefit the issuer by mitigating its need for cash to meet debt service, but also require a
higher rate of return to attract investors who are willing to defer receipt of cash. Because zero-coupon bonds allow an issuer to defer the need to generate cash to meet current interest payments, these
investments may involve greater credit risk than bonds that pay interest currently or in cash. In addition, zero coupon bonds may be difficult to value accurately because their continuing accruals require continuing judgments about the
collectability of the deferred payments and the value of any associated collateral.
Pay-in-Kind Bonds Risk
Similar to zero coupon obligations, pay-in-kind bonds also carry additional
risk as holders of these types of securities realize no cash until the cash payment date unless a portion of such securities is sold and, if the issuer defaults, the Trust may obtain no return at all on its investment. The market price of pay-in-kind bonds is affected by interest rate changes to a greater extent, and therefore tends to be more volatile, than that of securities which pay interest in cash.
Because pay-in-kind bonds allow an issuer to defer the need to generate cash to meet current interest payments, these investments may involve greater credit risk than
bonds that pay interest currently or in cash. In addition, pay-in-kind bonds may be difficult to value accurately because their continuing accruals require continuing
judgments about the collectability of the deferred payments and the value of any associated collateral. Additionally, interest on pay-in-kind bonds has the effect of
generating investment income, and the deferral of interest on pay-in-kind bonds increases the
loan-to-value ratio at a compounding rate. Current federal tax law requires the holder of certain
pay-in-kind bonds to accrue income with respect to these securities prior to the receipt of cash payments. To maintain its qualification as a regulated investment
company and avoid liability for U.S. federal income and excise taxes, the Trust may be required to distribute income accrued with respect to these securities and may have to dispose of portfolio securities under disadvantageous circumstances in
order to generate cash to satisfy these distribution requirements.
Insolvency of Issuers of Indebtedness Risk
Various laws enacted for the protection of creditors may apply to indebtedness in which the Trust invests. The information in this and the following
paragraph is applicable with respect to U.S. issuers subject to U.S. federal bankruptcy law. Insolvency considerations may differ with respect to other issuers. If, in a lawsuit brought by an unpaid creditor or representative of creditors
of an issuer of indebtedness, a court were to find that the issuer did not receive fair consideration or reasonably equivalent value for incurring the indebtedness and that, after giving effect to such indebtedness, the issuer (i) was
insolvent, (ii) was engaged in a business for which the remaining assets of such issuer constituted unreasonably small capital or (iii) intended to incur, or believed that it would incur, debts beyond its ability to pay such debts as they
mature, such court could determine to invalidate, in whole or in part, such indebtedness as a fraudulent conveyance, to subordinate such indebtedness to existing or future creditors of such issuer, or to recover amounts previously paid by such
issuer in satisfaction of such indebtedness. The measure of insolvency for purposes of the foregoing will vary. Generally, an issuer would be considered insolvent at a particular time if the sum of its debts was then greater than all of its
property at a fair valuation, or if the present fair saleable value of its assets was then less than the amount that would be required to pay its probable liabilities on its existing debts as they became absolute and matured. There can be no
assurance as to what standard a court would apply in order to determine whether the issuer was insolvent after giving effect to the incurrence of the indebtedness in which the Trust invested or that, regardless of the method of
valuation, a court would not determine that the issuer was insolvent upon giving effect to such incurrence. In addition, in the event of the insolvency of an issuer of indebtedness in which the Trust invests, payments made on such
indebtedness could be subject to
- 60 -
avoidance as a preference if made within a certain period of time (which may be as long as one year) before insolvency.
The Trust does not anticipate that it will engage in conduct that would form the basis for a successful cause of action based upon fraudulent conveyance,
preference or subordination. There can be no assurance, however, as to whether any lending institution or other party from which the Trust may acquire such indebtedness engaged in any such conduct (or any other conduct that would subject such
indebtedness and the Trust to insolvency laws) and, if it did, as to whether such creditor claims could be asserted in a U.S. court (or in the courts of any other country) against the Trust.
Indebtedness consisting of obligations of non-U.S. issuers may be subject to various laws enacted in the countries of
their issuance for the protection of creditors. These insolvency considerations will differ depending on the country in which each issuer is located or domiciled and may differ depending on whether the issuer is a
non-sovereign or a sovereign entity.
Warrants Risk
If the price of the underlying stock does not rise above the exercise price before the warrant expires, the warrant generally expires without any value and
the Trust will lose any amount it paid for the warrant. Thus, investments in warrants may involve substantially more risk than investments in common stock. Warrants may trade in the same markets as their underlying stock; however, the price of the
warrant does not necessarily move with the price of the underlying stock.
Rights Risk
The failure to exercise subscription rights to purchase common stock would result in the dilution of the Trusts interest in the issuing company. The
market for such rights is not well developed, and, accordingly, the Trust may not always realize full value on the sale of rights.
Convertible
Securities Risk
The market value of a convertible security performs like that of a regular debt security; that is, if market interest rates rise, the
value of a convertible security usually falls. In addition, convertible securities are subject to the risk that the issuer will not be able to pay interest or dividends when due, and their market value may change based on changes in the
issuers credit rating or the markets perception of the issuers creditworthiness. Since it derives a portion of its value from the common stock into which it may be converted, a convertible security is also subject to the same types
of market and issuer risks that apply to the underlying common stock.
Contingent Convertible Securities Risk
CoCos are subject to additional risk factors in addition to those related to convertible securities. CoCos are a newer form of instrument and the regulatory
environment for these instruments continues to evolve. Because the market for such securities is evolving, it is uncertain how the larger market for CoCos would react to a trigger event, coupon cancellation, write-down of par value or coupon
suspension (as described below) applicable to a single issuer. Following conversion of a CoCo, because the common stock of the issuer may not pay a dividend, investors in such securities could experience reduced yields or no yields at all.
There are special risks associated with investing in CoCos, including:
Loss Absorption Risk. CoCos have fully discretionary coupons. This means coupons can potentially be cancelled at the banking institutions
discretion or at the request of the relevant regulatory authority in order to help the bank absorb losses. The liquidation value of a CoCo may be adjusted downward to below the original par value or written off entirely under certain circumstances.
The write-down of the securitys par value may occur automatically and would not entitle holders to institute bankruptcy proceedings against the issuer. In addition, an automatic write-down could result in a reduced income rate if the dividend
or interest payment associated with the security is based on the
- 61 -
securitys par value. Coupon payments may also be subject to approval by the issuers regulator and may be suspended in the event there are insufficient distributable reserves. Due to
uncertainty surrounding coupon payments, CoCos may be volatile and their price may decline rapidly in the event that coupon payments are suspended.
Subordinated Instruments. CoCos will, in the majority of circumstances, be issued in the form of subordinated debt instruments in order to
provide the appropriate regulatory capital treatment prior to a conversion. Accordingly, in the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding-up of an issuer prior to a conversion having
occurred, the rights and claims of the holders of the CoCos, such as the Trust, against the issuer in respect of or arising under the terms of the CoCos shall generally rank junior to the claims of all holders of unsubordinated obligations of the
issuer. In addition, if the CoCos are converted into the issuers underlying equity securities following a conversion event (i.e., a trigger), each holder will be subordinated due to their conversion from being the holder of a
debt instrument to being the holder of an equity instrument. Such conversion may be automatic.
Unpredictable Market Value
Fluctuate. The value of CoCos is unpredictable and will be influenced by many factors including, without limitation: (i) the creditworthiness of the issuer and/or fluctuations in such issuers applicable capital ratios;
(ii) supply and demand for the CoCos; (iii) general market conditions and available liquidity; and (iv) economic, financial and political events that affect the issuer, its particular market or the financial markets in general.
Municipal Securities Risk
Municipal securities risks
include the ability of the issuer to repay the obligation, the relative lack of information about certain issuers of municipal securities, and the possibility of future legislative changes which could affect the market for and value of municipal
securities. These risks include:
General Obligation Bonds Risks. The full faith, credit and taxing power of the municipality that issues a
general obligation bond secures payment of interest and repayment of principal. Timely payments depend on the issuers credit quality, ability to raise tax revenues and ability to maintain an adequate tax base.
Revenue Bonds Risks. Revenue bonds issued by state or local agencies to finance the development of
low-income, multi-family housing involve special risks in addition to those associated with municipal bonds generally, including that the underlying properties may not generate sufficient income to pay
expenses and interest costs. Payments of interest and principal on revenue bonds are made only from the revenues generated by a particular facility, class of facilities or the proceeds of a special tax or other revenue source. These payments depend
on the money earned by the particular facility or class of facilities, or the amount of revenues derived from another source. Such bonds are generally nonrecourse against the property owner, may be junior to the rights of others with an interest in
the properties, may pay interest that changes based in part on the financial performance of the property, may be prepayable without penalty and may be used to finance the construction of housing developments which, until completed and rented, do not
generate income to pay interest. Increases in interest rates payable on senior obligations may make it more difficult for issuers to meet payment obligations on subordinated bonds.
Private Activity Bonds Risks. Municipalities and other public authorities issue private activity bonds to finance development of industrial
facilities for use by a private enterprise. The private enterprise pays the principal and interest on the bond, and the issuer does not pledge its full faith, credit and taxing power for repayment. If the private enterprise defaults on its payments,
the Trust may not receive any income or get its money back from the investment. These bonds may subject certain investors in the Trust to the federal alternative minimum tax.
Moral Obligation Bonds Risks. Moral obligation bonds are generally issued by special purpose public authorities of a state or municipality. If
the issuer is unable to meet its obligations, repayment of these bonds becomes a moral commitment, but not a legal obligation, of the state or municipality.
Municipal Notes Risks. Municipal notes are shorter term municipal debt obligations. They may provide interim financing in anticipation of, and
are secured by, tax collection, bond sales or revenue receipts. If there is a shortfall in the anticipated proceeds, the notes may not be fully repaid and the Trust may lose money.
- 62 -
Municipal Lease Obligations Risks. In a municipal lease obligation, the issuer agrees to make
payments when due on the lease obligation. The issuer will generally appropriate municipal funds for that purpose, but is not obligated to do so. Although the issuer does not pledge its unlimited taxing power for payment of the lease obligation, the
lease obligation is secured by the leased property. However, if the issuer does not fulfill its payment obligation it may be difficult to sell the property and the proceeds of a sale may not cover the Trusts loss.
Municipal leases and certificates of participation involve special risks not normally associated with general obligations or revenue bonds. Leases and
installment purchase or conditional sale contracts (which normally provide for title to the leased asset to pass eventually to the governmental issuer) have evolved as a means for governmental issuers to acquire property and equipment without
meeting the constitutional and statutory requirements for the issuance of debt. The debt issuance limitations are deemed to be inapplicable because of the inclusion in many leases or contracts of nonappropriation clauses that relieve the
governmental issuer of any obligation to make future payments under the lease or contract unless money is appropriated for such purpose by the appropriate legislative body on a yearly or other periodic basis. In addition, such leases or contracts
may be subject to the temporary abatement of payments in the event that the governmental issuer is prevented from maintaining occupancy of the lease premises or utilizing the leased equipment. Although the obligations may be secured by the leased
equipment or facilities, the disposition of the property in the event of nonappropriation or foreclosure might prove difficult, time consuming and costly, and may result in a delay in recovering or the failure to fully recover ownership of the
assets.
Certificates of participation, which represent interests in unmanaged pools of municipal leases or installment contracts, involve the same risks
as the underlying municipal leases. In addition, the Trust may be dependent upon the municipal authority issuing the certificate of participation to exercise remedies with respect to the underlying securities.
Certificates of participation also entail a risk of default or bankruptcy, both of the issuer of the municipal lease and also the municipal agency issuing the
certificate of participation.
Liquidity of Investments. Certain municipal bonds in which the Trust invests may lack an established secondary
trading market or are otherwise considered illiquid. Liquidity of a security relates to the ability to easily dispose of the security and the price to be obtained and does not generally relate to the credit risk or likelihood of receipt of cash at
maturity. Illiquid securities may trade at a discount from comparable, more liquid investments.
The financial markets in general, and certain segments of
the municipal securities markets in particular, have in recent years experienced periods of extreme secondary market supply and demand imbalance, resulting in a loss of liquidity during which market prices were suddenly and substantially below
traditional measures of intrinsic value. During such periods some securities could be sold only at arbitrary prices and with substantial losses. Periods of such market dislocation may occur again at any time.
Because the Trust does not expect that it will invest more 50% of its assets in tax-exempt municipal securities, the
Trust will not be eligible to pass tax-exempt interest through to its shareholders in the form of exempt-interest dividends. The amount of tax-exempt
interest earned by the Trust will, however, generally increase the Trusts earnings and profits for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Accordingly, distributions of the Trust attributable to
tax-exempt interest will generally be taxable to shareholders as ordinary dividend income that is not eligible for the preferential tax rates applicable to qualified dividend income, even though
the tax-exempt income, if earned directly by the shareholder, would not have been subject to U.S. federal income tax.
Municipal Securities Market Risk
Economic exposure to
the municipal securities market involves certain risks. The municipal market is one in which dealer firms make markets in bonds on a principal basis using their proprietary capital, and during the financial crisis of 2007-2009 these firms
capital was severely constrained. As a result, some firms were unwilling to commit their capital to purchase and to serve as a dealer for municipal securities. Certain municipal securities may not be registered with the SEC or any state securities
commission and will not be listed on any national securities exchange. The amount of public information available about the municipal securities to which the Trust is economically exposed is generally less than that for corporate equities or bonds,
and the investment performance of
- 63 -
the Trust may therefore be more dependent on the analytical abilities of the Advisors than would be a fund investing solely in stocks or taxable bonds. The secondary market for municipal
securities, particularly the below investment grade securities to which the Trust may be economically exposed, also tends to be less well-developed or liquid than many other securities markets, which may adversely affect the Trusts ability to
sell such securities at attractive prices or at prices approximating those at which the Trust currently values them.
In addition, many state and
municipal governments that issue securities are under significant economic and financial stress and may not be able to satisfy their obligations. This stress may be significantly exacerbated by the coronavirus pandemic. The ability of municipal
issuers to make timely payments of interest and principal may be diminished during general economic downturns and as governmental cost burdens are reallocated among federal, state and local governments. The taxing power of any governmental entity
may be limited by provisions of state constitutions or laws and an entitys credit will depend on many factors, including the entitys tax base, the extent to which the entity relies on federal or state aid, and other factors which are
beyond the entitys control. In addition, laws enacted in the future by Congress or state legislatures or referenda could extend the time for payment of principal and/or interest, or impose other constraints on enforcement of such obligations
or on the ability of municipalities to levy taxes. Issuers of municipal securities might seek protection under the bankruptcy laws. In the event of bankruptcy of such an issuer, holders of municipal securities could experience delays in collecting
principal and interest and such holders may not, in all circumstances, be able to collect all principal and interest to which they are entitled. To enforce its rights in the event of a default in the payment of interest or repayment of principal, or
both, the Trust may take possession of and manage the assets securing the issuers obligations on such securities, which may increase the Trusts operating expenses. Any income derived from the Trusts ownership or operation of such
assets may not be tax-exempt or may fail to generate qualifying income for purposes of the income tests applicable to RICs.
Taxable Municipal Securities Risk. Build America Bonds involve similar risks as municipal bonds, including credit and market risk. In particular,
should a Build America Bonds issuer fail to continue to meet the applicable requirements imposed on the bonds as provided by the ARRA , it is possible that such issuer may not receive federal cash subsidy payments, impairing the
issuers ability to make scheduled interest payments. The Build America Bond program expired on December 31, 2010 and no further issuance is permitted unless Congress renews the program. As a result, the number of available Build America
Bonds is limited, which may negatively affect the value of the Build America Bonds. In addition, there can be no assurance that Build America Bonds will be actively traded. It is difficult to predict the extent to which a market for such bonds will
continue, meaning that Build America Bonds may experience greater illiquidity than other municipal obligations. The Build America Bonds outstanding as of December 31, 2010 will continue to be eligible for the federal interest rate subsidy,
which continues for the life of the Build America Bonds; however, no bonds issued following expiration of the Build America Bond program will be eligible for the U.S. federal tax subsidy.
General Risk Factors in Hedging Foreign Currency
Hedging transactions involving Currency Instruments involve substantial risks, including correlation risk. While the Trusts use of Currency Instruments
to effect hedging strategies is intended to reduce the volatility of the NAV of the Trusts common shares, the NAV of the Trusts common shares will fluctuate. Moreover, although Currency Instruments may be used with the intention of
hedging against adverse currency movements, transactions in Currency Instruments involve the risk that anticipated currency movements will not be accurately predicted and that the Trusts hedging strategies will be ineffective. To the extent
that the Trust hedges against anticipated currency movements that do not occur, the Trust may realize losses and decrease its total return as the result of its hedging transactions. Furthermore, the Trust will only engage in hedging activities from
time to time and may not be engaging in hedging activities when movements in currency exchange rates occur.
It may not be possible for the Trust to hedge
against currency exchange rate movements, even if correctly anticipated, in the event that (i) the currency exchange rate movement is so generally anticipated that the Trust is not able to enter into a hedging transaction at an effective price,
or (ii) the currency exchange rate movement relates to a market with respect to which Currency Instruments are not available and it is not possible to engage in effective foreign currency hedging. The cost to the Trust of engaging in foreign
currency transactions varies with such factors as the currencies involved, the length of the contract period and the market conditions then prevailing. Since
- 64 -
transactions in foreign currency exchange usually are conducted on a principal basis, no fees or commissions are involved.
Foreign Currency Forwards Risk
Forward foreign currency
exchange contracts do not eliminate fluctuations in the value of Non-U.S. Securities (as defined in the prospectus) but rather allow the Trust to establish a fixed rate of exchange for a future point
in time. This strategy can have the effect of reducing returns and minimizing opportunities for gain.
In connection with its trading in forward foreign
currency contracts, the Trust will contract with a foreign or domestic bank, or foreign or domestic securities dealer, to make or take future delivery of a specified amount of a particular currency. There are no limitations on daily price moves in
such forward contracts, and banks and dealers are not required to continue to make markets in such contracts. There have been periods during which certain banks or dealers have refused to quote prices for such forward contracts or have quoted prices
with an unusually wide spread between the price at which the bank or dealer is prepared to buy and that at which it is prepared to sell. Governmental imposition of credit controls might limit any such forward contract trading. With respect to its
trading of forward contracts, if any, the Trust will be subject to the risk of bank or dealer failure and the inability of, or refusal by, a bank or dealer to perform with respect to such contracts. Any such default would deprive the Trust of any
profit potential or force the Trust to cover its commitments for resale, if any, at the then market price and could result in a loss to the Trust.
The
Trust may also engage in proxy hedging transactions to reduce the effect of currency fluctuations on the value of existing or anticipated holdings of portfolio securities. Proxy hedging is often used when the currency to which the Trust is exposed
is difficult to hedge or to hedge against the dollar. Proxy hedging entails entering into a forward contract to sell a currency whose changes in value are generally considered to be linked to a currency or currencies in which some or all of the
Trusts securities are, or are expected to be, denominated, and to buy U.S. dollars. Proxy hedging involves some of the same risks and considerations as other transactions with similar instruments. Currency transactions can result in losses to
the Trust if the currency being hedged fluctuates in value to a degree or in a direction that is not anticipated. In addition, there is the risk that the perceived linkage between various currencies may not be present or may not be present during
the particular time that the Trust is engaging in proxy hedging. The Trust may also cross-hedge currencies by entering into forward contracts to sell one or more currencies that are expected to decline in value relative to other currencies to which
the Trust has or in which the Trust expects to have portfolio exposure. For example, the Trust may hold both Canadian government bonds and Japanese government bonds, and the Advisors may believe that Canadian dollars will deteriorate against
Japanese yen. The Trust would sell Canadian dollars to reduce its exposure to that currency and buy Japanese yen. This strategy would be a hedge against a decline in the value of Canadian dollars, although it would expose the Trust to declines in
the value of the Japanese yen relative to the U.S. dollar.
Some of the forward non-U.S. currency
contracts entered into by the Trust may be classified as non-deliverable forwards (NDFs). NDFs are cash-settled, short-term forward contracts that may be thinly traded or are denominated in non-convertible foreign currency, where the profit or loss at the time at the settlement date is calculated by taking the difference between the agreed upon exchange rate and the spot rate at the time
of settlement, for an agreed upon notional amount of funds. All NDFs have a fixing date and a settlement date. The fixing date is the date at which the difference between the prevailing market exchange rate and the agreed upon exchange rate is
calculated. The settlement date is the date by which the payment of the difference is due to the party receiving payment. NDFs are commonly quoted for time periods of one month up to two years, and are normally quoted and settled in U.S. dollars.
They are often used to gain exposure to and/or hedge exposure to foreign currencies that are not internationally traded.
Currency Futures Risk
The Trust may also seek to hedge against the decline in the value of a currency or to enhance returns through use of currency futures or options
thereon. Currency futures are similar to forward foreign exchange transactions except that futures are standardized, exchange-traded contracts while forward foreign exchange transactions are traded in the OTC market. Currency futures involve
substantial currency risk, and also involve leverage risk.
- 65 -
Currency Options Risk
The Trust may also seek to hedge against the decline in the value of a currency or to enhance returns through the use of currency options. Currency options
are similar to options on securities. For example, in consideration for an option premium the writer of a currency option is obligated to sell (in the case of a call option) or purchase (in the case of a put option) a specified amount of a specified
currency on or before the expiration date for a specified amount of another currency. The Trust may engage in transactions in options on currencies either on exchanges or OTC markets. Currency options involve substantial currency risk, and may also
involve credit, leverage or illiquidity risk.
Currency Swaps Risk
The Trust may enter into currency swaps. Currency swaps involve the exchange of the rights of the Trust and another party to make or receive payments in
specified currencies. The Trust may also hedge portfolio positions through currency swaps, which are transactions in which one currency is simultaneously bought for a second currency on a spot basis and sold for the second currency on a forward
basis. Currency swaps usually involve the delivery of the entire principal value of one designated currency in exchange for the other designated currency. Because currency swaps usually involve the delivery of the entire principal value of one
designated currency in exchange for the other designated currency, the entire principal value of a currency swap is subject to the risk that the other party to the swap will default on its contractual delivery obligations.
Over-The-Counter Trading Risk
The derivative instruments that may be purchased or sold by the Trust may include instruments not traded on an exchange. The risk of nonperformance by the
counterparty to an instrument may be greater than, and the ease with which the Trust can dispose of or enter into closing transactions with respect to an instrument may be less than, the risk associated with an exchange traded or cleared OTC
instrument. In addition, significant disparities may exist between bid and asked prices for derivative instruments that are not traded on an exchange. The absence of liquidity may make it difficult or impossible for the Trust
to sell such instruments promptly at an acceptable price. Derivative instruments not traded on exchanges also are not subject to the same type of government regulation as exchange traded or cleared OTC instruments, and many of the protections
afforded to participants in a regulated environment may not be available in connection with the transactions. Because derivatives traded in OTC markets generally are not guaranteed by an exchange or clearing corporation and generally do not require
payment of margin, to the extent that the Trust has unrealized gains in such instruments or has deposited collateral with its counterparties the Trust is at risk that its counterparties will become bankrupt or otherwise fail to honor its
obligations.
Event Risk
Event risk is the risk
that corporate issuers may undergo restructurings, such as mergers, leveraged buyouts, takeovers, or similar events financed by increased debt. As a result of the added debt, the credit quality and market value of a companys bonds and/or other
debt securities may decline significantly.
Indexed and Inverse Securities Risk
The Trust may invest in securities the potential return of which is based on the change in a specified interest rate or equity index (an indexed
security). For example, the Trust may invest in a security that pays a variable amount of interest or principal based on the current level of the French or Korean stock markets. The Trust may also invest in securities whose return is inversely
related to changes in an interest rate or index (inverse securities). In general, the return on inverse securities will decrease when the underlying index or interest rate goes up and increase when that index or interest rate goes down.
- 66 -
Inverse Floater and Related Securities Risk
Investments in inverse floaters, residual interest tender option bonds and similar instruments expose the Trust to the same risks as investments in fixed
income securities and derivatives, as well as other risks, including those associated with leverage and increased volatility. An investment in these securities typically will involve greater risk than an investment in a fixed rate security.
Distributions on inverse floaters, residual interest tender option bonds and similar instruments will typically bear an inverse relationship to short term interest rates and typically will be reduced or, potentially, eliminated as interest rates
rise. Inverse floaters, residual interest tender option bonds and similar instruments will underperform the market for fixed rate securities in a rising interest rate environment. Inverse floaters may be considered to be leveraged to the extent that
their interest rates vary by a magnitude that exceeds the magnitude of the change in a reference rate of interest (typically a short term interest rate). The leverage inherent in inverse floaters is associated with greater volatility in their market
values. Investments in inverse floaters, residual interest tender option bonds and similar instruments that have fixed income securities underlying them will expose the Trust to the risks associated with those fixed income securities and the values
of those investments may be especially sensitive to changes in prepayment rates on the underlying fixed income securities.
Inflation-Indexed Bonds
Risk
The Trust may invest in inflation-indexed bonds, which are fixed-income securities or other instruments whose principal value is periodically
adjusted according to the rate of inflation. Two structures are common. The U.S. Treasury and some other issuers use a structure that accrues inflation into the principal value of the bond. Most other issuers pay out the Consumer Price Index
(CPI) accruals as part of a semi-annual coupon.
Inflation-indexed securities issued by the U.S. Treasury have maturities of five, ten or
thirty years, although it is possible that securities with other maturities will be issued in the future. The U.S. Treasury securities pay interest on a semi-annual basis, equal to a fixed percentage of the inflation-adjusted principal amount. For
example, if the Trust purchased an inflation-indexed bond with a par value of $1,000 and a 3% real rate of return coupon (payable 1.5% semi-annually), and inflation over the first six months was 1%,
the mid-year par value of the bond would be $1,010 and the first semi-annual interest payment would be $15.15 ($1,010 times 1.5%). If inflation during the second half of the year resulted in the
whole years inflation equaling 3%, the end-of-year par value of the bond would be $1,030 and the second semi-annual interest payment would be $15.45
($1,030 times 1.5%).
If the periodic adjustment rate measuring inflation falls, the principal value of inflation-indexed bonds will be adjusted downward,
and, consequently, the interest payable on these securities (calculated with respect to a smaller principal amount) will be reduced. Repayment of the original bond principal upon maturity (as adjusted for inflation) is guaranteed in the case of U.S.
Treasury inflation-indexed bonds, even during a period of deflation. However, the current market value of the bonds is not guaranteed, and will fluctuate. The Trust may also invest in other inflation related bonds which may or may not provide a
similar guarantee. If a guarantee of principal is not provided, the adjusted principal value of the bond repaid at maturity may be less than the original principal. In addition, if the Trust purchases inflation-indexed bonds offered by foreign
issuers, the rate of inflation measured by the foreign inflation index may not be correlated to the rate of inflation in the United States.
The value of
inflation-indexed bonds is expected to change in response to changes in real interest rates. Real interest rates, in turn, are tied to the relationship between nominal interest rates and the rate of inflation. Therefore, if inflation were to rise at
a faster rate than nominal interest rates, real interest rates might decline, leading to an increase in value of inflation-indexed bonds. In contrast, if nominal interest rates increased at a faster rate than inflation, real interest rates might
rise, leading to a decrease in value of inflation-indexed bonds. There can be no assurance, however, that the value of inflation-indexed bonds will be directly correlated to changes in interest rates.
While these securities are expected to be protected from long-term inflationary trends, short-term increases in inflation may lead to a decline in value. If
interest rates rise due to reasons other than inflation (for example, due to changes in currency exchange rates), investors in these securities may not be protected to the extent that the increase is not reflected in the bonds inflation
measure.
In general, the measure used to determine the periodic adjustment of U.S. inflation-indexed bonds is the Consumer Price Index for Urban Consumers (CPI-U), which is calculated monthly by the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics.
- 67 -
The CPI-U is a measurement of changes in the cost of living, made up of components such as housing, food, transportation and energy.
Inflation-indexed bonds issued by a foreign government are generally adjusted to reflect a comparable inflation index, calculated by that government. There can be no assurance that the CPI-U or any
foreign inflation index will accurately measure the real rate of inflation in the prices of goods and services. Moreover, there can be no assurance that the rate of inflation in a foreign country will be correlated to the rate of inflation in the
United States.
Any increase in the principal amount of an inflation-indexed bond will be considered taxable ordinary income, even though investors do not
receive their principal until maturity.
Structured Investments Risk
The Trust may invest in structured products, including structured notes, ELNs and other types of structured products. Holders of structured products bear the
risks of the underlying investments, index or reference obligation and are subject to counterparty risk.
The Trust may have the right to receive payments
only from the structured product and generally does not have direct rights against the issuer or the entity that sold the assets to be securitized. While certain structured products enable the investor to acquire interests in a pool of securities
without the brokerage and other expenses associated with directly holding the same securities, investors in structured products generally pay their share of the structured products administrative and other expenses.
Although it is difficult to predict whether the prices of indices and securities underlying structured products will rise or fall, these prices (and,
therefore, the prices of structured products) will be influenced by the same types of political and economic events that affect issuers of securities and capital markets generally. If the issuer of a structured product uses shorter term financing to
purchase longer term securities, the issuer may be forced to sell its securities at below market prices if it experiences difficulty in obtaining such financing, which may adversely affect the value of the structured products owned by the Trust.
Structured Notes Risk. Investments in structured notes involve risks, including credit risk and market risk. Where the
Trusts investments in structured notes are based upon the movement of one or more factors, including currency exchange rates, interest rates, referenced bonds and stock indices, depending on the factor used and the use of multipliers or
deflators, changes in interest rates and movement of the factor may cause significant price fluctuations. Additionally, changes in the reference instrument or security may cause the interest rate on the structured note to be reduced to zero and any
further changes in the reference instrument may then reduce the principal amount payable on maturity. Structured notes may be less liquid than other types of securities and more volatile than the reference instrument or security underlying the note.
Event-Linked Securities Risk. Event-linked securities are a form of derivative issued by insurance companies and
insurance-related special purpose vehicles that apply securitization techniques to catastrophic property and casualty damages. Unlike other insurable low-severity, high-probability events, the insurance risk
of which can be diversified by writing large numbers of similar policies, the holders of a typical event-linked securities are exposed to the risks from high-severity, low-probability events such as that posed
by major earthquakes or hurricanes. If a catastrophe occurs that triggers the event-linked security, investors in such security may lose some or all of the capital invested. In the case of an event, the funds are paid to the bond
sponsoran insurer, reinsurer or corporationto cover losses. In return, the bond sponsors pay interest to investors for this catastrophe protection. Event-linked securities can be structured to
pay-off on three types of variablesinsurance-industry catastrophe loss indices, insured-specific catastrophe losses and parametric indices based on the physical characteristics of catastrophic events.
Such variables are difficult to predict or model, and the risk and potential return profiles of event-linked securities may be difficult to assess. Catastrophe-related event-linked securities have been in use since the 1990s, and the securitization
and risk-transfer aspects of such event-linked securities are beginning to be employed in other insurance and risk-related areas. No active trading market may exist for certain event-linked securities, which may impair the ability of the Trust to
realize full value in the event of the need to liquidate such assets.
- 68 -
Equity-Linked Notes Risk. ELNs are hybrid securities with characteristics of both
fixed-income and equity securities. An ELN is a debt instrument, usually a bond, that pays interest based upon the performance of an underlying equity, which can be a single stock, basket of stocks or an equity index. The interest payment on an ELN
may in some cases be leveraged so that, in percentage terms, it exceeds the relative performance of the market. ELNs generally are subject to the risks associated with the securities of equity issuers, default risk and counterparty risk.
Credit-Linked Notes Risk. A credit-linked note is a derivative instrument. It is a synthetic obligation between two or more
parties where the payment of principal and/or interest is based on the performance of some obligation (a reference obligation). In addition to the credit risk of the reference obligations and interest rate risk, the buyer/seller of the credit-linked
note is subject to counterparty risk.
Repurchase Agreements and Purchase and Sale Contracts Risk
Subject to its investment objective and policies, the Trust may enter into repurchase agreements. Repurchase agreements typically involve the acquisition by
the Trust of fixed-income securities from a selling financial institution such as a bank, savings and loan association or broker-dealer. The agreement provides that the Trust will sell the securities back to the institution at a fixed time in the
future. The Trust does not bear the risk of a decline in the value of the underlying security unless the seller defaults under its repurchase obligation. In the event of the bankruptcy or other default of a seller of a repurchase agreement, the
Trust could experience both delays in liquidating the underlying securities and losses, including possible decline in the value of the underlying security during the period in which the Trust seeks to enforce its rights thereto; possible lack of
access to income on the underlying security during this period; and expenses of enforcing its rights. While repurchase agreements involve certain risks not associated with direct investments in fixed-income securities, the Trust follows procedures
approved by the Board that are designed to minimize such risks. In addition, the value of the collateral underlying the repurchase agreement will be at least equal to the repurchase price, including any accrued interest earned on the repurchase
agreement. In the event of a default or bankruptcy by a selling financial institution, the Trust generally will seek to liquidate such collateral. However, the exercise of the Trusts right to liquidate such collateral could involve certain
costs or delays and, to the extent that proceeds from any sale upon a default of the obligation to repurchase were less than the repurchase price, the Trust could suffer a loss.
When-Issued and Delayed Delivery Securities and Forward Commitments Risk
When-issued and delayed delivery securities and forward commitments involve the risk that the security the Trust buys will lose value prior to its delivery.
There also is the risk that the security will not be issued or that the other party to the transaction will not meet its obligation. If this occurs, the Trust may lose both the investment opportunity for the assets it set aside to pay for the
security and any gain in the securitys price.
Securities Lending Risk
The Trust may lend securities to financial institutions. Securities lending involves exposure to certain risks, including operational risk (i.e., the risk of
losses resulting from problems in the settlement and accounting process), gap risk (i.e., the risk of a mismatch between the return on cash collateral reinvestments and the fees the Trust has agreed to pay a borrower), and credit, legal,
counterparty and market risk. If a securities lending counterparty were to default, the Trust would be subject to the risk of a possible delay in receiving collateral or in recovering the loaned securities, or to a possible loss of rights in the
collateral. In the event a borrower does not return the Trusts securities as agreed, the Trust may experience losses if the proceeds received from liquidating the collateral do not at least equal the value of the loaned security at the time
the collateral is liquidated, plus the transaction costs incurred in purchasing replacement securities. This event could trigger adverse tax consequences for the Trust. The Trust could lose money if its short-term investment of the collateral
declines in value over the period of the loan. Substitute payments for dividends received by the Trust for securities loaned out by the Trust will generally not be considered qualified dividend income. The securities lending agent will take the tax
effects on shareholders of this difference into account in connection with the Trusts securities lending program. Substitute payments received on tax-exempt securities loaned out will generally
not be tax-exempt income.
- 69 -
Short Sales Risk
Short-selling involves selling securities which may or may not be owned and borrowing the same securities for delivery to the purchaser, with an obligation to
replace the borrowed securities at a later date. If the price of the security sold short increases between the time of the short sale and the time the Trust replaces the borrowed security, the Trust will incur a loss; conversely, if the price
declines, the Trust will realize a capital gain. Any gain will be decreased, and any loss will be increased, by the transaction costs incurred by the Trust, including the costs associated with providing collateral to the broker-dealer (usually cash
and liquid securities) and the maintenance of collateral with its custodian. Although the Trusts gain is limited to the price at which it sold the security short, its potential loss is theoretically unlimited.
Short-selling necessarily involves certain additional risks. However, if the short seller does not own the securities sold short (an uncovered short sale),
the borrowed securities must be replaced by securities purchased at market prices in order to close out the short position, and any appreciation in the price of the borrowed securities would result in a loss. Uncovered short sales expose the Trust
to the risk of uncapped losses until a position can be closed out due to the lack of an upper limit on the price to which a security may rise. Purchasing securities to close out the short position can itself cause the price of the securities to rise
further, thereby exacerbating the loss. There is the risk that the securities borrowed by the Trust in connection with a short-sale must be returned to the securities lender on short notice. If a request for return of borrowed securities occurs at a
time when other short-sellers of the security are receiving similar requests, a short squeeze can occur, and the Trust may be compelled to replace borrowed securities previously sold short with purchases on the open market at the most
disadvantageous time, possibly at prices significantly in excess of the proceeds received at the time the securities were originally sold short.
Inflation Risk
Inflation risk is the risk that the
value of assets or income from investment will be worth less in the future, as inflation decreases the value of money. Inflation rates may change frequently and drastically as a result of various factors, including unexpected shifts in the domestic
or global economy. As inflation increases, the real value of the common shares and distributions on those shares can decline. In addition, during any periods of rising inflation, interest rates on any borrowings by the Trust would likely increase,
which would tend to further reduce returns to the holders of common shares.
Deflation Risk
Deflation risk is the risk that prices throughout the economy decline over time, which may have an adverse effect on the market valuation of companies, their
assets and their revenues. In addition, deflation may have an adverse effect on the creditworthiness of issuers and may make issuer default more likely, which may result in a decline in the value of the Trusts portfolio.
EMU and Redenomination Risk
As the European debt crisis
progressed the possibility of one or more Eurozone countries exiting the European Monetary Union (EMU), or even the collapse of the Euro as a common currency, arose, creating significant volatility at times in currency and financial
markets generally. The effects of the collapse of the Euro, or of the exit of one or more countries from the EMU, on the U.S. and global economy and securities markets are impossible to predict and any such events could have a significant adverse
impact on the value and risk profile of the Trusts portfolio. Any partial or complete dissolution of the EMU could have significant adverse effects on currency and financial markets, and on the values of the Trusts portfolio investments.
If one or more EMU countries were to stop using the Euro as its primary currency, the Trusts investments in such countries may be redenominated into a different or newly adopted currency. As a result, the value of those investments could
decline significantly and unpredictably. In addition, securities or other investments that are redenominated may be subject to foreign currency risk, liquidity risk and valuation risk to a greater extent than similar investments currently
denominated in Euros. To the extent a currency used for redenomination purposes is not specified in respect of certain EMU-related investments, or should the Euro cease to be used entirely, the currency in
which such investments are denominated may be unclear, making such investments particularly difficult to value or dispose of. The Trust may incur
- 70 -
additional expenses to the extent it is required to seek judicial or other clarification of the denomination or value of such securities.
Allocation Risk
The Trusts ability to achieve its
investment objective depends upon the Advisors skill in determining the Trusts strategic asset class allocation and in selecting the best mix of investments. There is a risk that the Advisors evaluations and assumptions regarding
asset classes or investments may be incorrect in view of actual market conditions.
The Trusts allocation of its investments across various segments
of the securities markets and various countries, regions, asset classes and sectors may vary significantly over time based on the Advisors analysis and judgment. As a result, the particular risks most relevant to an investment in the
Trust, as well as the overall risk profile of the Trusts portfolio, may vary over time. The Advisors employs an active approach to the Trusts investment allocations, but there is no guarantee that the Advisors allocation
strategy will produce the desired results. The percentage of the Trusts total assets allocated to any category of investment may at any given time be significantly less than the maximum percentage permitted pursuant to the Trusts
investment policies. It is possible that the Trust will focus on an investment that performs poorly or underperforms other investments under various market conditions. The flexibility of the Trusts investment policies and the discretion
granted to the Advisors to invest the Trusts assets across various segments, classes and geographic regions of the securities markets and in securities with various characteristics means that the Trusts ability to achieve its investment
objective may be more dependent on the success of its investment advisers than other investment companies.
Risk Associated with Recent Market Events
[While interest rates have been historically low in recent years in the United States and abroad, inflation rates have recently risen significantly
and the Federal Reserve and other central banks have recently begun raising interest rates to address inflation which, among other factors, has led to markets experiencing high volatility. A significant increase in interest rates may cause a further
decline in the market for equity securities and could lead to a recession. Further, regulators have expressed concern that rate increases may contribute to price volatility. The impact of inflation and the recent actions of the Federal Reserve have
led to market volatility and may negatively affect the value of debt instruments held by the Trust and result in a negative impact on the Trusts performance. See Inflation Risk.]
Governments and regulators may take actions that affect the regulation of the Trust or the instruments in which the Trust invests, or the issuers of such
instruments, in ways that are unforeseeable. Future legislation or regulation or other governmental actions could limit or preclude the Trusts abilities to achieve its investment objectives or otherwise adversely impact an investment in the
Trust. Political and diplomatic events within the United States, including a contentious domestic political environment, changes in political party control of one or more branches of the U.S. Government, the U.S. Governments inability at times
to agree on a long-term budget and deficit reduction plan, the threat of a U.S. Government shutdown, and disagreements over, or threats not to increase, the U.S. Governments borrowing limit (or debt ceiling), as well as political
and diplomatic events abroad, may affect investor and consumer confidence and may adversely impact financial markets and the broader economy, perhaps suddenly and to a significant degree. A downgrade of the ratings of U.S. Government debt
obligations, or concerns about the U.S. Governments credit quality in general, could have a substantial negative effect on the U.S. and global economies. For example, concerns about the U.S. Governments credit quality may cause increased
volatility in the stock and bond markets, higher interest rates, reduced prices and liquidity of U.S. Treasury securities, and/or increased costs of various kinds of debt. Moreover, although the U.S. Government has honored its credit obligations,
there remains a possibility that the United States could default on its obligations. The consequences of such an unprecedented event are impossible to predict, but it is likely that a default by the United States would be highly disruptive to the
U.S. and global securities markets and could significantly impair the value of the Trusts investments.
Some countries, including the United States,
have adopted and/or are considering the adoption of more protectionist trade policies. A rise in protectionist trade policies, and the possibility of changes to some international trade agreements, could affect the economies of many nations in ways
that cannot necessarily be foreseen at the present
- 71 -
time. In addition, geopolitical and other risks, including environmental and public health risks, may add to instability in world economies and markets generally. Economies and financial markets
throughout the world are becoming increasingly interconnected. As a result, whether or not the Trust invests in securities of issuers located in or with significant exposure to countries experiencing economic, political and/or financial
difficulties, the value and liquidity of the Trusts investments may be negatively affected by such events
Reference Rate Replacement Risk
The Trust may be exposed to financial instruments that recently transitioned from, or continue to be tied to, the London Interbank Offered Rate
(LIBOR) to determine payment obligations, financing terms, hedging strategies or investment value.
The United Kingdoms Financial
Conduct Authority (FCA), which regulates LIBOR, has ceased publishing all LIBOR settings. In April 2023, however, the FCA announced that some USD LIBOR settings would continue to be published under a synthetic methodology until
September 30, 2024 for certain legacy contracts. After September 30, 2024, the remaining synthetic LIBOR settings ceased to be published, and all LIBOR settings have permanently ceased. The Secured Overnight Financing Rate
(SOFR) is a broad measure of the cost of borrowing cash overnight collateralized by U.S. Treasury securities in the repurchase agreement (repo) market and has been used increasingly on a voluntary basis in new instruments and
transactions. Under U.S. regulations that implement a statutory fallback mechanism to replace LIBOR, benchmark rates based on SOFR have replaced LIBOR in certain financial contracts.
Neither the effect of the LIBOR transition process nor its ultimate success can yet be known. While some existing LIBOR-based instruments may contemplate a
scenario where LIBOR is no longer available by providing for an alternative rate-setting methodology, there may be significant uncertainty regarding the effectiveness of any such alternative methodologies to replicate LIBOR. Not all existing
LIBOR-based instruments may have alternative rate-setting provisions and there remains uncertainty regarding the willingness and ability of issuers to add alternative rate-setting provisions in certain existing instruments. Parties to contracts,
securities or other instruments using LIBOR may disagree on transition rates or the application of transition regulation, potentially resulting in uncertainty of performance and the possibility of litigation. The Trust may have instruments linked to
other interbank offered rates that may also cease to be published in the future.
Market Disruption and Geopolitical Risk
The occurrence of events similar to those in recent years, such as the aftermath of the war in Iraq, instability in Afghanistan, Pakistan, Egypt, Libya, Syria
and the Middle East, international war or conflict (including the Israel-Hamas war), new and ongoing epidemics and pandemics of infectious diseases and other global health events, natural/environmental disasters, terrorist attacks in the United
States and around the world, social and political discord, debt crises (such as the Greek crisis), sovereign debt downgrades, the Russian invasion of Ukraine, increasingly strained relations between the United States and a number of foreign
countries, including historical adversaries, such as North Korea, Iran, China and Russia, and the international community generally, new and continued political unrest in various countries, such as Venezuela and Spain, the exit or potential exit of
one or more countries from the EU or the EMU, and continued changes in the balance of political power among and within the branches of the U.S. government, among others, may result in market volatility, may have long term effects on the U.S. and
worldwide financial markets, and may cause further economic uncertainties in the United States and worldwide.
Russia launched a large-scale invasion of
Ukraine on February 24, 2022. The extent and duration of the military action, resulting sanctions and resulting future market disruptions, including declines in its stock markets and the value of the ruble against the U.S. dollar, in the region
are impossible to predict, but could be significant. Any such disruptions caused by Russian military action or other actions (including cyberattacks and espionage) or resulting actual and threatened responses to such activity, including purchasing
and financing restrictions, boycotts or changes in consumer or purchaser preferences, sanctions, tariffs or cyberattacks on the Russian government, Russian companies or Russian individuals, including politicians, could have a severe adverse effect
on Russia and the European region, including significant negative impacts on the Russian economy, the European economy and the markets for certain securities and commodities, such as oil and natural gas, and may likely have collateral impacts
- 72 -
on such sectors globally as well as other sectors. How long such military action and related events will last cannot be predicted.
China and the United States have each imposed tariffs on the other countrys products. These actions may cause a significant reduction in international
trade, the oversupply of certain manufactured goods, substantial price reductions of goods and possible failure of individual companies and/or large segments of Chinas export industry, which could have a negative impact on the Trusts
performance. U.S. companies that source material and goods from China and those that make large amounts of sales in China would be particularly vulnerable to an escalation of trade tensions. Uncertainty regarding the outcome of the trade tensions
and the potential for a trade war could cause the U.S. dollar to decline against safe haven currencies, such as the Japanese yen and the euro. Events such as these and their consequences are difficult to predict and it is unclear whether further
tariffs may be imposed or other escalating actions may be taken in the future.
On January 31, 2020, the United Kingdom (UK) officially
withdrew from the EU (commonly known as Brexit). The UK and EU reached a preliminary trade agreement, which became effective on January 1, 2021, regarding the terms of their future trading relationship relating principally to the
trading of goods rather than services, including financial services; however, negotiations are ongoing for matters not covered by the trade agreement, such as the trade of financial services. Due to uncertainty of the current political environment,
it is not possible to foresee the form or nature of the future trading relationship between the UK and the EU. In the short term, financial markets may experience heightened volatility, particularly those in the UK and Europe, but possibly
worldwide. The UK and Europe may be less stable than they have been in recent years, and investments in the UK and EU may be difficult to value or subject to greater or more frequent volatility. The longer term economic, legal, political and social
framework to be put in place between the UK and the EU remains unclear and the ongoing political and economic uncertainty and periods of exacerbated volatility in both the UK and in wider European markets may continue for some time. In particular,
Brexit may lead to a call for similar referendums in other European jurisdictions which may cause increased economic volatility in the European and global markets and may destabilize some or all of the other EU member countries. This uncertainty may
have an adverse effect on the economy generally and on the ability of the Trust and its investments to execute their respective strategies, to receive attractive returns and/or to exit certain investments at an advantageous time or price. In
particular, currency volatility may mean that the returns of the Trust and its investments are adversely affected by market movements and may make it more difficult, or more expensive, if the Trust elects to execute currency hedges. Potential
decline in the value of the British Pound and/or the Euro against other currencies, along with the potential downgrading of the UKs sovereign credit rating, may also have an impact on the performance of portfolio companies or investments
located in the UK or Europe. In light of the above, no definitive assessment can currently be made regarding the impact that Brexit will have on the Trust, its investments or its organization more generally.
Cybersecurity incidents affecting particular companies or industries may adversely affect the economies of particular countries, regions or parts of the world
in which the Trust invests.
The occurrence of any of these above events could have a significant adverse impact on the value and risk profile of the
Trusts portfolio. The Trust does not know how long the securities markets may be affected by similar events and cannot predict the effects of similar events in the future on the U.S. economy and securities markets. There can be no assurance
that similar events and other market disruptions will not have other material and adverse implications.
Regulation and Government Intervention Risk
Federal, state, and other governments, their regulatory agencies or self-regulatory organizations may take actions that affect the regulation of the
issuers in which the Trust invests in ways that are unforeseeable. Legislation or regulation may also change the way in which the Trust is regulated. Such legislation or regulation could limit or preclude the Trusts ability to achieve its
investment objective.
In light of popular, political and judicial focus on finance related consumer protection, financial institution practices are also
subject to greater scrutiny and criticism generally. In the case of transactions between financial institutions and the general public, there may be a greater tendency toward strict interpretation of terms and legal rights in favor of the consuming
public, particularly where there is a real or perceived disparity in risk allocation and/or where
- 73 -
consumers are perceived as not having had an opportunity to exercise informed consent to the transaction. In the event of conflicting interests between retail investors holding common shares of a
closed-end investment company such as the Trust and a large financial institution, a court may similarly seek to strictly interpret terms and legal rights in favor of retail investors.
The Trust may be affected by governmental action in ways that are not foreseeable, and there is a possibility that such actions could have a significant
adverse effect on the Trust and its ability to achieve its investment objective.
Investment Company Act Regulations
The Trust is a registered closed-end management investment company and as such is subject to regulations under the
Investment Company Act. Generally speaking, any contract or provision thereof that is made, or where performance involves a violation of the Investment Company Act or any rule or regulation thereunder is unenforceable by either party unless a court
finds otherwise.
Regulation as a Commodity Pool
The CFTC subjects advisers to registered investment companies to regulation by the CFTC if a fund that is advised by the investment adviser either
(i) invests, directly or indirectly, more than a prescribed level of its liquidation value in CFTC-regulated futures, options and swaps (CFTC Derivatives), or (ii) markets itself as providing investment exposure to such
instruments. To the extent the Trust uses CFTC Derivatives, it intends to do so below such prescribed levels and will not market itself as a commodity pool or a vehicle for trading such instruments. Accordingly, the Advisor has claimed
an exclusion from the definition of the term commodity pool operator under the CEA pursuant to Rule 4.5 under the CEA. The Advisor is not, therefore, subject to registration or regulation as a commodity pool operator under
the CEA in respect of the Trust.
Failures of Futures Commission Merchants and Clearing Organizations Risk
The Trust is required to deposit funds to margin open positions in cleared derivative instruments (both futures and swaps) with a clearing broker
registered as a futures commission merchant (FCM). The CEA requires an FCM to segregate all funds received from customers with respect to any orders for the purchase or sale of U.S. domestic futures contracts and cleared
swaps from the FCMs proprietary assets. Similarly, the CEA requires each FCM to hold in a separate secure account all funds received from customers with respect to any orders for the purchase or sale of foreign futures contracts and
segregate any such funds from the funds received with respect to domestic futures contracts. However, all funds and other property received by an FCM from its customers are held by an FCM on a commingled basis in an omnibus account and amounts in
excess of assets posted to the clearing organization may be invested by an FCM in certain instruments permitted under the applicable regulation. There is a risk that assets deposited by the Trust with any FCM as margin for futures contracts or
commodity options may, in certain circumstances, be used to satisfy losses of other clients of the Trusts FCM. In addition, the assets of the Trust posted as margin against both swaps and futures contracts may not be fully protected in the
event of the FCMs bankruptcy.
Legal, Tax and Regulatory Risks
Legal, tax and regulatory changes could occur that may have material adverse effects on the Trust.
To qualify for the favorable U.S. federal income tax treatment generally accorded to RICs, the Trust must, among other things, derive in each taxable year at
least 90% of its gross income from certain prescribed sources and distribute for each taxable year at least 90% of its investment company taxable income (generally, ordinary income plus the excess, if any, of net short-term capital gain
over net long-term capital loss). If for any taxable year the Trust does not qualify as a RIC, all of its taxable income for that year (including its net capital gain) would be subject to tax at regular corporate rates without any deduction for
distributions to shareholders, and such
- 74 -
distributions would be taxable as ordinary dividends to the extent of the Trusts current and accumulated earnings and profits.
The current presidential administration has called for significant changes to U.S. fiscal, tax, trade, healthcare, immigration, foreign, and government
regulatory policy. In this regard, there is significant uncertainty with respect to legislation, regulation and government policy at the federal level, as well as the state and local levels. Recent events have created a climate of heightened
uncertainty and introduced new and difficult-to-quantify macroeconomic and political risks with potentially far-reaching
implications. There has been a corresponding meaningful increase in the uncertainty surrounding interest rates, inflation, foreign exchange rates, trade volumes and fiscal and monetary policy. To the extent the U.S. Congress or the current
presidential administration implements changes to U.S. policy, those changes may impact, among other things, the U.S. and global economy, international trade and relations, unemployment, immigration, corporate taxes, healthcare, the U.S. regulatory
environment, inflation and other areas. Although the Trust cannot predict the impact, if any, of these changes to the Trusts business, they could adversely affect the Trusts business, financial condition, operating results and cash
flows. Until the Trust knows what policy changes are made and how those changes impact the Trusts business and the business of the Trusts competitors over the long term, the Trust will not know if, overall, the Trust will benefit from
them or be negatively affected by them.
The rules dealing with U.S. federal income taxation are constantly under review by persons involved in the
legislative process and by the Internal Revenue Service and the U.S. Treasury Department. Revisions in U.S. federal tax laws and interpretations of these laws could adversely affect the tax consequences of your investment.
Potential Conflicts of Interest of the Advisor, the Sub-Advisors and Others
The investment activities of the Advisor, the Sub-Advisors and their affiliates (including BlackRock, Inc. and its
subsidiaries (collectively, the Affiliates)), and their respective directors, officers or employees, in managing their own accounts and other accounts, may present conflicts of interest that could disadvantage the Trust and its
shareholders. The Advisor and its Affiliates may engage in proprietary trading and advise accounts and other funds that have investment objectives similar to those of the Trust and/or that engage in and compete for transactions in the same or
similar types of securities, currencies and other assets as are held by the Trust. Subject to the requirements of the Investment Company Act, the Advisor and its Affiliates intend to engage in such activities and may receive compensation from third
parties for their services. Neither the Advisor nor any Affiliate is under any obligation to share any investment opportunity, idea or strategy with the Trust. As a result, an Affiliate may compete with the Trust for appropriate investment
opportunities. The results of the Trusts investment activities, therefore, may differ from those of an Affiliate and of other accounts managed by an Affiliate. It is possible that the Trust could sustain losses during periods in which one or
more Affiliates and other accounts achieve profits on their trading for proprietary or other accounts. The opposite result is also possible. The Advisor has adopted policies and procedures designed to address potential conflicts of interest. For
additional information about potential conflicts of interest and the way in which BlackRock addresses such conflicts, please see Conflicts of Interest and Management of the TrustPortfolio ManagementPotential Material
Conflicts of Interest in the SAI.
Defensive Investing Risk
For defensive purposes, the Trust may allocate assets into cash or short-term fixed-income securities without limitation. In doing so, the Trust may succeed
in avoiding losses but may otherwise fail to achieve its investment objective. Further, the value of short-term fixed-income securities may be affected by changing interest rates and by changes in credit ratings of the investments. If the Trust
holds cash uninvested it will be subject to the credit risk of the depository institution holding the cash.
Decision-Making Authority Risk
Investors have no authority to make decisions or to exercise business discretion on behalf of the Trust, except as set forth in the Trusts governing
documents. The authority for all such decisions is generally delegated to the Board, which in turn, has delegated the day-to-day management of the Trusts
investment activities to the Advisors, subject to oversight by the Board.
- 75 -
Management Risk
The Trust is subject to management risk because it is an actively managed investment portfolio. The Advisors and the individual portfolio managers will apply
investment techniques and risk analyses in making investment decisions for the Trust, but there can be no guarantee that these will produce the desired results. The Trust may be subject to a relatively high level of management risk because the Trust
may invest in derivative instruments, which may be highly specialized instruments that require investment techniques and risk analyses different from those associated with equities and bonds.
Valuation Risk
The Trust is subject to valuation risk,
which is the risk that one or more of the securities in which the Trust invests are valued at prices that the Trust is unable to obtain upon sale due to factors such as incomplete data, market instability or human error. The Advisor may use an
independent pricing service or prices provided by dealers to value securities at their market value. Because the secondary markets for certain investments may be limited, such instruments may be difficult to value. See Net Asset Value.
When market quotations are not available, the Advisor may price such investments pursuant to a number of methodologies, such as computer-based analytical modeling or individual security evaluations. These methodologies generate approximations of
market values, and there may be significant professional disagreement about the best methodology for a particular type of financial instrument or different methodologies that might be used under different circumstances. In the absence of an actual
market transaction, reliance on such methodologies is essential, but may introduce significant variances in the ultimate valuation of the Trusts investments. Technological issues and/or errors by pricing services or other third-party service
providers may also impact the Trusts ability to value its investments and the calculation of the Trusts NAV.
When market quotations are not
readily available or are believed by the Advisor to be unreliable, the Advisor will fair value the Trusts investments in accordance with its policies and procedures. Fair value represents a good faith approximation of the value of an asset or
liability. The fair value of an asset or liability held by the Trust is the amount the Trust might reasonably expect to receive from the current sale of that asset or the cost to extinguish that liability in an arms length transaction. Fair
value pricing may require determinations that are inherently subjective and inexact about the value of a security or other asset. As a result, there can be no assurance that fair value priced assets will not result in future adjustments to the
prices of securities or other assets, or that fair value pricing will reflect a price that the Trust is able to obtain upon sale, and it is possible that the fair value determined for a security or other asset will be materially different from
quoted or published prices, from the prices used by others for the same security or other asset and/or from the value that actually could be or is realized upon the sale of that security or other asset. For example, the Trusts NAV could be
adversely affected if the Trusts determinations regarding the fair value of the Trusts investments were materially higher than the values that the Trust ultimately realizes upon the disposal of such investments. Where market quotations
are not readily available, valuation may require more research than for more liquid investments. In addition, elements of judgment may play a greater role in valuation in such cases than for investments with a more active secondary market because
there is less reliable objective data available.
Because of overall size, duration and maturities of positions held by the Trust, the value at which its
investments can be liquidated may differ, sometimes significantly, from the interim valuations obtained by the Trust. In addition, the timing of liquidations may also affect the values obtained on liquidation. Securities held by the Trust may
routinely trade with bid-offer spreads that may be significant. There can be no guarantee that the Trusts investments could ultimately be realized at the Trusts valuation of such investments. In
addition, the Trusts compliance with the asset diversification tests applicable to regulated investment companies depends on the fair market values of the Trusts assets, and, accordingly, a challenge to the valuations ascribed by the
Trust could affect its ability to comply with those tests or require it to pay penalty taxes in order to cure a violation thereof.
The Trusts NAV
per common share is a critical component in several operational matters including computation of advisory and services fees. Consequently, variance in the valuation of the Trusts investments will impact, positively or negatively, the fees and
expenses shareholders will pay.
- 76 -
Reliance on the Advisor and Sub-Advisors Risk
The Trust is dependent upon services and resources provided by the Advisors, and therefore the Advisors parent, BlackRock. The Advisors are not required
to devote their full time to the business of the Trust and there is no guarantee or requirement that any investment professional or other employee of the Advisors will allocate a substantial portion of his or her time to the Trust. The loss of one
or more individuals involved with the Advisors could have a material adverse effect on the performance or the continued operation of the Trust. For additional information on the Advisors and BlackRock, see Management of the
TrustInvestment Advisor and Sub-Advisors.
Reliance on Service Providers Risk
The Trust must rely upon the performance of service providers to perform certain functions, which may include functions that are integral to the Trusts
operations and financial performance. Failure by any service provider to carry out its obligations to the Trust in accordance with the terms of its appointment, to exercise due care and skill or to perform its obligations to the Trust at all as a
result of insolvency, bankruptcy or other causes could have a material adverse effect on the Trusts performance and returns to shareholders. The termination of the Trusts relationship with any service provider, or any delay in
appointing a replacement for such service provider, could materially disrupt the business of the Trust and could have a material adverse effect on the Trusts performance and returns to shareholders.
Information Technology Systems Risk
The Trust is
dependent on the Advisors for certain management services as well as back-office functions. The Advisors depend on information technology systems in order to assess investment opportunities, strategies and markets and to monitor and control
risks for the Trust. It is possible that a failure of some kind which causes disruptions to these information technology systems could materially limit the Advisors ability to adequately assess and adjust investments, formulate strategies
and provide adequate risk control. Any such information technology-related difficulty could harm the performance of the Trust. Further, failure of the back-office functions of the Advisors to process trades in a timely fashion could
prejudice the investment performance of the Trust.
Operational Risk
The Trust is exposed to operational risks arising from a number of factors, including, but not limited to, human errors, processing and communication errors,
errors of the Trusts service providers, counterparties or other third parties, failed or inadequate internal or external processes, and technology or systems failures. The use of certain investment strategies that involve manual or additional
processing, such as over-the-counter derivatives, increases these risks. While service providers are required to have appropriate operational risk management policies
and procedures, their methods of operational risk management may differ from those of the Trust in the setting of priorities, the personnel and resources available or the effectiveness of relevant controls. The Trust and the Advisor seek to reduce
these operational risks through controls, procedures and oversight. However, it is not possible to identify all of the operational risks that may affect the Trust or to develop processes and controls that completely eliminate or mitigate the
occurrence or effects of such failures. The Trust, including its performance and continued operation, and its shareholders could be negatively impacted as a result.
Cyber Security Risk
With the increased use of
technologies such as the Internet to conduct business, the Trust is susceptible to operational, information security and related risks. In general, cyber incidents can result from deliberate attacks or unintentional events. Cyber-attacks include,
but are not limited to, gaining unauthorized access to digital systems (e.g., through hacking or malicious software coding) for purposes of misappropriating assets or sensitive information, corrupting data, or causing operational
disruption. Cyber-attacks may also be carried out in a manner that does not require gaining unauthorized access, such as causing denial-of-service attacks on websites
(i.e., efforts to make network services unavailable to intended users). Cyber security failures by or breaches of the Advisors and other service providers (including, but not limited to, fund accountants, custodians, transfer agents and
administrators), and the issuers of securities in which the Trust invests, have the ability to cause disruptions and
- 77 -
impact business operations, potentially resulting in financial losses, interference with the Trusts ability to calculate its NAV, impediments to trading, the inability of shareholders to
transact business, violations of applicable privacy and other laws, regulatory fines, penalties, reputational damage, reimbursement or other compensation costs, or additional compliance costs. In addition, substantial costs may be incurred in order
to prevent any cyber incidents in the future. While the Trust has established business continuity plans in the event of, and risk management systems to prevent, such cyber-attacks, there are inherent limitations in such plans and systems including
the possibility that certain risks have not been identified. Furthermore, the Trust cannot control the cyber security plans and systems put in place by service providers to the Trust and issuers in which the Trust invests. As a result, the Trust or
its shareholders could be negatively impacted.
Misconduct of Employees and of Service Providers Risk
Misconduct or misrepresentations by employees of the Advisors or the Trusts service providers could cause significant losses to the Trust. Employee
misconduct may include binding the Trust to transactions that exceed authorized limits or present unacceptable risks and unauthorized trading activities, concealing unsuccessful trading activities (which, in any case, may result in unknown and
unmanaged risks or losses) or making misrepresentations regarding any of the foregoing. Losses could also result from actions by the Trusts service providers, including, without limitation, failing to recognize trades and misappropriating
assets. In addition, employees and service providers may improperly use or disclose confidential information, which could result in litigation or serious financial harm, including limiting the Trusts business prospects or future marketing
activities. Despite the Advisors due diligence efforts, misconduct and intentional misrepresentations may be undetected or not fully comprehended, thereby potentially undermining the Advisors due diligence efforts. As a result,
no assurances can be given that the due diligence performed by the Advisors will identify or prevent any such misconduct.
Special Risks for Holders of
Rights
There is a risk that performance of the Trust may result in the common shares purchasable upon exercise of the rights being less attractive to
investors at the conclusion of the subscription period. This may reduce or eliminate the value of the rights. Investors who receive rights may find that there is no market to sell rights they do not wish to exercise. If investors exercise only a
portion of the rights, common shares may trade at less favorable prices than larger offerings for similar securities.
Portfolio Turnover Risk
The Trusts annual portfolio turnover rate may vary greatly from year to year, as well as within a given year. Portfolio turnover rate is not considered
a limiting factor in the execution of investment decisions for the Trust. A higher portfolio turnover rate results in correspondingly greater brokerage commissions and other transactional expenses that are borne by the Trust. High portfolio turnover
may result in an increased realization of net short-term capital gains by the Trust which, when distributed to common shareholders, will be taxable as ordinary income. Additionally, in a declining market, portfolio turnover may create realized
capital losses.
Anti-Takeover Provisions Risk
The
Trusts Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws include provisions that could limit the ability of other entities or persons to acquire control of the Trust or convert the Trust to open-end status
or to change the composition of the Board. Such provisions could limit the ability of shareholders to sell their shares at a premium over prevailing market prices by discouraging a third party from seeking to obtain control of the Trust. See
Certain Provisions in the Agreement and Declaration of Trust and Bylaws.
- 78 -
HOW THE TRUST MANAGES RISK
Investment Limitations
The Trust has adopted certain
investment limitations designed to limit investment risk. Some of these limitations are fundamental and thus may not be changed without the approval of the holders of a majority of the outstanding common shares. See Investment Objective and
PoliciesInvestment Restrictions in the SAI.
The restrictions and other limitations set forth throughout this Prospectus and in the SAI apply
only at the time of purchase of securities and will not be considered violated unless an excess or deficiency occurs or exists immediately after and as a result of the acquisition of securities.
Management of Investment Portfolio and Capital Structure to Limit Leverage Risk
The Trust may take certain actions if short-term interest rates increase or market conditions otherwise change (or the Trust anticipates such an increase or
change) and any leverage the Trust may have outstanding begins (or is expected) to adversely affect common shareholders. In order to attempt to offset such a negative impact of any outstanding leverage on common shareholders, the Trust may shorten
the average maturity of its investment portfolio (by investing in short-term securities) or may reduce any indebtedness that it may have incurred. The success of any such attempt to limit leverage risk depends on the Advisors ability to
accurately predict interest rate or other market changes. Because of the difficulty of making such predictions, the Trust may never attempt to manage its capital structure in the manner described in this paragraph.
If market conditions suggest that employing additional leverage would be beneficial, the Trust may enter into one or more credit facilities, issue preferred
shares or engage in additional leverage transactions, subject to the restrictions of the Investment Company Act.
Strategic Transactions
The Trust may use certain Strategic Transactions designed to limit the risk of price fluctuations of securities and to preserve capital. These Strategic
Transactions include using swaps, financial futures contracts, options on financial futures or options based on either an index of long-term securities, or on securities whose prices, in the opinion of the Advisors, correlate with the prices of the
Trusts investments. There can be no assurance that Strategic Transactions will be used or used effectively to limit risk, and Strategic Transactions may be subject to their own risks.
MANAGEMENT OF THE TRUST
Trustees and Officers
The Board is responsible for the
overall management of the Trust, including supervision of the duties performed by the Advisors. There are ten Trustees. A majority of the Trustees are Independent Trustees of the Trust. The name and business address of the Trustees and officers of
the Trust and their principal occupations and other affiliations during the past five years are set forth under Management of the Trust in the SAI.
Investment Advisor and Sub-Advisors
The Advisor is responsible for the management of the Trusts portfolio and provides the necessary personnel, facilities, equipment and certain other
services necessary to the operation of the Trust. BlackRock International Limited and BlackRock (Singapore) Limited serve as the Trusts sub-advisors and perform certain of the day-to-day investment management of the Trust. The Advisor, located at 100 Bellevue Parkway, Wilmington, Delaware 19809, BlackRock International Limited, located at Exchange
Place One, 1 Semple Street, Edinburgh, EH3 8BL, United Kingdom, and BlackRock (Singapore) Limited, located at 20 Anson Road #18-01, 079912 Singapore, are wholly-owned subsidiaries of BlackRock.
- 79 -
BlackRock is one of the worlds largest publicly-traded investment management firms. As of December 31,
2024, BlackRocks assets under management were approximately $11.6 trillion. BlackRock has over 30 years of experience managing closed-end products and, as of December 31, 2024, advised a registered closed-end family of 51 active exchange-traded funds with approximately $45 billion in managed assets.
BlackRock
is independent in ownership and governance, with no single majority shareholder and a majority of independent directors.
Investment Philosophy
BlackRocks investment decision-making process for the municipal security sector is subject to the same discipline, oversight and investment
philosophy that the firm applies to other sectors of the fixed-income market.
BlackRock uses a relative value strategy that evaluates the trade-off between risk and return to seek to achieve the Trusts investment objective. This strategy is combined with disciplined risk control techniques and applied in sector,
sub-sector and individual security selection decisions. BlackRocks extensive personnel and technology resources are the key drivers of the investment philosophy.
Portfolio Managers
The members of the portfolio
management team who are primarily responsible for the day-to-day management of the Trusts portfolio are as follows:
Mitchell S. Garfin, CFA, Managing Director, is Co-Head of US Leveraged Finance within BlackRocks
Fundamental Fixed Income Platform. He is responsible for managing high yield strategies and also has oversight responsibility for the platforms leveraged loan strategies.
Mr. Garfins tenure with the firm dates back to 1997 when he joined as an Analyst. He spent three years in the Account Management Group where he
maintained responsibility for developing and maintaining relationships with the firms taxable financial institution clients. In 2000, Mr. Garfin moved to the investment side of the business where he initially spent four years as an
investment grade credit research analyst. Here, he was responsible for providing investment recommendations on companies in the metals & mining, paper & packaging, utilities and energy sectors. In 2005, Mr. Garfin transitioned
to a portfolio management role with the investment grade credit team where he was responsible for sector positioning and trading within the commodities and basic materials sectors. Since 2007, Mr. Garfin has been a portfolio manager with the
high yield credit team, and he assumed his current, senior responsibilities in 2014.
Mr. Garfin earned a bachelors degree, with distinction,
in Finance from the University of Michigan in 1997 and an MBA degree in Finance and Economics from New York University in 2005.
Scott MacLellan, CFA,
CMT, Managing Director of BlackRock, is a portfolio manager in BlackRocks Fundamental Fixed Income Group. He is the co-lead portfolio manager of BlackRocks Low Duration Bond Fund, BGF USD Short
Duration Bond Fund and the iShares Short Maturity Bond ETF (NEAR), associated separately managed accounts, and certain closed-end funds. Prior to assuming his current responsibilities in 2008,
Mr. MacLellan was a member of the Global Client Group, covering clients in Asia and the Middle East. Previously, Mr. MacLellan spent four years with Nomura BlackRock Asset Management (NBAM), a former joint venture between BlackRock and
Nomura Asset Management Co., Ltd, in Tokyo as an account manager. Prior to joining NBAM in 2001, Mr. MacLellan spent a year in the Global Finance and Investment Department of IBJ Leasing in Tokyo. Mr. MacLellan earned a BA degree, with
honors, in economics and international development studies from Kings College in 1997.
David Delbos, Managing Director, is Co-Head of US Leveraged Finance within BlackRocks Fundamental Fixed Income Platform. He is responsible for managing high yield strategies and also has oversight responsibility for the platforms leveraged
loan strategies.
Mr. Delbos tenure with the firm dates back to 2002. He spent ten years as a credit research analyst in the US Leveraged
Finance group where he was responsible for providing investment recommendations on companies in the
- 80 -
consumer cyclicals, retail, industrials, services and packaging sectors. In 2012, Mr. Delbos transitioned to a relative value portfolio management role, also within the US Leveraged Finance
group, where he looked across all industries. Additionally, Mr. Delbos worked alongside BlackRock Global Credits Chief Investment Officer in managing the liquid credit sleeves of several BlackRock-managed hedge funds. He assumed his
current, senior responsibilities in 2014. Mr. Delbos began his career in 2000 as an analyst in the mergers & acquisitions investment banking division of Deutsche Bank Securities Inc.
Mr. Delbos earned a bachelors degree in History from Tufts University in 2000.
Akiva Dickstein, Managing Director, is head of Customized Multi-Sector, US Short Duration and co-head of Global
Inflation Linked Portfolios within BlackRocks Fundamental Fixed Income group, and a member of the Global Fixed Income executive team. He is also a portfolio manager of closed-end funds, BlackRocks
Core Bond, Low Duration Bond and BGF USD Short Duration Bond Funds and associated separate accounts. Prior to taking on his current responsibilities, Mr. Dickstein was the lead portfolio manager on BlackRocks mortgage portfolios. Before
joining BlackRock in 2009, Mr. Dickstein spent eight years at Merrill Lynch, where he served as Managing Director and head of the U.S. Rates & Structured Credit Research Group. He was responsible for the team that produced MBS, ABS,
CMBS, Treasuries, swaps, and interest rate derivatives research. Mr. Dicksteins publications on MBS strategy included the weekly Mortgage Investor as well as numerous lengthier articles on topics such as optimal loan modifications, the
valuation of credit-sensitive MBS and ABS, and the pricing of mortgage derivatives, options, and pass-throughs. In addition, he developed Merrills prepayment models for fixed rate and hybrid MBS. From 1993 to 2001, Mr. Dickstein was with
Lehman Brothers, most recently as a Senior Vice President in Mortgage Derivatives Trading. In this role, he traded mortgage derivatives and developed Lehmans credit default model. He joined Lehman as a mortgage and asset-backed securities
analyst and was named to Institutional Investors All American Fixed Income Research Team in pass-throughs, non-agency mortgages, and asset-backed securities. He earned a BA degree in economics, summa cum
laude, from Yale University in 1990, and an MA degree in physics from Princeton University in 1993.
The SAI provides additional information about other
accounts managed by the portfolio management team, the compensation of each portfolio manager and the ownership of the Trusts securities by each portfolio manager.
Investment Management Agreements
Pursuant to an
investment management agreement between the Advisor and the Trust (the Investment Management Agreement), the Trust has agreed to pay the Advisor a monthly management fee at an annual rate equal to 0.55% of the average weekly value of the
Trusts Managed Assets. Managed Assets means the total assets of the Trust (including any assets attributable to money borrowed for investment purposes) minus the sum of the Trusts accrued liabilities (other than money
borrowed for investment purposes).
The Advisor, and not the Trust, pays an annual sub-advisory fee to the Sub-Advisors. For that portion of the Trust for which each Sub-Advisor acts as sub-advisor, the
Advisor will pay to such Sub-Advisor, an annual sub-advisory fee equal to a percentage of the management fee received by the Advisor from the Trust with
respect to the average daily value of the Managed Assets of the Trust allocated to such Sub-Advisor.
A
discussion regarding the basis for the approval of the Investment Management Agreement and the sub-advisory agreements between the Advisor and each Sub-Advisor is
available in the Trusts semi-annual report to shareholders for the period ended June 30, 2024.
Except as otherwise described in this
Prospectus, the Trust pays, in addition to the fees paid to the Advisor, all other costs and expenses of its operations, including compensation of its Trustees (other than those affiliated with the Advisor), custodian, leveraging expenses, transfer
and dividend disbursing agent expenses, legal fees, rating agency fees, listing fees and expenses, expenses of independent auditors, expenses of repurchasing shares, expenses of preparing, printing and distributing shareholder reports, notices,
proxy statements and reports to governmental agencies and taxes, if any.
- 81 -
The Trust and the Advisor have entered into the Fee Waiver Agreement, pursuant to which the Advisor has
contractually agreed to waive the management fee with respect to any portion of the Trusts assets attributable to investments in any equity and fixed-income mutual funds and ETFs managed by the Advisor or its affiliates that have a contractual
management fee, through June 30, 2026. In addition, pursuant to the Fee Waiver Agreement, the Advisor has contractually agreed to waive its management fees by the amount of investment advisory fees the Trust pays to the Advisor indirectly
through its investment in money market funds advised by the Advisor or its affiliates, through June 30, 2026. The Fee Waiver Agreement may be continued from year to year thereafter, provided that such continuance is specifically approved by the
Advisor and the Trust (including by a majority of the Trusts Independent Trustees). Neither the Advisor nor the Trust is obligated to extend the Fee Waiver Agreement. The Fee Waiver Agreement may be terminated at any time, without the payment
of any penalty, only by the Trust (upon the vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees or a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Trust), upon 90 days written notice by the Trust to the Advisor.
Administration and Accounting Services
State Street
Bank and Trust Company provides certain administration and accounting services to the Trust pursuant to an Administration and Fund Accounting Services Agreement (the Administration Agreement). Pursuant to the Administration Agreement,
State Street Bank and Trust Company provides the Trust with, among other things, customary fund accounting services, including computing the Trusts NAV and maintaining books, records and other documents relating to the Trusts financial
and portfolio transactions, and customary fund administration services, including assisting the Trust with regulatory filings, tax compliance and other oversight activities. For these and other services it provides to the Trust, State Street Bank
and Trust Company is paid a monthly fee from the Trust at an annual rate ranging from 0.0075% to 0.015% of the Trusts Managed Assets, along with an annual fixed fee ranging from $3,000 to $10,000 for the services it provides to the Trust.
Custodian and Transfer Agent
The custodian of the
assets of the Trust is State Street Bank and Trust Company, whose principal business address is One Congress Street, Suite 1, Boston, Massachusetts 02114-2016. The custodian is responsible for, among other things, receipt of and disbursement of
funds from the Trusts accounts, establishment of segregated accounts as necessary, and transfer, exchange and delivery of Trust portfolio securities.
Computershare Trust Company, N.A., whose principal business address is 150 Royall Street, Canton, Massachusetts 02021, serves as the Trusts transfer
agent with respect to the common shares.
Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
[ ], whose principal business address is [ ], is the independent registered public accounting firm of the Trust and is expected to
render an opinion annually on the financial statements of the Trust.
NET ASSET VALUE
The NAV of the Trusts common shares will be computed based upon the value of the Trusts portfolio securities and other assets. NAV per common
share will be determined as of the close of the regular trading session on the NYSE on each business day on which the NYSE is open for trading. The Trust calculates NAV per common share by subtracting the Trusts liabilities (including accrued
expenses, dividends payable and any borrowings of the Trust), and the liquidation value of any outstanding preferred shares of the Trust from the Trusts total assets (the value of the securities the Trust holds plus cash or other assets,
including interest accrued but not yet received) and dividing the result by the total number of common shares of the Trust outstanding.
Valuation of
securities held by the Trust is as follows:
Equity Investments. Equity securities traded on a recognized securities exchange (e.g., NYSE), on
separate trading boards of a securities exchange or through a market system that provides contemporaneous transaction pricing information (each, an Exchange) are valued using information obtained via independent pricing services
generally
- 82 -
at the Exchange closing price or if an Exchange closing price is not available, the last traded price on that Exchange prior to the time as of which the assets or liabilities are valued. However,
under certain circumstances, other means of determining current market value may be used. If an equity security is traded on more than one Exchange, the current market value of the security where it is primarily traded generally will be used. In the
event that there are no sales involving an equity security held by the Trust on a day on which the Trust values such security, the last bid (long positions) or ask (short positions) price, if available, will be used as the value of such security. If
the Trust holds both long and short positions in the same security, the last bid price will be applied to securities held long and the last ask price will be applied to securities sold short. If no bid or ask price is available on a day on which the
Trust values such security, the prior days price will be used, unless the Advisor determines that such prior days price no longer reflects the fair value of the security, in which case such asset would be treated as a Fair Value Asset
(as defined below).
Fixed-Income Investments. Fixed-income securities for which market quotations are readily available are generally valued using
such securities current market value. The Trust values fixed-income portfolio securities using the last available bid prices or current market quotations provided by dealers or prices (including evaluated prices) supplied by the Trusts
approved independent third-party pricing services, each in accordance with the Advisors policies and procedures (the Valuation Procedures). The pricing services may use matrix pricing or valuation models that utilize certain inputs
and assumptions to derive values, including transaction data (e.g., recent representative bids and offers), credit quality information, perceived market movements, news, and other relevant information and by other methods, which may include
consideration of: yields or prices of securities of comparable quality, coupon, maturity and type; indications as to values from dealers; general market conditions; and/or other factors and assumptions. Pricing services generally value fixed-income
securities assuming orderly transactions of an institutional round lot size, but the Trust may hold or transact in such securities in smaller, odd lot sizes. Odd lots may trade at lower prices than institutional round lots. The amortized cost method
of valuation may be used with respect to debt obligations with 60 days or less remaining to maturity unless such method does not represent fair value. Certain fixed-income investments, including asset-backed and mortgage related securities, may be
valued based on valuation models that consider the estimated cash flows of each tranche of the issuer, establish a benchmark yield and develop an estimated tranche specific spread to the benchmark yield based on the unique attributes of the tranche.
Options, Futures, Swaps and Other Derivatives. Exchange-traded equity options for which market quotations are readily available are valued at the
mean of the last bid and ask prices as quoted on the exchange or the board of trade on which such options are traded. In the event that there is no mean price available for an exchange traded equity option held by the Trust on a day on which the
Trust values such option, the last bid (long positions) or ask (short positions) price, if available, will be used as the value of such option. If no bid or ask price is available on a day on which the Trust values such option, the prior days
price will be used, unless the Advisor determines that such prior days price no longer reflects the fair value of the option, in which case such option will be treated as a fair value asset. OTC derivatives may be valued using a mathematical
model which may incorporate a number of market data factors. Financial futures contracts and options thereon, which are traded on exchanges, are valued at their last sale price or settle price as of the close of such exchanges. Swap agreements and
other derivatives are generally valued daily based upon quotations from market makers or by a pricing service in accordance with the Valuation Procedures.
Underlying Funds. Shares of underlying open-end funds (including money market funds) are valued at NAV. Shares
of underlying exchange-traded closed-end funds and ETFs will be valued at their most recent closing price.
General Valuation Information. In determining the market value of portfolio investments, the Trust may employ independent third party pricing services,
which may use, without limitation, a matrix or formula method that takes into consideration market indexes, matrices, yield curves and other specified inputs and assumptions. This may result in the assets being valued at a price different from the
price that would have been determined had the matrix or formula method not been used. The price the Trust could receive upon the sale of any particular portfolio investment may differ from the Trusts valuation of the investment, particularly
for assets that trade in thin or volatile markets or that are valued using a fair valuation methodology or a price provided by an independent pricing service. As a result, the price received upon the sale of an investment may be less than the value
ascribed by the Trust, and the Trust could realize a greater than expected loss or lesser than expected gain upon the sale of the
- 83 -
investment. The Trusts ability to value its investments may also be impacted by technological issues and/or errors by pricing services or other third party service providers.
All cash, receivables and current payables are carried on the Trusts books at their fair value.
Prices obtained from independent third party pricing services, broker-dealers or market makers to value the Trusts securities and other assets and
liabilities are based on information available at the time the Trust values its assets and liabilities. In the event that a pricing service quotation is revised or updated subsequent to the day on which the Trust valued such security, the revised
pricing service quotation generally will be applied prospectively. Such determination will be made considering pertinent facts and circumstances surrounding the revision.
In the event that application of the methods of valuation discussed above result in a price for a security which is deemed not to be representative of the
fair market value of such security, the security will be valued by, under the direction of or in accordance with a method approved by the Advisor, the Trusts valuation designee, as reflecting fair value. All other assets and liabilities
(including securities for which market quotations are not readily available) held by the Trust (including restricted securities) are valued at fair value as determined in good faith by the Advisor pursuant to the Valuation Procedures. Any assets and
liabilities which are denominated in a foreign currency are translated into U.S. dollars at the prevailing market rates.
Certain of the securities
acquired by the Trust may be traded on foreign exchanges or OTC markets on days on which the Trusts NAV is not calculated. In such cases, the NAV of the Trusts common shares may be significantly affected on days when investors can
neither purchase nor sell shares of the Trust.
Fair Value. When market quotations are not readily available or are believed by the Advisor to be
unreliable, the Trusts investments are valued at fair value (Fair Value Assets). Fair Value Assets are valued by the Advisor in accordance with the Valuation Procedures. Pursuant to Rule 2a-5
under the Investment Company Act, the Board of Trustees has designated the Advisor as the valuation designee for the Trust. The Advisor may reasonably conclude that a market quotation is not readily available or is unreliable if, among other things,
a security or other asset or liability does not have a price source due to its complete lack of trading, if the Advisor believes a market quotation from a broker-dealer or other source is unreliable (e.g., where it varies significantly from a recent
trade, or no longer reflects the fair value of the security or other asset or liability subsequent to the most recent market quotation), or where the security or other asset or liability is only thinly traded or due to the occurrence of a
significant event subsequent to the most recent market quotation. For this purpose, a significant event is deemed to occur if the Advisor determines, in its reasonable business judgment, that an event that has occurred after the close of
trading for an asset or liability but prior to or at the time of pricing the Trusts assets or liabilities, is likely to cause a material change to the last exchange closing price or closing market price of one or more assets or liabilities
held by the Trust. On any day the NYSE is open and a foreign market or the primary exchange on which a foreign asset or liability is traded is closed, such asset or liability will be valued using the prior days price, provided that the Advisor
is not aware of any significant event or other information that would cause such price to no longer reflect the fair value of the asset or liability, in which case such asset or liability would be treated as a Fair Value Asset. For certain foreign
assets, a third-party vendor supplies evaluated, systematic fair value pricing based upon the movement of a proprietary multi-factor model after the relevant foreign markets have closed. This systematic fair value pricing methodology is designed to
correlate the prices of foreign assets following the close of the local markets to the price that might have prevailed as of the Trusts pricing time.
The Advisors Rule 2a-5 Committee is responsible for reviewing and approving methodologies by investment type and
significant inputs used in the fair valuation of Trust assets or liabilities. In addition, the Trusts accounting agent assists the Advisor by periodically endeavoring to confirm the prices it receives from all third party pricing services,
index providers and broker-dealers. The Advisor regularly evaluates the values assigned to the securities and other assets and liabilities of the Trust.
When determining the price for a Fair Value Asset, the Advisor will seek to determine the price that the Trust might reasonably expect to receive from the
current sale of that asset or liability in an arms-length transaction on the date on which the asset or liability is being valued, and does not seek to determine the price the Trust might reasonably
expect to receive for selling an asset or liability at a later time or if it holds the asset or liability to maturity. Fair value determinations will be based upon all available factors that the Advisor deems relevant at the time of the
- 84 -
determination, and may be based on analytical values determined by the Advisor using proprietary or third party valuation models.
Fair value represents a good faith approximation of the value of an asset or liability. When determining the fair value of an investment, one or more fair
value methodologies may be used (depending on certain factors, including the asset type). For example, the investment may be initially priced based on the original cost of the investment or, alternatively, using proprietary or third-party models
that may rely upon one or more unobservable inputs. Prices of actual, executed or historical transactions in the relevant investment (or comparable instruments) or, where appropriate, an appraisal by a third-party experienced in the valuation of
similar instruments, may also be used as a basis for establishing the fair value of an investment.
The fair value of one or more assets or liabilities
may not, in retrospect, be the price at which those assets or liabilities could have been sold during the period in which the particular fair values were used in determining the Trusts NAV. As a result, the Trusts sale or repurchase of
its shares at NAV, at a time when a holding or holdings are valued at fair value, may have the effect of diluting or increasing the economic interest of existing shareholders.
The Trusts annual audited financial statements, which are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of
America (US GAAP), follow the requirements for valuation set forth in Financial Accounting Standards Board Accounting Standards Codification Topic 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures (ASC 820), which
defines and establishes a framework for measuring fair value under US GAAP and expands financial statement disclosure requirements relating to fair value measurements.
Generally, ASC 820 and other accounting rules applicable to funds and various assets in which they invest are evolving. Such changes may adversely affect the
Trust. For example, the evolution of rules governing the determination of the fair market value of assets or liabilities, to the extent such rules become more stringent, would tend to increase the cost and/or reduce the availability of third-party
determinations of fair market value. This may in turn increase the costs associated with selling assets or affect their liquidity due to the Trusts inability to obtain a third-party determination of fair market value.
DISTRIBUTIONS
The Trust intends to make regular monthly cash distributions of all or a portion of its net investment income, including current gains, to common
shareholders. The Trust will pay common shareholders at least annually all or substantially all of its investment company taxable income. The Investment Company Act generally limits the Trust to one capital gain distribution per year, subject to
certain exceptions, including as discussed below in connection with the Distribution Plan.
The Trust has, with the approval of the Board, adopted a
managed distribution plan, consistent with its investment objectives and policies, to support a level distribution of income, capital gains and/or return of capital (the Distribution Plan). Under the Distribution Plan, the Trust will
distribute all available investment income, including current gains, to its shareholders as required by the Code. If sufficient income (inclusive of net investment income and short-term capital gains) is not earned on a monthly basis, the Trust will
distribute long-term capital gains and/or return of capital to shareholders in order to maintain a level distribution. Each monthly distribution to shareholders is expected to be at the fixed amount established by the Board; however, the Trust may
make additional distributions from time to time, including additional capital gain distributions at the end of the taxable year, if required to meet requirements imposed by the Code and/or the Investment Company Act. Shareholders should not draw any
conclusions about the Trusts investment performance from the amount of these distributions or from the terms of the Distribution Plan.
A return of
capital distribution may involve a return of the shareholders original investment. Though not currently taxable, such a distribution may lower a shareholders basis in the Trust, thus potentially subjecting the shareholder to future tax
consequences in connection with the sale of Trust shares, even if sold at a loss to the shareholders original investment. The Trusts total return performance on NAV will be presented in its financial highlights table, which will be
available in the Trusts shareholder reports, every six months. The Board may amend, suspend or terminate the Distribution Plan without prior notice if it deems such actions to be in the best interests of the Trust or its shareholders. The
suspension or termination of the Distribution Plan could have the effect of creating a trading
- 85 -
discount (if the Trusts stock is trading at or above NAV) or widening an existing trading discount. The Trust is subject to risks that could have an adverse impact on its ability to
maintain level distributions. Examples of potential risks include, but are not limited to, economic downturns impacting the markets, decreased market volatility, companies suspending or decreasing corporate dividend distributions and changes in the
Code. Please see Risks for a more complete description of the Trusts risks.
The tax treatment and characterization of the Trusts
distributions may vary significantly from time to time because of the varied nature of the Trusts investments. The ultimate tax characterization of the Trusts distributions made in a fiscal year cannot finally be determined until after
the end of that fiscal year. As a result, there is a possibility that the Trust may make total distributions during a fiscal year in an amount that exceeds the Trusts earnings and profits for U.S. federal income tax purposes. In such
situations, the amount by which the Trusts total distributions exceed earnings and profits would generally be treated as a return of capital reducing the amount of a shareholders tax basis in such shareholders shares, with any
amounts exceeding such basis treated as gain from the sale of shares.
Various factors will affect the level of the Trusts income, including the
asset mix and the Trusts use of hedging. To permit the Trust to maintain a more stable monthly distribution, the Trust may from time to time distribute less than the entire amount of income earned in a particular period. The undistributed
income would be available to supplement future distributions. As a result, the distributions paid by the Trust for any particular monthly period may be more or less than the amount of income actually earned by the Trust during that period.
Undistributed income will add to the Trusts NAV and, correspondingly, distributions from undistributed income will deduct from the Trusts NAV. The Trust intends to distribute any long-term capital gains not distributed under the
Distribution Plan annually.
Under normal market conditions, the Advisor seeks to manage the Trust in a manner such that the Trusts distributions
are reflective of the Trusts current and projected earnings levels. The distribution level of the Trust is subject to change based upon a number of factors, including the current and projected level of the Trusts earnings, and may
fluctuate over time.
The Trust reserves the right to change its distribution policy and the basis for establishing the rate of its monthly distributions
at any time and may do so without prior notice to common shareholders.
Shareholders will automatically have all dividends and distributions reinvested in
common shares of the Trust issued by the Trust or purchased in the open market in accordance with the Trusts dividend reinvestment plan unless an election is made to receive cash. See Dividend Reinvestment Plan.
DIVIDEND REINVESTMENT PLAN
Please refer to the section of the Trusts most recent annual report on Form N-CSR entitled Automatic
Dividend Reinvestment Plan, which is incorporated by reference herein, for a discussion of the Trusts dividend reinvestment plan.
RIGHTS OFFERINGS
The Trust may in the future, and at its discretion, choose to make offerings of rights to its shareholders to purchase common shares. Rights may be issued
independently or together with any other offered security and may or may not be transferable by the person purchasing or receiving the rights. In connection with a rights offering to shareholders, we would distribute certificates or other
documentation (i.e., rights cards distributed in lieu of certificates) evidencing the rights and a Prospectus Supplement to our shareholders as of the record date that we set for determining the shareholders eligible to receive rights in such
rights offering. Any such future rights offering will be made in accordance with the Investment Company Act. Under the laws of Delaware, the Board is authorized to approve rights offerings without obtaining shareholder approval.
The staff of the SEC has interpreted the Investment Company Act as not requiring shareholder approval of a transferable rights offering to purchase common
shares at a price below the then current NAV so long as certain conditions are met, including: (i) a good faith determination by a funds board that such offering would result in a
- 86 -
net benefit to existing shareholders; (ii) the offering fully protects shareholders preemptive rights and does not discriminate among shareholders (except for the possible effect of
not offering fractional rights); (iii) management uses its best efforts to ensure an adequate trading market in the rights for use by shareholders who do not exercise such rights; and (iv) the ratio of a transferable rights offering does not
exceed one new share for each three rights held.
The applicable Prospectus Supplement would describe the following terms of the rights in respect of
which this Prospectus is being delivered:
|
● |
|
the period of time the offering would remain open; |
|
● |
|
the underwriter or distributor, if any, of the rights and any associated underwriting fees or discounts
applicable to purchases of the rights; |
|
● |
|
the title of such rights; |
|
● |
|
the exercise price for such rights (or method of calculation thereof); |
|
● |
|
the number of such rights issued in respect of each share; |
|
● |
|
the number of rights required to purchase a single share; |
|
● |
|
the extent to which such rights are transferable and the market on which they may be traded if they are
transferable; |
|
● |
|
if applicable, a discussion of the material U.S. federal income tax considerations applicable to the issuance or
exercise of such rights; |
|
● |
|
the date on which the right to exercise such rights will commence, and the date on which such right will expire
(subject to any extension); |
|
● |
|
the extent to which such rights include an over-subscription privilege with respect to unsubscribed securities
and the terms of such over-subscription privilege; and |
|
● |
|
termination rights we may have in connection with such rights offering. |
A certain number of rights would entitle the holder of the right(s) to purchase for cash such number of common shares at such exercise price as in each case
is set forth in, or be determinable as set forth in, the Prospectus Supplement relating to the rights offered thereby. Rights would be exercisable at any time up to the close of business on the expiration date for such rights set forth in the
Prospectus Supplement. After the close of business on the expiration date, all unexercised rights would become void. Upon expiration of the rights offering and the receipt of payment and the rights certificate or other appropriate documentation
properly executed and completed and duly executed at the corporate trust office of the rights agent, or any other office indicated in the Prospectus Supplement, the common shares purchased as a result of such exercise will be issued as soon as
practicable. To the extent permissible under applicable law, we may determine to offer any unsubscribed offered securities directly to persons other than shareholders, to or through agents, underwriters or dealers or through a combination of such
methods, as set forth in the applicable Prospectus Supplement.
TAX MATTERS
The following discussion is a brief summary of certain U.S. federal income tax considerations affecting the Trust and the purchase, ownership and disposition
of the Trusts common shares. A more detailed discussion of the tax rules applicable to the Trust and its common shareholders can be found in the SAI that is incorporated by reference into this Prospectus. Except as otherwise noted, this
discussion assumes you are a taxable U.S. holder (as defined below) and that you hold your common shares as capital assets for U.S. federal income tax purposes (generally,
- 87 -
assets held for investment). This discussion is based upon current provisions of the Code, the regulations promulgated thereunder and judicial and administrative authorities, all of which are
subject to change or differing interpretations by the courts or the Internal Revenue Service, possibly with retroactive effect. No attempt is made to present a detailed explanation of all U.S. federal tax concerns affecting the Trust and its common
shareholders. The Trust has not sought and will not seek any ruling from the Internal Revenue Service regarding any matters discussed herein. No assurance can be given that the Internal Revenue Service would not assert, or that a court
would not sustain, a position contrary to those set forth below. This summary does not discuss any aspects of non-U.S., state or local tax. The discussion set forth herein does not constitute tax advice and
potential investors are urged to consult their own tax advisers to determine the specific U.S. federal, state, local and foreign tax consequences to them of investing in the Trust.
In addition, no attempt is made to address tax considerations applicable to an investor with a special tax status, such as without limitation, a financial
institution, REIT, insurance company, regulated investment company, individual retirement account, other tax-exempt organization, dealer in securities or currencies, person holding shares of the Trust as part
of a hedging, integrated, conversion or straddle transaction, trader in securities that has elected the mark-to-market method of accounting for its securities, U.S.
holder (as defined below) whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar, investor with applicable financial statements within the meaning of Section 451(b) of the Code, or non-U.S.
investor. Furthermore, this discussion does not reflect possible application of the alternative minimum tax.
A U.S. holder is a beneficial owner that is
for U.S. federal income tax purposes:
|
● |
|
a citizen or individual resident of the United States (including certain former citizens and
former long-term residents); |
|
● |
|
a corporation or other entity treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes, created or organized
in or under the laws of the United States or any state thereof or the District of Columbia; |
|
● |
|
an estate, the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source; or
|
|
● |
|
a trust with respect to which a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over its
administration and one or more U.S. persons have the authority to control all of its substantial decisions or the trust has made a valid election in effect under applicable Treasury regulations to be treated as a U.S. person for U.S. federal income
tax purposes, whose status as a U.S. person is not overridden by an applicable tax treaty. |
Taxation of the Trust
The Trust has elected to be treated as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code. In order to qualify as a RIC, the Trust must, among other things, satisfy certain
requirements relating to the sources of its income, diversification of its assets, and distribution of its income to its shareholders. First, the Trust must derive at least 90% of its annual gross income from dividends, interest, payments with
respect to securities loans, gains from the sale or other disposition of stock or securities or foreign currencies, or other income (including but not limited to gains from options, futures and forward contracts) derived with respect to its business
of investing in such stock, securities or currencies, or net income derived from interests in qualified publicly traded partnerships (as defined in the Code) (the 90% gross income test). Second, the Trust must diversify its
holdings so that, at the close of each quarter of its taxable year, (i) at least 50% of the value of its total assets consists of cash, cash items, U.S. Government securities, securities of other RICs and other securities, with such other
securities limited in respect of any one issuer to an amount not greater in value than 5% of the value of the Trusts total assets and to not more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer, and (ii) not more than 25% of
the market value of the total assets is invested in the securities (other than U.S. Government securities and securities of other RICs) of any one issuer, any two or more issuers controlled by the Trust and engaged in the same, similar or related
trades or businesses, or any one or more qualified publicly traded partnerships.
- 88 -
As long as the Trust qualifies as a RIC, the Trust will generally not be subject to corporate-level U.S. federal
income tax on income and gains that it distributes each taxable year to its shareholders, provided that in such taxable year it distributes at least 90% of the sum of (i) its net tax-exempt interest
income, if any, and (ii) its investment company taxable income (which includes, among other items, dividends, taxable interest, taxable original issue discount and market discount income, income from securities lending, net
short-term capital gain in excess of net long-term capital loss, and any other taxable income other than net capital gain (as defined below) and is reduced by deductible expenses) determined without regard to the deduction for dividends
paid. The Trust may retain for investment its net capital gain (which consists of the excess of its net long-term capital gain over its net short-term capital loss). However, if the Trust retains any net capital gain or any investment company
taxable income, it will be subject to tax at regular corporate rates on the amount retained.
The Code imposes a 4% nondeductible excise tax on the Trust
to the extent the Trust does not distribute by the end of any calendar year at least the sum of (i) 98% of its ordinary income (not taking into account any capital gain or loss) for the calendar year and (ii) 98.2% of its capital gain in
excess of its capital loss (adjusted for certain ordinary losses) for a one-year period generally ending on October 31 of the calendar year (unless an election is made to use the Trusts fiscal
year). In addition, the minimum amounts that must be distributed in any year to avoid the excise tax will be increased or decreased to reflect any under-distribution or over-distribution, as the case may be, from the previous year. For purposes of
the excise tax, the Trust will be deemed to have distributed any income on which it paid U.S. federal income tax. While the Trust intends to distribute any income and capital gain in the manner necessary to minimize imposition of the 4%
nondeductible excise tax, there can be no assurance that sufficient amounts of the Trusts taxable income and capital gain will be distributed to entirely avoid the imposition of the excise tax. In that event, the Trust will be liable for
the excise tax only on the amount by which it does not meet the foregoing distribution requirement.
If in any taxable year the Trust should fail to
qualify under Subchapter M of the Code for tax treatment as a RIC, the Trust would incur a regular corporate U.S. federal income tax upon all of its taxable income for that year, and all distributions to its shareholders (including distributions of
net capital gain) would be taxable to shareholders as ordinary dividend income for U.S. federal income tax purposes to the extent of the Trusts earnings and profits. Provided that certain holding period and other requirements were met, such
dividends would be eligible (i) to be treated as qualified dividend income in the case of shareholders taxed as individuals and (ii) for the dividends received deduction in the case of corporate shareholders. In addition, to qualify
again to be taxed as a RIC in a subsequent year, the Trust would be required to distribute to shareholders its earnings and profits attributable to non-RIC years. In addition, if the Trust failed to qualify as
a RIC for a period greater than two taxable years, then, in order to qualify as a RIC in a subsequent year, the Trust would be required to elect to recognize and pay tax on any net built-in gain (the excess of
aggregate gain, including items of income, over aggregate loss that would have been realized if the Trust had been liquidated) or, alternatively, be subject to taxation on such built-in gain recognized for a
period of five years.
The remainder of this discussion assumes that the Trust qualifies for taxation as a RIC.
The Trusts Investments. Certain of the Trusts investment practices are subject to special and complex U.S. federal income tax provisions
(including mark-to-market, constructive sale, straddle, wash sale, short sale and other rules) that may, among other things, (i) disallow, suspend or otherwise
limit the allowance of certain losses or deductions, (ii) convert lower taxed long-term capital gains or qualified dividend income into higher taxed short-term capital gains or ordinary income, (iii) convert ordinary loss or a deduction
into capital loss (the deductibility of which is more limited), (iv) cause the Trust to recognize income or gain without a corresponding receipt of cash, (v) adversely affect the time as to when a purchase or sale of stock or securities is
deemed to occur, (vi) adversely alter the characterization of certain complex financial transactions and (vii) produce income that will not be qualified income for purposes of the 90% annual gross income requirement described
above. These U.S. federal income tax provisions could therefore affect the amount, timing and character of distributions to common shareholders. The Trust intends to monitor its transactions and may make certain tax elections and may be required to
dispose of securities to mitigate the effect of these provisions and prevent disqualification of the Trust as a RIC. Additionally, the Trust may be required to limit its activities in derivative instruments in order to enable it to maintain its RIC
status.
- 89 -
The Trust may invest a portion of its net assets in below investment grade securities. Investments in these types
of securities may present special tax issues for the Trust. U.S. federal income tax rules are not entirely clear about issues such as when the Trust may cease to accrue interest, original issue discount or market discount, when and to what extent
deductions may be taken for bad debts or worthless securities, how payments received on obligations in default should be allocated between principal and income and whether modifications or exchanges of debt obligations in a bankruptcy or workout
context are taxable. These and other issues could affect the Trusts ability to distribute sufficient income to preserve its status as a RIC or to avoid the imposition of U.S. federal income or excise tax.
Certain debt securities acquired by the Trust may be treated as debt securities that were originally issued at a discount. Generally, the amount of the
original issue discount is treated as interest income and is included in taxable income (and required to be distributed by the Trust in order to qualify as a RIC and avoid U.S. federal income tax or the 4% excise tax on undistributed income) over
the term of the security, even though payment of that amount is not received until a later time, usually when the debt security matures.
If the Trust
purchases a debt security on a secondary market at a price lower than its adjusted issue price, the excess of the adjusted issue price over the purchase price is market discount. Unless the Trust makes an election to accrue market
discount on a current basis, generally, any gain realized on the disposition of, and any partial payment of principal on, a debt security having market discount is treated as ordinary income to the extent the gain, or principal payment, does not
exceed the accrued market discount on the debt security. Market discount generally accrues in equal daily installments. If the Trust ultimately collects less on the debt instrument than its purchase price plus the market discount
previously included in income, the Trust may not be able to benefit from any offsetting loss deductions.
The Trust may invest in preferred securities or
other securities the U.S. federal income tax treatment of which may not be clear or may be subject to recharacterization by the Internal Revenue Service. To the extent the tax treatment of such securities or the income from such securities differs
from the tax treatment expected by the Trust, it could affect the timing or character of income recognized by the Trust, potentially requiring the Trust to purchase or sell securities, or otherwise change its portfolio, in order to comply with the
tax rules applicable to RICs under the Code.
Gain or loss on the sale of securities by the Trust will generally be long-term capital gain or loss if the
securities have been held by the Trust for more than one year. Gain or loss on the sale of securities held for one year or less will be short-term capital gain or loss.
Because the Trust may invest in foreign securities, its income from such securities may be subject to non-U.S. taxes.
Foreign currency gain or loss on foreign currency exchange contracts, non-U.S. dollar-denominated securities
contracts, and non-U.S. dollar-denominated futures contracts, options and forward contracts that are not section 1256 contracts (as defined below) generally will be treated as ordinary income and loss.
Income from options on individual securities written by the Trust will generally not be recognized by the Trust for tax purposes until an option is exercised,
lapses or is subject to a closing transaction (as defined by applicable regulations) pursuant to which the Trusts obligations with respect to the option are otherwise terminated. If the option lapses without exercise, the premiums
received by the Trust from the writing of such options will generally be characterized as short-term capital gain. If the Trust enters into a closing transaction, the difference between the premiums received and the amount paid by the Trust to close
out its position will generally be treated as short-term capital gain or loss. If an option written by the Trust is exercised, thereby requiring the Trust to sell the underlying security, the premium will increase the amount realized upon the sale
of the security, and the character of any gain on such sale of the underlying security as short-term or long-term capital gain will depend on the holding period of the Trust in the underlying security. Because the Trust will not have control over
the exercise of the options it writes, such exercises or other required sales of the underlying securities may cause the Trust to realize gains or losses at inopportune times.
Index options that qualify as section 1256 contracts will generally be
marked-to-market for U.S. federal income tax purposes. As a result, the Trust will generally recognize gain or loss on the last day of each taxable year
equal to the difference between the value of the option on that date and the adjusted basis of the option. The adjusted basis of
- 90 -
the option will consequently be increased by such gain or decreased by such loss. Any gain or loss with respect to options on indices and sectors that qualify as section 1256
contracts will be treated as short-term capital gain or loss to the extent of 40% of such gain or loss and long-term capital gain or loss to the extent of 60% of such gain or loss. Because the mark-to-market rules may cause the Trust to recognize gain in advance of the receipt of cash, the Trust may be required to dispose of investments in order to meet its distribution requirements. Mark-to-market losses may be suspended or otherwise limited if such losses are part of a straddle or similar transaction.
Taxation of Common Shareholders
Trust distributions of
its tax-exempt interest on municipal securities, if properly reported by the Trust to its shareholders (exempt-interest dividends), will generally be exempt from regular federal income tax. In
order for the Trust to pay exempt-interest dividends, at least 50% of the value of the Trusts total assets must consist of tax-exempt obligations on a quarterly basis. If the Trust does not meet this
requirement, it would not be able to pay tax-exempt dividends, and your distributions attributable to interest received by the Trust from any source (including distributions of
tax-exempt interest income) would be taxable as ordinary income to the extent of the Trusts earnings and profits.
The Trust will either distribute or retain for reinvestment all or part of its net capital gain. If any such gain is retained, the Trust will be subject to a
corporate income tax on such retained amount. In that event, the Trust expects to report the retained amount as undistributed capital gain in a notice to its common shareholders, each of whom, if subject to U.S. federal income tax on long-term
capital gains, (i) will be required to include in income for U.S. federal income tax purposes as long-term capital gain its share of such undistributed amounts, (ii) will be entitled to credit its proportionate share of the tax paid by the
Trust against its U.S. federal income tax liability and to claim refunds to the extent that the credit exceeds such liability and (iii) will increase its basis in its common shares by the amount of undistributed capital gains included in the
shareholders income less the tax deemed paid by the shareholder under clause (ii).
Distributions paid to you by the Trust from its net capital
gain, if any, that the Trust properly reports as capital gain dividends (capital gain dividends) are taxable as long-term capital gains, regardless of how long you have held your common shares. All other dividends paid to you by the
Trust (including dividends from net short-term capital gains) from its current or accumulated earnings and profits, other than exempt-interest dividends (ordinary income dividends) are generally subject to tax as ordinary income.
Provided that certain holding period and other requirements are met, ordinary income dividends (if properly reported by the Trust) may qualify (i) for the dividends received deduction in the case of corporate shareholders to the extent that the
Trusts income consists of dividend income from U.S. corporations, and (ii) in the case of individual shareholders, as qualified dividend income eligible to be taxed at long-term capital gains rates to the extent that the Trust
receives qualified dividend income. Qualified dividend income is, in general, dividend income from taxable domestic corporations and certain qualified foreign corporations (e.g., generally, foreign corporations incorporated in a possession of the
United States or in certain countries with a qualifying comprehensive tax treaty with the United States, or whose stock with respect to which such dividend is paid is readily tradable on an established securities market in the United
States). There can be no assurance as to what portion, if any, of the Trusts distributions will constitute qualified dividend income or be eligible for the dividends received deduction.
Any distributions you receive that are in excess of the Trusts current and accumulated earnings and profits will be treated as a return of capital to
the extent of your adjusted tax basis in your common shares, and thereafter as capital gain from the sale of common shares. The amount of any Trust distribution that is treated as a return of capital will reduce your adjusted tax basis in your
common shares, thereby increasing your potential gain or reducing your potential loss on any subsequent sale or other disposition of your common shares.
Common shareholders may be entitled to offset their capital gain dividends with capital losses. The Code contains a number of statutory provisions affecting
when capital losses may be offset against capital gain, and limiting the use of losses from certain investments and activities. Accordingly, common shareholders that have capital losses are urged to consult their tax advisers.
Dividends and other taxable distributions are taxable to you even though they are reinvested in additional common shares of the Trust. Dividends and other
distributions paid by the Trust are generally treated under the Code as
- 91 -
received by you at the time the dividend or distribution is made. If, however, the Trust pays you a dividend in January that was declared in the previous October, November or December to common
shareholders of record on a specified date in one of such months, then such dividend will be treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes as being paid by the Trust and received by you on December 31 of the year in which the dividend was
declared. In addition, certain other distributions made after the close of the Trusts taxable year may be spilled back and treated as paid by the Trust (except for purposes of the 4% nondeductible excise tax) during such taxable
year. In such case, you will be treated as having received such dividends in the taxable year in which the distributions were actually made.
Interest on
certain private activity bonds is an item of tax preference subject to the alternative minimum tax on individuals. The Trust may invest a portion of its assets in municipal bonds subject to this provision so that a portion of its
exempt-interest dividends is an item of tax preference to the extent such dividends represent interest received from these private activity bonds. Accordingly, investment in the Trust could cause a holder of common shares to be subject to, or result
in an increased liability under, the alternative minimum tax.
Exempt-interest dividends are included in determining what portion, if any, of a
persons Social Security and railroad retirement benefits will be includable in gross income subject to federal income tax.
The price of common
shares purchased at any time may reflect the amount of a forthcoming distribution. Those purchasing common shares just prior to the record date of a distribution will receive a distribution which will be taxable to them even though it represents,
economically, a return of invested capital.
The Trust will send you information after the end of each year setting forth the amount and tax status of any
distributions paid to you by the Trust.
The sale or other disposition of common shares will generally result in capital gain or loss to you and will be
long-term capital gain or loss if you have held such common shares for more than one year at the time of sale. Any loss upon the sale or other disposition of common shares held for six months or less will be treated as long-term capital loss to the
extent of any capital gain dividends received (including amounts credited as an undistributed capital gain dividend) by you with respect to such common shares. Any loss you recognize on a sale or other disposition of common shares will be disallowed
if you acquire other common shares (whether through the automatic reinvestment of dividends or otherwise) within a 61-day period beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after your sale or exchange of the
common shares. In such case, your tax basis in the common shares acquired will be adjusted to reflect the disallowed loss.
If the Trust liquidates,
shareholders generally will realize capital gain or loss upon such liquidation in an amount equal to the difference between the amount of cash or other property received by the shareholder (including any property deemed received by reason of its
being placed in a liquidating trust) and the shareholders adjusted tax basis in its common shares. Any such gain or loss will be long-term if the shareholder is treated as having a holding period in the Trust shares of greater than one year,
and otherwise will be short-term.
Current U.S. federal income tax law taxes both long-term and short-term capital gain of corporations at the rates
applicable to ordinary income. For non-corporate taxpayers, short-term capital gain is currently taxed at rates applicable to ordinary income while long-term capital gain generally is taxed at a reduced
maximum rate. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations under the Code.
Certain U.S. holders who are individuals, estates or trusts
and whose income exceeds certain thresholds will be required to pay a 3.8% Medicare tax on all or a portion of their net investment income, which includes dividends received from the Trust and capital gains from the sale or other
disposition of the Trusts common shares.
A common shareholder that is a nonresident alien individual or a foreign corporation (a foreign
investor) generally will be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax at the rate of 30% (or possibly a lower rate provided by an applicable tax treaty) on ordinary income dividends (except as discussed below). In general, U.S. federal
withholding tax and U.S. federal income tax will not apply to any gain or income realized by a foreign investor in respect of any distribution of exempt-interest dividends or net capital gain (including amounts credited as an undistributed capital
- 92 -
gain dividend) or upon the sale or other disposition of common shares of the Trust. Different tax consequences may result if the foreign investor is engaged in a trade or business in the United
States or, in the case of an individual, is present in the United States for 183 days or more during a taxable year and certain other conditions are met. Foreign investors should consult their tax advisers regarding the tax consequences of investing
in the Trusts common shares.
Ordinary income dividends properly reported by a RIC are generally exempt from U.S. federal withholding tax where they
(i) are paid in respect of the RICs qualified net interest income (generally, its U.S.-source interest income, other than certain contingent interest and interest from obligations of a corporation or partnership in which the
RIC is at least a 10% shareholder, reduced by expenses that are allocable to such income) or (ii) are paid in respect of the RICs qualified short-term capital gains (generally, the excess of the RICs net short-term
capital gain over its long-term capital loss for such taxable year). Depending on its circumstances, the Trust may report all, some or none of its potentially eligible dividends as such qualified net interest income or as qualified short-term
capital gains, and/or treat such dividends, in whole or in part, as ineligible for this exemption from withholding. In order to qualify for this exemption from withholding, a foreign investor needs to comply with applicable certification
requirements relating to its non-U.S. status (including, in general, furnishing an IRS Form W-8BEN,
W-8BEN-E or substitute Form). In the case of common shares held through an intermediary, the intermediary may have withheld tax even if the Trust reported the payment as
qualified net interest income or qualified short-term capital gain. Foreign investors should contact their intermediaries with respect to the application of these rules to their accounts. There can be no assurance as to what portion of the
Trusts distributions would qualify for favorable treatment as qualified net interest income or qualified short-term capital gains.
In
addition, withholding at a rate of 30% will apply to dividends paid in respect of common shares of the Trust held by or through certain foreign financial institutions (including investment funds), unless such institution enters into an
agreement with the Treasury to report, on an annual basis, information with respect to shares in, and accounts maintained by, the institution to the extent such shares or accounts are held by certain U.S. persons and by certain non-U.S. entities that are wholly or partially owned by U.S. persons and to withhold on certain payments. Accordingly, the entity through which common shares of the Trust are held will affect the determination of
whether such withholding is required. Similarly, dividends paid in respect of common shares of the Trust held by an investor that is a non-financial foreign entity that does not qualify under certain
exemptions will be subject to withholding at a rate of 30%, unless such entity either (i) certifies that such entity does not have any substantial United States owners or (ii) provides certain information regarding the
entitys substantial United States owners, which the Trust or applicable withholding agent will in turn provide to the Secretary of the Treasury. An intergovernmental agreement between the United States and an applicable foreign
country, or future Treasury regulations or other guidance, may modify these requirements. The Trust will not pay any additional amounts to common shareholders in respect of any amounts withheld. Foreign investors are encouraged to consult with their
tax advisers regarding the possible implications of these rules on their investment in the Trusts common shares.
U.S. federal backup withholding
tax may be required on dividends, distributions and sale proceeds payable to certain non-exempt common shareholders who fail to supply their correct taxpayer identification number (in the case of individuals,
generally, their social security number) or to make required certifications, or who are otherwise subject to backup withholding. Backup withholding is not an additional tax and any amount withheld may be refunded or credited against your U.S.
federal income tax liability, if any, provided that you timely furnish the required information to the Internal Revenue Service.
Ordinary income
dividends, capital gain dividends, and gain from the sale or other disposition of common shares of the Trust also may be subject to state, local, and/or foreign taxes. Common shareholders are urged to consult their own tax advisers regarding
specific questions about U.S. federal, state, local or foreign tax consequences to them of investing in the Trust.
The foregoing is a general and
abbreviated summary of certain provisions of the Code and the Treasury regulations currently in effect as they directly govern the taxation of the Trust and its common shareholders. These provisions are subject to change by legislative or
administrative action, and any such change may be retroactive. A more detailed discussion of the tax rules applicable to the Trust and its common shareholders can be found in the SAI that is incorporated by reference into this Prospectus. Common
shareholders are
- 93 -
urged to consult their tax advisers regarding specific questions as to U.S. federal, state, local and foreign income or other taxes.
Please refer to the SAI for more detailed information. You are urged to consult your tax adviser.
TAXATION OF HOLDERS OF RIGHTS
The value of a right will not be includible in the income of a common shareholder at the time the right is issued.
The basis of a right issued to a common shareholder will be zero, and the basis of the share with respect to which the subscription right was issued (the old
share) will remain unchanged, unless either (a) the fair market value of the right on the date of distribution is at least 15% of the fair market value of the old share, or (b) such shareholder affirmatively elects (in the manner set out
in Treasury regulations under the Code) to allocate to the subscription right a portion of the basis of the old share. If either (a) or (b) applies, then except as described below such shareholder must allocate basis between the old share
and the right in proportion to their fair market values on the date of distribution.
The basis of a right purchased in the market will generally be its
purchase price.
The holding period of a right issued to a common shareholder will include the holding period of the old share. No gain or loss will be
recognized by a common shareholder upon the exercise of a right.
No loss will be recognized by a common shareholder if a right distributed to such common
shareholder expires unexercised because the basis of the old share may be allocated to a right only if the right is exercised. If a right that has been purchased in the market expires unexercised, there will be a recognized loss equal to the basis
of the right.
Any gain or loss on the sale of a right will be a capital gain or loss if the right is held as a capital asset (which in the case of rights
issued to common shareholders will depend on whether the old share of beneficial interest is held as a capital asset), and will be a long-term capital gain or loss if the holding period is deemed to exceed one year.
CERTAIN PROVISIONS IN THE AGREEMENT AND DECLARATION OF TRUST AND BYLAWS
The Agreement and Declaration of Trust includes provisions that could have the effect of limiting the ability of other entities or persons to acquire control
of the Trust or to change the composition of the Board. This could have the effect of depriving shareholders of an opportunity to sell their shares at a premium over prevailing market prices by discouraging a third party from seeking to obtain
control over the Trust. Such attempts could have the effect of increasing the expenses of the Trust and disrupting the normal operation of the Trust. The Board is divided into three classes. At each annual meeting of shareholders or special meeting
in lieu thereof the term of only one class of Trustees expires and only the Trustees in that one class stand for re-election. Trustees standing for election at an annual meeting of shareholders or special
meeting in lieu thereof are elected to a three-year term. This provision could delay for up to two years the replacement of a majority of the Board. A Trustee may be removed from office for cause only, and not without cause, and only by the action
of a majority of the remaining Trustees followed by a vote of the holders of at least 75% of the shares then entitled to vote for the election of the respective Trustee.
In addition, the Trusts Agreement and Declaration of Trust requires the favorable vote or consent of a majority of the Board followed by the favorable
vote of the holders of at least 75% of the outstanding shares of each affected class or series outstanding of the Trust, voting separately as a class or series, to approve, adopt or authorize certain transactions with 5% or greater holders of a
class or series of shares and their associates, unless 80% of the Trustees by resolution have approved a memorandum of understanding with such holders with respect to and substantially consistent with such transaction, in which case approval by
a majority of the outstanding voting securities (as defined in the Investment Company Act) of the Trust will be the only vote of the shareholders required. These voting requirements are in addition to any regulatory relief required from
the SEC with respect to such transaction. For purposes of these provisions, a 5% or greater holder of a class or series of shares (a Principal Shareholder) refers to any corporation, person or other entity who, whether directly or
indirectly and whether alone or together with its affiliates and associates, beneficially owns 5% or more of the outstanding shares of all outstanding classes or series of shares of beneficial interest of the Trust.
- 94 -
The 5% holder transactions subject to these special approval requirements are:
|
● |
|
the merger or consolidation of the Trust or any subsidiary of the Trust with or into any Principal Shareholder;
|
|
● |
|
the issuance of any securities of the Trust to any Principal Shareholder for cash (other than pursuant to any
automatic dividend reinvestment plan); |
|
● |
|
the sale, lease or exchange of all or any substantial part of the assets of the Trust to any Principal
Shareholder, except assets having an aggregate fair market value of less than $1,000,000, aggregating for the purpose of such computation all assets sold, leased or exchanged in any series of similar transactions within a twelve-month period; or
|
|
● |
|
the sale, lease or exchange to the Trust or any subsidiary of the Trust, in exchange for securities of the Trust,
of any assets of any Principal Shareholder, except assets having an aggregate fair market value of less than $1,000,000, aggregating for purposes of such computation all assets sold, leased or exchanged in any series of similar transactions within a
twelve-month period. |
To convert the Trust to an open-end investment company, the Trusts
Agreement and Declaration of Trust requires the favorable vote of a majority of the Board followed by the favorable vote of the holders of at least 75% of the outstanding shares of each affected class or series of shares of the Trust, voting
separately as a class or series, unless such conversion has been approved by at least 80% of the Trustees, in which case a majority of the outstanding voting securities (as defined in the Investment Company Act) of the Trust shall be
required. The foregoing vote would satisfy a separate requirement in the Investment Company Act that any conversion of the Trust to an open-end investment company be approved by the shareholders. If approved
in the foregoing manner, we anticipate conversion of the Trust to an open-end investment company might not occur until 90 days after the shareholders meeting at which such conversion was approved and
would also require at least 10 days prior notice to all shareholders. Conversion of the Trust to an open-end investment company would require the redemption of any outstanding preferred shares, which
could eliminate or alter the leveraged capital structure of the Trust with respect to the common shares. Following any such conversion, it is also possible that certain of the Trusts investment policies and strategies would have to be modified
to assure sufficient portfolio liquidity, including in order to comply with Rule 22e-4 under the Investment Company Act. In the event of conversion, the common shares would cease to be listed on the NYSE or
other national securities exchanges or market systems. Shareholders of an open-end investment company may require the company to redeem their shares at any time, except in certain circumstances as authorized
by or under the Investment Company Act, at their NAV, less such redemption charge, if any, as might be in effect at the time of a redemption. The Trust expects to pay all such redemption requests in cash, but reserves the right to pay redemption
requests in a combination of cash or securities. If such partial payment in securities were made, investors may incur brokerage costs in converting such securities to cash. If the Trust were converted to an
open-end fund, it is likely that new shares would be sold at NAV plus a sales load. The Board believes, however, that the closed-end structure is desirable in light of
the Trusts investment objective and policies. Therefore, you should assume that it is not likely that the Board would vote to convert the Trust to an open-end fund.
To dissolve the Trust, the Trusts Agreement and Declaration of Trust requires the approval of a resolution by a majority of the Board followed by the
favorable vote of the holders of at least 75% of the outstanding shares of each affected class or series of the Trust, voting separately as a class or series, unless such resolution has been approved by at least 80% of the Trustees, in which case
a majority of the outstanding voting securities (as defined in the Investment Company Act) of the Trust shall be required.
For the purposes
of calculating a majority of the outstanding voting securities under the Trusts Agreement and Declaration of Trust, each class and series of the Trust shall vote together as a single class, except to the extent required by the
Investment Company Act or the Trusts Agreement and Declaration of Trust with respect to any class or series of shares. If a separate vote is required, the applicable proportion of shares of the class or series, voting as a separate class or
series, also will be required.
- 95 -
The Board has determined that provisions with respect to the Board and the shareholder voting requirements
described above, which voting requirements are greater than the minimum requirements under Delaware law or the Investment Company Act, are in the best interests of shareholders generally. Reference should be made to the Agreement and Declaration of
Trust on file with the SEC for the full text of these provisions.
The Trusts Bylaws generally require that advance notice be given to the Trust in
the event a shareholder desires to nominate a person for election to the Board or to transact any other business at an annual meeting of shareholders. Notice of any such nomination or business must be delivered to or received at the principal
executive offices of the Trust not less than 120 calendar days nor more than 150 calendar days prior to the anniversary date of the prior years annual meeting (subject to certain exceptions). Any notice by a shareholder must be accompanied by
certain information as provided in the Bylaws. Reference should be made to the Bylaws on file with the SEC for the full text of these provisions.
CLOSED-END FUND STRUCTURE
The Trust is a diversified, closed-end management investment company (commonly referred to as a closed-end fund). Closed-end funds differ from open-end funds (which are generally referred to as mutual funds) in that closed-end funds generally list their shares for trading on a stock exchange and do not redeem their shares at the request of the shareholder. This means that if you wish to sell your shares of a closed-end fund you must trade them on the stock exchange like any other stock at the prevailing market price at that time. In a mutual fund, if the shareholder wishes to sell shares of the fund, the mutual fund
will redeem or buy back the shares at NAV. Also, mutual funds generally offer new shares on a continuous basis to new investors and closed-end funds generally do not. The continuous inflows and outflows of
assets in a mutual fund can make it difficult to manage the funds investments. By comparison, closed-end funds are generally able to stay more fully invested in securities that are consistent with their
investment objective and also have greater flexibility to make certain types of investments and to use certain investment strategies, such as financial leverage and investments in illiquid securities.
Shares of closed-end funds frequently trade at a discount to their NAV. Because of this possibility and the
recognition that any such discount may not be in the interest of shareholders, the Board might consider from time to time engaging in open-market repurchases, tender offers for shares or other programs intended to reduce the discount. We cannot
guarantee or assure, however, that the Board will decide to engage in any of these actions. Nor is there any guarantee or assurance that such actions, if undertaken, would result in the shares trading at a price equal or close to the NAV per share.
See Repurchase of Common Shares below and Repurchase of Common Shares in the SAI. The Board might also consider converting the Trust to an open-end mutual fund, which would also require
a vote of the shareholders of the Trust.
REPURCHASE OF COMMON SHARES
Shares of closed-end investment companies often trade at a discount to their NAVs and the Trusts common shares
may also trade at a discount to their NAV, although it is possible that they may trade at a premium above NAV. The market price of the Trusts common shares will be determined by such factors as relative demand for and supply of such common
shares in the market, the Trusts NAV, general market and economic conditions, market sentiment and other factors beyond the control of the Trust. See Net Asset Value and Description of SharesCommon Shares.
Although the Trusts common shareholders will not have the right to redeem their common shares, the Trust may take action to repurchase common shares in the open market or make tender offers for its common shares. This may have the effect of
reducing any market discount from NAV.
There is no assurance that, if action is undertaken to repurchase or tender for common shares, such action will
result in the common shares trading at a price which approximates their NAV. Although share repurchases and tender offers could have a favorable effect on the market price of the Trusts common shares, you should be aware that the
acquisition of common shares by the Trust will decrease the capital of the Trust and, therefore, may have the effect of increasing the Trusts expense ratio and decreasing the asset coverage with respect to any borrowings or preferred shares
outstanding. Any share repurchases or tender offers will be made in accordance with the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Investment Company Act and the principal stock exchange on which the common shares are traded. For
additional information, see Repurchase of Common Shares in the SAI.
- 96 -
PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION
We may sell common shares, including to existing shareholders in a rights offering, through underwriters or dealers, directly to one or more purchasers
(including existing shareholders in a rights offering), through agents, to or through underwriters or dealers, or through a combination of any such methods of sale. The applicable Prospectus Supplement will identify any underwriter or agent involved
in the offer and sale of our common shares, any sales loads, discounts, commissions, fees or other compensation paid to any underwriter, dealer or agent, the offering price, net proceeds and use of proceeds and the terms of any sale. In the case of
a rights offering, the applicable Prospectus Supplement will set forth the number of our common shares issuable upon the exercise of each right and the other terms of such rights offering.
The distribution of our common shares may be effected from time to time in one or more transactions at a fixed price or prices, which may be changed, at
prevailing market prices at the time of sale, at prices related to such prevailing market prices, or at negotiated prices. Sales of our common shares may be made in transactions that are deemed to be at the market as defined in Rule 415
under the Securities Act, including sales made directly on the NYSE or sales made to or through a market maker other than on an exchange.
We may sell our
common shares directly to, and solicit offers from, institutional investors or others who may be deemed to be underwriters as defined in the Securities Act for any resales of the securities. In this case, no underwriters or agents would be involved.
We may use electronic media, including the Internet, to sell offered securities directly.
In connection with the sale of our common shares, underwriters
or agents may receive compensation from us in the form of discounts, concessions or commissions. Underwriters may sell our common shares to or through dealers, and such dealers may receive compensation in the form of discounts, concessions or
commissions from the underwriters and/or commissions from the purchasers for whom they may act as agents. Underwriters, dealers and agents that participate in the distribution of our common shares may be deemed to be underwriters under the
Securities Act, and any discounts and commissions they receive from us and any profit realized by them on the resale of our common shares may be deemed to be underwriting discounts and commissions under the Securities Act. Any such underwriter or
agent will be identified and any such compensation received from us will be described in the applicable Prospectus Supplement. The maximum amount of compensation to be received by any Financial Industry Regulatory Authority member or independent
broker-dealer will not exceed eight percent for the sale of any securities being offered pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act. We will not pay any compensation to any underwriter or agent in the form of warrants, options, consulting or
structuring fees or similar arrangements.
If a Prospectus Supplement so indicates, we may grant the underwriters an option to purchase additional common
shares at the public offering price, less the underwriting discounts and commissions, within 45 days from the date of the Prospectus Supplement, to cover any over-allotments.
Under agreements into which we may enter, underwriters, dealers and agents who participate in the distribution of our common shares may be entitled to
indemnification by us against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act. Underwriters, dealers and agents may engage in transactions with us, or perform services for us, in the ordinary course of business.
If so indicated in the applicable Prospectus Supplement, we will ourselves, or will authorize underwriters or other persons acting as our agents to solicit
offers by certain institutions to purchase our common shares from us pursuant to contracts providing for payment and delivery on a future date. Institutions with which such contacts may be made include commercial and savings banks, insurance
companies, pension funds, investment companies, educational and charitable institutions and others, but in all cases such institutions must be approved by us. The obligation of any purchaser under any such contract will be subject to the condition
that the purchase of the common shares shall not at the time of delivery be prohibited under the laws of the jurisdiction to which such purchaser is subject. The underwriters and such other agents will not have any responsibility in respect of the
validity or performance of such contracts. Such contracts will be subject only to those conditions set forth in the Prospectus Supplement, and the Prospectus Supplement will set forth the commission payable for solicitation of such contracts.
- 97 -
To the extent permitted under the Investment Company Act and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder,
the underwriters may from time to time act as brokers or dealers and receive fees in connection with the execution of our portfolio transactions after the underwriters have ceased to be underwriters and, subject to certain restrictions, each may act
as a broker while it is an underwriter.
A Prospectus and accompanying Prospectus Supplement in electronic form may be made available on the websites
maintained by underwriters. The underwriters may agree to allocate a number of securities for sale to their online brokerage account holders. Such allocations of securities for Internet distributions will be made on the same basis as other
allocations. In addition, securities may be sold by the underwriters to securities dealers who resell securities to online brokerage account holders.
In
order to comply with the securities laws of certain states, if applicable, our common shares offered hereby will be sold in such jurisdictions only through registered or licensed brokers or dealers.
INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE
This Prospectus is part of a registration statement that we have filed with the SEC. We are allowed to incorporate by reference the information
that we file with the SEC, which means that we can disclose important information to you by referring you to those documents. We incorporate by reference into this Prospectus the documents listed below and any future filings we make with the SEC
under Sections 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, including any filings on or after the date of this Prospectus from the date of filing (excluding any information furnished, rather than filed), until we have sold all of the offered
securities to which this Prospectus and any accompanying prospectus supplement relates or the offering is otherwise terminated. The information incorporated by reference is an important part of this Prospectus. Any statement in a document
incorporated by reference into this Prospectus will be deemed to be automatically modified or superseded to the extent a statement contained in (1) this Prospectus or (2) any other subsequently filed document that is incorporated by
reference into this Prospectus modifies or supersedes such statement. The documents incorporated by reference herein include:
|
● |
|
The Trusts SAI, dated [], 2025, filed with this Prospectus; |
|
● |
|
our annual report on Form N-CSR for the fiscal year ended
December 31, 2024 filed with the SEC on March 7, 2025; and |
|
● |
|
the description of the Trusts common shares contained in our Registration Statement on Form 8-A (File No. 001-31741) filed with the SEC on July 22, 2003, including any amendment or report filed for the purpose of updating such description prior to the
termination of the offering registered hereby. |
The Trust will provide without charge to each person, including any beneficial owner, to
whom this Prospectus is delivered, upon written or oral request, a copy of any and all of the documents that have been or may be incorporated by reference in this Prospectus or the accompanying prospectus supplement. You should direct requests for
documents by calling:
Client Services Desk
(800) 882-0052
The Trust makes available this Prospectus, SAI and the Trusts annual and semi-annual reports, free of charge, at http://www.blackrock.com. You may also
obtain this Prospectus, the SAI, other documents incorporated by reference and other information the Trust files electronically, including reports and proxy statements, on the SEC website (http://www.sec.gov) or with the payment of a duplication
fee, by electronic request at publicinfo@sec.gov. Information contained in, or that can be accessed through, the Trusts website is not incorporated by reference into this Prospectus and should not be considered to be part of this Prospectus or
the accompanying prospectus supplement.
- 98 -
PRIVACY PRINCIPLES OF THE TRUST
The Trust is committed to maintaining the privacy of shareholders and to safeguarding their non-public personal
information. The following information is provided to help you understand what personal information the Trust collects, how we protect that information, and why in certain cases we may share such information with select other parties.
The Trust does not receive any non-public personal information relating to its shareholders who purchase shares
through their broker-dealers. In the case of shareholders who are record holders of the Trust, the Trust receives personal non-public information on account applications or other forms. With respect to these
shareholders, the Trust also has access to specific information regarding their transactions in the Trust.
The Trust does not disclose any non-public personal information about its shareholders or former shareholders to anyone, except as permitted by law or as is necessary in order to service our shareholders accounts (for example, to a transfer
agent).
The Trust restricts access to non-public personal information about its shareholders to BlackRock
employees with a legitimate business need for the information. The Trust maintains physical, electronic and procedural safeguards designed to protect the non-public personal information of our shareholders.
- 99 -
12,000,000 Shares
BLACKROCK LIMITED DURATION INCOME
TRUST
Common Shares of
Beneficial Interest
Rights to Purchase Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
PROSPECTUS
[●], 2025
The information in this Prospectus Supplement is not complete and may be
changed. BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This Prospectus Supplement is not an offer to sell these securities and
is not soliciting offers to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.
SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED [●], 2025
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
(To Prospectus dated [●], 2025)
Filed
Pursuant to Rule 424(b)([●])
Registration Statement No. 333-[●]
BLACKROCK LIMITED DURATION INCOME TRUST
Up to [●] Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust (the Trust, we, us or our) is offering for sale [●] of our
common shares of beneficial interest (common shares). Our common shares are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) under the symbol BLW. As of the close of business on [●], 2025, the last reported net
asset value per share of our common shares was $[●] and the last reported sales price per share of our common shares on the NYSE was $[●].
The Trust is a diversified, closed-end management investment company registered under the Investment Company Act of
1940, as amended (the Investment Company Act). The Trusts investment objective is to provide current income and capital appreciation. The Trusts investment adviser is BlackRock Advisors, LLC (the Advisor), and the
Advisors affiliates, BlackRock International Limited and BlackRock (Singapore) Limited), act as the Trusts sub-advisors.
Sales of our common shares, if any, under this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus may be made in negotiated transactions or transactions
that are deemed to be at the market as defined in Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the Securities Act), including sales made directly on the NYSE or sales made to or through a market maker other
than on an exchange.
Investing in the Trusts common shares involves certain risks, including risks of leverage, that are described in the
Risks section beginning on page [●] of the accompanying Prospectus.
NEITHER THE SEC NOR ANY STATE SECURITIES
COMMISSION HAS APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED THESE SECURITIES OR DETERMINED IF THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT IS TRUTHFUL OR COMPLETE. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
[●], 2025
S-1
This Prospectus Supplement, together with the accompanying Prospectus, sets forth concisely the information about
the Trust that a prospective investor should know before investing. You should read this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus, which contain important information, before deciding whether to invest in the common shares. You should
retain the accompanying Prospectus and this Prospectus Supplement for future reference. A Statement of Additional Information (SAI), dated [], 2025, containing additional information about the Trust, has been filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and, as amended from time to time, is incorporated by reference in its entirety into this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus. This Prospectus Supplement, the accompanying
Prospectus and the SAI are part of a shelf registration statement filed with the SEC. This Prospectus Supplement describes the specific details regarding this offering, including the method of distribution. If information in this
Prospectus Supplement is inconsistent with the accompanying Prospectus or the SAI, you should rely on this Prospectus Supplement. You may call (800) 882-0052, visit the Trusts website
(http://www.blackrock.com) or write to the Trust to obtain, free of charge, copies of the SAI and the Trusts semi-annual and annual reports, as well as to obtain other information about the Trust or to make shareholder inquiries. The SAI, as
well as the Trusts semi-annual and annual reports, are also available for free on the SECs website (http://www.sec.gov). You may also e-mail requests for these documents to publicinfo@sec.gov.
Information contained in, or that can be accessed through, the Trusts website is not part of this Prospectus Supplement or the accompanying Prospectus.
You should not construe the contents of this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus as legal, tax or financial advice. You should consult with
your own professional advisors as to the legal, tax, financial or other matters relevant to the suitability of an investment in the Trust.
The common
shares do not represent a deposit or an obligation of, and are not guaranteed or endorsed by, any bank or other insured depository institution, and are not federally insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the Federal Reserve Board or
any other government agency.
S-2
You should rely only on the information contained or incorporated by reference in this Prospectus Supplement
and the accompanying Prospectus. Neither the Trust nor the underwriters have authorized anyone to provide you with different information. The Trust is not making an offer to sell these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not
permitted. You should not assume that the information contained in this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus is accurate as of any date other than the date of this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus, respectively.
Our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects may have changed since those dates. In this Prospectus Supplement and in the accompanying Prospectus, unless otherwise indicated, Trust, us,
our and we refer to BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust, a Delaware statutory trust.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Prospectus Supplement
Prospectus
S-3
CAUTIONARY NOTICE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
This Prospectus Supplement, the accompanying Prospectus and the SAI contain forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements can be
identified by the words may, will, intend, expect, estimate, continue, plan, anticipate, and similar terms and the negative of such terms. Such
forward-looking statements may be contained in this Prospectus Supplement as well as in the accompanying Prospectus. By their nature, all forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties, and actual results could differ materially from
those contemplated by the forward-looking statements. Several factors that could materially affect our actual results are the performance of the portfolio of securities we hold, the price at which our shares will trade in the public markets and
other factors discussed in our periodic filings with the SEC.
Although we believe that the expectations expressed in our forward-looking statements are
reasonable, actual results could differ materially from those projected or assumed in our forward-looking statements. Our future financial condition and results of operations, as well as any forward-looking statements, are subject to change and are
subject to inherent risks and uncertainties, such as those disclosed in the Risks section of the accompanying Prospectus. All forward-looking statements contained or incorporated by reference in this Prospectus Supplement or the
accompanying Prospectus are made as of the date of this Prospectus Supplement or the accompanying Prospectus, as the case may be. Except for our ongoing obligations under the federal securities laws, we do not intend, and we undertake no obligation,
to update any forward-looking statement. The forward-looking statements contained in this Prospectus Supplement, the accompanying Prospectus and the SAI are excluded from the safe harbor protection provided by Section 27A of the Securities Act.
Currently known risk factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from our expectations include, but are not limited to, the factors
described in the Risks section of the accompanying Prospectus. We urge you to review carefully those sections for a more detailed discussion of the risks of an investment in our common shares.
S-4
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT SUMMARY
The following summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the more detailed information included elsewhere in this Prospectus Supplement and in
the accompanying Prospectus and in the SAI.
The Trust
The Trust is a diversified, closed-end management investment company. The Trusts investment objective is to
provide current income and capital appreciation. There can be no assurance that the Trusts investment objective will be achieved or that the Trusts investment program will be successful. The Trusts common shares are listed for
trading on the NYSE under the symbol BLW.
Investment Advisor and Sub-Advisors
BlackRock Advisors, LLC (previously defined as the Advisor) is the Trusts investment adviser. The Advisor receives an annual fee, payable
monthly, in an amount equal to 0.55% of the average weekly value of the Trusts Managed Assets. BlackRock International Limited (BIL) and BlackRock (Singapore) Limited (BSL and together with BIL, the Sub-Advisors and collectively with the Advisor, the Advisors) serve as the Trusts sub-advisors. The Advisor, and not the Trust, pays an annual sub-advisory fee to the Sub-Advisors. For that portion of the Trust for which each Sub-Advisor acts as
sub-advisor, the Advisor will pay to such Sub-Advisor, an annual sub-advisory fee equal to a percentage of the management fee
received by the Advisor from the Trust with respect to the average daily value of the Managed Assets of the Trust allocated to such Sub-Advisor.
The Offering
[The provisions of the Investment Company
Act generally require that the public offering price of common shares (less any underwriting commissions and discounts) must equal or exceed the net asset value per share of a companys common shares (calculated within 48 hours of pricing).
Sales of our common shares, if any, under this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus may be made in negotiated transactions or
transactions that are deemed to be at the market as defined in Rule 415 under the Securities Act, including sales made directly on the NYSE or sales made to or through a market maker other than on an exchange.]
Use of Proceeds
We currently anticipate that we will be
able to invest all of the net proceeds of any sales of common shares pursuant to this Prospectus Supplement in accordance with our investment objective and policies as described in the accompanying Prospectus under The Trusts
Investments within approximately three months of the receipt of such proceeds. Pending such investment, it is anticipated that the proceeds will be invested in short-term, tax-exempt or taxable
investment grade securities or in high quality, short-term money market instruments. Depending on market conditions and operations, a portion of the cash held by the Trust, including any proceeds raised from the offering, may be used to pay
distributions in accordance with the Trusts distribution policy and may be a return of capital.
SUMMARY OF TRUST EXPENSES
The following table and example are intended to assist you in understanding the various costs and expenses directly or indirectly associated with investing in
our common shares.
|
|
|
|
|
Shareholder Transaction Expenses |
|
|
|
|
Sales load paid by you (as a percentage of offering price)(1) |
|
|
[ |
●]% |
Offering expenses borne by the Trust (as a percentage of offering price)(1) |
|
|
[ |
●]% |
S-5
|
|
|
|
|
Dividend reinvestment plan fees |
|
$[●](2) per share for
open- market
purchases of common
shares(2) |
|
|
Dividend reinvestment plan sale transaction fee |
|
$2.50(2) |
|
|
Estimated Annual Expenses (as a percentage of net assets attributable to common
shares) |
|
|
|
|
Management fees(3)(4) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Interest Expense on Borrowed
Funds(5) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Other Expenses |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Acquired Fund Fees and Expenses(6) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Total Annual Expenses |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Fee Waivers(4) |
|
|
|
|
Total Annual Expenses after Fee Waivers(4)(6) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
Trust shareholders will pay all offering expenses involved with this offering. |
(2) |
Computershare Trust Company, N.A.s (the Reinvestment Plan Agent) fees for the handling of the
reinvestment of dividends will be paid by the Trust. However, you will pay a $0.02 per share fee incurred in connection with open-market purchases, which will be deducted from the value of the dividend. You will also be charged a $2.50 sales fee and
pay a $0.15 per share fee if you direct the Reinvestment Plan Agent to sell your common shares held in a dividend reinvestment account. Per share fees include any applicable brokerage commissions the Reinvestment Plan Agent is required to pay.
|
(3) |
The Trust currently pays the Advisor a monthly fee at an annual contractual investment management fee rate of
0.55% of the average weekly value of the Trusts Managed Assets, plus the proceeds of ay debt securities or outstanding borrowings used for leverage. Managed Assets means the total assets of the Trust (including any assets
attributable to money borrowed for investment purposes) minus the sum of the Trusts accrued liabilities (other than money borrowed for investment purposes). |
(4) |
The Trust and the Advisor have entered into a fee waiver agreement (the Fee Waiver Agreement),
pursuant to which the Advisor has contractually agreed to waive the management fee with respect to any portion of the Trusts assets attributable to investments in any equity and fixed-income mutual funds and exchange-traded funds managed by
the Advisor or its affiliates that have a contractual management fee, through June 30, 2026. In addition, pursuant to the Fee Waiver Agreement, the Advisor has contractually agreed to waive its management fees by the amount of investment
advisory fees the Trust pays to the Advisor indirectly through its investment in money market funds managed by the Advisor or its affiliates, through June 30, 2026. The Fee Waiver Agreement may be terminated at any time, without the payment of
any penalty, only by the Trust (upon the vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as defined in the Investment Company Act) of the Trust or a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Trust), upon 90
days written notice by the Trust to the Advisor. |
(5) |
The Trust uses leverage in the form of reverse repurchase agreements representing [●]% of Managed Assets
at an annual interest expense to the Trust of [●]%, which is based on current market conditions. The actual amount of interest expense borne by the Trust will vary over time in accordance with the level of the Trusts use of reverse
repurchase agreements and variations |
(6) |
The total annual expenses do not correlate to the ratios to average net assets shown in the Trusts
Financial Highlights for the year ended December 31, 2024, which do not include acquired fund fees and expenses. |
Example
The following example illustrates the expenses (including the sales load of $[●] and offering costs of $[●]) that you would pay on a
$1,000 investment in common shares, assuming (i) total net annual expenses of [●]% of net assets attributable to common shares and (ii) a 5% annual return:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1 Year |
|
3 Years |
|
5 Years |
|
10 Years |
Total expenses incurred |
|
|
|
$ [●] |
|
|
|
|
$ [●] |
|
|
|
|
$ [●] |
|
|
|
|
$ [●] |
|
The example should not be considered a representation of future expenses. The example assumes that the estimated
Other expenses set forth in the Estimated Annual Expenses table are accurate and that all dividends and distributions are reinvested at net asset value. Actual expenses may be greater or less than those assumed. Moreover, the
Trusts actual rate of return may be greater or less than the hypothetical 5% return shown in the example.
USE OF PROCEEDS
We estimate the total net proceeds of the offering to be $[●], based on the public offering price of $[●] per share
and after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.
S-6
The net proceeds from the issuance of common shares hereunder will be invested in accordance with the
Trusts investment objective and policies as set forth in this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus. We currently anticipate that we will be able to invest all of the net proceeds in accordance with our investment objective and
policies within approximately three months of the receipt of such proceeds. Pending such investment, it is anticipated that the proceeds will be invested in short-term, tax-exempt or taxable investment grade
securities or in high quality, short-term money market instruments. Depending on market conditions and operations, a portion of the cash held by the Trust, including any proceeds raised from the offering, may be used to pay distributions in
accordance with the Trusts distribution policy and may be a return of capital. A return of capital is a return to investors of a portion of their original investment in the Trust. In general terms, a return of capital would involve a situation
in which a Trust distribution (or a portion thereof) represents a return of a portion of a shareholders investment in the Trust, rather than making a distribution that is funded from the Trusts earned income or other profits. Although
return of capital distributions may not be currently taxable, such distributions would decrease the basis of a shareholders shares, and therefore, may increase a shareholders tax liability for capital gains upon a sale of shares, even if
sold at a loss to the shareholders original investments.
CAPITALIZATION
The following table sets forth the unaudited capitalization of the Trust as of [●], 2025 and its adjusted capitalization assuming the common shares
available in the offering discussed in this Prospectus Supplement had been issued.
[To be provided.]
PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION
[To be provided.]
LEGAL MATTERS
Certain legal matters in connection with the common shares will be passed upon for the Trust by Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP, New York, New York,
counsel to the Trust. Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP may rely as to certain matters of Delaware law on the opinion of [●]. [Certain legal matters will be passed on by [●] as special counsel to the Underwriters in connection with
the offering.]
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus constitute part of a Registration Statement filed by the Trust with the SEC under the Securities
Act and the Investment Company Act. This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus omit certain of the information contained in the Registration Statement, and reference is hereby made to the Registration Statement and related exhibits
for further information with respect to the Trust and the common shares offered hereby. Any statements contained herein concerning the provisions of any document are not necessarily complete, and, in each instance, reference is made to the copy of
such document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement or otherwise filed with the SEC. Each such statement is qualified in its entirety by such reference. The complete Registration Statement may be obtained from the SEC upon payment of the
fee prescribed by its rules and regulations or free of charge through the SECs website (http://www.sec.gov).
S-7
BLACKROCK LIMITED DURATION
INCOME TRUST
[●] Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
[●], 2025
Until [●], 2025 (25 days after the date of this Prospectus Supplement), all dealers that buy, sell or trade the common shares, whether
or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to the dealers obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriters.
The information in this Prospectus Supplement is not complete and may be
changed. BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This Prospectus Supplement is not an offer to sell these securities and
is not soliciting offers to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.
SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED [●], 2025
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
(To Prospectus dated [●], 2025)
Filed Pursuant to Rule 424(b)([●])
Registration Statement No. 333-[●]
BLACKROCK LIMITED DURATION INCOME TRUST
[●] Rights for [●] Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
Issuable Upon the Exercise of
Transferable Rights to Acquire Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust (the Trust, we, us or our) is issuing subscription rights (the
Rights) to our common shareholders (the Common Shareholders) to subscribe for an aggregate of [●] common shares of beneficial interest (each, a Common Share and collectively, the Common Shares).
The Trust is a diversified, closed-end management investment company registered under the Investment Company Act
of 1940, as amended. The Trusts investment objective is to provide current income and capital appreciation. The Trusts investment adviser is BlackRock Advisors, LLC (the Advisor), and the Advisors affiliates, BlackRock
International Limited and BlackRock (Singapore) Limited, act as the Trusts sub-advisors.
The Common Shares
are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) under the symbol BLW. Common Shareholders of record on [●], 2025 (the Record Date) will receive [●] Right for each Common Share held. These Rights are
transferable and will allow the holders thereof to purchase additional Common Shares. The Rights will be listed for trading on the [●] under the symbol [●] during the course of the Rights offering.
The Rights entitle their holders to purchase [●] new Common Share for every [●] Rights held. Any Common Shareholder who owns fewer than [●]
Common Shares as of the close of business on the Record Date may subscribe for [●] full Common Share. Common Shareholders as of the close of business on the Record Date who fully exercise all Rights initially issued to them (other than those
Rights that cannot be exercised because they represent the right to acquire less than one Common Share) will be entitled to subscribe for additional Common Shares that remain unsubscribed as a result of any unexercised Rights. This over-subscription
privilege is subject to a number of limitations and subject to allotment.
The subscription price per Common Share (the Subscription Price)
will be determined based upon a formula equal to [●]% of the average of the last reported sales price of a Common Share on the NYSE on the date on which the Rights offering expires, as such date may be extended from time to time, and each of
the [● (●)] preceding trading days (the Formula Price). If, however, the Formula Price is less than [●]% of the net asset value (NAV) per Common Share at the close of trading on the NYSE on the
Expiration Date (as defined below), then the Subscription Price will be [●]% of the Trusts NAV per Common Share at the close of trading on the NYSE on the Expiration Date. All offering expenses, including sales commissions, will be borne
by the Advisor, and not the Trust or any Common Shareholders. The Rights offering will expire at 5:00 p.m., Eastern time, on [●], 2025, unless extended as described in this Prospectus Supplement (the Expiration Date).
R-1
On [●], 2025 (the last trading date prior to the Common Shares trading
ex-Rights), the last reported net asset value per share of the Common Shares was $[●] and the last reported sales price per share of Common Shares on the NYSE was $[●], representing a [premium] to
net asset value of [●]%.
This Prospectus Supplement, together with the accompanying Prospectus, sets forth concisely the information about the
Trust that a prospective investor should know before investing. You should read this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus, which contain important information, before deciding whether to invest in the Common Shares. You should
retain the accompanying Prospectus and this Prospectus Supplement for future reference. A Statement of Additional Information (SAI), dated [●], 2025, containing additional information about the Trust, has been filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and, as amended from time to time, is incorporated by reference in its entirety into this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus. This Prospectus Supplement, the accompanying
Prospectus and the SAI are part of a shelf registration statement filed with the SEC. This Prospectus Supplement describes the specific details regarding this offering, including the method of distribution. If information in this
Prospectus Supplement is inconsistent with the accompanying Prospectus or the SAI, you should rely on this Prospectus Supplement. You may call (800) 882-0052, visit the Trusts website
(http://www.blackrock.com) or write to the Trust to obtain, free of charge, copies of the SAI and the Trusts semi-annual and annual reports, as well as to obtain other information about the Trust or to make shareholder inquiries. The SAI, as
well as the Trusts semi-annual and annual reports, are also available for free on the SECs website (http://www.sec.gov). You may also e-mail requests for these documents to publicinfo@sec.gov.
Information contained in, or that can be accessed through, the Trusts website is not part of this Prospectus Supplement or the accompanying Prospectus. Common Shareholders please call toll-free at [●] (banks and brokers please call
[●]) or please send written requests to [●].
Investing in Common Shares through Rights involves certain risks, including risks of
leverage, that are described in the Special Characteristics and Risks of the Rights Offering section of this Prospectus Supplement.
SHAREHOLDERS WHO DO NOT FULLY EXERCISE THEIR RIGHTS MAY, AT THE COMPLETION OF THE RIGHTS OFFERING, OWN A SMALLER PROPORTIONAL INTEREST IN THE TRUST THAN IF
THEY EXERCISED THEIR RIGHTS. AS A RESULT OF THE RIGHTS OFFERING YOU MAY EXPERIENCE SUBSTANTIAL DILUTION OF THE AGGREGATE NET ASSET VALUE OF YOUR COMMON SHARES DEPENDING UPON WHETHER THE TRUSTS NET ASSET VALUE PER COMMON SHARE IS ABOVE OR BELOW
THE SUBSCRIPTION PRICE ON THE EXPIRATION DATE. RIGHTS EXERCISED BY A SHAREHOLDER ARE IRREVOCABLE.
THE TRUST HAS DECLARED MONTHLY DISTRIBUTIONS
PAYABLE ON [●], 2025 WITH A RECORD DATE OF [●], 2025. ANY COMMON SHARES ISSUED AS A RESULT OF THE RIGHTS OFFERING WILL NOT BE RECORD DATE SHARES FOR THE TRUSTS MONTHLY DISTRIBUTION TO BE PAID ON
[●], 2025 AND WILL NOT BE ENTITLED TO RECEIVE SUCH DISTRIBUTION.
NEITHER THE SEC NOR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION HAS
APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED THESE SECURITIES OR DETERMINED IF THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT IS TRUTHFUL OR COMPLETE. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Per Common Share |
|
Total(1) |
Estimated subscription price of Common Shares to shareholders exercising Rights(2) |
|
$ [●] |
|
$[●] |
Underwriting discounts and commissions |
|
$ [●] |
|
$[●] |
Estimated proceeds, before expenses, to the
Trust(3) (4) |
|
$ [●] |
|
$[●] |
(1) |
Assumes that all Rights are exercised at the estimated Subscription Price (as described below). All of the
Rights may not be exercised, and the estimated Subscription Price may be higher or lower than the actual Subscription Price. |
(2) |
The estimated Subscription Price to the public is based upon [●]% of the last reported sales price of the
Trusts Common Shares on the NYSE on [●], 2025 and each of the [● (●)] preceding trading days. See Terms of the Rights OfferingSubscription Price. |
R-2
(3) |
Before deduction of expenses related to the Rights offering, which are estimated approximately at $[●].
Any offering expenses are paid indirectly by shareholders. Such fees and expenses will immediately reduce the net asset value per share of each Common Share purchased by an investor in the Rights offering. The indirect expenses of the offering that
shareholders will pay are estimated to be $[●] in the aggregate and $[●] per share. The amount of proceeds to the Trust net of any fees and expenses of the offering are estimated to be $[●] in the aggregate and $[●] per
share. Shareholders will not directly bear any offering expenses. |
(4) |
Funds received by check prior to the final due date of the Rights offering will be deposited into a segregated
account pending proration and distribution of Common Shares. The Subscription Agent (as defined in this Prospectus Supplement) may receive investment earnings on the funds deposited into such account. |
The Common Shares are expected to be ready for delivery in book-entry form through the [insert depository name] on or about [●], 2025 [, unless
extended. If the offering is extended, the Common Shares are expected to be ready for delivery in book-entry form through the [●] on or about [●], 2025.]
You should not construe the contents of this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus as legal, tax or financial advice. You should consult with
your own professional advisors as to the legal, tax, financial or other matters relevant to the suitability of an investment in the Trust.
The
Trusts Common Shares do not represent a deposit or an obligation of, and are not guaranteed or endorsed by, any bank or other insured depository institution, and are not federally insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the
Federal Reserve Board or any other government agency.
The date of this Prospectus Supplement is [●], 2025.
R-3
You should rely only on the information contained or incorporated by reference in this Prospectus Supplement
and the accompanying Prospectus. The Trust has not authorized anyone to provide you with different information. The Trust is not making an offer to sell these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted. You should not
assume that the information contained in this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus is accurate as of any date other than the date of this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus, respectively. This Prospectus
Supplement will be amended to reflect material changes to the information contained herein and will be delivered to shareholders. Our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects may have changed since those dates. In this
Prospectus Supplement and in the accompanying Prospectus, unless otherwise indicated, Trust, us, our and we refer to BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust, a Delaware statutory trust.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Prospectus Supplement
Prospectus
R-4
CAUTIONARY NOTICE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
This Prospectus Supplement, the accompanying Prospectus and the SAI contain forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements can be
identified by the words may, will, intend, expect, estimate, continue, plan, anticipate, and similar terms and the negative of such terms. Such
forward-looking statements may be contained in this Prospectus Supplement as well as in the accompanying Prospectus and in the SAI. By their nature, all forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties, and actual results could differ
materially from those contemplated by the forward-looking statements. Several factors that could materially affect our actual results are the performance of the portfolio of securities we hold, the price at which our shares will trade in the public
markets and other factors discussed in our periodic filings with the SEC.
Although we believe that the expectations expressed in our forward-looking
statements are reasonable, actual results could differ materially from those projected or assumed in our forward-looking statements. Our future financial condition and results of operations, as well as any forward-looking statements, are subject to
change and are subject to inherent risks and uncertainties, such as those disclosed in the Risks section of the accompanying Prospectus and Special Characteristics and Risks of the Rights Offering in this Prospectus
Supplement. All forward-looking statements contained or incorporated by reference in this Prospectus Supplement or the accompanying Prospectus, or in the SAI, are made as of the date of this Prospectus Supplement or the accompanying Prospectus or
SAI, as the case may be. Except for our ongoing obligations under the federal securities laws, we do not intend, and we undertake no obligation, to update any forward-looking statement. The forward-looking statements contained in this Prospectus
Supplement, the accompanying Prospectus and the SAI are excluded from the safe harbor protection provided by Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the Securities Act).
Currently known risk factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from our expectations include, but are not limited to, the factors described
in the Risks section of the accompanying Prospectus as well as in the Special Characteristics and Risks of the Rights Offering section of this Prospectus Supplement. We urge you to review carefully those sections for a more
detailed discussion of the risks of an investment in the Common Shares.
R-5
SUMMARY OF THE TERMS OF THE RIGHTS OFFERING
Purpose of the Rights Offering |
[To come.] |
Terms of the Rights Offering |
[●] transferable subscription right (a Right) will be issued for each common share of the Trust (each, a Common Share, and collectively, the Common Shares) held on the Record Date (as defined below).
Rights are expected to trade on the [●] under the symbol [●]. The Rights will allow Common Shareholders to subscribe for new Common Shares of the Trust. [●] Common Shares of the Trust are outstanding as of [●],
2025. [●] Rights will be required to purchase one Common Share. Shares of the Trust, as a closed-end fund, can trade at a discount to net asset value (NAV). Upon exercise of the Rights
offering, Trust shares are expected to be issued at a price below NAV per Common Share. [An over-subscription privilege will be offered, [subject to the right of the Board of Trustees of the Trust (the Board) to eliminate the
over-subscription privilege.] [●] Common Shares of the Trust will be issued if all Rights are exercised. See Terms of the Rights Offering. |
|
The Trust has declared monthly distributions payable on [●], 2025 with a record date of [●], 2025. Any Common Shares issued as a result of the Rights offering will not be record date shares for the
Trusts monthly distribution to be paid on [●], 2025 and will not be entitled to receive such distribution. |
|
The exercise of Rights by a Rights holder is irrevocable. |
Title |
Subscription Rights to Acquire Common Shares of Beneficial Interest |
Subscription Price |
The final subscription price per Common Share (the Subscription Price) will be determined based upon a formula equal to [●]% of the average of the last reported sales price of the Trusts Common Shares on the New York
Stock Exchange (NYSE) on the Expiration Date (as defined below) and each of the [●] preceding trading days (the Formula Price). If, however, the Formula Price is less than [●]% of the NAV per Common Share of the
Trusts Common Shares at the close of trading on the NYSE on the Expiration Date, then the Subscription Price will be [●]% of the Trusts NAV per Common Share at the close of trading on the NYSE on that day. See Terms of the
Rights Offering. |
Record Date |
Rights will be issued to Common Shareholders of record as of the close of business on [●], 2025 (the Record Date). See Terms of the Rights Offering. |
Number of Rights Issued |
[●] Right will be issued in respect of each Common Share of the Trust outstanding as of the close of business on the Record Date. See Terms of the Rights Offering. |
|
|
|
Number of Rights Required to Purchase One Common Share |
|
A holder of Rights may purchase [●] Common Share of the Trust for every [●] Rights exercised. The number of Rights to be issued to a shareholder as of the close of business on the Record Date will be rounded up to the
nearest number of Rights evenly divisible by [●]. See Terms of the Rights Offering. |
R-6
Over-Subscription Privilege |
Common Shareholders as of the close of business on the Record Date (Record Date Shareholders) who fully exercise all Rights initially issued to them (other than those Rights that cannot be exercised because they represent the right
to acquire less than one Common Share) generally are entitled, subject to the limitations described herein, to buy those Common Shares, referred to as primary over-subscription shares, that were not purchased by other Rights holders at
the same Subscription Price. If enough primary over-subscription shares are available, all such requests will be honored in full. If the requests for primary over-subscription shares exceed the primary over-subscription shares available, the
available primary over-subscription shares will be allocated pro rata among those fully exercising Record Date Shareholders who over-subscribe based on the number of Rights originally issued to them by the Trust. Common Shares acquired pursuant to
the primary over-subscription privilege are subject to allotment. Holders of Rights acquired in the secondary market may not participate in the primary over-subscription privilege. |
|
[In addition, the Trust, in its sole discretion, may determine to issue additional Common Shares at the same Subscription Price in an amount of up to [●]% of the shares issued pursuant to the primary subscription,
referred to as secondary over-subscription shares. Should the Trust determine to issue some or all of the secondary over-subscription shares, they will be allocated only among Record Date Shareholders who submitted over-subscription
requests. Secondary over-subscription shares will be allocated pro rata among those fully exercising Record Date Shareholders who over-subscribe based on the number of Rights originally issued to them by the Trust. Rights acquired in the
secondary market may not participate in the secondary over-subscription privilege.] |
|
Notwithstanding the above, the Board has the right in its absolute discretion to eliminate the primary over-subscription privilege and/or secondary over-subscription privilege (together, the over-subscription
privilege) if it considers it to be in the best interest of the Trust to do so. The Board may make that determination at any time, without prior notice to Rights holders or others, up to and including the fifth day following the Expiration
Date (as defined below). See Over-Subscription Privilege. |
|
Any Common Shares issued pursuant to the over-subscription privilege will be shares registered under the Prospectus. |
Transfer of Rights |
The Rights will be transferable. See Terms of the Rights Offering, Sale of Rights and Method of Transferring Rights. |
Subscription Period |
The Rights may be exercised at any time after issuance and prior to expiration of the Rights (the Subscription Period), which will be [5:00 PM Eastern Time] on [●], 2025 (the Expiration Date), unless otherwise
extended. See Terms of the Rights Offering and Method of Exercise of Rights. The Rights offering may be terminated [or extended] by the Trust at any time for any reason before the Expiration Date. If the Trust terminates the
Rights offering, the Trust will issue a press release announcing such termination and will direct the Subscription Agent (defined below) to return, without interest, all |
R-7
subscription proceeds received to such shareholders who had elected to purchase Common Shares.
Distribution Arrangements |
[●] |
Offering Expenses |
The expenses of the Rights offering are expected to be approximately $[●] and will be borne by holders of the Trusts Common Shares. See Use of Proceeds. |
Sale of Rights |
The Rights are transferable until the completion of the Subscription Period and will be admitted for trading on the [●] under the symbol [●]. Although no assurance can be given that a market for the Rights will develop,
trading in the Rights on the [●] is expected to begin two Business Days prior to the Record Date and may be conducted until the close of trading on the last [●] trading day prior to the Expiration Date. For purposes of this Prospectus
Supplement, a Business Day shall mean any day on which trading is conducted on the [●]. |
|
The value of the Rights, if any, will be reflected by their market price on the [●]. Rights may be sold by individual holders through their broker or financial advisor or may be submitted to the Subscription Agent (defined below) for sale.
Any Rights submitted to the Subscription Agent for sale must be received by the Subscription Agent prior to [5:00 PM, Eastern Time], on or before [●], 2025, [●] Business Days prior to the Expiration Date (or, if the Subscription Period
is extended, prior to [5:00 PM, Eastern Time], on the [●] Business Day prior to the extended Expiration Date). |
|
Rights that are sold will not confer any right to acquire any Common Shares in any over-subscription, and any Record Date Shareholder who sells any Rights will not be eligible to participate in the over-subscription privilege, if any.
|
|
Trading of the Rights on the [●] will be conducted on a when-issued basis until and including the date on which the Subscription Certificates (as defined below) are mailed to Record Date Shareholders of record and thereafter will be
conducted on a regular-way basis until and including the last [●] trading day prior to the completion of the Subscription Period. The shares are expected to begin trading
ex-Rights one Business Day prior to the Record Date. |
|
If the Subscription Agent receives Rights for sale in a timely manner, the Subscription Agent will use its best efforts to sell the Rights on the [●]. The Subscription Agent will also attempt to sell any Rights attributable to shareholders
of record whose addresses are outside the United States, or who have an APO or FPO address. See Foreign Restrictions. The Subscription Agent will attempt to sell such Rights, including by first offering such Rights to the Dealer Manager
(defined below) for purchase by the Dealer Manager at the then-current market price on the [●]. The Subscription Agent will offer Rights to the Dealer Manager before attempting to sell them on the [●]. |
|
Any commissions will be paid by the selling Rights holders. Neither the Trust nor the Subscription Agent will be responsible if Rights cannot be sold and neither has guaranteed any minimum sales price for the Rights. If the Rights can be sold,
sales of these Rights will be deemed to have |
R-8
been effected at the weighted average price received by the Subscription Agent on the day such
Rights are sold, less any applicable brokerage commissions, taxes and other expenses (i.e., costs incidental to the sale of Rights).
|
For a discussion of actions that may be taken by [●] (the Dealer Manager) to seek to facilitate the trading market for Rights and the placement of Common Shares pursuant to the exercise of Rights, including the purchase of
Rights and the sale during the Subscription Period by the Dealer Manager of Common Shares acquired through the exercise of Rights and the terms on which such sales will be made, see Plan of Distribution. |
|
Shareholders are urged to obtain a recent trading price for the Rights on the [●] from their broker, bank, financial advisor or the financial press. |
|
Banks, broker-dealers and trust companies that hold shares for the accounts of others are advised to notify those persons that purchase Rights in the secondary market that such Rights will not participate in any over-subscription privilege. See
Terms of the Rights Offering. |
Use of Proceeds |
The Trust estimates the net proceeds of the Rights offering to be approximately $[●]. This figure is based on the Subscription Price per Common Share of $[●] ([●]% of the last reported sales price of the Trusts Common
Shares on the NYSE on [●], 2025 and each of the [● (●)] preceding trading days) and assumes all new Common Shares offered are sold and that the expenses related to the Rights offering estimated at approximately $[●] are paid.
|
|
The Advisor anticipates that investment of the proceeds will be made in accordance with the Trusts investment objective and policies as appropriate investment opportunities are identified, which is expected to be substantially completed in
approximately [three] months; however, the identification of appropriate investment opportunities pursuant to the Trusts investment style or changes in market conditions may cause the investment period to extend as long as [six] months.
Pending such investment, the proceeds will be held in [short-term, tax-exempt or taxable investment grade securities or in high quality, short-term money market instruments]. |
|
Depending on market conditions and operations, a portion of the cash held by the Trust, including any proceeds raised from the offering, may be used to pay distributions in accordance with the Trusts distribution policy and may be a return
of capital. A return of capital is a return to investors of a portion of their original investment in the Trust. In general terms, a return of capital would involve a situation in which a Trust distribution (or a portion thereof) represents a return
of a portion of a shareholders investment in the Trust, rather than making a distribution that is funded from the Trusts earned income or other profits. Although return of capital distributions may not be currently taxable, such
distributions would decrease the basis of a shareholders shares, and therefore, may increase a shareholders tax liability for capital gains upon a sale of shares, even if sold at a loss to the shareholders original investments. See
Use of Proceeds. |
R-9
Taxation/ERISA |
See Taxation and Employee Benefit Plan and IRA Considerations. |
Subscription Agent |
[●]. See Subscription Agent. |
Information Agent |
[●]. See Information Agent. |
DESCRIPTION OF THE RIGHTS OFFERING
Terms of the Rights Offering
The Trust is
issuing to Record Date Shareholders Rights to subscribe for Common Shares of the Trust. Each Record Date Shareholder is being issued one transferable Right for each Common Share owned on the Record Date. The Rights entitle the holder to acquire, at
a subscription price per Common Share (the Subscription Price) determined based upon a formula equal to [●]% of the average of the last reported sales price of the Trusts Common Shares on the NYSE on the Expiration Date (as
defined below) and each of the [●] preceding trading days (the Formula Price), [●] new Common Share for each [●] Rights held. If, however, the Formula Price is less than [●]% of the NAV per share of the
Trusts Common Shares at the close of trading on the NYSE on the Expiration Date, then the Subscription Price will be [●]% of the Trusts NAV per Common Share at the close of trading on the NYSE on that day.
The estimated Subscription Price to the public of $[●] is based upon [●]% of the last reported sales price of the Trusts Common Shares on
the NYSE on [●], 2025. Fractional shares will not be issued upon the exercise of the Rights. Accordingly, Common Shares may be purchased only pursuant to the exercise of Rights in integral multiples of [●]. The number of Rights to be
issued to a Record Date Shareholder will be rounded up to the nearest number of Rights evenly divisible by [●]. In the case of Common Shares held of record by Cede & Co. (Cede), as nominee for the Depository Trust Company
(DTC), or any other depository or nominee, the number of Rights issued to Cede or such other depository or nominee will be adjusted to permit rounding up (to the nearest number of Rights evenly divisible by [●]) of the Rights to be
received by beneficial owners for whom it is the holder of record only if [insert nominee name] or such other depository or nominee provides to the Trust on or before the close of business on [●], 2025 written representation of the number of
Rights required for such rounding. Rights may be exercised at any time during the period (the Subscription Period) which commences on [●], 2025, and ends at [5:00 PM Eastern Time] on [●], 2025 (the Expiration
Date), unless otherwise extended. Shares of the Trust, as a closed-end fund, can trade at a discount to NAV. Upon exercise of the Rights offering, Trust shares may be issued at a price below NAV per
Common Share. The right to acquire one Common Share for each [●] Rights held during the Subscription Period (or any extension of the Subscription Period) at the Subscription Price will be referred to in the remainder of this Prospectus
Supplement as the Rights offering. Rights will expire on the Expiration Date and thereafter may not be exercised.
The Trust has
declared monthly distributions payable on [●], 2025 with a record date of [●], 2025. Any Common Shares issued as a result of the Rights offering will not be Record Date shares for the Trusts monthly distribution to be paid on
[●], 2025 and will not be entitled to receive such distribution.
The Trust has entered into a dealer manager agreement with
[●] (the Dealer Manager) that allows the Dealer Manager to take actions to seek to facilitate the trading market for Rights and the placement of Common Shares pursuant to the exercise of Rights. Those actions are expected to
involve the Dealer Manager purchasing and exercising Rights during the Subscription Period at prices determined at the time of such exercise, which are expected to vary from the Subscription Price. See Plan of Distribution for additional
information.
Rights may be evidenced by subscription certificates or may be uncertificated and evidenced by other appropriate documentation (i.e.,
a rights card distributed to registered shareholders in lieu of a subscription certificate) (Subscription Certificates). The number of Rights issued to each holder will be stated on the Subscription Certificate delivered to the holder.
The method by which Rights may be exercised and Common Shares paid for is set forth below in Method of Exercise of Rights, Payment for Shares and Plan of Distribution. A holder of Rights will have no right to
rescind a purchase after [●] (the Subscription Agent) has received payment. See
R-10
Payment for Shares below. It is anticipated that the Common Shares issued pursuant to an exercise of Rights will be listed on the [●].
[Holders of Rights [who are Record Date Shareholders] are entitled to subscribe for additional Common Shares at the same Subscription Price pursuant to the
over-subscription privilege, subject to certain limitations, allotment and the right of the Board to eliminate the primary over-subscription privilege [or secondary] over-subscription privilege. See Over-Subscription Privilege below.]
For purposes of determining the maximum number of Common Shares that may be acquired pursuant to the Rights offering, broker-dealers, trust companies,
banks or others whose shares are held of record by Cede or by any other depository or nominee will be deemed to be the holders of the Rights that are held by Cede or such other depository or nominee on their behalf.
The Rights are transferable until the completion of the Subscription Period and will be admitted for trading on the [●] under the symbol
[●]. Assuming a market exists for the Rights, the Rights may be purchased and sold through usual brokerage channels and also sold through the Subscription Agent. Although no assurance can be given that a market for the Rights will
develop, trading in the Rights on the [●] is expected to begin two Business Days prior to the Record Date and may be conducted until the close of trading on the last [●] trading day prior to the Expiration Date. Trading of the Rights on
the [●] is expected to be conducted on a when-issued basis until and including the date on which the Subscription Certificates are mailed to Record Date Shareholders of record and thereafter is expected to be conducted on a regular way basis
until and including the last [●] trading day prior to the Expiration Date. The method by which Rights may be transferred is set forth below under Method of Transferring Rights. The Common Shares are expected to begin trading ex-Rights one Business Day prior to the Record Date as determined and announced by the [●]. The Rights offering may be terminated or extended by the Trust at any time for any reason before the Expiration Date.
If the Trust terminates the Rights offering, the Trust will issue a press release announcing such termination and will direct the Subscription Agent to return, without interest, all subscription proceeds received to such shareholders who had elected
to purchase Common Shares.
Nominees who hold the Trusts Common Shares for the account of others, such as banks, broker-dealers, trustees or
depositories for securities, should notify the respective beneficial owners of such shares as soon as possible to ascertain such beneficial owners intentions and to obtain instructions with respect to the Rights. If the beneficial owner so
instructs, the nominee should complete the Subscription Certificate and submit it to the Subscription Agent with proper payment. In addition, beneficial owners of the Common Shares or Rights held through such a nominee should contact the nominee and
request the nominee to effect transactions in accordance with such beneficial owners instructions.
[Participants in the Trusts Dividend
Reinvestment Plan (the Plan) will be issued Rights in respect of the Common Shares held in their accounts in the Plan. Participants wishing to exercise these Rights must exercise the Rights in accordance with the procedures set forth in
Method of Exercise of Rights and Payment for Shares.]
Conditions of the Rights Offering
The Rights offering is being made in accordance with the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the Investment Company Act), without
shareholder approval. The staff of the SEC has interpreted the Investment Company Act as not requiring shareholder approval of a transferable rights offering to purchase common shares at a price below the then current NAV so long as certain
conditions are met, including: (i) a good faith determination by a funds board that such offering would result in a net benefit to existing shareholders; (ii) the offering fully protects shareholders preemptive rights and does
not discriminate among shareholders (except for the possible effect of not offering fractional rights); (iii) management uses its best efforts to ensure an adequate trading market in the rights for use by shareholders who do not exercise such
rights; and (iv) the ratio of a transferable rights offering does not exceed one new share for each three rights held.
Important Dates to
Remember
[Please note that the dates in the table below may change if the Rights offering is extended.]
R-11
|
|
|
|
|
Event |
|
|
|
Date |
Record Date |
|
|
|
[●], 2025 |
Subscription Period |
|
|
|
[●], 2025 through [●], 2025 |
Final Date Rights Will Trade |
|
|
|
|
Expiration Date* |
|
|
|
[●], 2025 |
Payment for Common Shares and Subscription Certificate or Notice of Guaranteed Delivery
Due* |
|
|
|
[●], 2025 |
Issuance Date |
|
|
|
[●], 2025 |
Confirmation Date |
|
|
|
[●], 2025 |
* |
A shareholder exercising Rights must deliver to the Subscription Agent by [5:00 PM Eastern Time] on [●],
2025 (unless the Rights offering is extended) either (a) a Subscription Certificate and payment for Common Shares or (b) a notice of guaranteed delivery and payment for Common Shares. |
|
Unless the Rights offering is extended. |
[Over-Subscription Privilege
Rights holders [who are
Record Date Shareholders and who fully exercise all Rights initially issued to them (other than those Rights that cannot be exercised because they represent the right to acquire less than one Common Share)] are entitled to subscribe for additional
Common Shares at the same Subscription Price pursuant to the over-subscription privilege, subject to certain limitations and subject to allotment. The Board has the right in its absolute discretion to eliminate the over-subscription privilege with
respect to primary over-subscription shares and secondary over-subscription shares if it considers it to be in the best interest of the Trust to do so. The Board may make that determination at any time, without prior notice to Rights holders or
others, up to and including the fifth day following the Expiration Date. If the primary over-subscription privilege is not eliminated, it will operate as set forth below.
[Record Date Shareholders who fully exercise all Rights initially issued to them (other than those Rights that cannot be exercised because they represent the
right to acquire less than one Common Share)] are entitled to buy those Common Shares, referred to as primary over-subscription shares, that were not purchased by other holders of Rights at the same Subscription Price. If enough primary
over-subscription shares are available, all such requests will be honored in full. If the requests for primary over-subscription shares exceed the primary over-subscription shares available, the available primary over-subscription shares will be
allocated pro rata among those fully exercising [Record Date Shareholders] who over-subscribe based on the number of Rights originally issued to them by the Trust. Common Shares acquired pursuant to the over-subscription privilege are subject
to allotment.
[In addition, the Trust, in its sole discretion, may determine to issue additional Common Shares at the same Subscription Price in
an amount of up to [●]% of the shares issued pursuant to the primary subscription, referred to as secondary over-subscription shares. Should the Trust determine to issue some or all of the secondary over-subscription shares, they
will be allocated only among Record Date Shareholders who submitted over-subscription requests. Secondary over-subscription shares will be allocated pro rata among those fully exercising Record Date Shareholders who over-subscribe based on the
number of Rights originally issued to them by the Trust. Holders of Rights acquired in the secondary market may not participate in the over-subscription privilege. In the event that the Subscription Price is lower than the
Trusts NAV per share, any secondary over-subscription shares issued by the Trust will not result in the ratio of the Rights offering exceeding one new share for each three Rights.]
Record Date Shareholders who are fully exercising their Rights during the Subscription Period should indicate, on the Subscription Certificate that they
submit with respect to the exercise of the Rights issued to them, how many Common Shares they are willing to acquire pursuant to the over-subscription privilege.
To the extent sufficient Common Shares are not available to fulfill all over-subscription requests, unsubscribed Common Shares (the Excess Shares)
will be allocated pro rata among those Record Date Shareholders who over-subscribe based on the number of Rights issued to them by the Trust. The allocation process may involve a series of allocations in order to assure that the total number of
Common Shares available for over-subscriptions is distributed on a pro rata basis.
R-12
The formula to be used in allocating the Excess Shares is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
Shareholders Record
Date Position |
|
X |
|
Excess Shares Remaining |
Total Record Date Position of All Over-Subscribers |
Banks, broker-dealers, trustees and other nominee holders of Rights will be required to certify to the Subscription Agent,
before any over-subscription privilege may be exercised with respect to any particular beneficial owner, as to the aggregate number of Rights exercised during the Subscription Period and the number of Common Shares subscribed for pursuant to the
over-subscription privilege by such beneficial owner and that such beneficial owners subscription was exercised in full. Nominee holder over-subscription forms and beneficial owner certification forms will be distributed to banks,
broker-dealers, trustees and other nominee holders of Rights with the Subscription Certificates. [Nominees should also notify holders purchasing Rights in the secondary market that such Rights may not participate in the over-subscription privilege.]
The Trust will not otherwise offer or sell any Common Shares that are not subscribed for pursuant to the primary subscription, the primary
over-subscription privilege or the secondary over-subscription privilege pursuant to the Rights offering.]
[Dealer Manager
[●] (previously defined as the Dealer Manager), a registered broker-dealer, may also act on behalf of its clients to purchase or sell Rights
in the open market and may receive commissions from its clients for such services. Holders of Rights attempting to sell any unexercised Rights in the open market through a broker-dealer other than the Dealer Manager may be charged a different
commission and should consider the commissions and fees charged by the broker-dealer prior to selling their Rights on the open market. The Dealer Manager is not expected to purchase Rights as principal for its own account in order to seek to
facilitate the trading market for Rights or otherwise. See Plan of Distribution for additional information.]
Sale of Rights
The Rights are transferable and will be admitted for trading on the [●] under the symbol [●]. Although no assurance can be given that
a market for the Rights will develop, trading in the Rights on the [●] is expected to begin two Business Days prior to the Record Date and may be conducted until the close of trading on the last [●] trading day prior to the Expiration
Date.
The value of the Rights, if any, will be reflected by the market price. Rights may be sold by individual holders through their broker or other
financial intermediary. Holders of Rights attempting to sell any unexercised Rights in the open market through their broker or financial advisor may be charged a commission or incur other transaction expenses and should consider the commissions and
fees charged prior to selling their Rights on the open market.
[Rights that are sold will not confer any right to acquire any Common Shares in any
primary over-subscription privilege or secondary over-subscription privilege, if any, and any Record Date Shareholder who sells any Rights will not be eligible to participate in the primary over-subscription privilege or secondary over-subscription
privilege, if any.]
Trading of the Rights on the [●] will be conducted on a when-issued basis until and including the date on which the
Subscription Certificates are mailed to Record Date Shareholders of record and thereafter will be conducted on a regular-way basis until and including the last [●] trading day prior to the Expiration
Date. The Common Shares are expected to begin trading ex-Rights one Business Day prior to the Record Date.
Shareholders are urged to obtain a recent trading price for the Rights on the [] from their broker, bank, financial advisor or the financial press.
R-13
Holders of Rights who are unable or do not wish to exercise any or all of their Rights may contact the
Subscription Agent to facilitate the sale of any unexercised Rights. The Subscription Agent will contact the Dealer Manager or other brokers in order to assist Rights holders whose Rights are not currently held at a broker-dealer or other applicable
financial intermediary to facilitate the sale of the Rights. Shareholders of record whose addresses are outside the United States, or who have an APO or FPO address, are encouraged to contact the Subscription Agent to facilitate the sale of their
Rights if they are otherwise unable or unwilling to exercise the Rights. The selling Rights holder will pay all applicable brokerage commissions incurred. There can be no assurance that the Subscription Agent will be able to facilitate the sale of
any of Rights and neither the Trust nor the Subscription Agent has guaranteed any minimum sales price for the Rights.
Method of Transferring Rights
The Rights evidenced by a single Subscription Certificate may be transferred in whole by endorsing the Subscription Certificate for transfer in
accordance with the accompanying instructions. A portion of the Rights evidenced by a single Subscription Certificate (but not fractional Rights) may be transferred by delivering to the Subscription Agent a Subscription Certificate properly endorsed
for transfer, with instructions to register the portion of the Rights evidenced thereby in the name of the transferee (and to issue a new Subscription Certificate to the transferee evidencing the transferred Rights). In this event, a new
Subscription Certificate evidencing the balance of the Rights will be issued to the Rights holder or, if the Rights holder so instructs, to an additional transferee.
Holders wishing to transfer all or a portion of their Rights (but not fractional Rights) should promptly transfer such Rights to ensure that: (i) the
transfer instructions will be received and processed by the Subscription Agent, (ii) a new Subscription Certificate will be issued and transmitted to the transferee or transferees with respect to transferred Rights, and to the holder with
respect to retained Rights, if any, and (iii) the Rights evidenced by the new Subscription Certificates may be exercised or sold by the recipients thereof prior to the Expiration Date. Neither the Trust nor the Subscription Agent shall have any
liability to a transferee or holder of Rights if Subscription Certificates are not received in time for exercise or sale prior to the Expiration Date.
Except for the fees charged by the Subscription Agent (which will be paid by the Trust as described below), all commissions, fees and other expenses
(including brokerage commissions and transfer taxes) incurred in connection with the purchase, sale, transfer or exercise of Rights will be for the account of the holder of the Rights, and none of these commissions, fees or expenses will be borne by
the Trust or the Subscription Agent.
The Trust anticipates that the Rights will be eligible for transfer through, and that the exercise of the Rights may
be effected through, the facilities of [insert depository] (Rights exercised through [insert depository] are referred to as [insert depository] Exercised Rights).
Subscription Agent
The Subscription Agent is [●].
The Subscription Agent will receive from the Trust an amount estimated to be $[●], comprised of the fee for its services and the reimbursement for certain expenses related to the Rights offering. The shareholders of the Trust will indirectly
pay such amount.
Information Agent
INQUIRIES BY
ALL HOLDERS OF RIGHTS SHOULD BE DIRECTED TO: THE INFORMATION AGENT, [●]; HOLDERS PLEASE CALL TOLL-FREE AT [●]; BANKS AND BROKERS PLEASE CALL [●].
Method of Exercise of Rights
Rights may be exercised by
completing and signing the Subscription Certificate and delivering the completed and signed Subscription Certificate to the Subscription Agent, together with payment for the Common Shares as described below under Payment for Shares.
Rights may also be exercised through the broker of a holder of Rights, who may charge the holder of Rights a servicing fee in connection with such exercise. See Plan of Distribution for additional information regarding the purchase and
exercise of Rights by the Dealer Manager.
R-14
Completed Subscription Certificates and payment must be received by the Subscription Agent prior to [5:00 PM
Eastern Time], on the Expiration Date (unless payment is effected by means of a notice of guaranteed delivery as described below under Payment for Shares). Your broker, bank, trust company or other intermediary may impose a deadline for
exercising Rights earlier than [5:00 PM, Eastern Time], on the Expiration Date. The Subscription Certificate and payment should be delivered to the Subscription Agent at the following address:
If By Mail:
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust
[●]
If By Overnight Courier:
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust
[●]
Payment for Shares
Holders of Rights who acquire Common
Shares in the Rights offering may choose between the following methods of payment:
|
(1) |
A holder of Rights can send the Subscription Certificate, together with payment in the form of a check (which
must include the name of the shareholder on the check) for the Common Shares subscribed for in the Rights offering and, if eligible, for any additional Common Shares subscribed for pursuant to the over-subscription privilege, to the Subscription
Agent based on the Subscription Price. To be accepted, the payment, together with the executed Subscription Certificate, must be received by the Subscription Agent at one of the addresses noted above prior to [5:00 PM Eastern Time] on the Expiration
Date. The Subscription Agent will deposit all share purchase checks received by it prior to the final due date into a segregated account pending proration and distribution of Common Shares. The Subscription Agent will not accept cash as a means of
payment for Common Shares. |
|
(2) |
Alternatively, a subscription will be accepted by the Subscription Agent if, prior to [5:00 PM Eastern Time] on
the Expiration Date, the Subscription Agent has received a written notice of guaranteed delivery by mail or email from a bank, trust company, or a NYSE member, guaranteeing delivery of a properly completed and executed Subscription Certificate. In
order for the notice of guarantee to be valid, full payment for the Common Shares at the Subscription Price must be received with the notice. The Subscription Agent will not honor a notice of guaranteed delivery unless a properly completed and
executed Subscription Certificate is received by the Subscription Agent by the close of business on the [second] Business Day after the Expiration Date. The notice of guaranteed delivery must be emailed to the Subscription Agent at [●] or
delivered to the Subscription Agent at one of the addresses noted above. |
A PAYMENT PURSUANT TO THIS METHOD MUST BE IN UNITED STATES
DOLLARS BY CHECK (WHICH MUST INCLUDE THE NAME OF THE SHAREHOLDER ON THE CHECK) DRAWN ON A BANK LOCATED IN THE CONTINENTAL UNITED STATES, MUST BE PAYABLE TO BLACKROCK LIMITED DURATION INCOME TRUST AND MUST ACCOMPANY AN EXECUTED SUBSCRIPTION
CERTIFICATE TO BE ACCEPTED.
The method and timing of payment for Common Shares acquired by the Dealer Manager through the exercise of Rights is described
under Plan of Distribution.
If a holder of Rights who acquires Common Shares pursuant to the subscription makes payment of an insufficient
amount, the Trust reserves the right to take any or all of the following actions: (i) reallocate such subscribed and unpaid-for Common Shares to Record Date Shareholders exercising the over-subscription
privilege who did not
R-15
receive the full over-subscription requested; (ii) apply any payment actually received by it toward the purchase of the greatest whole number of Common Shares which could be acquired by such
holder upon exercise of the Rights or any over-subscription privilege; and (iii) exercise any and all other rights or remedies to which it may be entitled, including, without limitation, the right to set off against payments actually received
by it with respect to such subscribed Common Shares (in other words, retain such payments) and to enforce the exercising Rights holders relevant payment obligation.
Any payment required from a holder of Rights must be received by the Subscription Agent prior to [5:00 PM Eastern Time] on the Expiration Date. Issuance and
delivery of the Common Shares purchased are subject to collection of checks.
Within [●] Business Days following the Expiration Date (the
Confirmation Date), a confirmation will be sent by the Subscription Agent to each holder of Rights (or, if the Common Shares are held by [insert nominee name] or any other depository or nominee, to [insert nominee name] or such other
depository or nominee), showing (i) the number of Common Shares acquired pursuant to the subscription, (ii) the number of Common Shares, if any, acquired pursuant to the over-subscription privilege, and (iii) the per share and total
purchase price for the Common Shares. Any payment required from a holder of Rights must be received by the Subscription Agent on or prior to the Expiration Date. Any excess payment to be refunded by the Trust to a holder of Rights, or to be paid to
a holder of Rights as a result of sales of Rights on its behalf by the Subscription Agent, will be mailed by the Subscription Agent to the holder within [●] Business Days after the Expiration Date.
A holder of Rights will have no right to rescind a purchase after the Subscription Agent has received payment either by means of a notice of guaranteed
delivery or a check, which must include the name of the shareholder on the check.
Upon acceptance of a subscription, all funds received by the
Subscription Agent shall be held by the Subscription Agent as agent for the Trust and deposited in one or more bank accounts. Such funds may be invested by the Subscription Agent in: bank accounts, short-term certificates of deposit, bank repurchase
agreements, and disbursement accounts with commercial banks meeting certain standards. The Subscription Agent may receive interest, dividends or other earnings in connection with such deposits or investments.
Holders, such as broker-dealers, trustees or depositories for securities, who hold Common Shares for the account of others, should notify the respective
beneficial owners of the Common Shares as soon as possible to ascertain such beneficial owners intentions and to obtain instructions with respect to the Rights. If the beneficial owner so instructs, the record holder of the Rights should
complete Subscription Certificates and submit them to the Subscription Agent with the proper payment. In addition, beneficial owners of Common Shares or Rights held through such a holder should contact the holder and request that the holder effect
transactions in accordance with the beneficial owners instructions. [Banks, broker-dealers, trustees and other nominee holders that hold Common Shares of the Trust for the accounts of others are advised to notify those persons that purchase
Rights in the secondary market that such Rights may not participate in any over-subscription privilege offered.]
THE INSTRUCTIONS ACCOMPANYING THE
SUBSCRIPTION CERTIFICATES SHOULD BE READ CAREFULLY AND FOLLOWED IN DETAIL. DO NOT SEND SUBSCRIPTION CERTIFICATES TO THE TRUST.
THE METHOD OF DELIVERY OF
SUBSCRIPTION CERTIFICATES AND PAYMENT OF THE SUBSCRIPTION PRICE TO THE SUBSCRIPTION AGENT WILL BE AT THE ELECTION AND RISK OF THE RIGHTS HOLDERS, BUT IF SENT BY MAIL IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE CERTIFICATES AND PAYMENTS BE SENT BY REGISTERED MAIL,
PROPERLY INSURED, WITH RETURN RECEIPT REQUESTED, AND THAT A SUFFICIENT NUMBER OF DAYS BE ALLOWED TO ENSURE DELIVERY TO THE SUBSCRIPTION AGENT AND CLEARANCE OF PAYMENT PRIOR TO [5:00 PM EASTERN TIME], ON THE EXPIRATION DATE BECAUSE UNCERTIFIED
PERSONAL CHECKS MAY TAKE AT LEAST FIVE BUSINESS DAYS TO CLEAR.
All questions concerning the timeliness, validity, form and eligibility of any exercise of
Rights will be determined by the Trust, whose determinations will be final and binding. The Trust in its sole discretion may waive any defect
R-16
or irregularity, or permit a defect or irregularity to be corrected within such time as it may determine, or reject the purported exercise of any Right. Subscriptions will not be deemed to have
been received or accepted until all irregularities have been waived or cured within such time as the Trust determines in its sole discretion. Neither the Trust nor the Subscription Agent will be under any duty to give notification of any defect or
irregularity in connection with the submission of Subscription Certificates or incur any liability for failure to give such notification.
Foreign
Restrictions
Offering documents, including Subscription Certificates, will not be mailed to Record Date Shareholders whose addresses are outside the
United States (for these purposes, the United States includes the District of Columbia and the territories and possessions of the United States) or who have an APO or FPO address (the Foreign Shareholders) if such mailing cannot be made
into the non-U.S. jurisdiction without additional registration and incurring other expense that the Board has determined is not in the best interest of the Trust and its shareholders. In such cases, unless
determined to be not in the best interest of the Trust and its shareholders in accordance with the previous sentence, the Subscription Agent will send a letter via regular mail to Foreign Shareholders who own Common Shares directly (Direct
Foreign Shareholders), as opposed to in street name with a broker or other financial intermediary, to notify them of the Rights offering. Direct Foreign Shareholders who wish to exercise their Rights should contact the Information
Agent, as described above under Information Agent, to facilitate the exercise of such Rights and for instructions or any other special requirements that may apply in order for such Direct Foreign Shareholder to exercise its Rights.
Direct Foreign Shareholders who wish to sell their Rights should contact the Subscription Agent and follow the procedures described above under Sale of Rights. Direct Foreign Shareholders are encouraged to contact the Trust or the
Subscription Agent as far in advance of the Expiration Date as possible to ensure adequate time for their Rights to be exercised or sold. Foreign Shareholders who own Common Shares in street name through a broker or other financial
intermediary should contact such broker or other financial intermediary with respect to any exercise or sale of Rights.
Employee Benefit Plan and IRA
Considerations
[Holders of Rights that are employee benefit plans subject to limitations imposed by the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
(the Code), such as employee plans subject to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (ERISA), Keogh Plans and Individual Retirement Accounts (IRA) (each a Benefit Plan and
collectively, Benefit Plans), should be aware that the use of additional contributions of cash outside of the Benefit Plan to exercise Rights may be treated as additional contributions to the Benefit Plan. When taken together with
contributions previously made, such deemed additional contributions may be in excess of tax limitations and subject the Rights holder to excise taxes for excess or nondeductible contributions. In the case of Benefit Plans qualified under
Section 401(a) of the Code, additional contributions could cause the maximum contribution limitations of Section 415 of the Code or other qualification rules to be violated. Benefit Plans contemplating making additional contributions to
exercise Rights should consult with their legal and tax counsel prior to making such contributions.
Benefit Plans and other tax exempt entities,
including governmental plans, should also be aware that if they borrow to finance their exercise of Rights, they may become subject to the tax on unrelated business taxable income (UBTI) under Section 511 of the Code. If any portion
of an IRA is used as security for a loan, the portion so used may also be treated as distributed to the IRA depositor.
A Benefit Plan may also be subject
to laws, such as ERISA, that impose certain requirements on the Benefit Plan and on those persons who are fiduciaries with respect to the Benefit Plans. Such requirements may include prudence and diversification requirements and require that
investments be made in accordance with the documents governing the fiduciary. The exercise of Rights by a fiduciary for a Benefit Plan should be considered in light of such fiduciary requirements.
In addition, ERISA and the Code prohibit certain transactions involving the assets of a Benefit Plan and certain persons (referred to as parties in
interest for purposes of ERISA and disqualified persons for purposes of the Code) having certain relationships to such Benefit Plans, unless a statutory or administrative exemption is applicable to the transaction. A party in
interest or disqualified person who engages in a nonexempt prohibited transaction may be subject to excise taxes and other penalties and liabilities under ERISA and the Code (or with respect to certain Benefit Plans, such as IRAs, a prohibited
transaction may cause the Benefit Plan to lose its tax-exempt status). In
R-17
this regard, the U.S. Department of Labor has issued prohibited transaction class exemptions (PTCEs) that may apply to the exercise of the Rights and holding of the Common Shares.
These class exemptions include, without limitation, PTCE 84-14 respecting transactions determined by independent qualified professional asset managers, PTCE 90-1
respecting insurance company pooled separate accounts, PTCE 91-38 respecting bank collective investment funds, PTCE 95-60 respecting life insurance company general
accounts and PTCE 96-23 respecting transactions determined by in-house asset managers, PTCE 84-24 governing purchases of shares
in investment companies) and PTCE 75-1 respecting sales of securities. In addition, Section 408(b)(17) of ERISA and Section 4975(d)(20) of the Code each provides a limited exemption, commonly
referred to as the service provider exemption, from the prohibited transaction provisions of ERISA and Section 4975 of the Code for certain transactions between a Benefit Plan and a person that is a party in interest and/or a
disqualified person (other than a fiduciary or an affiliate that, directly or indirectly, has or exercises any discretionary authority or control or renders any investment advice with respect to the assets of any Benefit Plan involved in the
transaction) solely by reason of providing services to the Benefit Plan or by relationship to a service provider, provided that the Benefit Plan receives no less, nor pays no more, than adequate consideration. There can be no assurance that all of
the conditions of any such exemptions or any other exemption will be satisfied at the time that the Rights are exercised, or thereafter while the Common Shares are held, if the facts relied upon for utilizing a prohibited transaction exemption
change.
Due to the complexity of these rules and the penalties for noncompliance, fiduciaries of Benefit Plans should consult with their legal and tax
counsel regarding the consequences of their exercise of Rights under ERISA, the Code and other similar laws.]
SUMMARY OF TRUST EXPENSES
The following table and example are intended to assist you in understanding the various costs and expenses directly or
indirectly associated with investing in our Common Shares as a percentage of net assets attributable to Common Shares. Amounts are for the current fiscal year after giving effect to anticipated net proceeds of the Rights offering.
|
|
|
|
|
Shareholder Transaction Expenses |
|
|
|
|
Sales load paid by you (as a percentage of offering price)(1) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Offering expenses borne by the Trust (as a percentage of offering price)(1) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Dividend reinvestment plan fees |
|
$[●](2)
per share for open-
market purchases of common
shares(2) |
|
|
Dividend reinvestment plan sale transaction fee |
|
$2.50(2) |
|
|
Estimated Annual Expenses (as a percentage of net assets attributable to common
shares) |
|
|
|
|
Management fees(3)(4) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Interest Expense on Borrowed
Funds(5) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Other Expenses |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Acquired Fund Fees and Expenses(6) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Total Annual Expenses |
|
[●]% |
|
|
Fee Waivers(4) |
|
|
|
|
Total Annual Expenses after Fee Waivers(4)(6) |
|
[●]% |
|
|
(1) |
Trust shareholders will pay all offering expenses involved with this offering. |
(2) |
Computershare Trust Company, N.A.s (the Reinvestment Plan Agent) fees for the handling of the
reinvestment of dividends will be paid by the Trust. However, you will pay a $0.02 per share fee incurred in connection with open-market purchases, which will be deducted from the value of the dividend. You will also be charged a $2.50 sales fee and
pay a $0.15 per share fee if you direct the Reinvestment Plan Agent to sell your common shares held in a dividend reinvestment account. Per share fees include any applicable brokerage commissions the Reinvestment Plan Agent is required to pay.
|
(3) |
The Trust currently pays the Advisor a monthly fee at an annual contractual investment management fee rate of
0.55% of the average weekly value of the Trusts Managed Assets, plus the proceeds of ay debt securities or outstanding borrowings used for leverage. Managed Assets means the total assets of the Trust (including any assets
attributable to money borrowed for investment purposes) minus the sum of the Trusts accrued liabilities (other than money borrowed for investment purposes). |
(4) |
The Trust and the Advisor have entered into a fee waiver agreement (the Fee Waiver Agreement),
pursuant to which the Advisor has contractually agreed to waive the management fee with respect to any portion of the Trusts assets attributable to investments in any equity |
R-18
|
and fixed-income mutual funds and exchange-traded funds managed by the Advisor or its affiliates that have a contractual management fee, through June 30, 2026. In addition, pursuant to the
Fee Waiver Agreement, the Advisor has contractually agreed to waive its management fees by the amount of investment advisory fees the Trust pays to the Advisor indirectly through its investment in money market funds managed by the Advisor or its
affiliates, through June 30, 2026. The Fee Waiver Agreement may be terminated at any time, without the payment of any penalty, only by the Trust (upon the vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as defined
in the Investment Company Act) of the Trust or a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Trust), upon 90 days written notice by the Trust to the Advisor. |
(5) |
The Trust uses leverage in the form of reverse repurchase agreements representing [●]% of Managed Assets
at an annual interest expense to the Trust of [●]%, which is based on current market conditions. The actual amount of interest expense borne by the Trust will vary over time in accordance with the level of the Trusts use of reverse
repurchase agreements and variations |
(6) |
The total annual expenses do not correlate to the ratios to average net assets shown in the Trusts
Financial Highlights for the year ended December 31, 2024, which do not include acquired fund fees and expenses. |
The purpose of
the table above and the examples below is to help you understand all fees and expenses that you, as a holder of Common Shares, would bear directly or indirectly.
Example
The following example illustrates the expenses
(including the sales load of $[●] and offering costs of $[●]) that you would pay on a $1,000 investment in common shares, assuming (i) total net annual expenses of [●]% of net assets attributable to common shares, and
(ii) a 5% annual return:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1 Year |
|
|
3 Years |
|
|
5 Years |
|
|
10 Years |
|
Total expenses incurred* |
|
|
$ [●] |
|
|
|
$ [●] |
|
|
|
$ [●] |
|
|
|
$ [●] |
|
* |
The example should not be considered a representation of future expenses. The example assumes that the
estimated Other expenses set forth in the Estimated Annual Expenses table are accurate and that all dividends and distributions are reinvested at NAV. Actual expenses may be greater or less than those assumed. Moreover, the Trusts
actual rate of return may be greater or less than the hypothetical 5% return shown in the example. |
USE OF PROCEEDS
The Trust estimates the net proceeds of the Rights offering to be approximately $[●], based on the estimated Subscription
Price per Common Share of $[●] ([●]% of the last reported sales price of the Trusts Common Shares on the NYSE on [●], 2025 and each of the [● (●)] preceding trading days), assuming all new Common Shares
offered are sold and that the expenses related to the Rights offering estimated at approximately $[●] are paid.
The net proceeds from the Rights
offering hereunder will be invested in accordance with the Trusts investment objective and policies as set forth in this Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus. We currently anticipate that we will be able to invest all of the
net proceeds in accordance with our investment objective and policies within approximately three months of the receipt of such proceeds. Pending such investment, it is anticipated that the proceeds will be invested in short-term, tax-exempt or taxable investment grade securities. Depending on market conditions and operations, a portion of the cash held by the Trust, including any proceeds raised from the offering, may be used to pay
distributions in accordance with the Trusts distribution policy and may be a return of capital. A return of capital is a return to investors of a portion of their original investment in the Trust. In general terms, a return of capital would
involve a situation in which a Trust distribution (or a portion thereof) represents a return of a portion of a shareholders investment in the Trust, rather than making a distribution that is funded from the Trusts earned income or other
profits. Although return of capital distributions may not be currently taxable, such distributions would decrease the basis of a shareholders shares, and therefore, may increase a shareholders tax liability for capital gains upon a sale
of shares, even if sold at a loss to the shareholders original investments.
CAPITALIZATION
The following table sets forth the unaudited capitalization of the Trust as of [●], 2025 and its adjusted capitalization assuming the Common
Shares available in the Rights offering discussed in this Prospectus Supplement had been issued.
R-19
[To be provided.]
SPECIAL CHARACTERISTICS AND RISKS OF THE RIGHTS OFFERING
Risk is inherent in all investing. Therefore, before investing in the Common Shares you should consider the risks associated with such an investment
carefully. See Risks in the Prospectus. The following summarizes some of the matters that you should consider before investing in the Trust through the Rights offering:
Dilution. Record Date Shareholders who do not fully exercise their Rights will, at the completion of the Rights offering, own a smaller proportional
interest in the Trust than owned prior to the Rights offering. The completion of the Rights offering will result in immediate voting dilution for such shareholders. [Further, both the sales load and the expenses associated with the Rights offering
will immediately reduce the NAV of each outstanding Common Share.] In addition, if the Subscription Price is less than the NAV per Common Share as of the Expiration Date, the completion of this Rights offering will result in an immediate dilution of
the NAV per Common Share for all existing Common Shareholders (i.e., will cause the NAV per Common Share to decrease). As a result, existing Common Shareholders may experience immediate dilution even if they fully exercise their Rights. Such
dilution, if any, is not currently determinable because it is not known how many Common Shares will be subscribed for, what the NAV per Common Share or market price of the Common Shares will be on the Expiration Date or what the Subscription Price
per Common Share will be. If the Subscription Price is substantially less than the current NAV per Common Share, this dilution could be substantial. The Trust will pay expenses associated with the Rights offering, estimated at approximately
$[●]. In addition, the Trust has agreed to pay a dealer manager fee (sales load) equal to [●]% of the Subscription Price per Common Share issued pursuant to the exercise of Rights (including pursuant to the Over-Subscription Privilege).
The Trust, not investors, pays the sales load, which is ultimately borne by all Common Shareholders. All of the costs of the Rights offering will be borne by the Trusts Common Shareholders. See Table of Fees and Expenses in this
Prospectus Supplement and Summary of Trust Expenses in the accompanying Prospectus for more information.
You will experience an immediate
dilution of the aggregate NAV per Common Share if you do not participate in the Rights offering and will experience a reduction in the NAV per Common Share whether or not you exercise your Rights, if the Subscription Price is below the Trusts
NAV per Common Share on the Expiration Date, because:
|
● |
|
the offered Common Shares are being sold at less than their current NAV; |
|
● |
|
you will indirectly bear the expenses of the Rights offering; and |
|
● |
|
the number of Common Shares outstanding after the Rights offering will have increased proportionately more than
the increase in the amount of the Trusts net assets. |
On the other hand, if the Subscription Price is above the Trusts NAV
per Common Share on the Expiration Date, you may experience an immediate accretion of the aggregate NAV per share of your Common Shares even if you do not exercise your Rights and an immediate increase in the NAV per Common Share whether or not you
participate in the Rights offering, because:
|
● |
|
the offered Common Shares are being sold at more than their current NAV after deducting the expenses of the
Rights offering; and |
|
● |
|
the number of Common Shares outstanding after the Rights offering will have increased proportionately less than
the increase in the amount of the Trusts net assets. |
[Furthermore, if you do not participate in the secondary over-subscription,
if it is available, your percentage ownership will also be diluted.] The Trust cannot state precisely the amount of any dilution because it is not known at this time what the NAV per Common Share will be on the Expiration Date or what proportion of
the Rights will be exercised or what the Subscription Price per Common Share will be. The impact of the Rights offering on NAV per Common Share is shown by the following examples, assuming the Rights offering is fully subscribed and the estimated
Subscription Price of $[●]:
R-20
|
|
|
[Scenario 1: (assumes NAV per share is above Subscription
Price)(1) |
|
|
NAV(2) |
|
[●] |
Subscription Price(3) |
|
[●] |
Reduction in NAV ($)(4) |
|
[●] |
Reduction in NAV (%) |
|
[●]] |
|
|
|
[Scenario 2: (assumes NAV per share is below Subscription
Price)(1) |
|
|
NAV(2) |
|
[●] |
Subscription Price(3) |
|
[●] |
Increase in NAV ($)(4) |
|
[●] |
Increase in NAV (%) |
|
[●]] |
(1) |
Both examples assume the full primary subscription [and secondary over-subscription privilege] are exercised.
Actual amounts may vary due to rounding. |
(2) |
For illustrative purposes only. It is not known at this time what the NAV per Common Share will be on the
Expiration Date. |
(3) |
For illustrative purposes only; reflects an estimated Subscription Price of $[●] based upon [●]% of
the last reported sales price of the Trusts Common Shares on the NYSE on [●], 2025 and each of the [● (●)] preceding trading days. It is not known at this time what the Subscription Price will be on the Expiration Date.
|
(4) |
Assumes $[●] in estimated offering expenses. |
If you do not wish to exercise your Rights, you should consider selling them as set forth in this Prospectus Supplement. Any cash you receive from selling
your Rights may serve as partial compensation for any possible dilution of your interest in the Trust. The Trust cannot give assurance, however, that a market for the Rights will develop or that the Rights will have any marketable value.
[The Trusts largest shareholders could increase their percentage ownership in the Trust through the exercise of the primary subscription and
over-subscription privilege.]
Risks of Investing in Rights. Shares of closed-end funds such as the Trust
frequently trade at a discount to NAV. The Subscription Price may be greater than the market price of a Common Share on the Expiration Date. If that is the case, the Rights will have no value, and a person who exercises Rights will experience an
immediate loss of value.
Leverage. Leverage creates a greater risk of loss, as well as a potential for more gain, for the Common Shares than if
leverage were not used. Following the completion of the Rights offering, the Trusts amount of leverage outstanding will decrease. The leverage of the Trust as of [●], 2025 was approximately [●]% of the Trusts Managed Assets.
After the completion of the Rights offering, the amount of leverage outstanding is expected to decrease to approximately [●]% of the Trusts Managed Assets. The use of leverage for investment purposes creates opportunities for greater
total returns but at the same time increases risk. When leverage is employed, the NAV and market price of the Common Shares and the yield to holders of Common Shares may be more volatile. Any investment income or gains earned with respect to the
amounts borrowed in excess of the interest due on the borrowing will augment the Trusts income. Conversely, if the investment performance with respect to the amounts borrowed fails to cover the interest on such borrowings, the value of the
Trusts Common Shares may decrease more quickly than would otherwise be the case, and distributions on the Common Shares could be reduced or eliminated. Interest payments and fees incurred in connection with such borrowings will reduce the
amount of net income available for distribution to holders of the Common Shares.
Because the fee paid to the Advisor is calculated on the basis of the
Trusts Managed Assets, which include the proceeds of leverage, the dollar amount of the management fee paid by the Trust to the Advisor will be higher (and the Advisor will be benefited to that extent) when leverage is used. The Advisor will
use leverage only if it believes such action would result in a net benefit to the Trusts shareholders after taking into account the higher fees and expenses associated with leverage (including higher management fees).
The Trusts leveraging strategy may not be successful.
R-21
Increase in Share Price Volatility; Decrease in Share Price. The Rights offering may result in an increase
in trading of the Common Shares, which may increase volatility in the market price of the Common Shares. The Rights offering may result in an increase in the number of shareholders wishing to sell their Common Shares, which would exert downward
price pressure on the price of Common Shares.
Under-Subscription. It is possible that the Rights offering will not be fully subscribed.
Under-subscription of the Rights offering would have an impact on the net proceeds of the Rights offering and whether the Trust achieves any benefits.
TAXATION
The following is a general summary of the U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Rights offering to Record Date Shareholders who are U.S. persons for
U.S. federal income tax purposes. The following summary supplements the discussion set forth in the accompanying Prospectus and SAI and is subject to the qualifications and assumptions set forth therein. The discussion set forth herein does not
constitute tax advice and potential investors are urged to consult their own tax advisers to determine the tax consequences of investing in the Trust.
Please refer to the Tax Matters sections in the Trusts Prospectus and SAI for a description of the consequences of investing in the
Trusts Common Shares. [Special tax considerations relating to this Rights offering are summarized below:
|
● |
|
The value of a Right will not be includible in the income of a Common Shareholder at the time the Right is
issued. |
|
● |
|
The basis of a Right issued to a Common Shareholder will be zero, and the basis of the share with respect to
which the Right was issued (the old share) will remain unchanged, unless either (a) the fair market value of the Right on the date of distribution is at least 15% of the fair market value of the old share, or (b) such Common Shareholder
affirmatively elects (in the manner set out in Treasury regulations under the Code) to allocate to the Right a portion of the basis of the old share. If either (a) or (b) applies, such Common Shareholder must allocate basis between the old
share and the Right in proportion to their fair market values on the date of distribution. |
|
● |
|
The basis of a Right purchased in the market will generally be its purchase price. |
|
● |
|
The holding period of a Right issued to a Common Shareholder will include the holding period of the old share.
|
|
● |
|
No loss will be recognized by a Common Shareholder if a Right distributed to such Common Shareholder expires
unexercised because the basis of the old share may be allocated to a Right only if the Right is exercised. If a Right that has been purchased in the market expires unexercised, there will be a recognized loss equal to the basis of the Right.
|
|
● |
|
Any gain or loss on the sale of a Right will be a capital gain or loss if the Right is held as a capital asset
(which in the case of a Right issued to Record Date Shareholders will depend on whether the old share is held as a capital asset), and will be a long term capital gain or loss if the holding period is deemed to exceed one year.
|
|
● |
|
No gain or loss will be recognized by a Common Shareholder upon the exercise of a Right, and the basis of any
Common Share acquired upon exercise (the new Common Share) will equal the sum of the basis, if any, of the Right and the subscription price for the new Common Share. The holding period for the new Common Share will begin on the date when the Right
is exercised (or, in the case of a Right purchased in the market, potentially the day after the date of exercise).] |
The foregoing is
a general and abbreviated summary of the provisions of the Code and the Treasury regulations in effect as they directly govern the taxation of the Trust and holders of its Common Shares, with respect to U.S.
R-22
federal income taxation only. Other tax issues such as state and local taxation may apply. Investors are urged
to consult their own tax advisers to determine the tax consequences of investing in the Trust. These provisions are subject to change by legislative or administrative action, and any such change may be retroactive.
PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION
[Distribution Arrangements
[●] will act as Dealer
Manager for this Rights offering. Under the terms and subject to the conditions contained in the Dealer Manager Agreement among the Dealer Manager, the Trust and the Advisor, the Dealer Manager will provide financial structuring and solicitation
services in connection with the Rights offering and will solicit the exercise of Rights and participation in the over-subscription privilege. The Rights offering is not contingent upon any number of Rights being exercised. The Dealer Manager will
also be responsible for forming and managing a group of selling broker-dealers (each, a Selling Group Member and collectively, the Selling Group Members), whereby each Selling Group Member will enter into a Selling Group
Agreement with the Dealer Manager to solicit the exercise of Rights and to sell Common Shares purchased by the Selling Group Member from the Dealer Manager. In addition, the Dealer Manager will enter into a Soliciting Dealer Agreement with other
soliciting broker-dealers (each, a Soliciting Dealer and collectively, the Soliciting Dealers) to solicit the exercise of Rights. See Compensation to Dealer Manager for a discussion of fees and other
compensation to be paid to the Dealer Manager, Selling Group Members and Soliciting Dealers in connection with the Rights offering.
The Trust and the
Advisor have each agreed to indemnify the Dealer Manager for losses arising out of certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act. The Dealer Manager Agreement also provides that the Dealer Manager will not be subject to any
liability to the Trust in rendering the services contemplated by the Dealer Manager Agreement except for any act of willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence of the Dealer Manager or reckless disregard by the Dealer Manager of its
obligations and duties under the Dealer Manager Agreement.
In order to seek to facilitate the trading market in the Rights for the benefit of non-exercising shareholders, and the placement of the Common Shares to new or existing investors pursuant to the exercise of the Rights, the Dealer Manager Agreement provides for special arrangements with the Dealer
Manager. Under these arrangements, the Dealer Manager is expected to purchase Rights on the [●], as well as Rights received by the Subscription Agent for sale by Record Date Shareholders and offered to the Dealer Manager and unexercised Rights
of Record Date Shareholders whose record addresses are outside the United States that are held by the Subscription Agent and for which no instructions are received. The number of rights, if any, purchased by the Dealer Manager will be determined by
the Dealer Manager in its sole discretion. The Dealer Manager is not obligated to purchase Rights or Common Shares as principal for its own account to facilitate the trading market for Rights or for investment purposes. Rather, its purchases are
expected to be closely related to interest in acquiring Common Shares generated by the Dealer Manager through its marketing and soliciting activities. The Dealer Manager intends to exercise Rights purchased by it during the Subscription Period but
prior to the Expiration Date. The Dealer Manager may exercise those Rights at its option on one or more dates, which are expected to be prior to the Expiration Date. The Subscription Price for the Common Shares issued through the exercise of Rights
by the Dealer Manager prior to the Expiration Date will be the greater of [●]% of the last reported sale price of a Common Share on the NYSE on the date of exercise or [●]% of the last reported NAV of a Common Share on the date prior to
the date of exercise. The price and timing of these exercises are expected to differ from those described herein for the Rights offering. The Subscription Price will be paid to the Trust and the dealer manager fee with respect to such proceeds will
be paid by the Trust on the applicable settlement date(s) of such exercise(s).
In connection with the exercise of Rights and receipt of Common Shares,
the Dealer Manager intends to offer those Common Shares for sale to the public and/or through a group of selling members it has established. The Dealer Manager may set the price for those Common Shares at any price that it determines, in its sole
discretion. The Dealer Manager has advised that the price at which such Common Shares are offered is expected to be at or slightly below the closing price of the Common Shares on the NYSE on the date the Dealer Manager exercises Rights. No portion
of the amount paid to the Dealer Manager or to a Selling Group Member from the sale of Common Shares in this manner will be paid to the Trust. If the sales price of the Common Shares is greater than the Subscription Price paid by the Dealer Manager
for such Common Shares plus the costs to purchase Rights for the purpose of acquiring those Common Shares, the Dealer Manager will receive a gain. Alternatively, if the sales price of the Common
R-23
Shares is less than the Subscription Price for such Common Shares plus the costs to purchase Rights for the
purpose of acquiring those Common Shares, the Dealer Manager will incur a loss. The Dealer Manager will pay a concession to Selling Group Members in an amount equal to approximately [2.50]% of the aggregate price of the Common Shares sold by the
respective Selling Group Member. Neither the Trust nor the Advisor has a role in setting the terms, including the sales price, on which the Dealer Manager offers for sale and sells Common Shares it has acquired through purchasing and exercising
Rights or the timing of the exercise of Rights or sales of Common Shares by the Dealer Manager. Persons who purchase Common Shares from the Dealer Manager or the selling group will purchase shares at a price set by the Dealer Manager, which may be
more or less than the Subscription Price, and at a time set by the Dealer Manager, which is expected to be prior to the Expiration Date.
The Dealer
Manager may purchase Rights as principal or act as agent on behalf of its clients for the resale of such Rights. The Dealer Manager may realize gains (or losses) in connection with the purchase and sale of Rights and the sale of Common Shares,
although such transactions are intended by the Dealer Manager to facilitate the trading market in the Rights and the placement of the Common Shares to new or existing investors pursuant to the exercise of the Rights. Any gains (or losses) realized
by the Dealer Manager from the purchase and sale of Rights and the sale of Common Shares is independent of and in addition to its fee as Dealer Manager. The Dealer Manager has advised that any such gains (or losses) are expected to be immaterial
relative to its fee as Dealer Manager.
Since neither the Dealer Manager nor persons who purchase Common Shares from the Dealer Manager or members of the
selling group were Record Date Shareholders, they would not be able to participate in the over-subscription privilege.
Persons who purchase Common Shares
from the Dealer Manager or the selling group will not purchase shares at the Subscription Price based on the formula price mechanism through which Common Shares will be sold in the Rights offering. Instead, those persons will purchase Common Shares
at a price set by the Dealer Manager, which may be more or less than the Subscription Price, and will not have the uncertainty of waiting for the determination of the Subscription Price on the Expiration Date.
There is no limit on the number of Rights the Dealer Manager can purchase or exercise. Common Shares acquired by the Dealer Manager pursuant to the exercise
of Rights acquired by it will reduce the number of Common Shares available pursuant to the over-subscription privilege, perhaps materially, depending on the number of Rights purchased and exercised by the Dealer Manager.
Although the Dealer Manager can seek to facilitate the trading market for Rights as described above, investors can acquire Common Shares at the Subscription
Price by acquiring Rights on the [●] and exercising them in the method described above under Description of the RightsMethod of Exercise of Rights and Description of the RightsPayment for Shares.
In the ordinary course of their businesses, the Dealer Manager and/or its affiliates may engage in investment banking or financial transactions with the
Trust, the Advisor and their affiliates. In addition, in the ordinary course of their businesses, the Dealer Manager and/or its affiliates may, from time to time, own securities of the Trust or its affiliates.
The principal business address of the Dealer Manager is [●].
Compensation to Dealer Manager
Pursuant to the Dealer
Manager Agreement, the Trust has agreed to pay the Dealer Manager a fee for its financial structuring and solicitation services equal to [●]% of the Subscription Price per Common Share for each Common Share issued pursuant to the exercise of
Rights, including the over-subscription privilege.
The Dealer Manager will reallow to Selling Group Members in the selling group to be formed and managed
by the Dealer Manager selling fees equal to [●]% of the Subscription Price for each Common Share issued pursuant to the Rights offering or the over-subscription privilege as a result of their selling efforts. In addition, the Dealer Manager
will reallow to Soliciting Dealers that have executed and delivered a Soliciting Dealer Agreement and have solicited
R-24
the exercise of Rights, solicitation fees equal to [●]% of the Subscription Price for each Common Share
issued pursuant to the exercise of Rights as a result of their soliciting efforts, subject to a maximum fee based on the number of Common Shares held by such Soliciting Dealer through [insert depository] on the Record Date. Fees will be paid to the
broker-dealer designated on the applicable portion of the subscription certificates or, in the absence of such designation, to the Dealer Manager.
In
addition, the Trust, has agreed to pay the Dealer Manager an amount up to $[●] as a partial reimbursement of its expenses incurred in connection with the Rights offering, including reasonable out-of-pocket fees and expenses, if any and not to exceed $[●], incurred by the Dealer Manager, Selling Group Members, Soliciting Dealers and other brokers, dealers and financial institutions in
connection with their customary mailing and handling of materials related to the Rights offering to their customers. No other fees will be payable by the Trust or the Advisor to the Dealer Manager in connection with the Rights offering.
LEGAL MATTERS
Certain legal matters in connection with the Common Shares will be passed upon for the Trust by Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP, New York, New York,
counsel to the Trust. Willkie Farr & Gallagher LLP may rely as to certain matters of Delaware law on the opinion of [●]. [Certain legal matters will be passed on by [●] as special counsel to the Dealer Manager in connection with
the Rights offering.]
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The audited annual financial statements of the Trust for the fiscal year ended December 31, 202[●] [and the unaudited financial statements for the
six months ended June 30, 202[●]] are incorporated by reference into this Prospectus Supplement, the accompanying Prospectus and the SAI.
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus constitute part of a Registration Statement filed by the Trust with the SEC under the Securities
Act and the Investment Company Act. This Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus omit certain of the information contained in the Registration Statement, and reference is hereby made to the Registration Statement and related exhibits
for further information with respect to the Trust and the common shares offered hereby. Any statements contained herein concerning the provisions of any document are not necessarily complete, and, in each instance, reference is made to the copy of
such document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement or otherwise filed with the SEC. Each such statement is qualified in its entirety by such reference. The complete Registration Statement may be obtained from the SEC upon payment of the
fee prescribed by its rules and regulations or free of charge through the SECs website (http://www.sec.gov).
R-25
BLACKROCK LIMITED
DURATION INCOME TRUST
[●] Rights for [●] Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
Subscription Rights to Acquire Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
Issuable Upon Exercise of Rights to Subscribe for
Such Common Shares of Beneficial Interest
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
[●], 2025
Until
[●], 2025 (25 days after the date of this Prospectus Supplement), all dealers that buy, sell or trade the common shares, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition
to the dealers obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriters.
THE INFORMATION IN THIS STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION IS NOT
COMPLETE AND MAY BE CHANGED. WE MAY NOT SELL THESE SECURITIES UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION IS EFFECTIVE. THIS STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION IS NOT AN OFFER TO SELL THESE SECURITIES AND IS
NOT SOLICITING AN OFFER TO BUY THESE SECURITIES IN ANY JURISDICTION WHERE THE OFFER OR SALE IS NOT PERMITTED.
Subject to Completion
Dated March 21, 2025
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust
STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
BlackRock Limited Duration Income Trust (the Trust) is a diversified, closed-end management investment
company. This Statement of Additional Information (SAI) relating to the Trusts common shares of beneficial interest (common shares) does not constitute a prospectus, but should be read in conjunction with the Prospectus
relating thereto dated [●], 2025 (the Prospectus) and any related prospectus supplement. This SAI, which is not a prospectus, does not include all information that a prospective investor should consider before purchasing common
shares, and investors should obtain and read the Prospectus and any related prospectus supplement prior to purchasing such shares. A copy of the Prospectus and any related prospectus supplement may be obtained without charge by calling (800) 882-0052. You may also obtain a copy of the Prospectus on the Securities and Exchange Commissions (the SEC) website (http://www.sec.gov). Capitalized terms used but not defined in this SAI have the
meanings ascribed to them in the Prospectus.
References to the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the Investment Company Act), or
other applicable law, will include any rules promulgated thereunder and any guidance, interpretations or modifications by the SEC, SEC staff or other authority with appropriate jurisdiction, including court interpretations, and exemptive, no-action or other relief or permission from the SEC, SEC staff or other authority.
This Statement of
Additional Information is dated [●], 2025.
S-1
TABLE OF CONTENTS
S-2
THE TRUST
The Trust is a diversified, closed-end management investment company registered under the Investment Company Act. The
Trust was formed as a Delaware statutory trust on May 16, 2003, pursuant to an Agreement and Declaration of Trust, as subsequently amended and restated, governed by the laws of the State of Delaware and the Certificate of Trust filed with the
Secretary of State of the State of Delaware. The Trusts investment adviser is BlackRock Advisors, LLC (the Advisor). BlackRock International Limited (BIL) and BlackRock (Singapore) Limited (BSL and together
with BIL, the Sub-Advisors and collectively with the Advisor, the Advisors) serve as the Trusts sub-advisors.
The common shares of the Trust are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) under the symbol BLW. As of March 18, 2025, the
Trust has outstanding 37,849,616 common shares.
INVESTMENT OBJECTIVE AND POLICIES
Investment Restrictions
The Trust has adopted
restrictions and policies relating to the investment of the Trusts assets and its activities. Certain of the restrictions are fundamental policies of the Trust and may not be changed without the approval of the holders of a majority of the
Trusts outstanding voting securities (which for this purpose and under the Investment Company Act means the lesser of (i) 67% of the shares represented at a meeting at which more than 50% of the outstanding shares are represented or
(ii) more than 50% of the outstanding shares), including class approval by a majority of the Trusts outstanding shares of preferred shares (preferred shares), if any (which for this purpose and under the Investment Company Act
means the lesser of (i) 67% of the preferred shares, as a single class, represented at a meeting at which more than 50% of the Trusts outstanding preferred shares are represented or (ii) more than 50% of the outstanding preferred shares).
Fundamental Investment Restrictions. Under these fundamental investment restrictions, the Trust may not:
|
1. |
Purchase any security if as a result 25% or more of the total assets of the Trust would be invested in the
securities of issuers having their principal business activities in the same industry (with respect to loan participations in which the Trust may invest, the Trust intends to treat as issuers the corporate borrower, the bank selling such
participation interests and any other person interpositioned between the bank and the Trust). |
|
2. |
With respect to 75% of its total assets, invest more than 5% of the value of its total assets in the
securities of any single issuer or purchase more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of any one issuer. |
|
3. |
Purchase commodities or commodity contracts, except that the Trust may purchase and sell options, futures
contracts and options thereon and may engage in interest rate and foreign currency transactions. |
|
4. |
Purchase, hold or deal in real estate or real estate mortgage loans, or oil, gas or other mineral leases or
exploration or development programs, except that the Trust may (a) purchase and sell securities that are secured by, or issued by companies that invest or deal in, real estate, oil, gas or other minerals, or interests therein and (b) hold
or sell any such assets acquired in connection with its investment in portfolio securities. |
|
5. |
Issue senior securities or borrow money, except as permitted by the Investment Company Act.
|
|
6. |
Make loans to others, except through the purchase of debt obligations (including senior loans), the entry
into repurchase agreements and the lending of its portfolio securities. |
|
7. |
Act as an underwriter of securities of other issuers, except to the extent the Trust may be deemed an
underwriter under the Securities Act, by virtue of its purchase or sale of portfolio securities. |
For purposes of applying the
limitation set forth in subparagraphs (1) and (2) above, securities of the U.S. government, its agencies, or instrumentalities, and securities backed by the credit of a governmental entity are not
S-3
considered to represent industries. However, obligations backed principally by the assets and revenues of non-governmental issuers may for this purpose be
deemed to be issued by such non-governmental issuers.
For the purpose of applying the limitation set forth in
subparagraph (1) above, a governmental issuer shall be deemed the sole issuer of a security when its assets and revenues are separate from other governmental entities and its securities are backed only by its assets and revenues. Similarly, in
the case of a non-governmental issuer, such as an industrial corporation or a privately owned or operated hospital, if the security is backed only by the assets and revenues of the non-governmental issuer, then such non-governmental issuer would be deemed to be the sole issuer. Where a security is backed by the enforceable obligation of a superior or
unrelated governmental entity, it will be included in the computation of securities owned that are issued by such governmental entity. When a security is backed by the enforceable obligation of a superior or unrelated
non-governmental entity (other than a bond insurer), it will also be included in the computation of securities owned that are issued by such non-governmental entity.
Where a security is guaranteed by a governmental entity or some other facility, such as a bank guarantee or letter of credit, such a guarantee or letter of credit would be considered a separate security and would be treated as an issue of such
government, other entity or bank. When a municipal security is insured by bond insurance, it shall not be considered a security that is issued or guaranteed by the insurer; instead, the issuer of such municipal security will be determined in
accordance with the principles set forth above. The foregoing restrictions do not limit the percentage of the Trusts assets that may be invested in municipal securities insured by any given insurer.
Under the Investment Company Act, the Trust may invest up to 10% of its total assets in the aggregate in shares of other investment companies and up to 5% of
its total assets in any one investment company, provided the investment does not represent more than 3% of the voting stock of the acquired investment company at the time such shares are purchased. The Trust may invest a greater percentage of its
assets in money market funds to the extent permitted by the Investment Company Act or the Securities and Exchange Commission.
Non-Fundamental Investment Restrictions. Any policies of the Trust not described as fundamental in this Prospectus may be changed by the Trusts Board of Trustees (the Board) without
shareholder approval, provide that the Trust may not:
|
A. |
Make any short sale of securities except in conformity with applicable laws, rules and regulations and unless
after giving effect to such sale, the market value of all securities sold short does not exceed 25% of the value of the Trusts managed assets and the Trusts aggregate short sales of a particular class of securities of an issuer does not
exceed 25% of the then outstanding securities of that class. The Trust may also make short sales against the box without respect to such limitations. In this type of short sale, at the time of the sale, the Trust owns or has the
immediate and unconditional right to acquire at no additional cost the identical security. |
|
B. |
Purchase securities of open-end or
closed-end investment companies except in compliance with the Investment Company Act or any exemptive relief obtained thereunder. |
|
C. |
Purchase securities of companies for the purpose of exercising control. |
The restrictions and other limitations set forth in the Trusts Prospectus and in this SAI will apply only at the time of purchase of securities and will
not be considered violated unless an excess or deficiency occurs or exists immediately after and as a result of the acquisition of securities. Any investment policy or restriction described in the Prospectus or in this SAI is deemed to be a non-fundamental policy or restriction of the Trust, unless otherwise stated.
If the Trust offers preferred shares, it
may apply for ratings for such preferred shares from Moodys, S&P and/or Fitch. In order to obtain and maintain the required ratings, the Trust may be required to comply with investment quality, diversification and other
guidelines established by Moodys, S&P and/or Fitch. Such guidelines may be more restrictive than the restrictions set forth above. The Trust does not anticipate that such guidelines would have a material adverse effect on the
Trusts holders of common shares or its ability to achieve its investment objective. The Trust presently anticipates that any preferred shares issued would be initially given the highest ratings by Moodys (Aaa) or by S&P or Fitch
(AAA), but no assurance can be given that such ratings will be obtained. No minimum rating is required for the issuance of preferred shares by the Trust. Moodys, S&P and Fitch receive fees in connection with their ratings issuances.
S-4
INVESTMENT POLICIES AND TECHNIQUES
The following information supplements the discussion of the Trusts investment objective, policies and techniques that are described in the Prospectus.
Special Purpose Acquisition Companies
The Trust
may invest in stock, warrants, rights and other interests issued by special purpose acquisition companies (SPACs) or similar special purpose entities that pool funds to seek potential acquisition opportunities, including the
founders shares and warrants described below. A SPAC is a publicly traded company that raises investment capital via an initial public offering (IPO) for the purpose of identifying and acquiring one or more operating
businesses or assets. In connection with forming a SPAC, the SPACs sponsors acquire founders shares, generally for nominal consideration, and warrants that will result in the sponsors owning a specified percentage (typically
20%) of the SPACs outstanding common stock upon completion of the IPO. At the time a SPAC conducts an IPO, it has selected a management team but has not yet identified a specific acquisition opportunity. Unless and until an acquisition is
completed, a SPAC generally invests its assets in U.S. government securities, money market securities and cash. If an acquisition that meets the requirements for the SPAC is not completed within a
pre-established period of time, the invested funds are returned to the SPACs public shareholders, the warrants expire, and the founders shares and such warrants become worthless.
Because SPACs and similar entities are in essence blank check companies without operating histories or ongoing business operations (other than identifying and pursuing acquisitions), the potential for the long term capital appreciation
of their securities is particularly dependent on the ability of the SPACs management to identify and complete a profitable acquisition. There is no guarantee that the SPACs in which the Trust invests will complete an acquisition or that any
acquisitions completed by the SPACs in which the Trust invests will be profitable. Some SPACs may pursue acquisitions only within certain industries or regions, which may ultimately lead to an increase in the volatility of their prices following the
acquisition. In addition, some of these securities may be considered illiquid and/or subject to restrictions on resale.
Environmental, Social and
Governance (ESG) Integration
Although the Trust does not seek to implement a specific sustainability objective, strategy or process
unless disclosed in the Prospectus, Trust management will consider ESG factors as part of the investment process for the Trust. Trust management views ESG integration as the practice of incorporating financially material ESG data or information into
investment processes with the objective of enhancing risk-adjusted returns. These ESG considerations will vary depending on a funds particular investment strategies and may include consideration of third-party research as well as consideration
of proprietary research of the Advisor across the ESG risks and opportunities regarding an issuer. The ESG characteristics utilized in the Trusts investment process are anticipated to evolve over time and one or more characteristics may not be
relevant with respect to all issuers that are eligible for investment.
Certain of these considerations may affect the Trusts exposure to certain
companies or industries. While Trust management views ESG considerations as having the potential to contribute to the Trusts long-term performance, there is no guarantee that such results will be achieved.
ADDITIONAL RISK FACTORS
Risk Factors in Strategic Transactions and Derivatives
The Trusts use of derivative instruments involves risks different from, and possibly greater than, the risks associated with investing directly in
securities and other traditional investments. There are significant risks that apply generally to derivatives transactions, including:
|
● |
|
Correlation Riskthe risk that changes in the value of a derivative will not match the changes in the
value of the portfolio holdings that are being hedged or of the particular market or security to which the Trust seeks exposure. There are a number of factors which may prevent a derivative instrument from achieving the
|
S-5
|
desired correlation (or inverse correlation) with an underlying asset, rate or index, such as the impact of fees, expenses and transaction costs, the timing of pricing, and disruptions or
illiquidity in the markets for such derivative instrument. |
|
● |
|
Counterparty Riskthe risk that the counterparty in a derivative transaction will be unable to honor
its financial obligation to the Trust and the related risks of having concentrated exposure to such a counterparty. In particular, derivatives traded in OTC markets often are not guaranteed by an exchange or clearing corporation and often do not
require payment of margin, and to the extent that the Trust has unrealized gains in such instruments or has deposited collateral with its counterparties the Trust is at risk that its counterparties will become bankrupt or otherwise fail to honor
their obligations. The Trust will typically attempt to minimize counterparty risk by engaging in OTC derivatives transactions only with creditworthy entities that have substantial capital or that have provided the Trust with a third-party guaranty
or other credit support. |
|
● |
|
Credit Riskthe risk that the reference entity in a credit default swap or similar derivative will
not be able to honor its financial obligations. |
|
● |
|
Currency Riskthe risk that changes in the exchange rate between two currencies will adversely affect
the value (in U.S. dollar terms) of a derivative. |
|
● |
|
Illiquidity Riskthe risk that certain securities or instruments may be difficult or impossible to
sell at the time or at the price desired by the counterparty in connection with payments of margin, collateral, or settlement payments. There can be no assurance that the Trust will be able to unwind or offset a derivative at its desired price, in a
secondary market or otherwise. It may, therefore, not be possible for the Trust to unwind its position in a derivative without incurring substantial losses (if at all). The absence of liquidity may also make it more difficult for the Trust to
ascertain a market value for such instruments. Although both OTC and exchange-traded derivatives markets may experience a lack of liquidity, certain derivatives traded in OTC markets, including swaps and OTC options, involve substantial illiquidity
risk. The Trust will, therefore, acquire illiquid OTC derivatives (i) if the agreement pursuant to which the instrument is purchased contains a formula price at which the instrument may be terminated or sold, or (ii) for which the Advisor
anticipates the Trust can receive on each business day at least two independent bids or offers, unless a quotation from only one dealer is available, in which case that dealers quotation may be used. The illiquidity of the derivatives markets
may be due to various factors, including congestion, disorderly markets, limitations on deliverable supplies, the participation of speculators, government regulation and intervention, and technical and operational or system failures. In addition,
the liquidity of a secondary market in an exchange-traded derivative contract may be adversely affected by daily price fluctuation limits established by the exchanges which limit the amount of fluctuation in an exchange-traded contract
price during a single trading day. Once the daily limit has been reached in the contract, no trades may be entered into at a price beyond the limit, thus preventing the liquidation of open positions. Prices have in the past moved beyond the daily
limit on a number of consecutive trading days. If it is not possible to close an open derivative position entered into by the Trust, the Trust would continue to be required to make daily cash payments of variation margin in the event of adverse
price movements. In such a situation, if the Trust has insufficient cash, it may have to sell portfolio securities to meet daily variation margin requirements at a time when it may be disadvantageous to do so. |
|
● |
|
Index Riskif the derivative is linked to the performance of an index, it will be subject to the
risks associated with changes in that index. If the index changes, the Trust could receive lower interest payments or experience a reduction in the value of the derivative to below the price that the Trust paid for such derivative.
|
|
● |
|
Legal Riskthe risk of insufficient documentation, insufficient capacity or authority of
counterparty, or legality or enforceability of a contract. |
|
● |
|
Leverage Riskthe risk that the Trusts derivatives transactions can magnify the Trusts
gains and losses. Relatively small market movements may result in large changes in the value of a derivatives position and can result in losses that greatly exceed the amount originally invested. |
S-6
|
● |
|
Market Riskthe risk that changes in the value of one or more markets or changes with respect to the
value of the underlying asset will adversely affect the value of a derivative. In the event of an adverse movement, the Trust may be required to pay substantial additional margin to maintain its position or the Trusts returns may be adversely
affected. |
|
● |
|
Operational Riskthe risk related to potential operational issues, including documentation issues,
settlement issues, systems failures, inadequate controls and human error. |
|
● |
|
Valuation Riskthe risk that valuation sources for a derivative will not be readily available in the
market. This is possible especially in times of market distress, since many market participants may be reluctant to purchase complex instruments or quote prices for them. |
|
● |
|
Volatility Riskthe risk that the value of derivatives will fluctuate significantly within a short
time period. |
When a derivative is used as a hedge against a position that the Trust holds, any loss generated by the derivative
generally should be substantially offset by gains on the hedged investment, and vice versa. While hedging can reduce or eliminate losses, it can also reduce or eliminate gains. Hedges are sometimes subject to imperfect matching between the
derivative and the underlying security, and there can be no assurance that the Trusts hedging transactions will be effective. The Trust could also suffer losses related to its derivative positions as a result of unanticipated market movements,
which losses are potentially unlimited. The Advisors may not be able to predict correctly the direction of securities prices, interest rates and other economic factors, which could cause the Trusts derivatives positions to lose value. In
addition, some derivatives are more sensitive to interest rate changes and market price fluctuations than other securities. The possible lack of a liquid secondary market for derivatives and the resulting inability of the Trust to sell or otherwise
close a derivatives position could expose the Trust to losses and could make derivatives more difficult for the Trust to value accurately.
When engaging
in a hedging transaction, the Trust may determine not to seek to establish a perfect correlation between the hedging instruments utilized and the portfolio holdings being hedged. Such an imperfect correlation may prevent the Trust from achieving the
intended hedge or expose the Trust to a risk of loss. The Trust may also determine not to hedge against a particular risk because it does not regard the probability of the risk occurring to be sufficiently high as to justify the cost of the hedge or
because it does do not foresee the occurrence of the risk. It may not be possible for the Trust to hedge against a change or event at attractive prices or at a price sufficient to protect the assets of the Trust from the decline in value of the
portfolio positions anticipated as a result of such change. In addition, it may not be possible to hedge at all against certain risks.
If the Trust
invests in a derivative instrument it could lose more than the principal amount invested. Moreover, derivatives raise certain tax, legal, regulatory and accounting issues that may not be presented by investments in securities, and there is some risk
that certain issues could be resolved in a manner that could adversely impact the performance of the Trust.
The Trust is not required to use derivatives
or other portfolio strategies to seek to increase return or to seek to hedge its portfolio and may choose not to do so. Also, suitable derivative transactions may not be available in all circumstances and there can be no assurance that the Trust
will engage in these transactions to reduce exposure to other risks when that would be beneficial. Although the Advisors seek to use derivatives to further the Trusts investment objective, there is no assurance that the use of derivatives will
achieve this result.
Options Risk. There are several risks associated with transactions in options on securities and indexes. For example, there
are significant differences between the securities and options markets that could result in an imperfect correlation between these markets, causing a given transaction not to achieve its objective. In addition, a liquid secondary market for
particular options, whether traded OTC or on a recognized securities exchange (e.g., NYSE), separate trading boards of a securities exchange or through a market system that provides contemporaneous transaction pricing information (an
Exchange) may be absent for reasons which include the following: there may be insufficient trading interest in certain options; restrictions may be imposed by an Exchange on opening transactions or closing transactions or both; trading
halts, suspensions or other restrictions may be imposed with respect to particular classes or series of options or underlying securities; unusual or unforeseen circumstances may
S-7
interrupt normal operations on an Exchange; the facilities of an Exchange or the OCC may not at all times be adequate to handle current trading volume; or one or more Exchanges could, for
economic or other reasons, decide or be compelled at some future date to discontinue the trading of options (or a particular class or series of options), in which event the secondary market on that Exchange (or in that class or series of options)
would cease to exist, although outstanding options that had been issued by the OCC as a result of trades on that Exchange would continue to be exercisable in accordance with their terms.
Futures Transactions and Options Risk. The primary risks associated with the use of futures contracts and options are (a) the imperfect
correlation between the change in market value of the instruments held by the Trust and the price of the futures contract or option; (b) possible lack of a liquid secondary market for a futures contract and the resulting inability to close a
futures contract when desired; (c) losses caused by unanticipated market movements, which are potentially unlimited; (d) the Advisors inability to predict correctly the direction of securities prices, interest rates, currency
exchange rates and other economic factors; and (e) the possibility that the counterparty will default in the performance of its obligations.
Investment in futures contracts involves the risk of imperfect correlation between movements in the price of the futures contract and the price of the
security being hedged. The hedge will not be fully effective when there is imperfect correlation between the movements in the prices of two financial instruments. For example, if the price of the futures contract moves more or less than the price of
the hedged security, the Trust will experience either a loss or gain on the futures contract which is not completely offset by movements in the price of the hedged securities. To compensate for imperfect correlations, the Trust may purchase or sell
futures contracts in a greater dollar amount than the hedged securities if the volatility of the hedged securities is historically greater than the volatility of the futures contracts. Conversely, the Trust may purchase or sell fewer futures
contracts if the volatility of the price of the hedged securities is historically lower than that of the futures contracts.
The particular securities
comprising the index underlying a securities index financial futures contract may vary from the securities held by the Trust. As a result, the Trusts ability to hedge effectively all or a portion of the value of its securities through the use
of such financial futures contracts will depend in part on the degree to which price movements in the index underlying the financial futures contract correlate with the price movements of the securities held by the Trust. The correlation may be
affected by disparities in the average maturity, ratings, geographical mix or structure of the Trusts investments as compared to those comprising the securities index and general economic or political factors. In addition, the correlation
between movements in the value of the securities index may be subject to change over time as additions to and deletions from the securities index alter its structure. The correlation between futures contracts on U.S. Government securities and the
securities held by the Trust may be adversely affected by similar factors and the risk of imperfect correlation between movements in the prices of such futures contracts and the prices of securities held by the Trust may be greater. The trading of
futures contracts also is subject to certain market risks, such as inadequate trading activity, which could at times make it difficult or impossible to liquidate existing positions.
The Trust may liquidate futures contracts it enters into through offsetting transactions on the applicable contract market. There can be no assurance,
however, that a liquid secondary market will exist for any particular futures contract at any specific time. Thus, it may not be possible to close out a futures position. In the event of adverse price movements, the Trust would continue to be
required to make daily cash payments of variation margin. In such situations, if the Trust has insufficient cash, it may be required to sell portfolio securities to meet daily variation margin requirements at a time when it may be disadvantageous to
do so. The inability to close out futures positions also could have an adverse impact on the Trusts ability to hedge effectively its investments in securities. The liquidity of a secondary market in a futures contract may be adversely affected
by daily price fluctuation limits established by commodity exchanges which limit the amount of fluctuation in a futures contract price during a single trading day. Once the daily limit has been reached in the contract, no trades may be
entered into at a price beyond the limit, thus preventing the liquidation of open futures positions. Prices have in the past moved beyond the daily limit on a number of consecutive trading days.
The successful use of transactions in futures and related options also depends on the ability of the Advisors to forecast correctly the direction and extent
of interest rate movements within a given time frame. To the extent interest rates remain stable during the period in which a futures contract or option is held by the Trust or such rates move in a direction opposite to that anticipated, the Trust
may realize a loss on the Strategic Transaction which is
S-8
not fully or partially offset by an increase in the value of portfolio securities. As a result, the Trusts total return for such period may be less than if it had not engaged in the
Strategic Transaction.
Because of low initial margin deposits made upon the opening of a futures position, futures transactions involve substantial
leverage. As a result, relatively small movements in the price of the futures contracts can result in substantial unrealized gains or losses. There is also the risk of loss by the Trust of margin deposits in the event of bankruptcy of a broker with
which the Trust has an open position in a financial futures contract. Because the Trust will engage in the purchase and sale of futures contracts for hedging purposes or to seek to enhance the Trusts return, any losses incurred in connection
therewith may, if the strategy is successful, be offset in whole or in part by increases in the value of securities held by the Trust or decreases in the price of securities the Trust intends to acquire.
The amount of risk the Trust assumes when it purchases an option on a futures contract is the premium paid for the option plus related transaction costs. In
addition to the correlation risks discussed above, the purchase of an option on a futures contract also entails the risk that changes in the value of the underlying futures contract will not be fully reflected in the value of the option purchased.
General Risk Factors in Hedging Foreign Currency. Hedging transactions involving Currency Instruments involve substantial risks, including
correlation risk. While the Trusts use of Currency Instruments to effect hedging strategies is intended to reduce the volatility of the NAV of the Trusts common shares, the NAV of the Trusts common shares will fluctuate. Moreover,
although Currency Instruments may be used with the intention of hedging against adverse currency movements, transactions in Currency Instruments involve the risk that anticipated currency movements will not be accurately predicted and that the
Trusts hedging strategies will be ineffective. To the extent that the Trust hedges against anticipated currency movements that do not occur, the Trust may realize losses and decrease its total return as the result of its hedging transactions.
Furthermore, the Trust will only engage in hedging activities from time to time and may not be engaging in hedging activities when movements in currency exchange rates occur.
It may not be possible for the Trust to hedge against currency exchange rate movements, even if correctly anticipated, in the event that (i) the currency
exchange rate movement is so generally anticipated that the Trust is not able to enter into a hedging transaction at an effective price, or (ii) the currency exchange rate movement relates to a market with respect to which Currency Instruments
are not available and it is not possible to engage in effective foreign currency hedging. The cost to the Trust of engaging in foreign currency transactions varies with such factors as the currencies involved, the length of the contract period and
the market conditions then prevailing. Since transactions in foreign currency exchange usually are conducted on a principal basis, no fees or commissions are involved.
Foreign Currency Forwards Risk. Forward foreign currency exchange contracts do not eliminate fluctuations in the value of Non-U.S. Securities (as defined in the Prospectus) but rather allow the Trust to establish a fixed rate of exchange for a future point in time. This strategy can have the effect of reducing returns and minimizing
opportunities for gain.
In connection with its trading in forward foreign currency contracts, the Trust will contract with a foreign or domestic bank, or
foreign or domestic securities dealer, to make or take future delivery of a specified amount of a particular currency. There are no limitations on daily price moves in such forward contracts, and banks and dealers are not required to continue to
make markets in such contracts. There have been periods during which certain banks or dealers have refused to quote prices for such forward contracts or have quoted prices with an unusually wide spread between the price at which the bank or dealer
is prepared to buy and that at which it is prepared to sell. Governmental imposition of credit controls might limit any such forward contract trading. With respect to its trading of forward contracts, if any, the Trust will be subject to the risk of
bank or dealer failure and the inability of, or refusal by, a bank or dealer to perform with respect to such contracts. Any such default would deprive the Trust of any profit potential or force the Trust to cover its commitments for resale, if any,
at the then market price and could result in a loss to the Trust.
The Trust may also engage in proxy hedging transactions to reduce the effect of
currency fluctuations on the value of existing or anticipated holdings of portfolio securities. Proxy hedging is often used when the currency to which
S-9
the Trust is exposed is difficult to hedge or to hedge against the dollar. Proxy hedging entails entering into a forward contract to sell a currency whose changes in value are generally
considered to be linked to a currency or currencies in which some or all of the Trusts securities are, or are expected to be, denominated, and to buy U.S. dollars. Proxy hedging involves some of the same risks and considerations as other
transactions with similar instruments. Currency transactions can result in losses to the Trust if the currency being hedged fluctuates in value to a degree or in a direction that is not anticipated. In addition, there is the risk that the perceived
linkage between various currencies may not be present or may not be present during the particular time that the Trust is engaging in proxy hedging. The Trust may also cross-hedge currencies by entering into forward contracts to sell one or more
currencies that are expected to decline in value relative to other currencies to which the Trust has or in which the Trust expects to have portfolio exposure. For example, the Trust may hold both Canadian government bonds and Japanese government
bonds, and the Advisors may believe that Canadian dollars will deteriorate against Japanese yen. The Trust would sell Canadian dollars to reduce its exposure to that currency and buy Japanese yen. This strategy would be a hedge against a decline in
the value of Canadian dollars, although it would expose the Trust to declines in the value of the Japanese yen relative to the U.S. dollar.
Some of the
forward non-U.S. currency contracts entered into by the Trust may be classified as non-deliverable forwards (NDFs). NDFs are cash-settled, short-term forward
contracts that may be thinly traded or are denominated in non-convertible foreign currency, where the profit or loss at the time at the settlement date is calculated by taking the difference between the agreed
upon exchange rate and the spot rate at the time of settlement, for an agreed upon notional amount of funds. All NDFs have a fixing date and a settlement date. The fixing date is the date at which the difference between the prevailing market
exchange rate and the agreed upon exchange rate is calculated. The settlement date is the date by which the payment of the difference is due to the party receiving payment. NDFs are commonly quoted for time periods of one month up to two years, and
are normally quoted and settled in U.S. dollars. They are often used to gain exposure to and/or hedge exposure to foreign currencies that are not internationally traded.
Currency Futures Risk. The Trust may also seek to hedge against the decline in the value of a currency or to enhance returns through use of currency
futures or options thereon. Currency futures are similar to forward foreign exchange transactions except that futures are standardized, exchange-traded contracts while forward foreign exchange transactions are traded in the OTC market. Currency
futures involve substantial currency risk, and also involve leverage risk.
Currency Options Risk. The Trust may also seek to hedge against the
decline in the value of a currency or to enhance returns through the use of currency options. Currency options are similar to options on securities. For example, in consideration for an option premium the writer of a currency option is obligated to
sell (in the case of a call option) or purchase (in the case of a put option) a specified amount of a specified currency on or before the expiration date for a specified amount of another currency. The Trust may engage in transactions in options on
currencies either on exchanges or OTC markets. Currency options involve substantial currency risk, and may also involve credit, leverage or illiquidity risk.
Currency Swaps Risk. The Trust may enter into currency swaps, which are transactions in which one currency is simultaneously bought for a second
currency on a spot basis and sold for the second currency on a forward basis. Currency swaps involve the exchange of the rights of the Trust and another party to make or receive payments in specified currencies. Currency swaps usually involve the
delivery of the entire principal value of one designated currency in exchange for the other designated currency. Because currency swaps usually involve the delivery of the entire principal value of one designated currency in exchange for the other
designated currency, the entire principal value of a currency swap is subject to the risk that the other party to the swap will default on its contractual delivery obligations.
Over-the-Counter Trading Risk. The derivative instruments that may be
purchased or sold by the Trust may include instruments not traded on an exchange. The risk of nonperformance by the counterparty to an instrument may be greater than, and the ease with which the Trust can dispose of or enter into closing
transactions with respect to an instrument may be less than, the risk associated with an exchange traded instrument. In addition, significant disparities may exist between bid and asked prices for derivative instruments that
are not traded on an exchange. The absence of liquidity may make it difficult or impossible for the Trust to sell such instruments promptly at an acceptable price. Derivative instruments not traded on exchanges also are not subject to the same type
of
S-10
government regulation as exchange traded instruments, and many of the protections afforded to participants in a regulated environment may not be available in connection with the transactions.
Because derivatives traded in OTC markets generally are not guaranteed by an exchange or clearing corporation and generally do not require payment of margin, to the extent that the Trust has unrealized gains in such instruments or has deposited
collateral with its counterparties the Trust is at risk that its counterparties will become bankrupt or otherwise fail to honor its obligations.
Dodd-Frank Act Risk. The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (Dodd-Frank), enacted in July 2010, includes provisions
that comprehensively regulate the over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives markets for the first time. While the Commodity Futures Trading Commission
(CFTC) and other U.S. regulators have adopted many of the required Dodd-Frank regulations, certain regulations have only recently become effective and other regulations remain to be adopted. The full impact of Dodd-Frank on the Trust
remains uncertain.
OTC derivatives dealers are now required to register with the CFTC as swap dealers and will ultimately be required to
register with the SEC as security-based swap dealers. Registered swap dealers are subject to various regulatory requirements, including, but not limited to, margin, recordkeeping, reporting, transparency, position limits, limitations on
conflicts of interest, business conduct standards, minimum capital requirements and other regulatory requirements.
The CFTC requires that certain
interest rate swaps and certain credit default swaps must be executed in regulated markets and be submitted for clearing to regulated clearinghouses. The SEC is also expected to impose similar requirements on certain security-based derivatives in
the future. OTC derivatives trades submitted for clearing are subject to minimum initial and variation margin requirements set by the relevant clearinghouse, as well as margin requirements mandated by the CFTC, SEC and/or federal prudential
regulators. In addition, futures commission merchants (FCMs), who act as clearing members on behalf of customers for cleared OTC derivatives and futures contracts, also have discretion to increase the Trusts margin requirements for
these transactions beyond any regulatory and clearinghouse minimums subject to any restrictions on such discretion in the documentation between the FCM and the customer. These regulatory requirements may make it more difficult and costly for the
Trust to enter into highly tailored or customized transactions, potentially rendering certain investment strategies impossible or not economically feasible. If the Trust decides to execute and clear cleared OTC derivatives and/or futures contracts
through execution facilities, exchanges or clearinghouses, either indirectly through an executing broker, clearing member FCM or as a direct member, the Trust would be required to comply with the rules of the execution facility, exchange or
clearinghouse and other applicable law.
With respect to cleared OTC derivatives and futures contracts and options on futures, the Trust will not face a
clearinghouse directly but rather will do so through a FCM that is registered with the CFTC and/or SEC and that acts as a clearing member. The Trust may face the indirect risk of the failure of another clearing member customer to meet its
obligations to its clearing member. Such scenario could arise due to a default by the clearing member on its obligations to the clearinghouse simultaneously with a customers failure to meet its obligations to the clearing member.
Clearing member FCMs are required to post initial margin to the clearinghouses through which they clear their customers cleared OTC derivatives and
futures contracts, instead of using such initial margin in their businesses, as was widely permitted before Dodd-Frank. While an FCM may require its customer to post initial margin in excess of clearinghouse requirements, and certain clearinghouses
may share a portion of their earnings on initial margin with their clearing members, some portion of the initial margin that is passed through to the clearinghouse does not generate earnings for the FCM. The inability of FCMs to earn the same levels
of returns on initial margin for cleared OTC derivatives as they could earn with respect to non-cleared OTC derivatives may cause FCMs to charge higher fees, or provide less favorable pricing on cleared OTC
derivatives than swap dealers will provide for non-cleared OTC derivatives. Furthermore, customers, including the Trust, are subject to additional fees payable to FCMs with respect to cleared OTC derivatives,
which may raise the cost to the Trust of clearing as compared to trading non-cleared OTC derivatives bilaterally.
With respect to uncleared swaps, swap dealers are required to collect variation margin from the Trust and may be required by applicable regulations to collect
initial margin from the Trust. Both initial and variation margin may be
S-11
comprised of cash and/or securities, subject to applicable regulatory haircuts. Shares of investment companies (other than certain money market funds) may not be posted as collateral under
applicable regulations.
The CFTC and the U.S. commodities exchanges impose limits on the maximum net long or net short speculative positions that any
person may hold or control in any particular futures or options contracts traded on U.S. commodities exchanges. For example, the CFTC has historically imposed speculative position limits on a number of agricultural commodities (e.g., corn, oats,
wheat, soybeans and cotton) and United States commodities exchanges currently impose speculative position limits on many other commodities. The Trust could be required to liquidate positions it holds in order to comply with position limits or may
not be able to fully implement trading instructions generated by its trading models, in order to comply with position limits. Any such liquidation or limited implementation could result in substantial costs to the Trust.
Dodd-Frank significantly expanded the CFTCs authority to impose position limits with respect to agricultural commodities and other physical commodity
futures contracts, options on these futures contracts and economically equivalent swaps. In October 2020, the CFTC adopted a new set of speculative position limit rules with respect to agricultural commodities and other physical commodity futures
contracts, options on these futures contracts (core referenced futures contracts) and economically equivalent swaps. An economically equivalent swap is a swap with identical material contractual specifications, terms and conditions to a
core referenced futures contract, disregarding differences with respect to any of the following: (1) lot size specifications or notional amounts, (2) post-trade risk management arrangements and (3) delivery dates for
physically-settled swaps as long as these delivery dates diverge by less than one calendar day from the referenced contracts delivery date (or, for natural gas, two calendar days). A cash-settled swap could only be deemed to be economically
equivalent to a cash-settled referenced contract, and a physically-settled swap could only be deemed to be economically equivalent to a physically-settled referenced contract. However, a cash-settled swap that initially did not qualify as
economically equivalent due to the fact that there was no corresponding cash-settled core referenced futures contract could subsequently become an economically equivalent swap if a cash-settled futures contract market were to subsequently be
developed. The CFTCs new position limits rules include an exemption from limits for bona fide hedging transactions or positions. A bona fide hedging transaction or position may exceed the applicable federal position limits if the transaction
or position: (1) represents a substitute for transactions or positions made or to be made at a later time in a physical marketing channel; (2) is economically appropriate to the reduction of price risks in the conduct and management of a
commercial enterprise; and (3) arises from the potential change in value of (A) assets which a person owns, produces, manufactures, processes or merchandises, or anticipates owning, producing, manufacturing, processing or merchandising;
(B) liabilities which a person owes or anticipates incurring; or (C) services that a person provides or purchases, or anticipates providing or purchasing. The CFTCs new position rules set forth a list of enumerated bona fide hedges
for which a market participant is not required to request prior approval from the CFTC in order to hold a bona fide hedge position above the federal position limit. However, a market participant holding an enumerated bona fide hedge position still
would need to request an exemption from the relevant exchange for exchange-set limits. For non-enumerated bona fide hedge positions, a market participant may request
CFTC approval which must be granted prior to exceeding the applicable federal position limit, except where there is a demonstrated sudden or unforeseen increase in bona fide hedging needs (in which case the application must be submitted within five
business days after the market participant exceeds the applicable limit). The compliance dates for the CFTCs new federal speculative position limits are January 1, 2022 for the core referenced futures contracts and January 1, 2023
for economically equivalent swaps. While the ultimate effect of the final position limit rules are not yet known, these limits will likely restrict the ability of many market participants to trade in the commodities markets to the same extent as
they have in the past. These rules may, among other things, reduce liquidity, increase market volatility, limit the size and duration of positions available to market participants, and increase costs in these markets, which could adversely affect
the Trust.
These new regulations and the resulting increased costs and regulatory oversight requirements may result in market participants being required
or deciding to limit their trading activities, which could lead to decreased market liquidity and increased market volatility. In addition, transaction costs incurred by market participants are likely to be higher due to the increased costs of
compliance with the new regulations. These consequences could adversely affect the Trusts returns.
Additional Regulation of Derivatives.
Regulatory bodies outside the U.S. have also passed, proposed, or may propose in the future, legislation similar to Dodd-Frank or other legislation that could increase the costs of
S-12
participating in, or otherwise adversely impact the liquidity of, participating in the commodities markets. For example, the European Market Infrastructure Regulation (Regulation (EU) No
648/2012) (EMIR) introduced certain requirements in respect of OTC derivatives including:(i) the mandatory clearing of OTC derivative contracts declared subject to the clearing obligation; (ii) risk mitigation techniques in respect
of uncleared OTC derivative contracts, including the mandatory margining of uncleared OTC derivative contracts; and (iii) reporting and recordkeeping requirements in respect of all derivatives contracts. By way of further example, the European
Union Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (Directive 2014/65/EU) and Markets in Financial Instruments Regulation (Regulation (EU) No 600/2014) (together MiFID II), which have applied since January 3, 2018, govern the
provision of investment services and activities in relation to, as well as the organized trading of, financial instruments such as shares, bonds, units in collective investment schemes and derivatives. In particular, MiFID II requires European Union
Member States to apply position limits to the size of a net position a person can hold at any time in commodity derivatives traded on European Union trading venues and in economically equivalent OTC contracts. If the requirements of EMIR
and MiFID II apply, the cost of derivatives transactions is expected to increase.
In addition, regulations adopted by global prudential regulators that
are now in effect require certain prudentially regulated entities and certain of their affiliates and subsidiaries (including swap dealers) to include in their derivatives contracts and certain other financial contracts, terms that delay or restrict
the rights of counterparties (such as the Trust) to terminate such contracts, foreclose upon collateral, exercise other default rights or restrict transfers of credit support in the event that the prudentially regulated entity and/or its affiliates
are subject to certain types of resolution or insolvency proceedings. Similar regulations and laws have been adopted in non-U.S. jurisdictions that may apply to the Trusts counterparties located in those
jurisdictions. It is possible that these new requirements, as well as potential additional related government regulation, could adversely affect the Trusts ability to terminate existing derivatives contracts, exercise default rights or satisfy
obligations owed to it with collateral received under such contracts.
Rule 18f-4 Under the Investment Company
Act. Rule 18f-4 under the Investment Company Act permits the Trust to enter into Derivatives Transactions (as defined below) and certain other transactions notwithstanding the restrictions on the issuance
of senior securities under Section 18 of the Investment Company Act. Section 18 of the Investment Company Act, among other things, prohibits closed-end funds, including the Trust, from
issuing or selling any senior security representing indebtedness (unless the fund maintains 300% asset coverage) or any senior security representing stock (unless the fund maintains 200% asset coverage).
Under Rule 18f-4, Derivatives Transactions include the following: (1) any swap, security-based swap
(including a contract for differences), futures contract, forward contract, option (excluding purchased options), any combination of the foregoing, or any similar instrument, under which the Trust is or may be required to make any payment or
delivery of cash or other assets during the life of the instrument or at maturity or early termination, whether as margin or settlement payment or otherwise; (2) any short sale borrowing; (3) reverse repurchase agreements and similar
financing transactions (e.g., recourse and non-recourse tender option bonds, and borrowed bonds), if the Trust elects to treat these transactions as Derivatives Transactions under Rule 18f-4; and (4) when-issued or forward-settling securities (e.g., firm and standby commitments, including to-be-announced
(TBA) commitments, and dollar rolls) and non-standard settlement cycle securities, unless such transactions meet the Delayed-Settlement Securities Provision (as defined above under Investment
Policies and TechniquesWhen-Issued and Forward Commitment Securities).
Unless the Trust is relying on the Limited Derivatives User Exception
(as defined below), the Trust must comply with Rule 18f-4 with respect to its Derivatives Transactions. Rule 18f-4, among other things, requires the Trust to adopt and
implement a comprehensive written derivatives risk management program (DRMP) and comply with a relative or absolute limit on fund leverage risk calculated based on
value-at-risk (VaR). The DRMP is administered by a derivatives risk manager, who is appointed by the Trusts Board of Trustees (the
Board), including a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as defined in the Investment Company Act) (the Independent Trustees), and periodically reviews the DRMP and reports to the Board.
Rule 18f-4 provides an exception from the DRMP, VaR limit and certain other requirements if the Trusts
derivatives exposure is limited to 10% of its net assets (as calculated in accordance with Rule 18f-4) and the Trust
S-13
adopts and implements written policies and procedures reasonably designed to manage its derivatives risks (the Limited Derivatives User Exception).
MANAGEMENT OF THE TRUST
Investment Management Agreement
Although the Advisor
intends to devote such time and effort to the business of the Trust as is reasonably necessary to perform its duties to the Trust, the services of the Advisor are not exclusive and the Advisor provides similar services to other investment companies
and other clients and may engage in other activities.
The investment management agreement between the Advisor and the Trust (the Investment
Management Agreement) also provides that except for a loss resulting from a breach of fiduciary duty with respect to the receipt of compensation or a loss resulting from willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard by
the Advisor of its duties under the Investment Management Agreement, the Advisor is not liable for any error of judgment or mistake of law or for any loss suffered by the Advisor or the Trust in connection with the performance of the Investment
Management Agreement. The Investment Management Agreement also provides for indemnification by the Trust of the Advisor and each of the Advisors directors, officers, employees, agents, associates and controlling persons, and the directors,
partners, members, officers, employees and agents thereof (including any individual who serves at the Advisors request as director, officer, partner, member, trustee or the like of another entity) for liabilities and expenses incurred by them
in connection with their services to the Trust, subject to certain limitations and conditions.
The Investment Management Agreement provides for the Trust
to pay a monthly management fee at an annual rate equal to 0.55% of the average weekly value of the Trusts managed assets, plus the proceeds of ay debt securities or outstanding borrowings used for leverage. Managed Assets means
the total assets of the Trust (including any assets attributable to money borrowed for investment purposes) minus the sum of the Trusts accrued liabilities (other than money borrowed for investment purposes).
The Trust and the Advisor have entered into a fee waiver agreement (the Fee Waiver Agreement), pursuant to which the Advisor has contractually
agreed to waive the management fee with respect to any portion of the Trusts assets attributable to investments in any equity and fixed-income mutual funds and ETFs managed by the Advisor or its affiliates that have a contractual management
fee, through June 30, 2026. In addition, effective December 1, 2019, pursuant to the Fee Waiver Agreement, the Advisor has contractually agreed to waive its management fees by the amount of investment advisory fees the Trust pays to the
Advisor indirectly through its investment in money market funds advised by the Advisor or its affiliates, through June 30, 2026. The Fee Waiver Agreement may be continued from year to year thereafter, provided that such continuance is
specifically approved by the Advisor and the Trust (including by a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as defined in the Investment Company Act) (the Independent Trustees)). Neither the Advisor nor the
Trust is obligated to extend the Fee Waiver Agreement. The Fee Waiver Agreement may be terminated at any time, without the payment of any penalty, only by the Trust (upon the vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees or a majority of the
outstanding voting securities of the Trust), upon 90 days written notice by the Trust to the Advisor. Prior to December 1, 2019, the agreement to waive a portion of the Trusts management fee in connection with the Trusts
investment in affiliated money market funds was voluntary.
The Investment Management Agreement will continue in effect from year to year provided that
each continuance is specifically approved at least annually by both (1) the vote of a majority of the Board or the vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Trust (as such term is defined in the Investment Company Act) and
(2) by the vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not parties to the Investment Management Agreement or interested persons (as such term is defined in the Investment Company Act) of any such party, cast in person at a meeting
called for the purpose of voting on such approval. The Investment Management Agreement may be terminated as a whole at any time by the Trust, without the payment of any penalty, upon the vote of a majority of the Trustees or a majority of the
outstanding voting securities of the Trust or by the Advisor, on 60 days written notice by either party to the other which can be waived by the non-terminating party. The Investment Management Agreement
will terminate automatically in the event of its assignment (as such term is defined in the Investment Company Act and the rules thereunder).
S-14
The table below sets forth information about the total management fees paid by the Trust to the Advisor, and the
amounts waived by the Advisor, for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fiscal Year Ended |
|
Paid to the Advisor |
|
|
Waived by the Advisor |
|
December 31, 2024 |
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
4,544,341 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
2,065 |
|
December 31, 2023 |
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
4,049,194 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
2,132 |
|
December 31, 2022 |
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
4,467,146 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
2,971 |
|
Sub-Investment Advisory Agreements
BlackRock International Limited and BlackRock (Singapore) Limited (previously defined as the
Sub-Advisors), each a wholly owned subsidiary of BlackRock, will perform certain of
the day-to-day investment management of the Trust pursuant to separate sub-investment advisory agreements. The Sub-Advisors receive a portion of the management fee paid by the Trust to the Advisor. The Advisor, and not the Trust, will pay an
annual sub-advisory fee to the Sub-Advisors. For that portion of the Trust for which each Sub-Advisor acts as
sub-advisor, the Advisor will pay to such Sub-Advisor, an annual sub-advisory fee equal to a percentage of the management fee
received by the Advisor from the Trust with respect to the average daily value of the Managed Assets of the Trust allocated to such Sub-Advisor.
The sub-investment advisory agreements provide that, in the absence of willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross
negligence or reckless disregard of its obligations thereunder, the Trust will indemnify the Sub-Advisors and with respect to BIL, its directors, officers, employees, agents, associates and control
persons for liabilities incurred by them in connection with their services to the Trust, subject to certain limitations.
Although the Sub-Advisors intend to devote such time and effort to the business of the Trust as is reasonably necessary to perform its duties to the Trust, the services of
the Sub-Advisors are not exclusive and the Sub-Advisors provide similar services to other investment companies and other clients and may engage in
other activities.
The sub-investment advisory agreements will continue in effect for a period of two
years from its effective date, and if not sooner terminated, will continue in effect for successive periods of 12 months thereafter, provided that each continuance is specifically approved at least annually by both (1) the vote of a majority of
the Board or the vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Trust (as defined in the Investment Company Act) and (2) by the vote of a majority of the trustees who are not parties to such agreement or interested persons (as
such term is defined in the Investment Company Act) of any such party, cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval. The sub-investment advisory agreements may be
terminated as a whole at any time by the Trust without the payment of any penalty, upon the vote of a majority of the Board or a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Trust or by the Advisor or
the Sub-Advisor, on 60 days written notice by either party to the other. The sub-investment advisory agreements will also terminate
automatically in the event of their assignment (as such term is defined in the Investment Company Act and the rules thereunder).
Biographical
Information Pertaining to the Trustees
The Board consists of ten individuals (each, a Trustee), eight of whom are Independent Trustees.
The registered investment companies advised by the Advisor or its affiliates (the BlackRock-advised Funds) are organized into one complex of closed-end funds and open-end non-index fixed-income funds (the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex), one complex
of open-end equity, multi-asset, index and money market funds (the BlackRock Multi-Asset Complex) and one complex of exchange-traded funds (each, a BlackRock Fund
Complex). The Trust is included in the BlackRock Fund Complex referred to as the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex. The Trustees also oversee as board members the operations of the other open-end and closed-end registered investment companies included in the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex.
Please refer to the section of the Trusts June 5, 2024 definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A for the annual meeting of the Trusts
shareholders entitled: Proposal 1Board Members/Nominees Biographical Information, which is incorporated by reference herein, for a discussion of the Trusts Trustees, their principal occupations and
S-15
other affiliates during the past five years, the number of portfolios in the Fixed-Income Complex that they oversee, and other information about them.
Board Leadership Structure and Oversight
Please refer
to the sections of the Trusts definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A for the annual meeting of the Trusts shareholders entitled: Proposal 1Board Leadership Structure and Oversight and Appendix
ECommittees of the Board which is incorporated by reference herein, for a discussion of the Boards leadership structure and oversight.
During the Trusts fiscal year ended December 31, 2024, the Boards Audit Committee, Governance Committee, Compliance Committee, Performance
Oversight Committee, Discount Committee, Securities Lending Committee and Executive Committee met the following number of times:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number of Audit Committee Meetings |
|
Number of Governance Committee Meetings |
|
Number of Compliance Committee Meetings |
|
Number of Performance Oversight Committee Meetings |
|
Number of Discount Committee Meetings |
|
Number of Securities Lending Committee Meetings |
|
Number of Executive Committee Meetings |
|
|
8 |
|
5 |
|
4 |
|
4 |
|
1 |
|
2 |
|
1 |
|
|
Trustee Share Ownership
Information relating to each Trustees share ownership in the Trust and in all BlackRock-advised Funds that are currently overseen by the respective
Trustee (Supervised Funds) as of December 31, 2024 is set forth in the chart below. Amounts shown may include shares as to which a Trustee has indirect beneficial ownership, such as through participation in certain family accounts,
529 college savings plan interests, or similar arrangements where the Trustee has beneficial economic interest but not a direct ownership interest.
|
|
|
|
|
Name of Trustee |
|
Dollar Range in the Trust* |
|
Aggregate Dollar Range in Supervised Funds* |
Independent Trustees |
|
|
|
|
Cynthia L. Egan |
|
None |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
|
|
|
Lorenzo A. Flores |
|
Over $100,000 |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
|
|
|
Stayce D. Harris |
|
Over $100,000 |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
|
|
|
J. Phillip Holloman |
|
Over $100,000 |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
|
|
|
R. Glenn Hubbard |
|
Over $100,000 |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
|
|
|
W. Carl Kester |
|
Over $100,000 |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
|
|
|
Catherine A. Lynch |
|
Over $100,000 |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
|
|
|
Arthur P. Steinmetz |
|
$10,001-$50,000 |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
|
|
|
Interested Trustees |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Robert Fairbairn |
|
None |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
|
|
|
John M. Perlowski |
|
None |
|
Over $ 100,000 |
S-16
* |
Includes share equivalents owned under the deferred compensation plan in the Supervised Funds by certain
Independent Trustees who have participated in the deferred compensation plan of the Supervised Funds. |
Compensation of Trustees
Each Independent Trustee is paid an annual retainer of $370,000 per year for his or her services as a Board member of the BlackRock-advised Funds,
including the Trust, together with out-of-pocket expenses in accordance with a Board policy on travel and other business expenses relating to attendance at meetings. In
addition, the Chair of the Board and the Vice Chair of the Board are paid an additional annual retainer of $140,000 and $84,000, respectively. The Chairs of the Audit Committee, Performance Oversight Committee, Compliance Committee, Governance and
Nominating Committee, Discount Committee and Securities Lending Committee are each paid an additional annual retainer of $55,000, $42,500, $50,000, $42,500, $25,000 and $20,000, respectively. Each of the other members of the Audit Committee,
Compliance Committee, Governance and Nominating Committee, Discount Committee and Securities Lending Committee are paid an additional annual retainer of $30,000, $25,000, $25,000, $20,000 and $15,000, respectively, for his or her service on such
committee. An Independent Trustee may receive additional compensation for his or her service as a member or Chair, as applicable, of one or more ad hoc committees of the Board. The Trust will pay a pro rata portion quarterly (based on relative net
assets) of the foregoing Trustee fees paid by the funds in the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex.
The Independent Trustees have agreed that a maximum of 50%
of each Independent Trustees total compensation paid by funds in the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex may be deferred pursuant to the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complexs deferred compensation plan. Under the deferred compensation plan,
deferred amounts earn a return for the Independent Trustees as though equivalent dollar amounts had been invested in shares of certain funds in the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex selected by the Independent Trustees. This has approximately the same
economic effect for the Independent Trustees as if they had invested the deferred amounts in such funds in the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex. The deferred compensation plan is not funded and obligations thereunder represent general unsecured claims
against the general assets of a fund and are recorded as a liability for accounting purposes.
Prior to January 1, 2024, the Chair of the Board and
the Vice Chair of the Board were paid an additional annual retainer of $100,000 and $60,000, respectively. The Chairs of the Audit Committee, Performance Oversight Committee, Compliance Committee, and Governance and Nominating Committee were paid an
additional annual retainer of $45,000, $37,500, $45,000 and $37,500, respectively.
The following table sets forth the compensation paid to the Trustees
by the Trust for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2024, and the aggregate compensation, including deferred compensation amounts, paid to them by all BlackRock-advised Funds for the calendar year ended December 31, 2024. Messrs. Fairbairn
and Perlowski serve without compensation from the Trust because of their affiliation with BlackRock, Inc. and the Advisor.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name(1) |
|
Compensation from the Trust |
|
|
Estimated Annual Benefits upon Retirement |
|
|
Aggregate Compensation from the BlackRock-Advised Funds(2)(3) |
|
Independent Trustees |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cynthia L. Egan |
|
|
$4,269 |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
$655,000 |
|
Lorenzo A. Flores |
|
|
$3,103 |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
$420,000 |
|
Stayce D. Harris |
|
|
$2,921 |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
$395,000 |
|
J. Phillip Holloman |
|
|
$3,139 |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
$425,000 |
|
R. Glenn Hubbard |
|
|
$4,411 |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
$600,000 |
|
W. Carl Kester |
|
|
$4,825 |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
$746,000 |
|
Catherine A. Lynch |
|
|
$4,488 |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
$695,000 |
|
Arthur P. Steinmetz(4) |
|
|
$3,384 |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
$534,206 |
|
Interested Trustees |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Robert Fairbairn |
|
|
None |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
None |
|
John M. Perlowski |
|
|
None |
|
|
|
None |
|
|
|
None |
|
S-17
(1) |
For the number of BlackRock-advised Funds from which each Trustee receives compensation, see the Biographical
Information section beginning on page S-15. |
(2) |
For the Independent Trustees, this amount represents the aggregate compensation earned from the funds in the
BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex during the calendar year ended December 31, 2024. Of this amount, Mr. Flores, Ms. Harris, Mr. Holloman, Dr. Hubbard, Dr. Kester, Ms. Lynch and Mr. Steinmetz deferred $210,000,
$197,500, $212,500, $300,000, $58,641, $34,750 and $266,957, respectively, pursuant to the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complexs deferred compensation plan. |
(3) |
Total amount of deferred compensation payable by the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex to Mr. Flores,
Ms. Harris, Mr. Holloman, Dr. Hubbard, Dr. Kester, Ms. Lynch and Mr. Steinmetz is $743,845, $726,494, $773,663, $5,010,835, $2,155,608, $631,953 and $278,737, respectively, as of December 31, 2024. Ms. Egan
did not participate in the deferred compensation plan as of December 31, 2024. |
(4) |
Mr. Steinmetz was appointed as a member and Chair of the Performance Oversight Committee effective
January 1, 2024 and January 19, 2024, respectively, and appointed as a member of the Audit Committee effective January 19, 2024. |
Independent Trustee Ownership of Securities
As of
December 31, 2024, none of the Independent Trustees of the Trust or their immediate family members owned beneficially or of record any securities of BlackRock or any affiliate of any BlackRock person controlling, controlled by or under common
control with BlackRock nor did any Independent Trustee of the Trust or their immediate family members have any material interest in any transaction, or series of similar transactions, during the most recently completed two calendar years involving
the Trust, BlackRock or any affiliate of any BlackRock person controlling, controlled by or under common control with the Trust or BlackRock.
[As of the
date of this SAI, the officers and Trustees of the Trust, as a group, beneficially owned less than 1% of the outstanding common shares of the Trust.]
Information Pertaining to the Officers
Please refer to
the section of the Trusts definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A for the annual meeting of the Trusts shareholders entitled: Appendix F Information Pertaining to the Executive Officers of the Funds, which is
incorporated by reference herein, for certain biographical and other information relating to the officers of the Trust who are not Trustees.
Indemnification of Trustees and Officers
The governing
documents of the Trust generally provide that, to the extent permitted by applicable law, the Trust will indemnify its Trustees and officers against liabilities and expenses incurred in connection with litigation in which they may be involved
because of their offices with the Trust unless, as to liability to the Trust or its investors, it is finally adjudicated that they engaged in willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of the duties involved in their
offices. In addition, the Trust will not indemnify Trustees with respect to any matter as to which Trustees did not act in good faith in the reasonable belief that his or her action was in the best interest of the Trust or, in the case of any
criminal proceeding, as to which Trustees had reasonable cause to believe that the conduct was unlawful. Indemnification provisions contained in the Trusts governing documents are subject to any limitations imposed by applicable law.
Closed-end funds in the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex, including the Trust, have also entered into a separate
indemnification agreement with the board members of each board of such funds (the Indemnification Agreement). The Indemnification Agreement (i) extends the indemnification provisions contained in a funds governing documents to
board members who leave that funds board and serve on an advisory board of a different fund in the BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex; (ii) sets in place the terms of the indemnification provisions of a funds governing documents once a
board member retires from a board; and (iii) in the case of board members who left the board of a fund in connection with or prior to the board consolidation that occurred in 2007 as a result of the merger of BlackRock and Merrill
Lynch & Co., Inc.s investment management business, clarifies that such fund continues to indemnify the trustee for claims arising out of his or her past service to that fund.
S-18
Portfolio Management
Portfolio Manager Assets Under Management
The following
table sets forth information about funds and accounts other than the Trust for which the portfolio managers are primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio
management as of December 31, 2024:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number of Other Accounts Managed
and Assets by Account Type |
|
Number of Other Accounts and
Assets for Which Advisory Fee is
Performance-Based |
Name of Portfolio
Manager |
|
Other
Registered
Investment
Companies |
|
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles |
|
Other
Accounts |
|
Other
Registered
Investment
Companies |
|
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles |
|
Other
Accounts |
Mitchell Garfin |
|
29 |
|
25 |
|
131 |
|
0 |
|
0 |
|
5 |
|
|
$43.55 Billion |
|
$9.90 Billion |
|
$18.01 Billion |
|
$0 |
|
$0 |
|
$652.1 Million |
Scott MacLellan, CFA, CMT |
|
10 |
|
15 |
|
122 |
|
0 |
|
2 |
|
3 |
|
|
$8.93 Billion |
|
$3.02 Billion |
|
$44.78 Billion |
|
$0 |
|
$118.3 Million |
|
$1.02 Billion |
David Delbos |
|
28 |
|
25 |
|
118 |
|
0 |
|
0 |
|
5 |
|
|
$42.38 Billion |
|
$9.75 Billion |
|
$17.54 Billion |
|
$0 |
|
$0 |
|
$652.1 Million |
Akiva Dickstein |
|
17 |
|
21 |
|
196 |
|
0 |
|
0 |
|
3 |
|
|
$20.68 Billion |
|
$6.41 Billion |
|
$85.24 Billion |
|
$0 |
|
$0 |
|
$1.02 Billion |
Portfolio Manager Compensation Overview
The discussion below describes the portfolio managers compensation as of December 31, 2024.
The Advisors financial arrangements with its portfolio managers, its competitive compensation and its career path emphasis at all levels reflect the
value senior management places on key resources. Compensation may include a variety of components and may vary from year to year based on a number of factors. The principal components of compensation include a base salary, a performance-based
discretionary bonus, participation in various benefits programs and one or more of the incentive compensation programs established by the Advisor.
Base Compensation. Generally, portfolio managers receive base compensation based on their position with the firm.
Discretionary Incentive Compensation. Discretionary incentive compensation is a function of several components: the performance of BlackRock, Inc., the
performance of the portfolio managers group within the Advisor, the investment performance, including risk-adjusted returns, of the firms assets under management or supervision by that portfolio manager relative to predetermined
benchmarks, and the individuals performance and contribution to the overall performance of these portfolios and the Advisor. In most cases, these benchmarks are the same as the benchmark or benchmarks against which the performance of the Trust
or other accounts managed by the portfolio managers are measured. Among other things, the Advisors Chief Investment Officers make a subjective determination with respect to each portfolio managers compensation based on the performance of
the Trust and other accounts managed by each portfolio manager relative to the various benchmarks. Performance of fixed income funds is measured on a pre-tax and/or
after-tax basis over various time periods including 1-, 3- and 5- year periods, as
applicable. With respect to these portfolio managers, such benchmarks for the Trust and other accounts are:
S-19
|
|
|
Portfolio Managers |
|
Applicable Benchmarks |
Mitchell Garfin,
CFA David Delbos |
|
A combination of market-based indices (e.g., The Bloomberg U.S. Corporate High Yield 2% Issuer Cap Index), certain customized indices and
certain fund industry peer groups. |
Scott MacLellan, CFA, CMT |
|
A combination of market-based indices (e.g., Bank of America Merrill Lynch U.S. Corporate & Government Index, 1-3 Years), certain customized indices and certain fund industry peer groups. |
Akiva Dickstein |
|
A combination of market-based indices (e.g. Bloomberg US Aggregate Index, Bloomberg US Universal Index and Bloomberg Intermediate Aggregate
Index), certain customized indices and certain fund industry peer groups. |
Distribution of Discretionary Incentive Compensation. Discretionary incentive compensation is distributed to
portfolio managers in a combination of cash, deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock awards, and/or deferred cash awards that notionally track the return of certain Advisor investment products.
Portfolio managers receive their annual discretionary incentive compensation in the form of cash. Portfolio managers whose total compensation is above a
specified threshold also receive deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock awards annually as part of their discretionary incentive compensation. Paying a portion of discretionary incentive compensation in the form of deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock puts
compensation earned by a portfolio manager for a given year at risk based on the Advisors ability to sustain and improve its performance over future periods. In some cases, additional deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock may be granted
to certain key employees as part of a long-term incentive award to aid in retention, align interests with long-term shareholders and motivate performance. Deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock awards are generally granted in the form of BlackRock, Inc.
restricted stock units that vest pursuant to the terms of the applicable plan and, once vested, settle in BlackRock, Inc. common stock. The portfolio managers of this Trust have deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock awards.
For certain portfolio managers, a portion of the discretionary incentive compensation is also distributed in the form of deferred cash awards that notionally
track the returns of select Advisor investment products they manage, which provides direct alignment of portfolio manager discretionary incentive compensation with investment product results. Deferred cash awards vest ratably over a number of years
and, once vested, settle in the form of cash. Only portfolio managers who manage specified products and whose total compensation is above a specified threshold are eligible to participate in the deferred cash award program.
Other Compensation Benefits. In addition to base salary and discretionary incentive compensation, portfolio managers may be eligible to
receive or participate in one or more of the following:
Incentive Savings PlansBlackRock, Inc. has created a variety of incentive
savings plans in which BlackRock, Inc. employees are eligible to participate, including a 401(k) plan, the BlackRock Retirement Savings Plan (RSP), and the BlackRock Employee Stock Purchase Plan (ESPP). The employer contribution components of
the RSP include a company match equal to 50% of the first 8% of eligible pay contributed to the plan capped at $5,000 per year, and a company retirement contribution equal to 3-5% of eligible
compensation up to the Internal Revenue Service limit ($345,000 for 2024). The RSP offers a range of investment options, including registered investment companies and collective investment funds managed by the firm. BlackRock, Inc. contributions
follow the investment direction set by participants for their own contributions or, absent participant investment direction, are invested into a target date fund that corresponds to, or is closest to, the year in which the participant attains age
65. The ESPP allows for investment in BlackRock, Inc. common stock at a 5% discount on the fair market value of the stock on the purchase date. Annual participation in the ESPP is limited to the purchase of 1,000 shares of common stock or
a dollar value of $25,000 based on its fair market value on the purchase date. All of the eligible portfolio managers are eligible to participate in these plans.
Securities Ownership of Portfolio Managers
S-20
As of December 31, 2024, the end of the Trusts most recently completed fiscal year end, the dollar
range of securities beneficially owned by each portfolio manager in the Trust is shown below:
|
|
|
Portfolio Manager |
|
Dollar Range of Equity
Securities of the Trust
Beneficially Owned |
Mitchell Garfin, CFA |
|
$10,001 - $50,000 |
David Delbos |
|
$50,001 $100,000 |
Scott MacLellan, CFA, CMT |
|
$10,001 - $50,000 |
Akiva Dickstein |
|
$50,001 - $100,000 |
Potential Material Conflicts of Interest
The Advisors have built a professional working environment, firm-wide compliance culture and compliance procedures and systems designed to protect against
potential incentives that may favor one account over another. The Advisors have adopted policies and procedures that address the allocation of investment opportunities, execution of portfolio transactions, personal trading by employees and other
potential conflicts of interest that are designed to ensure that all client accounts are treated equitably over time. Nevertheless, the Advisors furnish investment management and advisory services to numerous clients in addition to the Trust, and
the Advisors may, consistent with applicable law, make investment recommendations to other clients or accounts (including accounts which are hedge funds or have performance or higher fees paid to the Advisors, or in which portfolio managers have a
personal interest in the receipt of such fees), which may be the same as or different from those made to the Trust. In addition, BlackRock, Inc., its affiliates and significant shareholders and any officer, director, shareholder or employee may or
may not have an interest in the securities whose purchase and sale the Advisors recommend to the Trust. BlackRock, Inc. or any of its affiliates or significant shareholders, or any officer, director, shareholder, employee or any member of their
families may take different actions than those recommended to the Trust by the Advisors with respect to the same securities. Moreover, the Advisors may refrain from rendering any advice or services concerning securities of companies of which any of
BlackRock, Inc.s (or its affiliates or significant shareholders) officers, directors or employees are directors or officers, or companies as to which BlackRock, Inc. or any of its affiliates or significant shareholders or the
officers, directors and employees of any of them has any substantial economic interest or possesses material non-public information. Certain portfolio managers also may manage accounts whose investment
strategies may at times be opposed to the strategy utilized for a fund. It should also be noted that Messrs. Garfin, MacLellan, Delbos and Dickstein may be managing hedge fund and/or long only accounts, or may be part of a team managing hedge fund
and/or long only accounts, subject to incentive fees. Messrs. Garfin, MacLellan, Delbos and Dickstein may therefore be entitled to receive a portion of any incentive fees earned on such accounts.
As fiduciaries, the Advisors owe a duty of loyalty to their clients and must treat each client fairly. When the Advisors purchase or sell securities for more
than one account, the trades must be allocated in a manner consistent with its fiduciary duties. The Advisors attempt to allocate investments in a fair and equitable manner among client accounts, with no account receiving preferential treatment. To
this end, BlackRock, Inc. has adopted policies that are intended to ensure reasonable efficiency in client transactions and provide the Advisors with sufficient flexibility to allocate investments in a manner that is consistent with the particular
investment discipline and client base, as appropriate.
Proxy Voting Policies
The Board has delegated the voting of proxies for the Trusts securities to the Advisor pursuant to the
Closed-End Fund Proxy Voting Policy. The Advisor has adopted the BlackRock Active Investment Stewardship Global Engagement and Voting Guidelines (the BAIS Guidelines) with respect to certain
funds, including the Trust.
Copies of the Closed-End Fund Proxy Voting Policy and the BAIS Guidelines are
attached as Appendix B to this SAI.
S-21
Information on how the Trust voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent 12-month period ended June 30 is available (i) without charge, upon request, by calling (800) 882-0052, (ii) at www.blackrock.com and (iii) on the SECs
website at http://www.sec.gov.
Codes of Ethics
The
Trust and the Advisors have adopted codes of ethics pursuant to Rule 17j-1 under the Investment Company Act. These codes permit personnel subject to the codes to invest in securities, including securities
that may be purchased or held by the Trust. These codes may be obtained by calling the SEC at (202) 551-8090. These codes of ethics are available on the EDGAR Database on the SECs website
(http://www.sec.gov), and copies of these codes may be obtained, after paying a duplicating fee, by electronic request at the following e-mail address: publicinfo@sec.gov.
Other Information
BlackRock, Inc. is independent in
ownership and governance, with no single majority stockholder and a majority of independent directors.
PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS AND BROKERAGE
Subject to policies established by the Board, the Advisors are primarily responsible for the execution of the Trusts portfolio transactions and the
allocation of brokerage. The Advisors do not execute transactions through any particular broker or dealer, but seeks to obtain the best net results for the Trust, taking into account such factors as price (including the applicable brokerage
commission or dealer spread), size of order, difficulty of execution, operational facilities of the firm and the firms risk and skill in positioning blocks of securities. While the Advisors generally seek reasonable trade execution costs, the
Trust does not necessarily pay the lowest spread or commission available, and payment of the lowest commission or spread is not necessarily consistent with obtaining the best price and execution in particular transactions. Subject to applicable
legal requirements, the Advisors may select a broker based partly upon brokerage or research services provided to the Advisors and their clients, including the Trust. In return for such services, the Advisors may cause the Trust to pay a higher
commission than other brokers would charge if the Advisors determine in good faith that the commission is reasonable in relation to the services provided.
In selecting brokers or dealers to execute portfolio transactions, the Advisors seek to obtain the best price and most favorable execution for the Trust,
taking into account a variety of factors including: (i) the size, nature and character of the security or instrument being traded and the markets in which it is purchased or sold; (ii) the desired timing of the transaction; (iii) the
Advisors knowledge of the expected commission rates and spreads currently available; (iv) the activity existing and expected in the market for the particular security or instrument, including any anticipated execution difficulties;
(v) the full range of brokerage services provided; (vi) the brokers or dealers capital; (vii) the quality of research and research services provided; (viii) the reasonableness of the commission, dealer spread or its
equivalent for the specific transaction; and (ix) the Advisors knowledge of any actual or apparent operational problems of a broker or dealer.
Section 28(e) of the Exchange Act (Section 28(e)) permits an investment adviser, under certain circumstances and, if applicable, subject
to the restrictions of MiFID II as described further below, to cause an account to pay a broker or dealer a commission for effecting a transaction that exceeds the amount another broker or dealer would have charged for effecting the same transaction
in recognition of the value of brokerage and research services provided by that broker or dealer. This includes commissions paid on riskless principal transactions under certain conditions. Brokerage and research services include:
(1) furnishing advice as to the value of securities, including pricing and appraisal advice, credit analysis, risk measurement analysis, performance and other analysis, as well as the advisability of investing in, purchasing or selling
securities, and the availability of securities or purchasers or sellers of securities; (2) furnishing analyses and reports concerning issuers, industries, securities, economic factors and trends, portfolio strategy, and the performance of
accounts; and (3) effecting securities transactions and performing functions incidental to securities transactions (such as clearance, settlement, and custody). The Advisors believe that access to independent investment research is beneficial
to its investment decision-making processes and, therefore, to the Trust.
S-22
The Advisors, unless prohibited by applicable law, may participate in client commission arrangements under which
the Advisors may execute transactions through a broker-dealer and request that the broker-dealer allocate a portion of the commissions or commission credits to another firm that provides research to the Advisors. The Advisors believe that research
services obtained through soft dollar or commission sharing arrangements enhance its investment decision-making capabilities, thereby increasing the prospects for higher investment returns. The Advisors will engage only in soft dollar or commission
sharing transactions that comply with the requirements of Section 28(e) and MiFID II. Under MiFID II, European Union (EU) investment managers, including BIL, pay for any research out of their own resources and not through soft
dollars or commission sharing arrangements. The Advisors regularly evaluate the soft dollar products and services utilized, as well as the overall soft dollar and commission sharing arrangements to ensure that trades are executed by firms that are
regarded as best able to execute trades for client accounts, while at the same time providing access to the research and other services the Advisors view as impactful to its trading results.
The Advisors, unless prohibited by applicable law, may utilize soft dollars and related services, including research (whether prepared by the broker-dealer or
prepared by a third-party and provided to the Advisors by the broker-dealer) and execution or brokerage services within applicable rules and the Advisors policies to the extent that such permitted services do not compromise the Advisors
ability to seek to obtain best execution. In this regard, the portfolio management investment and/or trading teams may consider a variety of factors, including the degree to which the broker-dealer: (a) provides access to company management;
(b) provides access to their analysts; (c) provides meaningful/insightful research notes on companies or other potential investments; (d) facilitates calls on which meaningful or insightful ideas about companies or potential
investments are discussed; (e) facilitates conferences at which meaningful or insightful ideas about companies or potential investments are discussed; or (f) provides research tools such as market data, financial analysis, and other third
party related research and brokerage tools that aid in the investment process.
Research-oriented services for which the Advisors, unless prohibited by
applicable law, might pay with Trust commissions may be in written form or through direct contact with individuals and may include information as to particular companies or industries and securities or groups of securities, as well as market,
economic, or institutional advice and statistical information, political developments and technical market information that assists in the valuation of investments. Except as noted immediately below, research services furnished by brokers may be
used in servicing some or all client accounts and not all services may be used in connection with the Trust or account that paid commissions to the broker providing such services. In some cases, research information received from brokers by
investment company management personnel, or personnel principally responsible for the Advisors individually managed portfolios, is not necessarily shared by and between such personnel. Any investment advisory or other fees paid by the Trust to
the Advisors are not reduced as a result of the Advisors receipt of research services. In some cases, the Advisors may receive a service from a broker that has both a research and a
non-research use. When this occurs the Advisors make a good faith allocation, under all the circumstances, between the research and non-research uses of the
service. The percentage of the service that is used for research purposes may be paid for with client commissions, while each Advisor will use its own funds to pay for the percentage of the service that is used for
non-research purposes. In making this good faith allocation, the Advisors face a potential conflict of interest, but the Advisors believes that its allocation procedures are reasonably designed to ensure that
it appropriately allocates the anticipated use of such services to their research and non-research uses.
Effective January 3, 2018 under MiFID II, investment managers in the EU, including BIL, are no longer able to use soft dollars to pay for research from
brokers. Investment managers in the EU are required to either pay for research out of their own profit and loss or agree with clients to have research costs paid by clients through research payment accounts that are funded out of execution
commissions or by a specific client research charge, provided that the payments for research are unbundled from the payments for execution. MiFID II restricts the use of soft dollars by sub-advisers to the
Trust located in the EU, such as BIL, if applicable. BIL will pay for any research out of its own resources and not through soft dollars or commission sharing arrangements.
Payments of commissions to brokers who are affiliated persons of the Trust will be made in accordance with Rule 17e-1
under the Investment Company Act.
From time to time, the Trust may purchase new issues of securities in a fixed price offering. In these situations, the
broker may be a member of the selling group that will, in addition to selling securities, provide the Advisor with
S-23
research services. The Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. has adopted rules expressly permitting these
types of arrangements under certain circumstances. Generally, the broker will provide research credits in these situations at a rate that is higher than that available for typical secondary market transactions. These arrangements may not
fall within the safe harbor of Section 28(e).
The Advisors do not consider sales of shares of the investment companies it advises as a factor in the
selection of brokers or dealers to execute portfolio transactions for the Trust; however, whether or not a particular broker or dealer sells shares of the investment companies advised by the Advisor neither qualifies nor disqualifies such broker or
dealer to execute transactions for those investment companies.
The Trust anticipates that its brokerage transactions involving foreign securities
generally will be conducted primarily on the principal stock exchanges of the applicable country. Foreign equity securities may be held by the Trust in the form of depositary receipts, or other securities convertible into foreign equity securities.
Depositary receipts may be listed on stock exchanges, or traded in OTC markets in the United States or Europe, as the case may be. American Depositary Receipts, like other securities traded in the United States, will be subject to negotiated
commission rates.
The Trust may invest in certain securities traded in the OTC market and intends to deal directly with the dealers who make a market in
the particular securities, except in those circumstances in which better prices and execution are available elsewhere. Under the Investment Company Act, persons affiliated with the Trust and persons who are affiliated with such affiliated persons
are prohibited from dealing with the Trust as principal in the purchase and sale of securities unless a permissive order allowing such transactions is obtained from the SEC. Since transactions in the OTC market usually involve transactions with the
dealers acting as principal for their own accounts, the Trust will not deal with affiliated persons in connection with such transactions. However, an affiliated person of the Trust may serve as its broker in OTC transactions conducted on an agency
basis provided that, among other things, the fee or commission received by such affiliated broker is reasonable and fair compared to the fee or commission received by non-affiliated brokers in connection with
comparable transactions.
OTC issues, including most fixed-income securities such as corporate debt and U.S. Government securities, are normally traded on
a net basis without a stated commission, through dealers acting for their own account and not as brokers. The Trust will primarily engage in transactions with these dealers or deal directly with the issuer unless a better price or
execution could be obtained by using a broker. Prices paid to a dealer with respect to both foreign and domestic securities will generally include a spread, which is the difference between the prices at which the dealer is willing to
purchase and sell the specific security at the time, and includes the dealers normal profit.
Purchases of money market instruments by the Trust are
made from dealers, underwriters and issuers. The Trust does not currently expect to incur any brokerage commission expense on such transactions because money market instruments are generally traded on a net basis with dealers acting as
principal for their own accounts without a stated commission. The price of the security, however, usually includes a profit to the dealer.
Securities
purchased in underwritten offerings include a fixed amount of compensation to the underwriter, generally referred to as the underwriters concession or discount. When securities are purchased or sold directly from or to an issuer, no
commissions or discounts are paid.
The Advisors may seek to obtain an undertaking from issuers of commercial paper or dealers selling commercial paper to
consider the repurchase of such securities from the Trust prior to maturity at their original cost plus interest (sometimes adjusted to reflect the actual maturity of the securities), if it believes that the Trusts anticipated need for
liquidity makes such action desirable. Any such repurchase prior to maturity reduces the possibility that the Trust would incur a capital loss in liquidating commercial paper, especially if interest rates have risen since acquisition of such
commercial paper.
Investment decisions for the Trust and for other investment accounts managed by the Advisors are made independently of each other in
light of differing conditions. The Advisors allocate investments among client accounts in a fair and equitable manner. A variety of factors will be considered in making such allocations. These factors include: (i) investment objectives or
strategies for particular accounts, including sector, industry, country or region and capitalization weightings, (ii) tax considerations of an account, (iii) risk or investment concentration
S-24
parameters for an account, (iv) supply or demand for a security at a given price level, (v) size of available investment, (vi) cash availability and liquidity requirements for
accounts, (vii) regulatory restrictions, (viii) minimum investment size of an account, (ix) relative size of account, and (x) such other factors as may be approved by the Advisors general counsel. Moreover, investments may
not be allocated to one client account over another based on any of the following considerations: (i) to favor one client account at the expense of another, (ii) to generate higher fees paid by one client account over another or to produce
greater performance compensation to the Advisors, (iii) to develop or enhance a relationship with a client or prospective client, (iv) to compensate a client for past services or benefits rendered to the Advisors or to induce future
services or benefits to be rendered to the Advisors, or (v) to manage or equalize investment performance among different client accounts.
Equity
securities will generally be allocated among client accounts within the same investment mandate on a pro rata basis. This pro-rata allocation may result in the Trust receiving less of a particular security
than if pro-ration had not occurred. All allocations of equity securities will be subject, where relevant, to share minimums established for accounts and compliance constraints.
Initial public offerings of securities may be over-subscribed and subsequently trade at a premium in the secondary market. When the Advisors are given an
opportunity to invest in such an initial offering or new or hot issue, the supply of securities available for client accounts is often less than the amount of securities the accounts would otherwise take. In order to allocate
these investments fairly and equitably among client accounts over time, each portfolio manager or a member of his or her respective investment team will indicate to the Advisors trading desk their level of interest in a particular offering
with respect to eligible clients accounts for which that team is responsible. Initial public offerings of U.S. equity securities will be identified as eligible for particular client accounts that are managed by portfolio teams who have
indicated interest in the offering based on market capitalization of the issuer of the security and the investment mandate of the client account and in the case of international equity securities, the country where the offering is taking place and
the investment mandate of the client account. Generally, shares received during the initial public offering will be allocated among participating client accounts within each investment mandate on a pro rata basis. In situations where supply is too
limited to be allocated among all accounts for which the investment is eligible, portfolio managers may rotate such investment opportunities among one or more accounts so long as the rotation system provides for fair access for all client accounts
over time. Other allocation methodologies that are considered by the Advisors to be fair and equitable to clients may be used as well.
Because different
accounts may have differing investment objectives and policies, the Advisors may buy and sell the same securities at the same time for different clients based on the particular investment objective, guidelines and strategies of those accounts. For
example, the Advisors may decide that it may be entirely appropriate for a growth fund to sell a security at the same time a value fund is buying that security. To the extent that transactions on behalf of more than one client of the Advisors or
their affiliates during the same period may increase the demand for securities being purchased or the supply of securities being sold, there may be an adverse effect on price. For example, sales of a security by the Advisors on behalf of one or more
of its clients may decrease the market price of such security, adversely impacting other of the Advisors clients that still hold the security. If purchases or sales of securities arise for consideration at or about the same time that would
involve the Trust or other clients or funds for which the Advisors or an affiliate act as investment manager, transactions in such securities will be made, insofar as feasible, for the respective funds and clients in a manner deemed equitable to
all.
In certain instances, the Advisors may find it efficient for purposes of seeking to obtain best execution, to aggregate or bunch certain
contemporaneous purchases or sale orders of its advisory accounts. In general, all contemporaneous trades for client accounts under management by the same portfolio manager or investment team will be bunched in a single order if the trader believes
the bunched trade would provide each client with an opportunity to achieve a more favorable execution at a potentially lower execution cost. The costs associated with a bunched order will be shared pro rata among the clients in the bunched order.
Generally, if an order for a particular portfolio manager or management team is filled at several different prices through multiple trades, all accounts participating in the order will receive the average price except in the case of certain
international markets where average pricing is not permitted. While in some cases this practice could have a detrimental effect upon the price or value of the security as far as the Trust is concerned, in other cases it could be beneficial to the
Trust. Transactions effected by the Advisors on behalf of more than one of its clients during the same period may increase the demand for securities being purchased or the supply of securities being sold, causing an adverse effect on price. The
trader
S-25
will give the bunched order to the broker dealer that the trader has identified as being able to provide the best execution of the order. Orders for purchase or sale of securities will be placed
within a reasonable amount of time of the order receipt and bunched orders will be kept bunched only long enough to execute the order.
The Trust will not
purchase securities during the existence of any underwriting or selling group relating to such securities of which the Advisors or any affiliated person (as defined in the Investment Company Act) thereof is a member except pursuant to procedures
adopted by the Board in accordance with Rule 10f-3 under the Investment Company Act. In no instance will portfolio securities be purchased from or sold to the Advisors or any affiliated person of the foregoing
entities except as permitted by SEC exemptive order or by applicable law.
While the Trust generally does not expect to engage in trading for short-term
gains, it will effect portfolio transactions without regard to any holding period if, in the Advisors judgment, such transactions are advisable in light of a change in circumstances of a particular company or within a particular industry or in
general market, economic or financial conditions. The portfolio turnover rate is calculated by dividing the lesser of the Trusts annual sales or purchases of portfolio securities (exclusive of purchases or sales of U.S. Government Securities
and all other securities whose maturities at the time of acquisition were one year or less) by the monthly average value of the securities in the portfolio during the year. A high rate of portfolio turnover results in certain tax consequences, such
as increased capital gain dividends and/or ordinary income dividends, and in correspondingly greater transaction costs in the form of dealer spreads and brokerage commissions, which are borne directly by the Trust.
Information about the brokerage commissions paid by the Trust, including commissions paid to affiliates, for the last three fiscal years, is set forth in the
following table:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fiscal Year/Period
Ended |
|
Aggregate Brokerage Commissions Paid |
|
|
Commissions Paid to Affiliates |
|
December 31, 2024 |
|
$ |
42,227 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
0 |
|
December 31, 2023 |
|
$ |
51,395 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
0 |
|
December 31, 2022 |
|
$ |
39,258 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
0 |
|
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2024, the brokerage commissions paid to affiliates by the Trust represented 0% of
the aggregate brokerage commissions paid and involved 0% of the dollar amount of transactions involving payment of commissions during the year.
The
following table shows the dollar amount of brokerage commissions paid to brokers for providing third-party research services and the approximate dollar amount of the transactions involved for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2024. The
provision of third-party research services was not necessarily a factor in the placement of all brokerage business with such brokers.
|
|
|
Amount of Commissions Paid to Brokers for Providing Research Services |
|
Amount of Brokerage Transactions Involved |
$ 0 |
|
$ 0 |
As of December 31, 2024, the Trust held securities of its regular brokers or dealers (as defined in Rule 10b-1 under the Investment Company Act) whose shares were purchased during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2024, as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
Regular Broker or Dealer |
|
Debt (D) / Equity (E) |
|
Aggregate Holdings (000s) |
Barclays Plc |
|
D |
|
$5,740 |
J P Morgan Chase & Co |
|
D |
|
$4,895 |
S-26
CONFLICTS OF INTEREST
Certain activities of BlackRock, Inc., BlackRock Advisors, LLC, BlackRock Fund Advisors and the other subsidiaries of BlackRock, Inc. (collectively
referred to in this section as BlackRock) and their respective directors, officers or employees, with respect to the Trust and/or other accounts managed by BlackRock, may give rise to actual or perceived conflicts of interest such as
those described below.
BlackRock is one of the worlds largest asset management firms. BlackRock, its subsidiaries and their respective
directors, officers and employees, including the business units or entities and personnel who may be involved in the investment activities and business operations of the Trust, are engaged worldwide in businesses, including managing equities, fixed
income securities, cash and alternative investments, and other financial services, and have interests other than that of managing the Trust. These are considerations of which investors in the Trust should be aware, and which may cause conflicts of
interest that could disadvantage the Trust and its shareholders. These businesses and interests include potential multiple advisory, transactional, financial and other relationships with, or interests in companies and interests in securities or
other instruments that may be purchased or sold by the Trust.
BlackRock may have proprietary interests in, and may manage or advise with respect to,
accounts or funds (including separate accounts and other funds and collective investment vehicles) that have investment objectives identical or similar to those of the Trust and/or that engage in transactions in the same types of securities,
currencies and instruments as the Trust. Such other funds or accounts may offer exposure to strategies that are identical or substantially similar to those of the Trust but with different fees and expenses, governance and structures, and/or services
provided by BlackRock. BlackRock is also a major participant in the global currency, equities, swap and fixed income markets, in each case, for the accounts of clients and, in some cases, on a proprietary basis. As such, BlackRock is or may be
actively engaged in transactions in the same securities, currencies, and instruments in which the Trust invests.
Such activities could affect the prices
and availability of the securities, currencies, and instruments in which the Trust invests, which could have an adverse impact on the Trusts performance. Such transactions, particularly in respect of most proprietary accounts or client
accounts, will be executed independently of the Trusts transactions and thus at prices or rates that may be more or less favorable than those obtained by the Trust.
In addition, the portfolio holdings of certain BlackRock-advised investment vehicles managed in an identical or substantially similar manner as certain funds
are made publicly available on a more timely basis than the applicable Trust. In some cases, such portfolio holdings are made publicly available on a daily basis. While not expected, it is possible that a recipient of portfolio holdings information
for such an investment vehicle could cause harm to the fust that is managed in an identical or substantially similar manner, including by trading ahead of or against such fund based on the information received.
When BlackRock seeks to purchase or sell the same assets for client accounts, including the Trust, the assets actually purchased or sold may be allocated
among the accounts on a basis determined in its good faith discretion to be equitable. In some cases, this system may adversely affect the size or price of the assets purchased or sold for the Trust. In addition, transactions in investments by one
or more other accounts managed by BlackRock may have the effect of diluting or otherwise disadvantaging the values, prices or investment strategies of the Trust, particularly, but not limited to, with respect to small capitalization, emerging market
or less liquid strategies. This may occur with respect to BlackRock-advised accounts when investment decisions regarding the Trust are based on research or other information that is also used to support decisions for other accounts. When BlackRock
implements a portfolio decision or strategy on behalf of another account ahead of, or contemporaneously with, similar decisions or strategies for the Trust, market impact, liquidity constraints, or other factors could result in the Trust receiving
less favorable trading results and the costs of implementing such decisions or strategies could be increased or the Trust could otherwise be disadvantaged. BlackRock may, in certain cases, elect to implement internal policies and procedures designed
to limit such consequences, which may cause the Trust to be unable to engage in certain activities, including purchasing or disposing of securities, when it might otherwise be desirable for it to do so. Conflicts may also arise because portfolio
decisions regarding the Trust may benefit other accounts managed by BlackRock. For example, the sale of a long position or establishment of a short position by the Trust may impair the price of the same security sold short by (and therefore benefit)
BlackRock or its other accounts or funds, and the
S-27
purchase of a security or covering of a short position in a security by the Trust may increase the price of the same security held by (and therefore benefit) BlackRock or its other accounts or
funds.
BlackRock, on behalf of other client accounts, on the one hand, and the Trust, on the other hand, may invest in or extend credit to different
parts of the capital structure of a single issuer. BlackRock may pursue rights, provide advice or engage in other activities, or refrain from pursuing rights, providing advice or engaging in other activities, on behalf of other clients with respect
to an issuer in which the Trust has invested, and such actions (or refraining from action) may have a material adverse effect on the Trust. In situations in which clients of BlackRock (including the Trust) hold positions in multiple parts of the
capital structure of an issuer, BlackRock may not pursue certain actions or remedies that may be available to the Trust, as a result of legal and regulatory requirements or otherwise. BlackRock addresses these and other potential conflicts of
interest based on the facts and circumstances of particular situations. For example, BlackRock may determine to rely on information barriers between different business units or portfolio management teams. BlackRock may also determine to rely on the
actions of similarly situated holders of loans or securities rather than, or in connection with, taking such actions itself on behalf of the Trust.
In
addition, to the extent permitted by applicable law, the Trust may invest its assets in other funds advised by BlackRock, including funds that are managed by one or more of the same portfolio managers, which could result in conflicts of interest
relating to asset allocation, timing of Trust purchases and redemptions, and increased remuneration and profitability for BlackRock and/or its personnel, including portfolio managers.
Third parties, including service providers to BlackRock or the Trust, may sponsor events (including, but not limited to, marketing and promotional activities
and presentations, educational training programs and conferences) for registered representatives, other professionals and individual investors. There is a potential conflict of interest as such sponsorships may defray the costs of such activities to
BlackRock, and may provide an incentive to BlackRock to retain such third parties to provide services to the Trust.
In certain circumstances, BlackRock,
on behalf of the Trust, may seek to buy from or sell securities to another fund or account advised by BlackRock. BlackRock may (but is not required to) effect purchases and sales between BlackRock clients (cross trades), including the
Trust, if BlackRock believes such transactions are appropriate based on each partys investment objectives and guidelines, subject to applicable law and regulation. There may be potential conflicts of interest or regulatory issues relating to
these transactions which could limit BlackRocks decision to engage in these transactions for the Trust. BlackRock may have a potentially conflicting division of loyalties and responsibilities to the parties in such transactions.
BlackRock and its clients may pursue or enforce rights with respect to an issuer in which the Trust has invested, and those activities may have an adverse
effect on the Trust. As a result, prices, availability, liquidity and terms of the Trusts investments may be negatively impacted by the activities of BlackRock or its clients, and transactions for the Trust may be impaired or effected at
prices or terms that may be less favorable than would otherwise have been the case.
The results of the Trusts investment activities may differ
significantly from the results achieved by BlackRock for its proprietary accounts or other accounts (including investment companies or collective investment vehicles) that it manages or advises. It is possible that one or more accounts managed or
advised by BlackRock and such other accounts will achieve investment results that are substantially more or less favorable than the results achieved by the Trust. Moreover, it is possible that the Trust will sustain losses during periods in which
one or more proprietary or other accounts managed or advised by BlackRock achieve significant profits. The opposite result is also possible.
From time to
time, the Trust may be restricted from purchasing or selling securities, or from engaging in other investment activities because of regulatory, legal or contractual requirements applicable to BlackRock or other accounts managed or advised by
BlackRock, and/or the internal policies of BlackRock designed to comply with such requirements. As a result, there may be periods, for example, when BlackRock will not initiate or recommend certain types of transactions in certain securities or
instruments with respect to which BlackRock is performing services or when position limits have been reached. For example, the investment activities of BlackRock for its proprietary accounts and accounts under its management may limit the investment
opportunities for the Trust in certain emerging and other markets in which limitations are imposed upon the amount of investment, in the aggregate or in individual issuers, by affiliated foreign investors.
S-28
In connection with its management of the Trust, BlackRock may have access to certain fundamental analysis and
proprietary technical models developed by BlackRock. BlackRock will not be under any obligation, however, to effect transactions on behalf of the Trust in accordance with such analysis and models. In addition, BlackRock will not have any obligation
to make available any information regarding its proprietary activities or strategies, or the activities or strategies used for other accounts managed by them, for the benefit of the management of the Trust and it is not anticipated that BlackRock
will have access to such information for the purpose of managing the Trust. The proprietary activities or portfolio strategies of BlackRock, or the activities or strategies used for accounts managed by BlackRock or other client accounts could
conflict with the transactions and strategies employed by BlackRock in managing the Trust.
The Trust may be included in investment models developed by
BlackRock for use by clients and financial advisors. To the extent clients invest in these investment models and increase the assets under management of the Trust, the investment management fee amounts paid by the Trust to BlackRock may also
increase. The net asset value and liquidity of the Trust may be impacted by purchases and sales of the Trust by model-driven investment portfolios, as well as by BlackRock itself and by its advisory clients.
In addition, certain principals and certain employees of the Trusts investment adviser are also principals or employees of other business units or
entities within BlackRock. As a result, these principals and employees may have obligations to such other business units or entities or their clients and such obligations to other business units or entities or their clients may be a consideration of
which investors in the Trust should be aware.
BlackRock may enter into transactions and invest in securities, instruments and currencies on behalf of the
Trust in which clients of BlackRock, or, to the extent permitted by the Commission and applicable law, BlackRock, serves as the counterparty, principal or issuer. In such cases, such partys interests in the transaction will be adverse to the
interests of the Trust, and such party may have no incentive to assure that the Trust obtains the best possible prices or terms in connection with the transactions. In addition, the purchase, holding and sale of such investments by the Trust may
enhance the profitability of BlackRock.
BlackRock may also create, write or issue derivatives for clients, the underlying securities, currencies or
instruments of which may be those in which the Trust invests or which may be based on the performance of the Trust. Additionally, an affiliate of BlackRock will create, write or issue options, which may be based on the performance of certain
BlackRock-advised funds. BlackRock has entered into an arrangement with Markit Indices Limited, the index provider for underlying fixed-income indexes used by certain iShares ETFs, related to derivative fixed-income products that are based on such
iShares ETFs. Trading activity in these derivative products could also potentially lead to greater liquidity for such products, increased purchase activity with respect to these iShares ETFs and increased assets under management for BlackRock.
The Trust may, subject to applicable law, purchase investments that are the subject of an underwriting or other distribution by BlackRock and may also enter
into transactions with other clients of BlackRock where such other clients have interests adverse to those of the Trust. At times, these activities may cause business units or entities within BlackRock to give advice to clients that may cause these
clients to take actions adverse to the interests of the Trust. To the extent such transactions are permitted, the Trust will deal with BlackRock on an arms-length basis.
To the extent authorized by applicable law, BlackRock may act as broker, dealer, agent, lender or adviser or in other commercial capacities for the Trust. It
is anticipated that the commissions, mark-ups, mark-downs, financial advisory fees, underwriting and placement fees, sales fees, financing and commitment fees, brokerage fees, other fees, compensation or
profits, rates, terms and conditions charged by BlackRock will be in its view commercially reasonable, although BlackRock, including its sales personnel, will have an interest in obtaining fees and other amounts that are favorable to BlackRock and
such sales personnel, which may have an adverse effect on the Trust. Index based funds may use an index provider that is affiliated with another service provider of the Trust or BlackRock that acts as a broker, dealer, agent, lender or in other
commercial capacities for the Trust or BlackRock.
Subject to applicable law, BlackRock (and its personnel and other distributors) will be entitled to
retain fees and other amounts that they receive in connection with their service to the Trust as broker, dealer, agent, lender, adviser or in other commercial capacities. No accounting to the Trust or its shareholders will be required, and no fees
or
S-29
other compensation payable by the Trust or its shareholders will be reduced by reason of receipt by BlackRock of any such fees or other amounts.
When BlackRock acts as broker, dealer, agent, adviser or in other commercial capacities in relation to the Trust, BlackRock may take commercial steps in its
own interests, which may have an adverse effect on the Trust.
The Trust will be required to establish business relationships with its counterparties
based on the Trusts own credit standing. BlackRock will not have any obligation to allow its credit to be used in connection with the Trusts establishment of its business relationships, nor is it expected that the Trusts
counterparties will rely on the credit of BlackRock in evaluating the Trusts creditworthiness.
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC (previously
defined as BIM) or BlackRock Institutional Trust Company, N.A. (BTC), as applicable, each, an affiliate of BlackRock, pursuant to SEC exemptive relief, acts as securities lending agent to, and receives a share of securities
lending revenues from, the Trust. BlackRock will also receive compensation for managing the reinvestment of the cash collateral from securities lending. There are potential conflicts of interests in managing a securities lending program, including
but not limited to: (i) BlackRock as securities lending agent may have an incentive to, among other things, increase or decrease the amount of securities on loan or to lend particular securities in order to generate additional risk-adjusted
revenue for BlackRock and its affiliates; and (ii) BlackRock as securities lending agent may have an incentive to allocate loans to clients that would provide more revenue to BlackRock. As described further below, BlackRock seeks to mitigate
this conflict by providing its securities lending clients with equal lending opportunities over time in order to approximate pro rata allocation.
As part
of its securities lending program, BlackRock indemnifies the Trust and certain other clients and/or funds against a shortfall in collateral in the event of borrower default. On a regular basis, BlackRock calculates the potential dollar exposure of
collateral shortfall resulting from a borrower default (shortfall risk) in the securities lending program. BlackRock establishes program wide borrower limits (credit limits) to actively manage borrower-specific credit
exposure. BlackRock oversees the risk model that calculates projected collateral shortfall values using loan-level factors such as loan and collateral type and market value as well as specific borrower credit characteristics. When necessary,
BlackRock may adjust securities lending program attributes by restricting eligible collateral or reducing borrower credit limits. As a result, the management of program-wide exposure as well as BlackRock-specific indemnification exposure may affect
the amount of securities lending activity BlackRock may conduct at any given point in time by reducing the volume of lending opportunities for certain loans (including by asset type, collateral type and/or revenue profile).
BlackRock may decline to make a securities loan on behalf of the Trust, discontinue lending on behalf of the Trust or terminate a securities loan on behalf of
the Trust for any reason, including but not limited to regulatory requirements and/or market rules, liquidity considerations, or credit considerations, which may impact the Trust by reducing or eliminating the volume of lending opportunities for
certain types of loans, loans in particular markets, loans of particular securities or types of securities, or for loans overall. In addition, some borrowers may prefer certain BlackRock lenders that provide additional protections against lender
default that are favored by their prudential regulation.
BlackRock uses a predetermined systematic process in order to approximate pro rata allocation
over time. In order to allocate a loan to a portfolio: (i) BlackRock as a whole must have sufficient lending capacity pursuant to the various program limits (i.e. indemnification exposure limit and borrower credit limits); (ii) the lending
portfolio must hold the asset at the time a loan opportunity arrives; and (iii) the lending portfolio must also have enough inventory, either on its own or when aggregated with other portfolios into one single market delivery, to satisfy the
loan request. In doing so, BlackRock seeks to provide equal lending opportunities for all portfolios, independent of whether BlackRock indemnifies the portfolio. Equal opportunities for lending portfolios does not guarantee equal outcomes.
Specifically, short and long-term outcomes for individual clients may vary due to asset mix, asset/liability spreads on different securities, and the overall limits imposed by the firm.
Purchases and sales of securities and other assets for the Trust may be bunched or aggregated with orders for other BlackRock client accounts, including with
accounts that pay different transaction costs solely due to the fact that they have different research payment arrangements. BlackRock, however, is not required to bunch or aggregate
S-30
orders if portfolio management decisions for different accounts are made separately, or if they determine that bunching or aggregating is not practicable or required, or in cases involving client
direction.
Prevailing trading activity frequently may make impossible the receipt of the same price or execution on the entire volume of securities
purchased or sold. When this occurs, the various prices may be averaged, and the Trust will be charged or credited with the average price. Thus, the effect of the aggregation may operate on some occasions to the disadvantage of the Trust. In
addition, under certain circumstances, the Trust will not be charged the same commission or commission equivalent rates in connection with a bunched or aggregated order.
As discussed in the section below entitled Portfolio Transactions and Brokerage, BlackRock, unless prohibited by applicable law, may cause the
Trust or account to pay a broker or dealer a commission for effecting a transaction that exceeds the amount another broker or dealer would have charged for effecting the same transaction in recognition of the value of brokerage and research services
provided by that broker or dealer. Under MiFID II, EU investment managers, including BlackRock International Limited, pay for research from brokers and dealers directly out of their own resources, rather than through client commissions.
Subject to applicable law, BlackRock may select brokers that furnish BlackRock, the Trust, other BlackRock client accounts or personnel, directly or through
correspondent relationships, with research or other appropriate services which provide, in BlackRocks view, appropriate assistance to BlackRock in the investment decision-making process (including with respect to futures, fixed-price offerings
and OTC transactions). Such research or other services may include, to the extent permitted by law, research reports on companies, industries and securities; economic and financial data; financial publications; proxy analysis; trade industry
seminars; computer data bases; research-oriented software and other services and products.
Research or other services obtained in this manner may be used
in servicing any or all of the Trust and other BlackRock client accounts, including in connection with BlackRock client accounts other than those that pay commissions to the broker relating to the research or other service arrangements. Such
products and services may disproportionately benefit other BlackRock client accounts relative to the Trust based on the amount of brokerage commissions paid by the Trust and such other BlackRock client accounts. For example, research or other
services that are paid for through one clients commissions may not be used in managing that clients account. In addition, other BlackRock client accounts may receive the benefit, including disproportionate benefits, of economies of scale
or price discounts in connection with products and services that may be provided to the Trust and to such other BlackRock client accounts. To the extent that BlackRock uses soft dollars, it will not have to pay for those products and services
itself.
BlackRock, unless prohibited by applicable law, may endeavor to execute trades through brokers who, pursuant to such arrangements, provide
research or other services in order to ensure the continued receipt of research or other services BlackRock believes are useful in its investment decision-making process. BlackRock may from time to time choose not to engage in the above described
arrangements to varying degrees. BlackRock, unless prohibited by applicable law, may also enter into commission sharing arrangements under which BlackRock may execute transactions through a broker-dealer and request that the broker-dealer allocate a
portion of the commissions or commission credits to another firm that provides research to BlackRock. To the extent that BlackRock engages in commission sharing arrangements, many of the same conflicts related to traditional soft dollars may exist.
BlackRock may utilize certain electronic crossing networks (ECNs) (including, without limitation, ECNs in which BlackRock has an investment
or other interest, to the extent permitted by applicable law) in executing client securities transactions for certain types of securities. These ECNs may charge fees for their services, including access fees and transaction fees. The transaction
fees, which are similar to commissions or markups/markdowns, will generally be charged to clients and, like commissions and markups/markdowns, would generally be included in the cost of the securities purchased. Access fees may be paid by BlackRock
even though incurred in connection with executing transactions on behalf of clients, including the Trust. In certain circumstances, ECNs may offer volume discounts that will reduce the access fees typically paid by BlackRock. BlackRock will only
utilize ECNs consistent with its obligation to seek to obtain best execution in client transactions.
S-31
BlackRock owns a minority interest in, and is a member of, Members Exchange (MEMX), a newly created
U.S. stock exchange. Transactions for the Trust may be executed on MEMX if third party brokers select MEMX as the appropriate venue for execution of orders placed by BlackRock traders on behalf of client portfolios.
BlackRock has adopted policies and procedures designed to prevent conflicts of interest from influencing proxy voting decisions that it makes on behalf of
advisory clients, including the Trust, and to help ensure that such decisions are made in accordance with BlackRocks fiduciary obligations to its clients. Nevertheless, notwithstanding such proxy voting policies and procedures, actual proxy
voting decisions of BlackRock may have the effect of favoring the interests of other clients or businesses of other divisions or units of BlackRock, provided that BlackRock believes such voting decisions to be in accordance with its fiduciary
obligations. For a more detailed discussion of these policies and procedures, see Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures .
It is also possible
that, from time to time, BlackRock and/or its advisory clients (including other funds and separately managed accounts) may, subject to compliance with applicable law, purchase and hold shares of the Trust. Increasing the Trusts assets may
enhance investment flexibility and diversification and may contribute to economies of scale that tend to reduce the Trusts expense ratio. BlackRock reserves the right, subject to compliance with applicable law, to redeem at any time some or
all of the shares of the Trust acquired for its own accounts. A large redemption of shares of the Trust by BlackRock could significantly reduce the asset size of the Trust, which might have an adverse effect on the Trusts investment
flexibility, portfolio diversification and expense ratio. BlackRock seeks to consider the effect of redemptions on the Trust and other shareholders in deciding whether to redeem its shares but is not obligated to do so and may elect not to do so.
It is possible that the Trust may invest in securities of, or engage in transactions with, companies in which BlackRock has significant debt or equity
investments or other interests. The Trust may also invest in issuances (such as structured notes) by entities for which BlackRock provides and is compensated for cash management services relating to the proceeds from the sale of such issuances. In
making investment decisions for the Trust, BlackRock is not permitted to obtain or use material non-public information acquired by any unit of BlackRock, in the course of these activities. In addition, from
time to time, the activities of BlackRock may limit the Trusts flexibility in purchases and sales of securities. As indicated below, BlackRock may engage in transactions with companies in which BlackRock-advised funds or other clients of
BlackRock have an investment.
BlackRock and its personnel and other financial service providers may have interests in promoting sales of the Trust. With
respect to BlackRock and its personnel, the remuneration and profitability relating to services to and sales of the Trust or other products may be greater than remuneration and profitability relating to services to and sales of certain funds or
other products that might be provided or offered. BlackRock and its sales personnel may directly or indirectly receive a portion of the fees and commissions charged to the Trust or its shareholders. BlackRock and its advisory or other personnel may
also benefit from increased amounts of assets under management. Fees and commissions may also be higher than for other products or services, and the remuneration and profitability to BlackRock and such personnel resulting from transactions on behalf
of or management of the Trust may be greater than the remuneration and profitability resulting from other funds or products.
BlackRock may provide
valuation assistance to certain clients with respect to certain securities or other investments and the valuation recommendations made for such clients accounts may differ from the valuations for the same securities or investments assigned by
the Trusts pricing vendors, especially if such valuations are based on broker-dealer quotes or other data sources unavailable to the Trusts pricing vendors. While BlackRock will generally communicate its valuation information or
determinations to the Trusts pricing vendors and/or fund accountants, there may be instances where the Trusts pricing vendors or fund accountants assign a different valuation to a security or other investment than the valuation for such
security or investment determined or recommended by BlackRock.
As disclosed in more detail in Net Asset Value in the Prospectus, when market
quotations are not readily available or are believed by BlackRock to be unreliable, the Trusts investments are valued at fair value by BlackRock. BlackRock has been designated as the Trusts valuation designee pursuant to Rule 2a-5 under the Investment Company Act and acts through BlackRocks Rule 2a-5 Committee (the 2a-5 Committee), with
assistance from other BlackRock pricing committees and in accordance with BlackRocks policies and procedures (the Valuation Procedures). When determining a fair value price, the
2a-5 Committee seeks to determine the price that the Trust
S-32
might reasonably expect to receive from the current sale of that asset or liability in an arms-length transaction. The price generally may not be
determined based on what the Trust might reasonably expect to receive for selling an asset or liability at a later time or if it holds the asset or liability to maturity. While fair value determinations will be based upon all available factors that
BlackRock deems relevant at the time of the determination, and may be based on analytical values determined by BlackRock using proprietary or third party valuation models, fair value represents only a good faith approximation of the value of an
asset or liability. The fair value of one or more assets or liabilities may not, in retrospect, be the price at which those assets or liabilities could have been sold during the period in which the particular fair values were used in determining the
Trusts NAV. As a result, the Trusts sale or redemption of its shares at NAV, at a time when a holding or holdings are valued by the 2a-5 Committee at fair value, may have the effect of diluting or
increasing the economic interest of existing shareholders and may affect the amount of revenue received by BlackRock with respect to services for which it receives an asset-based fee.
To the extent permitted by applicable law, the Trust may invest all or some of its short term cash investments in any money market fund or similarly-managed
private fund advised or managed by BlackRock. In connection with any such investments, the Trust, to the extent permitted by the Investment Company Act, may pay its share of expenses of a money market fund or other similarly-managed private fund in
which it invests, which may result in the Trust bearing some additional expenses.
BlackRock and its directors, officers and employees, may buy and sell
securities or other investments for their own accounts and may have conflicts of interest with respect to investments made on behalf of the Trust. As a result of differing trading and investment strategies or constraints, positions may be taken by
directors, officers and employees of BlackRock that are the same, different from or made at different times than positions taken for the Trust. To lessen the possibility that the Trust will be adversely affected by this personal trading, the Trust,
BRIL and BlackRock each have adopted a Code of Ethics in compliance with Section 17(j) of the Investment Company Act that restricts securities trading in the personal accounts of investment professionals and others who normally come into
possession of information regarding the Trusts portfolio transactions. Each Code of Ethics is also available on the EDGAR Database on the Commissions Internet site at http://www.sec.gov, and copies may be obtained, after paying a
duplicating fee, by e-mail at publicinfo@sec.gov.
BlackRock will not purchase securities or other property from,
or sell securities or other property to, the Trust, except that the Trust may in accordance with rules or guidance adopted under the Investment Company Act engage in transactions with another Fund or accounts that are affiliated with the Trust as a
result of common officers, directors, or investment advisers or pursuant to exemptive orders granted to the Trust and/or BlackRock by the Commission. These transactions would be effected in circumstances in which BlackRock determined that it would
be appropriate for the Trust to purchase and another client of BlackRock to sell, or the Trust to sell and another client of BlackRock to purchase, the same security or instrument on the same day. From time to time, the activities of the Trust may
be restricted because of regulatory requirements applicable to BlackRock and/or BlackRocks internal policies designed to comply with, limit the applicability of, or otherwise relate to such requirements. A client not advised by BlackRock would
not be subject to some of those considerations. There may be periods when BlackRock may not initiate or recommend certain types of transactions, or may otherwise restrict or limit its advice in certain securities or instruments issued by or related
to companies for which BlackRock is performing advisory or other services or has proprietary positions. For example, when BlackRock is engaged to provide advisory or risk management services for a company, BlackRock may be prohibited from or limited
in purchasing or selling securities of that company on behalf of the Trust, particularly where such services result in BlackRock obtaining material non-public information about the company (e.g., in connection
with participation in a creditors committee). Similar situations could arise if personnel of BlackRock serve as directors of companies the securities of which the Trust wishes to purchase or sell. However, if permitted by applicable law, and
where consistent with BlackRocks policies and procedures (including the necessary implementation of appropriate information barriers), the Trust may purchase securities or instruments that are issued by such companies, are the subject of an
advisory or risk management assignment by BlackRock, or where personnel of BlackRock are directors or officers of the issuer.
BlackRock has adopted and
implemented policies and procedures that are designed to address potential conflicts that arise in connection with the advisory services BlackRock provides to the Trust and other clients. Certain BlackRock advisory personnel may take views, and make
decisions or recommendations, that are different than or opposite those of other BlackRock advisory personnel. Certain portfolio management teams within BlackRock may make decisions or take (or refrain from taking) actions with respect to clients
they advise in a manner different than or
S-33
adverse to the decisions made or the actions taken (or not taken) by the Trusts portfolio management teams. The various portfolio management teams may not share information with each other,
including as a result of certain information barriers and other policies, and will not have any obligation or other duty to do so.
BlackRock has
established certain information barriers and other policies to address the sharing of information between different businesses within BlackRock, including, effective on or about January 21, 2025, with respect to personnel responsible with
managing portfolios and voting proxies with respect to certain index equity portfolios versus those responsible for managing portfolios and voting proxies with respect to all other portfolios. As a result of information barriers, certain units of
BlackRock generally will not have access, or will have limited access, to certain information and personnel, including senior personnel, in other units of BlackRock, and generally will not manage the Trust with the benefit of information possessed
by such other units. Therefore, BlackRock may not be able to review potential investments for the Trust with the benefit of information held by certain areas of BlackRock.
BlackRock may determine to move certain personnel, businesses, or business units from one side of an information barrier to the other side of the information
barrier. In connection therewith, BlackRock personnel, businesses, and business units that were moved will no longer have access to the information and personnel from the side of the information barrier from which they were moved. Information
obtained in connection with such changes to information barriers may limit or restrict the ability of BlackRock to engage in or otherwise effect transactions on behalf of the Trust (including purchasing or selling securities that BlackRock may
otherwise have purchased or sold for a client in the absence of a change to an information barrier). Information barriers may not have their intended impact due to, for example, changes in applicable law or inadvertent crossings of the barriers, and
actions by personnel on one side of a barrier may impact the potential actions of personnel on the other side of a barrier.
Although the information
barriers are intended to allow for independent portfolio management decision-making and proxy voting among certain BlackRock businesses, the investment activities of BlackRock for BlackRock clients, as well as BlackRocks proprietary accounts,
may nonetheless limit the investment strategies and rights of other clients (including the Trust). As BlackRocks assets under management increases, BlackRock clients may face greater negative impacts due to ownership restrictions and
limitations imposed by laws, regulations, rules, regulators, or issuers. For example, in certain circumstances where a BlackRock client invests in securities issued by companies that operate in certain industries (e.g., banking, insurance, and
utilities) or in certain emerging or international markets, or are subject to regulatory or corporate ownership restrictions (e.g., with mechanisms such as poison pills in place to prevent takeovers), or where a BlackRock client invests in certain
futures and derivatives, there may be limits on the aggregate amount invested by BlackRock for its clients and BlackRocks proprietary accounts that may not be exceeded without the grant of a license or other regulatory or corporate approval,
order, consent, relief, waiver or non-disapproval or, if exceeded, may cause BlackRock or its clients to be subject to enforcement actions, disgorgement of share ownership or profits, regulatory restrictions,
complex compliance reporting, increased compliance costs or suffer disadvantages or business restrictions. In light of certain restrictions, BlackRock may also seek to make indirect investments (e.g., using derivatives) on behalf of its clients to
receive exposure to certain securities in excess of the applicable ownership restrictions and limitations when legally permitted that will expose such clients to additional costs and additional risks, including any risks associated with investing in
derivatives. There may be limited availability of derivatives that provide indirect exposure to an impacted security. BlackRock clients can be subject to more than one ownership limitation depending on each clients holdings, and each ownership
limitation can impact multiple securities held by the client. Certain clients or shareholders may have their own overlapping obligations to monitor their compliance with ownership limitations across their investments.
If certain aggregate ownership thresholds are reached either through the actions of BlackRock or a BlackRock client or as a result of corporate actions by the
issuer, the ability of BlackRock on behalf of clients to purchase or dispose of investments, or exercise rights (including voting) or undertake business transactions, may be restricted by law, regulation, rule, or organizational documents or
otherwise impaired. For example, to meet the requirements of an ownership limitation or restriction, a client may be unable to purchase or directly hold a security the client would otherwise purchase or hold. The limitation or restriction may be
based on the holdings of other BlackRock clients instead of the specific client being restricted. For index funds, this means a fund may not be able to track its index as closely as it would if it was not subject to an ownership limitation or
restriction because the fund cannot acquire the amount of the impacted security included in its index. BlackRock on behalf of its clients may limit purchases, sell existing investments, utilize information barriers, or otherwise restrict, forgo or
limit the exercise of rights (including transferring, outsourcing or limiting voting rights or forgoing the right to receive dividends) when
S-34
BlackRock, in its sole discretion, deems it appropriate in light of potential regulatory or other restrictions on ownership or other consequences resulting from reaching investment thresholds.
These types of restrictions could negatively impact a clients performance or ability to meet its investment objective.
When BlackRock or a
BlackRock client is subject to an ownership limitation, BlackRock may in its discretion seek permission from the applicable issuers or regulators to exceed the limitation. However, there is no guarantee that permission will be granted, or that, once
granted, it will not be modified or revoked at a later date with minimal or no notice. The issuer and/or regulator may also require that BlackRock on behalf of itself and its clients take or refrain from taking certain actions in connection with the
approval, order, consent, relief or non-disapproval, which BlackRock may accept if it believes the benefits outweigh the costs and may limit BlackRock from taking actions that it otherwise would take. In those
circumstances where ownership thresholds or limitations must be observed, BlackRock seeks to allocate limited investment opportunities equitably among clients, taking into consideration benchmark weight and investment strategy. BlackRock may adopt
certain controls designed to prevent the occurrence of a breach of any applicable ownership thresholds or limits, including, for example, when ownership in certain securities nears an applicable threshold, BlackRock may limit additional purchases in
such securities or, with respect to ETFs, remove such securities from the list of Deposit Securities to be delivered to the Trust in connection with purchases of Creation Units of such Fund. If client holdings of an issuer exceed an applicable
threshold and BlackRock is unable to obtain relief to enable the continued holding of such investments, it may be necessary to reduce these positions to meet the applicable limitations and BlackRock or such client may be subject to regulatory
actions. In these cases, the investments will be sold in a manner that BlackRock deems fair and equitable over time.
Ownership limitations are highly
complex. It is possible that, despite BlackRocks intent to either comply with or be granted permission to exceed ownership limitations, it may inadvertently breach a limit or violate the corporate or regulatory approval, order, consent, relief
or non-disapproval that was obtained.
In addition to the foregoing, other ownership thresholds may trigger
reporting requirements to governmental and regulatory authorities, and such reports may entail the disclosure of the identity of a client or BlackRocks intended strategy with respect to such security or asset.
BlackRock may maintain securities indices. To the extent permitted by applicable laws, the Trust may seek to license and use such indices as part of their
investment strategy. Index based funds that seek to track the performance of securities indices also may use the name of the index or index provider in the fund name. Index providers, including BlackRock (to the extent permitted by applicable law),
may be paid licensing fees for use of their index or index name. In instances where BlackRock charges a unitary management fee, BlackRock may have a financial incentive to use a BlackRock index that is less costly to BlackRock than a third party
index. BlackRock may benefit from the Trust using BlackRock indices by creating increasing acceptance in the marketplace for such indices. BlackRock is not obligated to license its indices to the Trust and the Trust is under no obligation to use
BlackRock indices. Any fund that enters into a license for a BlackRock index cannot be assured that the terms of any index licensing agreement with BlackRock will be as favorable as those terms offered to other licensees.
BlackRock may enter into contractual arrangements with third-party service providers to the Trust (e.g., custodians, administrators and index providers)
pursuant to which BlackRock receives fee discounts or concessions in recognition of BlackRocks overall relationship with such service providers. BlackRock may also enter into contractual arrangements with such service providers pursuant to
which BlackRock incurs additional costs if the service providers services are terminated with respect to the Trust. To the extent that BlackRock is responsible for paying service providers out of its fees that it receives from the Trust, the
benefits of lower fees, including any fee discounts or concessions, or any additional savings, may accrue, in whole or in part, to BlackRock, which could result in conflicts of interest relating to the use or termination of service providers to the
Trust. In addition, conflicts of interest may arise with respect to contractual arrangements with third-party service providers to the Trust, or the selection of such providers, particularly in circumstances where BlackRock is negotiating on behalf
of both funds that have a unitary management fee and those that do not or different service providers have different fee structures.
Conflicts of
interest may arise as a result of simultaneous investment management of multiple client accounts by the BlackRocks investment professionals. For example, differences in the advisory fee structure may create the appearance of actual or
potential conflicts of interest because such differences could create pecuniary incentives for BlackRock to favor one client account over another.
S-35
BlackRock owns or has an ownership interest in certain trading, portfolio management, operations and/or
information systems used by Trust service providers. These systems are, or will be, used by a Trust service provider in connection with the provision of services to accounts managed by BlackRock and funds managed and sponsored by BlackRock,
including the Trust, that engage the service provider (typically the custodian). The Trusts service provider remunerates BlackRock for the use of the systems. A Trust service providers payments to BlackRock for the use of these systems
may enhance the profitability of BlackRock.
BlackRocks receipt of fees from a service provider in connection with the use of systems provided by
BlackRock may create an incentive for BlackRock to recommend that the Trust enter into or renew an arrangement with the service provider.
In recognition
of a BlackRock clients overall relationship with BlackRock, BlackRock may offer special pricing arrangements for certain services provided by BlackRock. Any such special pricing arrangements will not affect Trust fees and expenses applicable
to such clients investment in the Trust.
Present and future activities of BlackRock and its directors, officers and employees, in addition to those
described in this section, may give rise to additional conflicts of interest.
DESCRIPTION OF SHARES
Common Shares
The Trust intends to hold annual
meetings of shareholders so long as the common shares are listed on a national securities exchange and such meetings are required as a condition to such listing.
Preferred Shares
The Trust currently does not intend to
issue preferred shares. Although the terms of any preferred shares that the Trust might issue in the future, including dividend rate, liquidation preference and redemption provisions, will be determined by the Board, subject to applicable law and
the Agreement and Declaration of Trust, it is likely that any such preferred shares issued would be structured to carry a relatively short-term dividend rate reflecting interest rates on short-term debt securities, by providing for the periodic
redetermination of the dividend rate at relatively short intervals through a fixed spread or remarketing procedure, subject to a maximum rate which would increase over time in the event of an extended period of unsuccessful remarketing. The Trust
also believes that it is likely that the liquidation preference, voting rights and redemption provisions of any such preferred shares would be similar to those stated below.
Liquidation Preference. In the event of any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Trust, the holders of shares of any
outstanding preferred shares will be entitled to receive a preferential liquidating distribution (expected to equal the original purchase price per share plus an amount equal to accumulated but unpaid dividends, whether or not earned or declared)
before any distribution of assets is made to holders of beneficial interests. After payment of the full amount of the liquidating distribution to which they are entitled, it is expected that preferred shareholders will not be entitled to any further
participation in any distribution of assets by the Trust. A consolidation or merger of the Trust with or into any other corporation or corporations or a sale of all or substantially all of the assets of the Trust will not be deemed to be a
liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Trust.
Voting Rights. Except as otherwise indicated in the Prospectus and except as otherwise
required by applicable law, holders of shares of any outstanding preferred shares will have equal voting rights with holders of shares of beneficial interests (one vote per share) and will vote together with holders of beneficial interests as a
single class. In connection with the election of the Trusts Trustees, holders of shares of any outstanding preferred shares, voting as a separate class, will be entitled to elect two of the Trusts Trustees, and the remaining Trustees
will be elected by all holders of capital stock, voting as a single class. So long as any preferred share is outstanding, it is expected that the Trust will have not less than five Trustees. If at any time dividends on shares of any outstanding
preferred share shall be unpaid in an amount equal to two full years dividends thereon, the holders of all outstanding shares of
S-36
preferred shares, voting as a separate class, will be entitled to elect a majority of the Trusts Trustees until all dividends in default have been paid or declared and set apart for
payment. It is expected that the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of any outstanding preferred shares, voting as a separate class, will be required to (i) authorize, create or issue any class or series of
stock ranking prior to any series of preferred shares with respect to payment of dividends or the distribution of assets on liquidation or (ii) amend, alter or repeal the provisions of the Agreement and Declaration of Trust, whether by merger,
consolidation or otherwise, so as to adversely affect any of the contract rights expressly set forth in the Agreement and Declaration of Trust of holders of preferred shares.
Redemption Provisions. It is anticipated that any outstanding shares of preferred shares will generally be redeemable at the option of the Trust at a
price equal to their liquidation preference plus accumulated but unpaid dividends to the date of redemption plus, under certain circumstances, a redemption premium. Shares of preferred shares will also be subject to mandatory redemption at a price
equal to their liquidation preference plus accumulated but unpaid dividends to the date of redemption upon the occurrence of certain specified events, such as the failure of the Trust to maintain asset coverage requirements for the preferred shares
specified by the Investment Company Act and rating services that issue ratings on the preferred shares.
Liquidity Feature. Preferred shares may
include a liquidity feature that allows holders of preferred shares to have their shares purchased by a liquidity provider in the event that sell orders have not been matched with purchase orders and successfully settled in a remarketing. The Trust
would pay a fee to the provider of this liquidity feature, which would be borne by common shareholders of the Trust. The terms of such liquidity feature may require the Trust to redeem preferred shares still owned by the liquidity provider following
a certain period of continuous, unsuccessful remarketing, which may adversely impact the Trust.
The discussion above describes the possible offering of
preferred shares by the Trust. If the Board determines to proceed with such an offering, the terms of the preferred shares may be the same as, or different from, the terms described above, subject to applicable law and the Trusts Agreement and
Declaration of Trust. The Board, without the approval of the holders of common shares, may authorize an offering of preferred shares or may determine not to authorize such an offering, and may fix the terms of the preferred shares to be offered.
Other Shares
The Board (subject to applicable law
and the Trusts Agreement and Declaration of Trust) may authorize an offering, without the approval of the holders of common shares and, depending on their terms, any preferred shares outstanding at that time, of other classes of shares, or
other classes or series of shares, as they determine to be necessary, desirable or appropriate, having such terms, rights, preferences, privileges, limitations and restrictions as the Board sees fit. The Trust currently does not expect to issue any
other classes of shares, or series of shares, except for the common shares.
REPURCHASE OF COMMON SHARES
The Trust is a closed-end management investment company and as such its shareholders will not have
the right to cause the Trust to redeem their shares. Instead, the Trusts common shares will trade in the open market at a price that will be a function of several factors, including dividend levels (which are in turn affected by expenses),
NAV, call protection for portfolio securities, dividend stability, liquidity, relative demand for and supply of the common shares in the market, general market and economic conditions and other factors. Because shares of a closed-end investment company may frequently trade at prices lower than NAV, the Board may consider action that might be taken to reduce or eliminate any material discount from NAV in respect of common
shares, which may include the repurchase of such shares in the open market or in private transactions, the making of a tender offer for such shares, or the conversion of the Trust to
an open-end investment company. The Board may decide not to take any of these actions. In addition, there can be no assurance that share repurchases or tender offers, if undertaken, will reduce
market discount.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, at any time when the Trust has preferred shares outstanding, the Trust may not purchase, redeem or
otherwise acquire any of its common shares unless (1) all accrued preferred share dividends have been paid and (2) at the time of such purchase, redemption or acquisition, the NAV of the Trusts portfolio
S-37
(determined after deducting the acquisition price of the common shares) is at least 200% of the liquidation value of any outstanding preferred shares (expected to equal the original purchase
price per share plus any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon). Any service fees incurred in connection with any tender offer made by the Trust will be borne by the Trust and will not reduce the stated consideration to be paid to tendering
shareholders.
Subject to its investment restrictions, the Trust may borrow to finance the repurchase of shares or to make a tender offer. Interest on any
borrowings to finance share repurchase transactions or the accumulation of cash by the Trust in anticipation of share repurchases or tender offers will reduce the Trusts net income. Any share repurchase, tender offer or borrowing that might be
approved by the Board would have to comply with the Exchange Act, the Investment Company Act and the rules and regulations thereunder.
Although the
decision to take action in response to a discount from NAV will be made by the Board at the time it considers such issue, it is the Boards present policy, which may be changed by the Board, not to authorize repurchases of common shares or a
tender offer for such shares if: (i) such transactions, if consummated, would (a) result in the delisting of the common shares from the NYSE, or (b) impair the Trusts status as a RIC under the Code, (which would make the Trust a
taxable entity, causing the Trusts income to be taxed at the corporate level in addition to the taxation of shareholders who receive dividends from the Trust) or as a registered closed-end
investment company under the Investment Company Act; (ii) the Trust would not be able to liquidate portfolio securities in an orderly manner and consistent with the Trusts investment objective and policies in order to repurchase shares;
or (iii) there is, in the Boards judgment, any (a) material legal action or proceeding instituted or threatened challenging such transactions or otherwise materially adversely affecting the Trust, (b) general suspension of or
limitation on prices for trading securities on the NYSE, (c) declaration of a banking moratorium by federal or state authorities or any suspension of payment by United States or New York banks, (d) material limitation affecting the Trust
or the issuers of its portfolio securities by federal or state authorities on the extension of credit by lending institutions or on the exchange of foreign currency, (e) commencement of war, armed hostilities or other international or national
calamity directly or indirectly involving the United States, or (f) other event or condition which would have a material adverse effect (including any adverse tax effect) on the Trust or its shareholders if shares were repurchased. The Board
may in the future modify these conditions in light of experience.
The repurchase by the Trust of its shares at prices below NAV will result in an
increase in the NAV of those shares that remain outstanding. However, there can be no assurance that share repurchases or tender offers at or below NAV will result in the Trusts common shares trading at a price equal to their NAV.
Nevertheless, the fact that the Trusts common shares may be the subject of repurchases or tender offers from time to time, or that the Trust may be converted to an open-end investment company,
may reduce any spread between market price and NAV that might otherwise exist.
In addition, a purchase by the Trust of its common shares will decrease
the Trusts net assets which would likely have the effect of increasing the Trusts expense ratio. Any purchase by the Trust of its common shares at a time when preferred shares are outstanding will increase the leverage applicable to the
outstanding common shares then remaining.
Before deciding whether to take any action if the common shares trade below NAV, the Board would likely
consider all relevant factors, including the extent and duration of the discount, the liquidity of the Trusts portfolio, the impact of any action that might be taken on the Trust or its shareholders and market considerations. Based on these
considerations, even if the Trusts common shares should trade at a discount, the Board may determine that, in the interest of the Trust and its shareholders, no action should be taken.
TAX MATTERS
The following is a description of certain U.S. federal income tax consequences to a shareholder of acquiring, holding and disposing of common shares of the
Trust. Except as otherwise noted, this discussion assumes you are a taxable U.S. holder (as defined below). This discussion is based upon current provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the Code), the regulations
promulgated thereunder and judicial and administrative authorities, all of which are subject to change or differing interpretations by the courts or the Internal Revenue Service, possibly with retroactive effect. No attempt is made to present a
detailed explanation of all U.S. federal income tax concerns affecting the Trust and its shareholders, and the discussions set forth herein do not constitute
S-38
tax advice. This discussion assumes that investors hold common shares of the Trust as capital assets for U.S. federal income tax purposes (generally, assets held for investment). The Trust has
not sought and will not seek any ruling from the Internal Revenue Service regarding any matters discussed herein. No assurance can be given that the Internal Revenue Service would not assert, or that a court would not sustain, a position contrary to
those set forth below. This summary does not discuss any aspects of non-U.S., state or local tax. Prospective investors must consult their own tax advisers as to the U.S. federal income tax consequences
(including the alternative minimum tax consequences) of acquiring, holding and disposing of the Trusts common shares, as well as the effects of state, local and non-U.S. tax laws.
In addition, no attempt is made to address tax considerations applicable to an investor with a special tax status, such as a financial institution, REIT,
insurance company, regulated investment company, individual retirement account, other tax-exempt organization, dealer in securities or currencies, person holding shares of the Trust as part of a hedging,
integrated, conversion or straddle transaction, trader in securities that has elected the mark-to-market method of accounting for its securities, U.S. holder (as defined
below) whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar, investor with applicable financial statements within the meaning of Section 451(b) of the Code, or non-U.S. investor. Furthermore, this
discussion does not reflect possible application of the alternative minimum tax.
A U.S. holder is a beneficial owner that is for U.S. federal income tax
purposes:
|
● |
|
a citizen or individual resident of the United States (including certain former citizens and former long-term
residents); |
|
● |
|
a corporation or other entity treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes, created or organized
in or under the laws of the United States or any state thereof or the District of Columbia; |
|
● |
|
an estate, the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source; or
|
|
● |
|
a trust with respect to which a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over its
administration and one or more U.S. persons have the authority to control all of its substantial decisions or the trust has made a valid election in effect under applicable Treasury regulations to be treated as a U.S. person for U.S. federal income
tax purposes, whose status as a U.S. person is not overridden by an applicable tax treaty. |
Taxation of the Trust
The Trust intends to elect to be treated and to qualify to be taxed as a RIC under Subchapter M of the Code. In order to qualify as a RIC, the Trust must,
among other things, satisfy certain requirements relating to the sources of its income, diversification of its assets, and distribution of its income to its shareholders. First, the Trust must derive at least 90% of its annual gross income from
dividends, interest, payments with respect to securities loans, gains from the sale or other disposition of stock or securities or foreign currencies, or other income (including but not limited to gains from options, futures and forward contracts)
derived with respect to its business of investing in such stock, securities or currencies, or net income derived from interests in qualified publicly traded partnerships (as defined in the Code) (the 90% gross income test).
Second, the Trust must diversify its holdings so that, at the close of each quarter of its taxable year, (i) at least 50% of the value of its total assets consists of cash, cash items, U.S. Government securities, securities of other RICs and
other securities, with such other securities limited in respect of any one issuer to an amount not greater in value than 5% of the value of the Trusts total assets and to not more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer,
and (ii) not more than 25% of the market value of the Trusts total assets is invested in the securities (other than U.S. Government securities and securities of other RICs) of any one issuer, any two or more issuers controlled by the
Trust and engaged in the same, similar or related trades or businesses, or any one or more qualified publicly traded partnerships.
As long as
the Trust qualifies as a RIC, the Trust will generally not be subject to corporate-level U.S. federal income tax on income and gains that it distributes each taxable year to its shareholders, provided that in such taxable year it distributes at
least 90% of the sum of (i) its net tax-exempt interest income, if any, and (ii) its investment company taxable income (which includes, among other items, dividends, taxable interest,
taxable original issue discount and
S-39
market discount income, income from securities lending, net short-term capital gain in excess of net long-term capital loss, and any other taxable income other than net capital gain
(as defined below) and is reduced by deductible expenses) determined without regard to the deduction for dividends paid. The Trust may retain for investment its net capital gain (which consists of the excess of its net long-term capital gain over
its net short-term capital loss). However, if the Trust retains any net capital gain or any investment company taxable income, it will be subject to tax at regular corporate rates on the amount retained.
The Code imposes a 4% nondeductible excise tax on the Trust to the extent the Trust does not distribute by the end of any calendar year at least the sum of
(i) 98% of its ordinary income (not taking into account any capital gain or loss) for the calendar year and (ii) 98.2% of its capital gain in excess of its capital loss (adjusted for certain ordinary losses) for a one-year period generally ending on October 31 of the calendar year (unless an election is made to use the Trusts fiscal year). In addition, the minimum amounts that must be distributed in any year to
avoid the excise tax will be increased or decreased to reflect any under-distribution or over-distribution, as the case may be, from the previous year. For purposes of the excise tax, the Trust will be deemed to have distributed any income on which
it paid U.S. federal income tax. While the Trust intends to distribute any income and capital gain in the manner necessary to minimize imposition of the 4% nondeductible excise tax, there can be no assurance that sufficient amounts of the
Trusts taxable income and capital gain will be distributed to entirely avoid the imposition of the excise tax. In that event, the Trust will be liable for the excise tax only on the amount by which it does not meet the foregoing distribution
requirement.
If in any taxable year the Trust should fail to qualify under Subchapter M of the Code for tax treatment as a RIC, the Trust would incur a
regular corporate U.S. federal income tax upon all of its taxable income for that year, and all distributions to its shareholders (including distributions of net capital gain) would be taxable to shareholders as ordinary dividend income for U.S.
federal income tax purposes to the extent of the Trusts earnings and profits. Provided that certain holding period and other requirements were met, such dividends would be eligible (i) to be treated as qualified dividend income in the
case of shareholders taxed as individuals and (ii) for the dividends received deduction in the case of corporate shareholders. In addition, to qualify again to be taxed as a RIC in a subsequent year, the Trust would be required to
distribute to shareholders its earnings and profits attributable to non-RIC years. In addition, if the Trust failed to qualify as a RIC for a period greater than two taxable years, then, in order to qualify as
a RIC in a subsequent year, the Trust would be required to elect to recognize and pay tax on any net built-in gain (the excess of aggregate gain, including items of income, over aggregate loss that would have
been realized if the Trust had been liquidated) or, alternatively, be subject to taxation on such built-in gain recognized for a period of five years.
The remainder of this discussion assumes that the Trust qualifies for taxation as a RIC.
The Trusts Investments
Certain of the
Trusts investment practices are subject to special and complex U.S. federal income tax provisions (including mark-to-market, constructive sale, straddle, wash
sale, short sale and other rules) that may, among other things, (i) disallow, suspend or otherwise limit the allowance of certain losses or deductions, (ii) convert lower taxed long-term capital gains or qualified dividend income into
higher taxed short-term capital gains or ordinary income, (iii) convert ordinary loss or a deduction into capital loss (the deductibility of which is more limited), (iv) cause the Trust to recognize income or gain without a corresponding
receipt of cash, (v) adversely affect the time as to when a purchase or sale of stock or securities is deemed to occur, (vi) adversely alter the characterization of certain complex financial transactions and (vii) produce income that
will not be qualified income for purposes of the 90% annual gross income requirement described above. These U.S. federal income tax provisions could therefore affect the amount, timing and character of distributions to common
shareholders. The Trust intends to monitor its transactions and may make certain tax elections and may be required to dispose of securities to mitigate the effect of these provisions and prevent disqualification of the Trust as a RIC. Additionally,
the Trust may be required to limit its activities in derivative instruments in order to enable it to maintain its RIC status.
The Trust may invest a
portion of its net assets in below investment grade securities, commonly known as junk securities. Investments in these types of securities may present special tax issues for the Trust. U.S. federal income tax rules are not entirely
clear about issues such as when the Trust may cease to accrue interest, original issue discount or market discount, when and to what extent deductions may be taken for bad debts or worthless securities,
S-40
how payments received on obligations in default should be allocated between principal and income and whether modifications or exchanges of debt obligations in a bankruptcy or workout context are
taxable. These and other issues could affect the Trusts ability to distribute sufficient income to preserve its status as a RIC or to avoid the imposition of U.S. federal income or excise tax.
Certain debt securities acquired by the Trust may be treated as debt securities that were originally issued at a discount. Generally, the amount of the
original issue discount is treated as interest income and is included in taxable income (and required to be distributed by the Trust in order to qualify as a RIC and avoid U.S. federal income tax or the 4% excise tax on undistributed income) over
the term of the security, even though payment of that amount is not received until a later time, usually when the debt security matures.
If the Trust
purchases a debt security on a secondary market at a price lower than its adjusted issue price, the excess of the adjusted issue price over the purchase price is market discount. Unless the Trust makes an election to accrue market
discount on a current basis, generally, any gain realized on the disposition of, and any partial payment of principal on, a debt security having market discount is treated as ordinary income to the extent the gain, or principal payment, does not
exceed the accrued market discount on the debt security. Market discount generally accrues in equal daily installments. If the Trust ultimately collects less on the debt instrument than its purchase price plus the market discount
previously included in income, the Trust may not be able to benefit from any offsetting loss deductions.
The Trust may invest in preferred securities or
other securities the U.S. federal income tax treatment of which may not be clear or may be subject to recharacterization by the Internal Revenue Service. To the extent the tax treatment of such securities or the income from such securities differs
from the tax treatment expected by the Trust, it could affect the timing or character of income recognized by the Trust, potentially requiring the Trust to purchase or sell securities, or otherwise change its portfolio, in order to comply with the
tax rules applicable to RICs under the Code.
Gain or loss on the sale of securities by the Trust will generally be long-term capital gain or loss if the
securities have been held by the Trust for more than one year. Gain or loss on the sale of securities held for one year or less will be short-term capital gain or loss.
Because the Trust may invest in foreign securities, its income from such securities may be subject to non-U.S. taxes.
Foreign currency gain or loss on foreign currency exchange contracts, non-U.S. dollar-denominated securities
contracts, and non-U.S. dollar-denominated futures contracts, options and forward contracts that are not section 1256 contracts (as defined below) generally will be treated as ordinary income and loss.
Income from options on individual securities written by the Trust will generally not be recognized by the Trust for tax purposes until an option is exercised,
lapses or is subject to a closing transaction (as defined by applicable regulations) pursuant to which the Trusts obligations with respect to the option are otherwise terminated. If the option lapses without exercise, the premiums
received by the Trust from the writing of such options will generally be characterized as short-term capital gain. If the Trust enters into a closing transaction, the difference between the premiums received and the amount paid by the Trust to close
out its position will generally be treated as short-term capital gain or loss. If an option written by the Trust is exercised, thereby requiring the Trust to sell the underlying security, the premium will increase the amount realized upon the sale
of the security, and the character of any gain on such sale of the underlying security as short-term or long-term capital gain will depend on the holding period of the Trust in the underlying security. Because the Trust will not have control over
the exercise of the options it writes, such exercises or other required sales of the underlying securities may cause the Trust to realize gains or losses at inopportune times.
Options on indices of securities and sectors of securities that qualify as section 1256 contracts will generally be
marked-to-market for U.S. federal income tax purposes. As a result, the Trust will generally recognize gain or loss on the last day of each taxable year
equal to the difference between the value of the option on that date and the adjusted basis of the option. The adjusted basis of the option will consequently be increased by such gain or decreased by such loss. Any gain or loss with respect to
options on indices and sectors that qualify as section 1256 contracts will be treated as short-term capital gain or loss to the extent of 40% of such gain or loss and long-term capital gain or loss to the extent of 60% of such gain
or loss. Because the mark-to-market rules may cause the Trust
S-41
to recognize gain in advance of the receipt of cash, the Trust may be required to dispose of investments in order to meet its distribution requirements. Mark-to-market losses may be suspended or otherwise limited if such losses are part of a straddle or similar transaction.
Taxation of Common Shareholders
Trust distributions of
its tax-exempt interest on municipal securities, if properly reported by the Trust to its shareholders (exempt-interest dividends), will generally be exempt from regular federal income tax. In
order for the Trust to pay exempt-interest dividends, at least 50% of the value of the Trusts total assets must consist of tax-exempt obligations on a quarterly basis. Although the Trust intends to meet
this requirement, no assurance can be given in this regard. If the Trust failed to do so, it would not be able to pay tax-exempt dividends, and your distributions attributable to interest received by the Trust
from any source (including distributions of tax-exempt interest income) would be taxable as ordinary income to the extent of the Trusts earnings and profits.
The Trust will either distribute or retain for reinvestment all or part of its net capital gain. If any such gain is retained, the Trust will be subject to a
corporate income tax on such retained amount. In that event, the Trust expects to report the retained amount as undistributed capital gain in a notice to its common shareholders, each of whom, if subject to U.S. federal income tax on long-term
capital gains, (i) will be required to include in income for U.S. federal income tax purposes as long-term capital gain its share of such undistributed amounts, (ii) will be entitled to credit its proportionate share of the tax paid by the
Trust against its U.S. federal income tax liability and to claim refunds to the extent that the credit exceeds such liability and (iii) will increase its basis in its common shares by the amount of undistributed capital gains included in the
shareholders income less the tax deemed paid by the shareholder under clause (ii).
Distributions paid to you by the Trust from its net capital
gain, if any, that the Trust properly reports as capital gain dividends (capital gain dividends) are taxable as long-term capital gains, regardless of how long you have held your common shares. All other dividends paid to you by the
Trust (including dividends from net short-term capital gains) from its current or accumulated earnings and profits, other than exempt-interest dividends (ordinary income dividends), are generally subject to tax as ordinary income.
Provided that certain holding period and other requirements are met, ordinary income dividends (if properly reported by the Trust) may qualify (i) for the dividends received deduction in the case of corporate shareholders to the extent that the
Trusts income consists of dividend income from U.S. corporations, and (ii) in the case of individual shareholders, as qualified dividend income eligible to be taxed at long-term capital gains rates to the extent that the Trust
receives qualified dividend income. Qualified dividend income is, in general, dividend income from taxable domestic corporations and certain qualified foreign corporations (e.g., generally, foreign corporations incorporated in a possession of the
United States or in certain countries with a qualifying comprehensive tax treaty with the United States, or whose stock with respect to which such dividend is paid is readily tradable on an established securities market in the United States). There
can be no assurance as to what portion, if any, of the Trusts distributions will constitute qualified dividend income or be eligible for the dividends received deduction.
Any distributions you receive that are in excess of the Trusts current and accumulated earnings and profits will be treated as a return of capital to
the extent of your adjusted tax basis in your common shares, and thereafter as capital gain from the sale of common shares. The amount of any Trust distribution that is treated as a return of capital will reduce your adjusted tax basis in your
common shares, thereby increasing your potential gain or reducing your potential loss on any subsequent sale or other disposition of your common shares.
Common shareholders may be entitled to offset their capital gain dividends with capital losses. The Code contains a number of statutory provisions affecting
when capital losses may be offset against capital gain, and limiting the use of losses from certain investments and activities. Accordingly, common shareholders that have capital losses are urged to consult their tax advisers.
Dividends and other taxable distributions are taxable to you even though they are reinvested in additional common shares of the Trust. Dividends and other
distributions paid by the Trust are generally treated under the Code as received by you at the time the dividend or distribution is made. If, however, the Trust pays you a dividend in January that was declared in the previous October, November or
December to common shareholders of record on a specified date in one of such months, then such dividend will be treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes as
S-42
being paid by the Trust and received by you on December 31 of the year in which the dividend was declared. In addition, certain other distributions made after the close of the Trusts
taxable year may be spilled back and treated as paid by the Trust (except for purposes of the 4% nondeductible excise tax) during such taxable year. In such case, you will be treated as having received such dividends in the taxable year
in which the distributions were actually made.
Interest on certain private activity bonds is an item of tax preference subject to the
alternative minimum tax on individuals. The Trust may invest a portion of its assets in municipal bonds subject to this provision so that a portion of its exempt-interest dividends is an item of tax preference to the extent such dividends represent
interest received from these private activity bonds. Accordingly, investment in the Trust could cause a holder of common shares to be subject to, or result in an increased liability under, the alternative minimum tax.
Exempt-interest dividends are included in determining what portion, if any, of a persons Social Security and railroad retirement benefits will be
includable in gross income subject to federal income tax.
The price of common shares purchased at any time may reflect the amount of a forthcoming
distribution. Those purchasing common shares just prior to the record date for a distribution will receive a distribution which will be taxable to them even though it represents, economically, a return of invested capital.
The Trust will send you information after the end of each year setting forth the amount and tax status of any distributions paid to you by the Trust.
The sale or other disposition of common shares will generally result in capital gain or loss to you and will be long-term capital gain or loss if you have
held such common shares for more than one year at the time of sale. Any loss upon the sale or other disposition of common shares held for six months or less will be treated as long-term capital loss to the extent of any capital gain dividends
received (including amounts credited as an undistributed capital gain dividend) by you with respect to such common shares. Any loss you recognize on a sale or other disposition of common shares will be disallowed if you acquire other common shares
(whether through the automatic reinvestment of dividends or otherwise) within a 61-day period beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after your sale or exchange of the common shares. In such case,
your tax basis in the common shares acquired will be adjusted to reflect the disallowed loss.
If the Trust conducts a tender offer for its shares, a
repurchase by the Trust of a shareholders shares pursuant to such tender offer generally will be treated as a sale or exchange of the shares by a shareholder provided that either (i) the shareholder tenders, and the Trust repurchases, all
of such shareholders shares, thereby reducing the shareholders percentage ownership of the Trust, whether directly or by attribution under Section 318 of the Code, to 0%, (ii) the shareholder meets numerical safe harbors under
the Code with respect to percentage voting interest and reduction in ownership of the Trust following completion of the tender offer, or (iii) the tender offer otherwise results in a meaningful reduction of the shareholders
ownership percentage interest in the Trust, which determination depends on a particular shareholders facts and circumstances.
If a tendering
shareholders proportionate ownership of the Trust (determined after applying the ownership attribution rules under Section 318 of the Code) is not reduced to the extent required under the tests described above, such shareholder will be
deemed to receive a distribution from the Trust under Section 301 of the Code with respect to the shares held (or deemed held under Section 318 of the Code) by the shareholder after the tender offer (a Section 301
distribution). The amount of this distribution will equal the price paid by the Trust to such shareholder for the shares sold, and will be taxable as a dividend, i.e., as ordinary income, to the extent of the Trusts current or
accumulated earnings and profits allocable to such distribution, with the excess treated as a return of capital reducing the shareholders tax basis in the shares held after the tender offer, and thereafter as capital gain. Any Trust shares
held by a shareholder after a tender offer will be subject to basis adjustments in accordance with the provisions of the Code.
Provided that no tendering
shareholder is treated as receiving a Section 301 distribution as a result of selling shares pursuant to a particular tender offer, shareholders who do not sell shares pursuant to that tender offer will not realize constructive distributions on
their shares as a result of other shareholders selling shares in the tender offer. In the event that any tendering shareholder is deemed to receive a Section 301 distribution, it is possible that shareholders
S-43
whose proportionate ownership of the Trust increases as a result of that tender offer, including shareholders who do not tender any shares, will be deemed to receive a constructive distribution
under Section 305(c) of the Code in an amount equal to the increase in their percentage ownership of the Trust as a result of the tender offer. Such constructive distribution will be treated as a dividend to the extent of current or accumulated
earnings and profits allocable to it.
Use of the Trusts cash to repurchase shares may adversely affect the Trusts ability to satisfy the
distribution requirements for treatment as a regulated investment company described above. The Trust may also recognize income in connection with the sale of portfolio securities to fund share purchases, in which case the Trust would take any such
income into account in determining whether such distribution requirements have been satisfied.
If the Trust liquidates, shareholders generally will
realize capital gain or loss upon such liquidation in an amount equal to the difference between the amount of cash or other property received by the shareholder (including any property deemed received by reason of its being placed in a liquidating
trust) and the shareholders adjusted tax basis in its shares. Any such gain or loss will be long-term if the shareholder is treated as having a holding period in Trust shares of greater than one year, and otherwise will be short-term.
The foregoing discussion does not address the tax treatment of shareholders who do not hold their shares as a capital asset. Such shareholders should consult
their own tax advisors on the specific tax consequences to them of participating or not participating in the tender offer or upon liquidation of the Trust.
Current U.S. federal income tax law taxes both long-term and short-term capital gain of corporations at the rates applicable to ordinary income. For non-corporate taxpayers, short-term capital gain is currently taxed at rates applicable to ordinary income while long-term capital gain generally is taxed at a reduced maximum rate. The deductibility of capital
losses is subject to limitations under the Code.
Certain U.S. holders who are individuals, estates or trusts and whose income exceeds certain thresholds
will be required to pay a 3.8% Medicare tax on all or a portion of their net investment income, which includes dividends received from the Trust and capital gains from the sale or other disposition of the Trusts common shares.
A common shareholder that is a nonresident alien individual or a foreign corporation (a foreign investor) generally will be subject to U.S.
federal withholding tax at the rate of 30% (or possibly a lower rate provided by an applicable tax treaty) on ordinary income dividends (except as discussed below). In general, U.S. federal withholding tax and U.S. federal income tax will not apply
to any gain or income realized by a foreign investor in respect of any distribution of exempt-interest dividends or net capital gain (including amounts credited as an undistributed capital gain dividend) or upon the sale or other disposition of
common shares of the Trust. Different tax consequences may result if the foreign investor is engaged in a trade or business in the United States or, in the case of an individual, is present in the United States for 183 days or more during a taxable
year and certain other conditions are met. Foreign investors should consult their tax advisers regarding the tax consequences of investing in the Trusts common shares.
Ordinary income dividends properly reported by the RIC are generally exempt from U.S. federal withholding tax where they (i) are paid in respect of the
RICs qualified net interest income (generally, its U.S.-source interest income, other than certain contingent interest and interest from obligations of a corporation or partnership in which the RIC is at least a 10% shareholder,
reduced by expenses that are allocable to such income) or (ii) are paid in respect of the RICs qualified short-term capital gains (generally, the excess of the RICs net short-term capital gain over its long-term capital
loss for such taxable year). Depending on its circumstances, the Trust may report all, some or none of its potentially eligible dividends as such qualified net interest income or as qualified short-term capital gains, and/or treat such dividends, in
whole or in part, as ineligible for this exemption from withholding. In order to qualify for this exemption from withholding, a foreign investor needs to comply with applicable certification requirements relating to its non-U.S. status (including, in general, furnishing an IRS Form W-8BEN, W-8BEN-E, or substitute
Form). In the case of common shares held through an intermediary, the intermediary may have withheld tax even if the Trust reported the payment as qualified net interest income or qualified short-term capital gain. Foreign investors should contact
their intermediaries with respect to the application of these rules to their accounts. There can be no assurance as to what portion of the Trusts distributions would qualify for favorable treatment as qualified net interest income or qualified
short-term capital gains if the provision is extended.
S-44
In addition withholding at a rate of 30% will apply to dividends paid in respect of common shares of the Trust
held by or through certain foreign financial institutions (including investment funds), unless such institution enters into an agreement with the Treasury to report, on an annual basis, information with respect to shares in, and accounts maintained
by, the institution to the extent such shares or accounts are held by certain U.S. persons and by certain non-U.S. entities that are wholly or partially owned by U.S. persons and to withhold on certain
payments. Accordingly, the entity through which common shares of the Trust are held will affect the determination of whether such withholding is required. Similarly, dividends paid in respect of common shares of the Trust held by an investor that is
a non-financial foreign entity that does not qualify under certain exemptions will be subject to withholding at a rate of 30%, unless such entity either (i) certifies that such entity does not have any
substantial United States owners or (ii) provides certain information regarding the entitys substantial United States owners, which the applicable withholding agent will in turn provide to the Secretary of the
Treasury. An intergovernmental agreement between the United States and an applicable foreign country, or future Treasury regulations or other guidance, may modify these requirements. The Trust will not pay any additional amounts to common
shareholders in respect of any amounts withheld. Foreign investors are encouraged to consult with their tax advisers regarding the possible implications of these rules on their investment in the Trusts common shares.
U.S. federal backup withholding tax may be required on dividends, distributions and sale proceeds payable to certain
non-exempt common shareholders who fail to supply their correct taxpayer identification number (in the case of individuals, generally, their social security number) or to make required certifications, or who
are otherwise subject to backup withholding. Backup withholding is not an additional tax and any amount withheld may be refunded or credited against your U.S. federal income tax liability, if any, provided that you timely furnish the required
information to the Internal Revenue Service.
Ordinary income dividends, capital gain dividends, and gain from the sale or other disposition of common
shares of the Trust also may be subject to state, local, and/or foreign taxes. Common shareholders are urged to consult their own tax advisers regarding specific questions about U.S. federal, state, local or foreign tax consequences to them of
investing in the Trust.
Under U.S. Treasury regulations, if a common shareholder recognizes a loss with respect to common shares of $2 million or
more for an individual shareholder in a single taxable year (or $4 million or more in any combination of taxable years in which the transaction is entered into and the five succeeding taxable years) or $10 million or more for a corporate
shareholder in any single taxable year (or $20 million or more in any combination of taxable years in which the transaction is entered into and the five succeeding taxable years), the shareholder must file with the Internal Revenue Service a
disclosure statement on Internal Revenue Service Form 8886. The fact that a loss is reportable under these regulations does not affect the legal determination of whether the taxpayers treatment of the loss is proper. Common shareholders should
consult their tax advisors to determine the applicability of these regulations in light of their individual circumstances.
***
The foregoing is a general and abbreviated summary of certain provisions of the Code and the Treasury Regulations presently in effect as they directly govern
the taxation of the Trust and its shareholders. For complete provisions, reference should be made to the pertinent Code sections and Treasury Regulations. The Code and the Treasury Regulations are subject to change by legislative or administrative
action, and any such change may be retroactive with respect to Trust transactions. Holders of common shares are advised to consult their own tax advisers for more detailed information concerning the U.S. federal income taxation of the Trust and the
income tax consequences to its holders of common shares.
CUSTODIAN AND TRANSFER AGENT
The custodian of the assets of the Trust is State Street Bank and Trust Company, whose principal business address is One Congress Street, Suite 1, Boston,
Massachusetts 02114-2016. The custodian is responsible for, among other things, receipt of and disbursement of funds from the Trusts accounts, establishment of segregated accounts as necessary, and transfer, exchange and delivery of Trust
portfolio securities.
Computershare Trust Company, N.A., whose principal business address is 150 Royall Street, Canton, Massachusetts 02021, serves as
the Trusts transfer agent with respect to the common shares.
S-45
INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
[ ], whose principal business address is [ ], is the independent registered public accounting firm of
the Trust and is expected to render an opinion annually on the financial statements of the Trust.
CONTROL
PERSONS AND PRINCIPAL HOLDERS OF SECURITIES
A control person is a person who beneficially owns, either directly or indirectly, more than 25% of the
voting securities of a company. As of February 28, 2025 the Trust did not know of any person or entity who controlled the Trust. As of February 28, 2025, to the knowledge of the Trust, no person owned of record or beneficially 5% or more
of the outstanding common shares of any class of the Trust.
INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE
This SAI is part of a registration statement that we have filed with the SEC. We are allowed to incorporate by reference the information that we
file with the SEC, which means that we can disclose important information to you by referring you to those documents. We incorporate by reference into this SAI the documents listed below and any future filings we make with the SEC under Sections
13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, including any filings on or after the date of this SAI from the date of filing (excluding any information furnished, rather than filed), until we have sold all of the offered securities to which this
SAI, the Prospectus and any accompanying prospectus supplement relates or the offering is otherwise terminated. The information incorporated by reference is an important part of this SAI. Any statement in a document incorporated by reference into
this SAI will be deemed to be automatically modified or superseded to the extent a statement contained in (1) this SAI or (2) any other subsequently filed document that is incorporated by reference into this SAI modifies or supersedes such
statement. The documents incorporated by reference herein include:
|
● |
|
The Trusts Prospectus, dated [●], 2025, filed with this SAI; |
|
● |
|
our annual report on Form N-CSR for the fiscal year ended
December 31, 2024 filed with the SEC on March 7, 2025; |
|
● |
|
the description of the Trusts common shares contained in our Registration Statement on Form 8-A (File No. 001-31741) filed with the SEC on July 22, 2003, including any amendment or report filed for the purpose of updating such description prior to the
termination of the offering registered hereby. |
The Trust will provide without charge to each person, including any beneficial owner, to
whom this SAI is delivered, upon written or oral request, a copy of any and all of the documents that have been or may be incorporated by reference in this SAI, the Prospectus or the accompanying prospectus supplement. You should direct requests for
documents by calling:
Client Services Desk
(800) 882-0052
The Trust makes available the Prospectus, SAI and the Trusts annual and semi-annual reports, free of charge, at http://www.blackrock.com. You may also
obtain this SAI, the Prospectus, other documents incorporated by reference and other information the Trust files electronically, including reports and proxy statements, on the SEC website (http://www.sec.gov) or with the payment of a duplication
fee, by electronic request at publicinfo@sec.gov.
S-46
Information contained in, or that can be accessed through, the Trusts website is not part of this SAI, the Prospectus or the accompanying prospectus supplement.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The audited financial statements and financial highlights included in the annual
report to the Trusts shareholders for the fiscal year ended December
31, 2024 (the 2024 Annual Report), together with the report of [ ] on the financial statements and financial highlights included in the Trusts 2024 Annual Report, are incorporated herein by reference to the
2024 Annual Report.
S-47
APPENDIX A
Description of Bond Ratings
A rating is
generally assigned to a fixed-income security at the time of issuance by a credit rating agency designated as a nationally recognized statistical rating organization (NRSRO) by the SEC. While NRSROs may from time to time revise such
ratings, they undertake no obligation to do so, and the ratings given to securities at issuance do not necessarily represent ratings which would be given to these securities on a particular subsequent date.
NRSROs may rate specific investments (e.g., bonds), issuers (e.g., corporations, governments and financial institutions) and/or programs (e.g., commercial
paper programs). However, certain types of investments may not be rated by NRSROs, such as certain government/sovereign obligations, US agency securities, commercial paper, time deposits at financial institutions, and derivative instruments such as
credit default swaps. For these types of investments, as well as US Treasury securities (some of which are not rated), where a NRSRO has not rated the specific investment but has rated the investments issuer, program, financial institution or
underlying reference asset, BlackRock Advisors, LLC, BlackRock Fund Advisors or their respective affiliates (BlackRock) may consider the investment to have the same NRSRO rating as its issuer, program, financial institution or underlying
reference asset, as applicable. In the case of municipal securities, where one NRSRO provides multiple ratings for the same security (e.g., underlying, insured and/or enhanced ratings), BlackRock may consider the
security to have the highest of the multiple ratings.
New issue securities (regardless of type) may not be rated by a NRSRO at the time of their initial
offering. Preliminary prospectuses or term sheets for new issue securities may include an expected rating for the security (as determined by the underwriter and/or issuer) or a NRSRO rating for the issuer of the security. If applicable, when
deciding whether to purchase a new issue security that has not yet been rated by a NRSRO, BlackRock may attribute an expected rating to the security based on: (i) the expected rating of the security set forth in the preliminary prospectus or
term sheet for the security; (ii) the NRSROs rating for the issuer of the security set forth in the preliminary prospectus or term sheet for the security; or (iii) with respect to asset-backed securities, the rating of a prior
issuance having a similar structure or the same sponsor.
Where the investment objective of a fund is to track the performance of an index that includes
credit ratings eligibility criteria as part of its index methodology, the fund may purchase any security within the index, such security having been determined by the index provider as meeting its credit ratings eligibility criteria. The credit
ratings practices of an index provider may differ from BlackRocks practices, as described above. Further, the fund may invest, directly or indirectly, in securities that are not rated by a rating agency or securities with a credit rating that
differs from the credit rating specified in its index methodology in various circumstances, including where a security is downgraded but not yet removed from an index, following the removal of a security from an index prior to its sale by the fund
or as a result of a corporate action or restructuring affecting an issuer of a security held by the fund.
Fixed-income securities which are unrated may
expose the investor to risks with respect to capacity to pay interest or repay principal which are similar to the risks of lower-rated speculative bonds. Evaluation of these securities is dependent on BlackRocks judgment, analysis and
experience in the evaluation of such securities.
Investors should note that the assignment of a rating to a security by an NRSRO may not reflect the
effect of recent developments on the issuers ability to make interest and principal payments or on the likelihood of default.
Securities deemed to
be high yield are rated below Baa3 by Moodys and below BBB- by S&P Global Ratings and Fitch.
The
descriptions below relate to general long-term and short-term obligations of an issuer.
A-1
A Description of Moodys Investors Service, Inc.s (Moodys) Global Rating Scales
Ratings assigned on Moodys global long-term and short-term rating scales are forward-looking opinions of the relative credit risks of financial
obligations issued by non-financial corporates, financial institutions, structured finance vehicles, project finance vehicles, and public sector entities. Moodys defines credit risk as the risk that an
entity may not meet its contractual financial obligations as they come due and any estimated financial loss in the event of default or impairment. The contractual financial obligations addressed by Moodys ratings are those that call for,
without regard to enforceability, the payment of an ascertainable amount, which may vary based upon standard sources of variation (e.g., floating interest rates), by an ascertainable date. Moodys rating addresses the issuers ability to
obtain cash sufficient to service the obligation, and its willingness to pay. Moodys ratings do not address non-standard sources of variation in the amount of the principal obligation (e.g., equity
indexed), absent an express statement to the contrary in a press release accompanying an initial rating. Long-term ratings are assigned to issuers or obligations with an original maturity of one year or more and reflect both on the likelihood of a
default or impairment on contractual financial obligations and the expected financial loss suffered in the event of default or impairment. Short-term ratings are assigned for obligations with an original maturity of thirteen months or less and
reflect both on the likelihood of a default or impairment on contractual financial obligations and the expected financial loss suffered in the event of default or impairment. Moodys issues ratings at the issuer level and instrument level on
both the long-term scale and the short-term scale. Typically, ratings are made publicly available although private and unpublished ratings may also be assigned.
Moodys differentiates structured finance ratings from fundamental ratings (i.e., ratings on nonfinancial corporate, financial institution, and public
sector entities) on the global long-term scale by adding (sf) to all structured finance ratings. The addition of (sf) to structured finance ratings should eliminate any presumption that such ratings and fundamental ratings at the same letter grade
level will behave the same. The (sf) indicator for structured finance security ratings indicates that otherwise similarly rated structured finance and fundamental securities may have different risk characteristics. Through its current methodologies,
however, Moodys aspires to achieve broad expected equivalence in structured finance and fundamental rating performance when measured over a long period of time.
Description of Moodys Global Long-Term Rating Scale
|
|
|
|
|
Aaa |
|
|
|
Obligations rated Aaa are judged to be of the highest quality, subject to the lowest level of credit risk. |
|
|
|
|
|
Aa |
|
|
|
Obligations rated Aa are judged to be of high quality and are subject to very low credit risk. |
|
|
|
|
|
A |
|
|
|
Obligations rated A are judged to be upper-medium grade and are subject to low credit risk. |
|
|
|
|
|
Baa |
|
|
|
Obligations rated Baa are judged to be medium-grade and subject to moderate credit risk and as such may possess certain speculative characteristics. |
|
|
|
|
|
Ba |
|
|
|
Obligations rated Ba are judged to be speculative and are subject to substantial credit risk. |
|
|
|
|
|
B |
|
|
|
Obligations rated B are considered speculative and are subject to high credit risk. |
|
|
|
|
|
Caa |
|
|
|
Obligations rated Caa are judged to be speculative of poor standing and are subject to very high credit risk. |
|
|
|
|
|
Ca |
|
|
|
Obligations rated Ca are highly speculative and are likely in, or very near, default, with some prospect of recovery of principal and interest. |
C |
|
|
|
Obligations rated C are the lowest rated and are typically in default, with little prospect for recovery of principal or interest. |
A-2
Note: Moodys appends numerical modifiers 1, 2, and 3 to each generic rating classification from Aa
through Caa. The modifier 1 indicates that the obligation ranks in the higher end of its generic rating category; the modifier 2 indicates a mid-range ranking; and the modifier 3 indicates a ranking in the
lower end of that generic rating category. Additionally, a (hyb) indicator is appended to all ratings of hybrid securities issued by banks, insurers, finance companies, and securities firms.
By their terms, hybrid securities allow for the omission of scheduled dividends, interest, or principal payments, which can potentially result in impairment
if such an omission occurs. Hybrid securities may also be subject to contractually allowable write-downs of principal that could result in impairment. Together with the hybrid indicator, the long-term obligation rating assigned to a hybrid security
is an expression of the relative credit risk associated with that security.
Description of Moodys Global Short-Term Rating Scale
P-1 |
Ratings of Prime-1 reflect a superior ability to repay short-term
obligations. |
P-2 |
Ratings of Prime-2 reflect a strong ability to repay short-term
obligations. |
P-3 |
Ratings of Prime-3 reflect an acceptable ability to repay short-term
obligations. |
NP |
Issuers (or supporting institutions) rated Not Prime do not fall within any of the Prime rating categories.
|
Description of Moodys U.S. Municipal Short-Term Debt and Demand Obligation Ratings
Description of Moodys Short-Term Obligation Ratings
Moodys uses the global short-term Prime rating scale for commercial paper issued by U.S. municipalities and nonprofits. These commercial paper programs
may be backed by external letters of credit or liquidity facilities, or by an issuers self-liquidity.
For other short-term municipal obligations,
Moodys uses one of two other short-term rating scales, the Municipal Investment Grade (MIG) and Variable Municipal Investment Grade (VMIG) scales discussed below.
Moodys uses the MIG scale for U.S. municipal cash flow notes, bond anticipation notes and certain other short-term obligations, which typically mature
in three years or less. Under certain circumstances, Moodys uses the MIG scale for bond anticipation notes with maturities of up to five years.
MIG Scale
|
|
|
MIG 1 |
|
This designation denotes superior credit quality. Excellent protection is afforded by established cash flows, highly reliable liquidity support, or demonstrated broad-based access to the market for refinancing. |
|
|
MIG 2 |
|
This designation denotes strong credit quality. Margins of protection are ample, although not as large as in the preceding group. |
|
|
MIG 3 |
|
This designation denotes acceptable credit quality. Liquidity and cash-flow protection may be narrow, and market access for refinancing is likely to be less well-established. |
|
|
SG |
|
This designation denotes speculative-grade credit quality. Debt instruments in this category may lack sufficient margins of protection. |
A-3
Description of Moodys Demand Obligation Ratings
In the case of variable rate demand obligations (VRDOs), a two-component rating is assigned. The
components are a long-term rating and a short-term demand obligation rating. The long-term rating addresses the issuers ability to meet scheduled principal and interest payments. The short-term demand obligation rating addresses the ability of
the issuer or the liquidity provider to make payments associated with the purchase-price-upon-demand feature (demand feature) of the VRDO. The short-term demand obligation rating uses the VMIG scale. VMIG ratings with liquidity support
use as an input the short-term Counterparty Risk Assessment of the support provider, or the long-term rating of the underlying obligor in the absence of third party liquidity support. Transitions of VMIG ratings of demand obligations with
conditional liquidity support differ from transitions on the Prime scale to reflect the risk that external liquidity support will terminate if the issuers long-term rating drops below investment grade.
Moodys typically assigns the VMIG short-term demand obligation rating if the frequency of the demand feature is less than every three years. If the
frequency of the demand feature is less than three years but the purchase price is payable only with remarketing proceeds, the short-term demand obligation rating is NR.
VMIG Scale
|
|
|
VMIG 1 |
|
This designation denotes superior credit quality. Excellent protection is afforded by the superior short-term credit strength of the liquidity provider and structural and legal protections that ensure the timely payment of purchase
price upon demand. |
|
|
VMIG 2 |
|
This designation denotes strong credit quality. Good protection is afforded by the strong short-term credit strength of the liquidity provider and structural and legal protections that ensure the timely payment of purchase price
upon demand. |
|
|
VMIG 3 |
|
This designation denotes acceptable credit quality. Adequate protection is afforded by the satisfactory short-term credit strength of the liquidity provider and structural and legal protections that ensure the timely payment of
purchase price upon demand. |
|
|
SG |
|
This designation denotes speculative-grade credit quality. Demand features rated in this category may be supported by a liquidity provider that does not have a sufficiently strong short-term rating or may lack the structural or
legal protections necessary to ensure the timely payment of purchase price upon demand. |
Description of S&P Global Ratings (S&P), a Division of S&P Global Inc., Issue Credit Ratings
An S&P issue credit rating is a forward-looking opinion about the creditworthiness of an obligor with respect to a specific financial obligation,
a specific class of financial obligations, or a specific financial program (including ratings on medium-term note programs and commercial paper programs). It takes into consideration the creditworthiness of guarantors, insurers, or other forms of
credit enhancement on the obligation and takes into account the currency in which the obligation is denominated. The opinion reflects S&Ps view of the obligors capacity and willingness to meet its financial commitments as they come
due, and this opinion may assess terms, such as collateral security and subordination, which could affect ultimate payment in the event of default.
Issue
credit ratings can be either long-term or short-term. Short-term issue credit ratings are generally assigned to those obligations considered short-term in the relevant market, typically with an original maturity of no more than 365 days. Short-term
issue credit ratings are also used to indicate the creditworthiness of an obligor with respect to put features on long-term obligations. S&P would typically assign a long-term issue credit rating to an obligation with an original maturity of
greater than 365 days. However, the ratings S&P assigns to certain instruments may diverge from these guidelines based on market practices. Medium-term notes are assigned long-term ratings.
Issue credit ratings are based, in varying degrees, on S&Ps analysis of the following considerations:
A-4
|
● |
|
The likelihood of paymentthe capacity and willingness of the obligor to meet its financial commitments on
an obligation in accordance with the terms of the obligation; |
|
● |
|
The nature and provisions of the financial obligation, and the promise S&P imputes; and
|
|
● |
|
The protection afforded by, and relative position of, the financial obligation in the event of a bankruptcy,
reorganization, or other arrangement under the laws of bankruptcy and other laws affecting creditors rights. |
An issue rating is
an assessment of default risk but may incorporate an assessment of relative seniority or ultimate recovery in the event of default. Junior obligations are typically rated lower than senior obligations, to reflect lower priority in bankruptcy, as
noted above. (Such differentiation may apply when an entity has both senior and subordinated obligations, secured and unsecured obligations, or operating company and holding company obligations.)
Long-Term Issue Credit Ratings*
|
|
|
AAA |
|
An obligation rated AAA has the highest rating assigned by S&P. The obligors capacity to meet its
financial commitments on the obligation is extremely strong. |
|
|
|
AA |
|
An obligation rated AA differs from the highest-rated obligations only to a small degree. The obligors
capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation is very strong. |
|
|
|
A |
|
An obligation rated A is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and
economic conditions than obligations in higher-rated categories. However, the obligors capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation is still strong. |
|
|
|
BBB |
|
An obligation rated BBB exhibits adequate protection parameters. However, adverse economic conditions or
changing circumstances are more likely to weaken the obligors capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation. |
|
|
|
BB,
B,
CCC,
CC,
and C |
|
Obligations rated BB, B, CCC, CC, and C are regarded as having
significant speculative characteristics. BB indicates the least degree of speculation and C the highest. While such obligations will likely have some quality and protective characteristics, these may be outweighed by large
uncertainties or major exposure to adverse conditions. |
|
|
|
BB |
|
An obligation rated BB is less vulnerable to nonpayment than other speculative issues. However, it faces major
ongoing uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions that could lead to the obligors inadequate capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation. |
|
|
|
B |
|
An obligation rated B is more vulnerable to nonpayment than obligations rated BB, but the obligor
currently has the capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will likely impair the obligors capacity or willingness to meet its financial commitments on the
obligation. |
|
|
|
CCC |
|
An obligation rated CCC is currently vulnerable to nonpayment and is dependent upon favorable business,
financial, and economic conditions for the obligor to meet its financial commitments on the obligation. In the event of adverse business, financial, or economic conditions, the obligor is not likely to have the capacity to meet its financial
commitments on the obligation. |
A-5
|
|
|
CC |
|
An obligation rated CC is currently highly vulnerable to nonpayment. The CC rating is used when
a default has not yet occurred but S&P expects default to be a virtual certainty, regardless of the anticipated time to default. |
|
|
|
C |
|
An obligation rated C is currently highly vulnerable to nonpayment, and the obligation is expected to have
lower relative seniority or lower ultimate recovery compared with obligations that are rated higher. |
|
|
|
D |
|
An obligation rated D is in default or in breach of an imputed promise. For
non-hybrid capital instruments, the D rating category is used when payments on an obligation are not made on the date due, unless S&P believes that such payments will be made within five
business days in the absence of a stated grace period or within the earlier of the stated grace period or 30 calendar days. The D rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition or the taking of similar action and where
default on an obligation is a virtual certainty, for example due to automatic stay provisions. A rating on an obligation is lowered to D if it is subject to a distressed debt restructuring. |
* Ratings from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a plus (+) or minus (-) sign to show
relative standing within the rating categories.
Short-Term Issue Credit Ratings
|
|
|
A-1 |
|
A short-term obligation rated A-1 is rated in the highest category by S&P. The obligors capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation is strong. Within
this category, certain obligations are designated with a plus sign (+). This indicates that the obligors capacity to meet its financial commitments on these obligations is extremely strong. |
|
|
A-2 |
|
A short-term obligation rated A-2 is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than obligations in higher rating
categories. However, the obligors capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation is satisfactory. |
|
|
A-3 |
|
A short-term obligation rated A-3 exhibits adequate protection parameters. However, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to weaken an
obligors capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation. |
|
|
B |
|
A short-term obligation rated B is regarded as vulnerable and has significant speculative characteristics. The obligor currently has the capacity to meet its financial commitments; however, it faces major ongoing
uncertainties that could lead to the obligors inadequate capacity to meet its financial commitments. |
|
|
C |
|
A short-term obligation rated C is currently vulnerable to nonpayment and is dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions for the obligor to meet its financial commitments on the
obligation. |
|
|
D |
|
A short-term obligation rated D is in default or in breach of an imputed promise. For non-hybrid capital instruments, the D rating category is used when payments on an
obligation are not made on the date due, unless S&P believes that such payments will be made within any stated grace period. However, any stated grace period longer than five business days will be treated as five business days. The D
rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition or the taking of a similar action and where default on an obligation is a virtual certainty, for example due to automatic stay provisions. A rating on an obligation is lowered to
D if it is subject to a distressed debt restructuring. |
Description of S&Ps Municipal Short-Term Note Ratings
An S&P U.S. municipal note rating reflects S&Ps opinion about the liquidity factors and market access risks unique to the notes. Notes due in
three years or less will likely receive a note rating. Notes with an original maturity of more
A-6
than three years will most likely receive a long-term debt rating. In determining which type of rating, if any, to assign, S&Ps analysis will review the following considerations:
|
● |
|
Amortization schedulethe larger the final maturity relative to other maturities, the more likely it will be
treated as a note; and |
|
● |
|
Source of paymentthe more dependent the issue is on the market for its refinancing, the more likely it will
be treated as a note. |
S&Ps municipal short-term note rating symbols are as follows:
|
|
|
SP-1 |
|
Strong capacity to pay principal and interest. An issue determined to possess a very strong capacity to pay debt service is given a plus (+) designation. |
|
|
SP-2 |
|
Satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest, with some vulnerability to adverse financial and economic changes over the term of the notes. |
|
|
SP-3 |
|
Speculative capacity to pay principal and interest. |
|
|
D |
|
D is assigned upon failure to pay the note when due, completion of a distressed debt restructuring, or the filing of a bankruptcy petition or the taking of similar action and where default on an obligation is a virtual
certainty, for example due to automatic stay provisions. |
Description of Fitch Ratings (Fitchs) Credit Ratings Scales
Fitch Ratings publishes opinions on a variety of scales. The most common of these are credit ratings, but the agency also publishes ratings, scores and other
relative opinions relating to financial or operational strength. For example, Fitch also provides specialized ratings of servicers of residential and commercial mortgages, asset managers and funds. In each case, users should refer to the definitions
of each individual scale for guidance on the dimensions of risk covered in each assessment.
Fitchs credit ratings relating to issuers are an
opinion on the relative ability of an entity to meet financial commitments, such as interest, preferred dividends, repayment of principal, insurance claims or counterparty obligations. Credit ratings relating to securities and obligations of an
issuer can include a recovery expectation. Credit ratings are used by investors as indications of the likelihood of receiving the money owed to them in accordance with the terms on which they invested. The agencys credit ratings cover the
global spectrum of corporate, sovereign financial, bank, insurance, and public finance entities (including supranational and sub-national entities) and the securities or other obligations they issue, as well
as structured finance securities backed by receivables or other financial assets.
The terms investment grade and speculative
grade have established themselves over time as shorthand to describe the categories AAA to BBB (investment grade) and BB to D (speculative grade). The terms investment grade and speculative grade
are market conventions and do not imply any recommendation or endorsement of a specific security for investment purposes. Investment grade categories indicate relatively low to moderate credit risk, while ratings in the speculative categories either
signal a higher level of credit risk or that a default has already occurred.
For the convenience of investors, Fitch may also include issues relating to
a rated issuer that are not and have not been rated on its web page. Such issues are also denoted as NR.
Credit ratings express risk in
relative rank order, which is to say they are ordinal measures of credit risk and are not predictive of a specific frequency of default or loss. For information about the historical performance of ratings
A-7
please refer to Fitchs Ratings Transition and Default studies which detail the historical default rates and their meaning. The European Securities and Markets Authority also maintains a
central repository of historical default rates.
Fitchs credit ratings do not directly address any risk other than credit risk. In particular,
ratings do not deal with the risk of a market value loss on a rated security due to changes in interest rates, liquidity and other market considerations. However, in terms of payment obligation on the rated liability, market risk may be considered
to the extent that it influences the ability of an issuer to pay upon a commitment.
Ratings nonetheless do not reflect market risk to the extent that
they influence the size or other conditionality of the obligation to pay upon a commitment (for example, in the case of index-linked bonds).
In the
default components of ratings assigned to individual obligations or instruments, the agency typically rates to the likelihood of non-payment or default in accordance with the terms of that instruments
documentation. In limited cases, Fitch may include additional considerations (i.e. rate to a higher or lower standard than that implied in the obligations documentation).
The primary credit rating scales can be used to provide a rating of privately issued obligations or certain note issuance programs or for private ratings. In
this case the rating is not published, but only provided to the issuer or its agents in the form of a rating letter.
The primary credit rating scales may
also be used to provide ratings for a more narrow scope, including interest strips and return of principal or in other forms of opinions such as credit opinions or rating assessment services. Credit opinions are either a notch- or category-specific
view using the primary rating scale and omit one or more characteristics of a full rating or meet them to a different standard. Credit opinions will be indicated using a lower case letter symbol combined with either an * (e.g.
bbb+*) or (cat) suffix to denote the opinion status. Credit opinions will be point-in-time typically but may be monitored if the analytical group believes
information will be sufficiently available. Rating assessment services are a notch-specific view using the primary rating scale of how an existing or potential rating may be changed by a given set of hypothetical circumstances. While credit opinions
and rating assessment services are point-in-time and are not monitored, they may have a directional watch or outlook assigned, which can signify the trajectory of the
credit profile.
Description of Fitchs Long-Term Corporate Finance Obligations Rating Scales
Ratings of individual securities or financial obligations of a corporate issuer address relative vulnerability to default on an ordinal scale. In addition,
for financial obligations in corporate finance, a measure of recovery given default on that liability is also included in the rating assessment. This notably applies to covered bonds ratings, which incorporate both an indication of the probability
of default and of the recovery given a default of this debt instrument. On the contrary, Ratings of debtor-in-possession (DIP) obligations incorporate the
expectation of full repayment.
The relationship between the issuer scale and obligation scale assumes a generic historical average recovery. Individual
obligations can be assigned ratings higher, lower, or the same as that entitys issuer rating or issuer default rating (IDR), based on their relative ranking, relative vulnerability to default or based on explicit Recovery Ratings.
As a result, individual obligations of entities, such as corporations, are assigned ratings higher, lower, or the same as that entitys issuer
rating or IDR, except DIP obligation ratings that are not based off an IDR. At the lower end of the ratings scale, Fitch publishes explicit Recovery Ratings in many cases to complement issuer and obligation ratings.
Fitch long-term obligations rating scales are as follows:
A-8
|
|
|
AAA |
|
Highest Credit Quality. AAA ratings denote the lowest expectation of credit risk. They are assigned only in cases of exceptionally strong capacity for payment of financial commitments. This capacity is highly unlikely
to be adversely affected by foreseeable events. |
|
|
AA |
|
Very High Credit Quality. AA ratings denote expectations of very low credit risk. They indicate very strong capacity for payment of financial commitments. This capacity is not significantly vulnerable to foreseeable
events. |
|
|
A |
|
High Credit Quality. A ratings denote expectations of low credit risk. The capacity for payment of financial commitments is considered strong. This capacity may, nevertheless, be more vulnerable to adverse business or
economic conditions than is the case for higher ratings. |
|
|
BBB |
|
Good Credit Quality. BBB ratings indicate that expectations of credit risk are currently low. The capacity for payment of financial commitments is considered adequate, but adverse business or economic conditions are
more likely to impair this capacity. |
|
|
BB |
|
Speculative. BB ratings indicate an elevated vulnerability to credit risk, particularly in the event of adverse changes in business or economic conditions over time; however, business or financial alternatives may be
available to allow financial commitments to be met. |
|
|
B |
|
Highly Speculative. B ratings indicate that material credit risk is present. |
|
|
CCC |
|
Substantial Credit Risk. CCC ratings indicate that substantial credit risk is present. |
|
|
CC |
|
Very High Levels of Credit Risk. CC ratings indicate very high levels of credit risk. |
|
|
C |
|
Exceptionally High Levels of Credit Risk. C indicates exceptionally high levels of credit risk. |
Within rating categories, Fitch may use modifiers. The modifiers + or - may be appended to a rating to
denote relative status within major rating categories.
For example, the rating category AA has three notch-specific rating levels
(AA+; AA; AA; each a rating level). Such suffixes are not added to AAA ratings and ratings below the CCC category. For the short-term rating category of F1, a
+ may be appended.
Description of Fitchs Short-Term Ratings Assigned to Issuers and Obligations
A short-term issuer or obligation rating is based in all cases on the short-term vulnerability to default of the rated entity and relates to the capacity to
meet financial obligations in accordance with the documentation governing the relevant obligation. Short-term deposit ratings may be adjusted for loss severity. Short-term ratings are assigned to obligations whose initial maturity is viewed as
short term based on market convention. Typically, this means up to 13 months for corporate, sovereign, and structured obligations and up to 36 months for obligations in U.S. public finance markets.
Fitch short-term ratings are as follows:
|
|
|
F1 |
|
Highest Short-Term Credit Quality. Indicates the strongest intrinsic capacity for timely payment of financial commitments; may have an added + to denote any exceptionally strong credit feature. |
|
|
F2 |
|
Good Short-Term Credit Quality. Good intrinsic capacity for timely payment of financial commitments. |
|
|
F3 |
|
Fair Short-Term Credit Quality. The intrinsic capacity for timely payment of financial commitments is adequate. |
A-9
|
|
|
B |
|
Speculative Short-Term Credit Quality. Minimal capacity for timely payment of financial commitments, plus heightened vulnerability to near term adverse changes in financial and economic conditions. |
|
|
C |
|
High Short-Term Default Risk. Default is a real possibility. |
|
|
RD |
|
Restricted Default. Indicates an entity that has defaulted on one or more of its financial commitments, although it continues to meet other financial obligations. Typically applicable to entity ratings only. |
|
|
D |
|
Default. Indicates a broad-based default event for an entity, or the default of a short-term obligation. |
A-10
APPENDIX B
Effective Date: January 1, 2025
Applies to the following types of Funds registered under the 1940 Act:
☐ |
Index Equity Mutual Funds and Exchange-Traded Funds |
☐ |
Open-End Active and Fixed Income Index Mutual Funds and Exchange-Traded
Funds |
Objective and Scope
Set forth below is the Closed-End Fund Proxy Voting Policy.
Policy / Document Requirements and Statements
The
Boards of Trustees/Directors (the Directors) of the closed-end funds advised by BlackRock Advisors, LLC (BlackRock), (the Funds) have the responsibility for the oversight of
voting proxies relating to portfolio securities of the Funds, and have determined that it is in the best interests of the Funds and their shareholders to delegate the responsibility to vote proxies to BlackRock as part of BlackRocks authority
to manage, acquire and dispose of account assets, all as contemplated by the Funds respective investment management agreements.
BlackRock has
adopted the BlackRock Active Investment Stewardship Global Engagement and Voting Guidelines (as from time to time amended, the Guidelines) governing proxy voting by accounts managed by BlackRock.
BlackRock will cast votes on behalf of each of the Funds covered by this policy on specific proxy issues in respect of securities held by each such Fund (or
may refrain from voting) in accordance with the Guidelines; provided, however, that in the case of underlying closed-end funds (including business development companies and other similarly-situated asset
pools) held by the Funds that have, or are proposing to adopt, a classified board structure, BlackRock will typically (a) vote in favor of proposals to adopt classification and against proposals to eliminate classification, and (b) not
vote against directors as a result of their adoption of a classified board structure.
B-1
Conflicts Management
BlackRock Active Investment Stewardship (BAIS) maintains policies and procedures that seek to prevent undue influence on BlackRocks proxy
voting activity and to mitigate material conflicts of interest in the exercise of proxy voting responsibilities. Potential material conflicts, and the resultant potential for undue influence, might be due to a relationship between the investee
company (or any shareholder proponent or dissident shareholder) and BlackRock, BlackRocks affiliates or employees, or a Fund or a Funds affiliates. BlackRock has taken certain steps to mitigate potential conflicts, which are outlined in
detail in the Guidelines. In mitigating conflicts, BAIS will adhere to the Guidelines.
In certain instances, BAIS will engage an independent
third-party voting service provider to make proxy voting recommendations as a further safeguard to avoid potential conflicts of interest, to satisfy regulatory compliance requirements, or as may be otherwise required by applicable law.
With respect to the relationship between securities lending and proxy voting, shares on loan cannot be voted and BlackRock may determine to recall them for
voting, as guided by BlackRocks fiduciary responsibility to act in clients financial interests. The Guidelines set forth BlackRocks approach to recalling securities on loan in connection with proxy voting.
Reports to the Board
BlackRock will report on an
annual basis to the Directors on (1) a summary of the proxy voting process as applicable to the Funds covered by this Policy in the preceding year together with a representation that all votes were in accordance with the Guidelines (as modified
pursuant to the immediately preceding paragraph), and (2) any material changes to the Guidelines, including material changes to conflicts management practices, that have not previously been reported.
B-2
BlackRock Active Investment Stewardship
Global Engagement and Voting Guidelines
Effective as of
January 2025
B-3
Contents
B-4
Overview
This document provides high level guidance on how BlackRock Active Investment Stewardship (BAIS) views corporate governance matters that are commonly put to
a shareholder vote, or on which investors engage with issuers. BAIS works in partnership with BlackRocks investment teams, excluding index equity, providing expertise on investment stewardship, engaging with companies on behalf of those teams
when appropriate, and assisting in recommending, operationalizing and reporting on voting decisions. The guidance informs BAIS voting recommendations to BlackRocks active portfolio managers. It applies to active equity holdings in
BlackRocks fundamental equity, systematic equity and multi-asset solutions strategies. It also may apply to holdings in BlackRocks index and active fixed income strategies, to the extent those strategies hold voting securities or conduct
issuer engagements. The guidelines are not prescriptive as active portfolio managers have discretion as to how they integrate these guidelines within their investment processes in light of their clients or funds investment objectives.
There are separate, independently developed principles and voting policies that are applied to BlackRocks index equity investments by a distinct and independent function, BlackRock Investment Stewardship.
B-5
Introduction to BlackRock
BlackRocks purpose is to help more and more people experience financial well-being. We manage assets on behalf of institutional and individual clients,
across a full spectrum of investment strategies, asset classes, and regions. Our client base includes pension plans, endowments, foundations, charities, official institutions, insurers, and other financial institutions, as well as individuals around
the world.
About BlackRock Active Investment Stewardship
BlackRock Active Investment Stewardship (BAIS) is a specialist team within the Portfolio Management Group and manages BlackRocks stewardship engagement
and voting on behalf of clients invested in active strategies globally. BAIS is also responsible for engagement with issuers in index fixed income strategies, where appropriate. Our activities are informed by these Global Engagement and Voting
Guidelines (the Guidelines) and insights from active investment analysts and portfolio managers, with whom we work closely in engaging companies and voting at shareholder meetings.
Engagement with public companies is the foundation of our approach to stewardship within fundamental active investing. Through direct dialogue with company
leadership, we seek to understand their businesses and how they manage risks and opportunities to deliver durable, risk adjusted financial returns. Generally, portfolio managers and stewardship specialists engage jointly on substantive matters. Our
discussions focus on topics relevant to a companys success over time including governance and leadership, corporate strategy, capital structure and financial performance, operations and sustainability-related risks, as well as macro-economic,
geopolitical and sector dynamics. We aim to be constructive investors and are generally supportive of management teams that have a track record of financial value creation. We aim to build and maintain strong relationships with company leadership
based on open dialogue and mutual respect.
Different active equity strategies may implement these voting guidelines differently, as a result of the
latitude the portfolio manager has to make independent voting decisions aligned with their portfolio objectives and investment strategy. For example, BAIS will generally vote the holdings in Systematic Active Equity portfolios in accordance with
these guidelines. We provide voting recommendations to fundamental equity portfolio managers, who may determine to vote differently based on their portfolio investment objectives and strategy.
These guidelines discuss corporate governance topics on which we may engage with management teams and board directors1 and matters that routinely come to a
shareholder vote. We recognize that accepted corporate governance norms can differ across markets, and believe these guidelines represent globally applicable elements of governance that support a companys ability to manage material risks and
opportunities and deliver financial returns to investors. Generally, we believe companies should observe accepted corporate governance norms within their local markets or, particularly in markets without well-established norms, aspire to widely
recognized international best practices. As one of many minority shareholders, BlackRock cannot and does not try to direct a companys strategy or its implementation. We look to companies to provide disclosures that explain how
their approach to corporate governance best aligns with the financial interests of their investors.
1 References to the board, board directors or non-executive
directors should be understood to include supervisory boards and their members, where relevant.
B-6
Our approach to stewardship within active equities
As shareholders of public companies, BlackRocks clients have certain fundamental rights, including the right to vote on proposals put forth by a
companys management or its shareholders. The voting rights attached to these clients holdings are an important mechanism for investors to express support for, or concern about, a companys performance. As a fiduciary, BlackRock is
legally required to make proxy voting determinations, on behalf of clients who have delegated voting authority to us, in a manner that is consistent with their investment objectives.
In general, we tend to support the recommendations of the board of directors and management. As indicated below, we may vote against management
recommendations when we have concerns about how companies are serving the financial interests of our clients as their shareholders. We take a globally consistent approach to voting but consider the different corporate governance regulations and
norms in various markets. Votes are determined on a case-by-case basis, in the context of a companys situation and the investment mandate we have from clients.
Please see page 16 for more information about how we fulfil and oversee BlackRocks non-index equity investment stewardship responsibilities.
Our approach to stewardship within fixed income
Although fixed income investors do not have the right to vote at shareholder meetings, issuer engagement is a component of fixed income investment strategies
at BlackRock, particularly those with sustainability objectives in addition to financial objectives. Most corporate governance-related fixed income engagements are undertaken in conjunction with the active investment stewardship team, and often
active equity investors. In addition to the topics listed below, engagement with fixed income investment teams can help inform an issuers approach to structuring specialist issuances, such as green bonds, and the standard terms and information
in bond documentation.
B-7
Boards of Directors
Roles and responsibilities
There is widespread
consensus that the foundation of good corporate governance is an effective board of directors that is able to advise and supervise management in an independent and objective manner.2
We look to the board of directors (hereafter the board) to have an oversight role in the establishment and realization of a companys
strategy, purpose and culture. These constructs are interdependent and, when aligned, can better position a company to be resilient in the face of a changing business environment, help reduce the risks of corporate or employee misconduct, and
attract and retain the caliber of workers necessary to deliver financial performance over time.
In promoting the success of the company, the board
ensures the necessary resources, policies and procedures are in place to help management meet its strategic objectives within an agreed risk tolerance.
One of the most important responsibilities of the board is to appoint, and remove as necessary, the chief executive officer (CEO). In addition, the board
plays a meaningful role in monitoring the performance of the CEO and other key executives, determining executive compensation, ensuring a rigorous audit, overseeing strategy execution and risk management and engaging with shareholders, and other
stakeholders, as necessary.
Composition and effectiveness
Appointment process
A formal and transparent
process for identifying and appointing director candidates is critical to ensuring the board is composed of directors with the appropriate mix of skills and experience. The board or a sub-committee should
determine the general criteria given the companys circumstances (e.g., sector, maturity, geographic footprint) and any additional criteria for a specific role being filled (e.g., financial expertise, industry track record). To inform the
process, we encourage companies to review the skills and experience of incumbent directors to identify any gaps and whether a director candidates characteristics would be additive. We welcome disclosures that explain how the board considered
different skills, backgrounds and experience to ensure the directors collectively can be effective in fulfilling their responsibilities. We assess a companys board composition against that of its peer group and local market requirements.
Shareholders periodically vote to elect, remove and nominate directors to serve on the board. We may vote against the election of the most senior independent
director, or the chair of the relevant committee, where a company has not demonstrated it has an appointment process that results in a high functioning board with the appropriate complement of skills, backgrounds and experience amongst the directors
to support strong financial performance over time. We may vote against newly nominated directors who do not seem to have the appropriate skills or experience to contribute to the boards effectiveness.
Independence
Director independence from
management, significant shareholders or other stakeholders (e.g., government or employees) is of paramount importance to the protection of the interests of minority shareholders such as
2 See the Corporate Governance Codes of Germany, Japan, and the UK, as well as the corporate governance
principles of the US Business Roundtable as examples.
B-8
BlackRocks clients. At least half of the directors should be independent and free from conflicts of interest or undue influence.3 This
ensures sufficient independent directors to have appropriately independent board committees. Companies domiciled in markets with a higher threshold for board independence should meet those requirements.
We may vote against the election of non-independent directors if the board does not have a sufficient balance of
independence. We may also vote against the election of the chair of the committee responsible for board composition if this is a perennial issue.
Independent board leadership
Practices across
markets differ, as do board structures, but we observe two main approaches to independent board leadership. One is a non-executive, independent chair of the board who is responsible for leading the board in
the effective exercise of its duties. The other is a lead or senior independent director, who is responsible for coordinating with the other non-executive directors and working closely with the executive chair
on the board agenda and other board procedures. In this case, the executive chair and the lead independent director work together to ensure the board is effectively fulfilling its responsibilities. In our view, the independent leader of the board,
and/or the chair of a relevant committee, should be available to investors to discuss board governance matters such as CEO succession, executive pay, and board performance. We look to boards to explain their independent board leadership model and
how it serves the interests of shareholders.
We may vote against the election of the chair of the committee responsible for board composition if there is
not an identified independent leader of the board with clear responsibilities for board performance. We may vote against the most senior independent director if the board has a policy of not engaging with shareholders.
Tenure and succession
Boards should establish
the length of time a director would normally be expected to serve, in line with market norms where those exist. In such markets, we find it helpful when companies disclose their approach to director tenure particularly around the contributions of
directors who have served for longer periods than provided for in local practices. In our experience, long-serving directors could become less independent given their relationship with management and involvement in past board decisions.
Succession planning for board roles helps achieve the appropriate cadence of turnover that balances renewal through the regular introduction of directors with
fresh perspectives and expertise with continuity through the retention of directors with long-term knowledge of the board and company.
In markets where
there is not specific director tenure guidance, we may vote against the election of the chair of the committee responsible for board composition if there is not a clearly disclosed approach to director tenure and board renewal. We may vote against
the election of directors who have served for longer duration than typical in markets with specific guidance, where the case for their continued service is not evident.
3 Common impediments to independence may include but are not limited to: current or recent employment at
the company or a subsidiary; being, or representing, a shareholder with a substantial shareholding in the company; interlocking directorships; lengthy tenure, and having any other interest, business, or other relationship which could, or could
reasonably be perceived to, materially interfere with a directors ability to act in the best interests of the company and shareholders.
B-9
Capacity
To be effective and engaged, directors must commit appropriate time and energy to the role. A board should assess the ability of its members to maintain an
appropriate focus on board matters and the company taking into consideration competing responsibilities. We recognize that board leadership roles vary across markets in responsibilities and required time commitment but note that they are generally
more intensive than a standard directorship. We will take local norms and practices into consideration when making our voting determinations across markets.
We may vote against the election of directors who do not seem to have sufficient capacity to effectively fulfil their duties to the board and company.
Director elections
In support of director
accountability to shareholders, directors should stand for election on a regular basis, ideally annually. A classified board structure may be justified by a company when it needs consistency and stability during a time of transition, or on the basis
of its business model, e.g., a non-operating company such as closed-end funds.
Shareholders should have the opportunity to evaluate nominated directors individually rather than in bundled slates. We look to companies to provide
sufficient information on each director standing for election so that shareholders can assess their capabilities and suitability. We will not support the election of directors whose names and biographical details have not been disclosed sufficiently
in advance of the shareholder meeting.
Each directors appointment should be dependent on receiving a simple majority of the votes cast at the
shareholder meeting. Where a companys practices differ, we look to the board to provide a detailed explanation as to how its approach best serves investors interests.
We may vote for shareholder or management proposals seeking to establish annual election of directors and/or a simple majority vote standard for director
elections. We may vote against all the directors standing for election as part of a single slate if we have concerns about the profile or performance of an individual director.
Committees
Many boards establish committees to
focus on specific responsibilities of the board such as audit and risk, governance and human capital, and executive compensation, amongst other matters. We do not prescribe to companies what committees they should establish but we seek to understand
the boards rationale for the committee structure it determines is appropriate. We note that, in some markets, regulation requires such committees. The responsibilities of each committee should be clear, and the board should ensure that all
critical matters are assigned either to the full board or to one of the committees. The board should disclose to shareholders the structure, membership, proportion of independent directors, and responsibilities of each committee. The
responsibilities we typically see assigned to the three most common committees include:
|
● |
|
Audit and risk oversight responsibilities for the integrity of financial reporting, risk management and
compliance with legal and regulatory requirements; may also play an oversight role in relation to the internal audit function and whistleblowing mechanisms. |
B-10
|
● |
|
Nominating, governance and human capital ensures appropriate corporate governance principles and practices
including the periodic review of board performance; responsible for succession planning for CEO and key board roles, as well as the director appointment process; may also have oversight responsibilities for human capital management strategies
including corporate culture and purpose. |
|
● |
|
Executive compensation determines the compensation policies and programs for the CEO and other executive
officers, approves annual awards and payments under the policies; may also have oversight responsibilities for firm-wide compensation policies. |
We may vote against the election of the chair of the committee or other directors serving as committee members to convey our concerns and provide feedback on
how a committee has undertaken its responsibilities. We may vote against the election of the most senior non-executive director if there is not a clearly disclosed approach to board committees.
Board and director evaluation
We consider it
best practice for companies to conduct an annual review of the performance of the board, the committees, the chair and individual directors. Periodically, this review could be undertaken by an independent third party able to bring objective
perspectives to the board on governance and performance. We encourage companies to disclose their approach to and objectives of evaluations, including any changes made to the boards approach as a result.
Access to independent advice
To support the
directors in effectively fulfilling their duties to the company and shareholders, they should have access to independent advice. When circumstances warrant, boards should be able to retain independent third parties to advise on critical matters.
These might include new industry developments such as emergent and disruptive technology, operating events with material consequences for the companys reputation and/or performance, or significant transactions. Board committees may similarly
retain third parties to advise them on specialist matters such as audit, compensation and succession planning.
Executive
compensation
Boards should establish compensation arrangements that enable the company to recruit, retain and reward the caliber of executive
management necessary to lead and operate the company to deliver superior financial returns over time. We focus on alignment between variable pay and a companys financial performance.
Generally, executive compensation arrangements have four components: base salary, annual bonus that rewards performance against short-term metrics,
share-based incentives that reward performance against long-term metrics, and pensions and benefits. In our observation, base salary, pensions and benefits are largely set relative to market norms and benchmarks. The annual bonus and share-based
incentive, or variable pay plans, tend to be tailored to the company, its sector and long-term strategy, as well as the individuals the board is seeking to recruit and motivate.
B-11
Recognizing the unique circumstances of each company, we determine whether to support a companys approach
to executive compensation on a case-by-case basis. We rely on companies providing sufficient quantitative and qualitative information in their disclosures to enable
shareholders to understand the compensation arrangements and assess the alignment with investors interests. Features we look for in compensation arrangements include:
|
● |
|
Fixed pay components, including base salary, benefits and prerequisites that are appropriate in the context of
the companys size, sector and market. |
|
● |
|
Variable pay subject to performance metrics that are closely linked to the companys short- and long-term
strategic objectives. |
|
● |
|
Long-term incentives that motivate sustained performance across a multi-year period. |
|
● |
|
A balance between fixed and variable pay, short- and long-term incentives, and specific instruments (cash and
equity awards) that promotes pay program durability and seldom necessitates one-off, discretionary payments. |
|
● |
|
Outcomes that are consistent with the returns to investors over the relevant time period. |
|
● |
|
Board discretion, if allowed within the variable pay arrangements, to be used sparingly, responsibly and
transparently. |
|
● |
|
A requirement, that participants in long-term share-based incentive plans build a meaningful shareholding in the
company within a defined time period, as determined by the board. |
|
● |
|
Change of control provisions that appropriately balance the interests of executives and shareholders.
|
|
● |
|
Clawback or malus provisions that allow the company to recoup or hold back variable compensation from individuals
whose awards were based on fraudulent activities, misstated financial reports, or executive misconduct. |
|
● |
|
Severance arrangements that protect the companys interests but do not cost more than is contractual.
|
We may vote against proposals to introduce new share-based incentives, approve existing policies or plans, or approve the compensation
report where we do not see alignment between executive compensation arrangements and our clients financial interests. When there is not an alternative, or where there have been multi-year issues with compensation misaligned with performance,
we may vote against the election of the chair of the responsible committee, or the most senior independent director.
Non-executive director compensation
Companies generally pay non-executive
directors an annual retainer or fee in cash, shares or a combination of the two. Some companies also pay additional fees for service on board committees or in board leadership roles. We do not support
non-executive directors participating in performance-based incentive plans as doing so may create a conflict of interest and undermine their independence from management, whom they oversee.
B-12
Capital structure
Boards are responsible for ensuring senior executive leadership has established a capital strategy that achieves appropriate capital allocation and management
in support of long-term financial resilience.
Where company practices diverge from those set out below, we look for companies to disclose why they view
these practices to be aligned with shareholders interests. We may vote against management proposals seeking capital-related authorities or the election of the most senior independent director if we have concerns about a companys
approach. We may also support a shareholder proposal seeking conversion of shares with differentiated voting rights to a one-share, one-vote standard.
Share issuance
We assess requests for
share issuance for particular transactions on a case-by-case basis. We will generally support authorities to issue shares when subject to
pre-emptive rights, and up to 20% absent pre-emptive rights. Companies should seek regular approval of these authorities to allow shareholders to take into consideration
how prior authorities were used, as well as the current circumstances of the company and the market environment.
Share buybacks
We assess share buyback proposals in the context of the companys disclosed capital management strategy and managements determination of the
appropriate balance between investment that supports the long-term growth of the company and returning cash to investors. We also take into consideration the effect of a buyback program on the companys balance sheet and executive compensation
arrangements and the price at which shares are repurchased relative to market price. Companies should seek regular approval of these authorities to allow shareholders to take into consideration how prior authorities were used, as well as the current
circumstances of the company and the market environment.
We would normally expect companies to cancel repurchased shares. If a company plans to retain
them as treasury shares, management should provide a detailed rationale in the context of the disclosed capital management strategy.
Dividends
We generally defer to management and the board on dividend policy but may engage to seek further clarification where a proposed dividend appears out
of line with the companys financial position.
Differentiated voting rights
We prefer companies to adopt a one-share, one-vote structure for share classes
with the same economic exposure. Certain companies, particularly those new to public markets, could make the case to adopt a differentiated voting rights structure, or dual class stock. In those situations, we encourage companies to evaluate and
seek approval for their capital structure on a periodic basis.
B-13
Transactions and special situations
We monitor developments in transactions and special situations closely and undertake our own detailed analyses of proposals.
Mergers and acquisitions
We evaluate proposed mergers
or acquisitions by assessing the financial outcome for our clients as minority shareholders. Management should provide an assessment of the proposed transactions strategic and financial rationale, along with its execution and operational
risks. We review each transaction independently based on these factors and the degree to which the transaction enhances shareholder value. The board should consider establishing an ad hoc transaction committee to undertake an independent assessment
of a significant merger or acquisition, in advance of making its recommendation to shareholders.
We will vote against transactions that, in our
assessment, do not advance our clients financial interests.
Anti-takeover defenses
In principle, we do not support companies using anti-takeover defenses, also known as poison pills or shareholder rights plans, as they can entrench
management and boards which have not delivered long-term shareholder value. By exception, a poison pill may be supported if its purpose is to delay a takeover that is considered sub-optimal and enable
management to seek an improved offer. Similarly, management could make the case to use a poison pill to block a shareholder activism campaign that may be counter to the interests of other investors. Defense mechanisms introduced in these
circumstances should be limited in term and threshold, and also be closely monitored by the independent members of the board. We look for a shareholder vote for any mechanisms expected to be in place for more than 12 months.
Shareholder activism
When companies are the focus of an
activism campaign, we may engage with the activist to understand their analysis and objectives, once they have gone public. We will also engage with company management and possibly board members, especially those the activist may be seeking to
replace. In our assessment, we evaluate various factors, including the concerns raised by the activist and the case for change; the quality of both the activists and managements plans; and the qualifications of each partys
candidates. We evaluate each contested situation by assessing the potential financial outcome for our clients as minority shareholders.
We may support
board candidates nominated by a shareholder activist if the activist has demonstrated that their case for change enhances shareholder value, or if the incumbent board members do not demonstrate the relevant skills and expertise or have a poor track
record of protecting shareholders interests.
Significant shareholders and related party transactions
Boards of companies with affiliated shareholders or directors should be able to demonstrate that the interests of all shareholders are given equitable
consideration.
Transactions with related parties, such as significant shareholders or companies connected with the public company, should be disclosed in
detail and conducted on terms similar to what would objectively have been agreed with a non-related party. Such transactions should be reviewed and approved by the independent members of the board, and if
voted on, only disinterested shareholders should vote.
B-14
Corporate reporting, risk management and audit
Investors depend on corporate reporting, both regulatory and voluntary, to understand a companys strategy, its implementation and financial performance,
as well as to assess the quality of management and operations and potential for the company to create shareholder value over time. The board should oversee corporate reporting and the policies and procedures underpinning the internal audit function
and external audit.
A companys financial reporting should provide decision-useful information for investors and other stakeholders on its financial
performance and position. It should provide an accurate and balanced assessment of the risks and opportunities the company faces in realizing its long-term strategy. Accordingly, the assumptions made by management and reviewed by the auditor in
preparing the financial statements should be reasonable and justified. Financial statements should be prepared in accordance with globally developed reporting standards and any divergence from generally accepted accounting principles should be
explained in detail and justified. Accounting restatements should be explained in detail and any remedial actions, and the implications of these, disclosed.
In this context, audit committees play a vital role in a companys financial reporting system by providing independent oversight of the accounts,
material financial and, where appropriate to the jurisdiction, nonfinancial information, internal control frameworks and Enterprise Risk Management systems. In our view, effective audit committee oversight strengthens the quality and reliability of
a companys financial statements and provides an important level of reassurance to shareholders. Audit committees should have a procedure in place for assessing the independence of the auditor and the quality of the external audit process
annually.
Similarly, material sustainability-related factors that are integral to how a company manages risks or generates revenue should be disclosed.
In our view, the standards developed by the International Sustainability Standards Board, can be helpful to companies in preparing such reports.
4
Companies should establish robust risk management and internal control processes appropriate
to the companys business, risk tolerance, and regulatory environment. A credible whistleblowing system for employees, and potentially other stakeholders, can be a useful mechanism for ensuring that senior management and the board are aware of
potential misconduct or breaches in risk management and internal control processes.
A comprehensive audit conducted by an independent audit firm
contributes to investor confidence in the quality of corporate reporting. It is helpful when the audit report gives some insight into the scope and focus of the audit, as well as any critical audit matters identified and how these were resolved. A
comprehensive and effective audit is time and resource intensive, and the audit fee should be commensurate. Fees paid to the audit firm for non-audit consulting should not exceed the audit fee to a degree that
may prompt concerns about the independence of the audit. The audit committee should explain its position on auditor tenure and how it confirmed that the auditor remained independent.
We may vote against the election of the responsible directors if corporate reporting is insufficient or there are material misstatements in financial reports.
In markets where relevant, we may vote against a proposal to
4 The objective of IFRS S1 General Requirements for Disclosure of Sustainability-related Financial
Information is to require an entity to disclose information about its sustainability-related risks and opportunities that is useful to primary users of general-purpose financial reports in making decisions relating to providing resources to the
entity. The objective of IFRS S2 Climate-related Disclosures is to require an entity to disclose information about its climate-related risks and opportunities that is useful to primary users of general-purpose financial reports in making decisions
relating to providing resources to the entity.
B-15
approve the financial statements or the discharge of the board when we are concerned about the quality of the reporting or the audit. We may vote against proposals to appoint the auditor, ratify
the audit report, or approve the audit fee if we are concerned about the auditors independence, the quality of the audit, or there are material misstatements in financial reports and the board has not established reasonable remediation plans.
Shareholder rights and protections
General shareholder meetings
Companies normally have an
annual general meeting of shareholders at which routine and non-routine items of business are discussed and voted on by shareholders in attendance or submitting proxy votes. Companies should disclose materials
relevant to the shareholder meeting sufficiently in advance so that shareholders can take them into consideration in their voting decisions. Many companies offer shareholders the option of participating in the meeting virtually which, whilst
welcome, should not limit the rights of shareholders to participate as they would during an in-person meeting.
We
may vote against directors when materials related to the business of the shareholder meeting are not provided in a timely manner or do not provide sufficient information for us to take an informed voting decision. We may vote against directors if
the format of the shareholder meeting does not accommodate reasonable shareholder participation.
Bylaw amendments
We review bylaw amendments proposed by management on a case-by-case basis and
will generally support those that are aligned with the interests of minority shareholders. Any material changes to the bylaws should be explained in detail and put to a shareholder vote.
We may vote against bylaw amendments that reduce shareholder rights and protections. We may vote against directors if material changes are made to the bylaws
without shareholder approval.
If not provided for in the relevant corporate law, company bylaws should allow shareholders, individually or as a group,
with a meaningful shareholding the right to call a special meeting of shareholders. The shareholding required to exercise this right should balance its utility with the cost to the company of holding special meetings.
If not provided for in the relevant corporate law, company bylaws should allow shareholders, individually or as a group, with a meaningful shareholding the
right to nominate directors to the companys board. The threshold for this right should be set so that shareholders can exercise it without being unduly disruptive to the boards own nomination process.
Whilst we would not use either of these rights ourselves, we see them as important accountability mechanisms. We may vote for a shareholder proposal seeking
the addition of either of these provisions to a companys bylaws.
B-16
Change of domicile
We generally defer to management on proposals to change a companys domicile as long as the rationale for doing so is consistent with the companys
long-term strategy and business model and the related costs are immaterial.
We may vote against directors or a proposal to change a companys
domicile where it does not seem aligned with our clients financial interests.
Changes to a companys purpose or the nature of its business
Plans to materially change the nature of a companys business or its purpose should be disclosed and explained in the context of long-term
strategy and business dynamics. Such changes may significantly alter an investors views on the suitability of a company for their investment strategy or portfolio.
Where relevant, we may vote against proposals to change a companys purpose or the nature of its business if the board has not provided a credible
argument for change.
Shareholder proposals
Shareholders in many markets, who meet certain eligibility criteria, have the right to submit proposals to the general shareholder meeting asking a company to
take a particular course of action subject to the proposal being supported by a majority of votes cast at the meeting. The topics raised address a range of governance, social and environmental matters that may be relevant to a companys
business. Shareholder proposals are considered by many investors to be an escalation tool when a company is unresponsive to their engagement.
We vote on
these proposals on a case-by-case basis. We assess the relevance of the topic raised to a companys business and its current approach, whether the actions sought
are consistent with shareholders interests, and what impact the proposal being acted upon might have on financial performance.
Our general approach
where we have concerns about a companys governance, disclosures or performance is to engage to understand the apparent difference in perspective. If we continue to believe the company is not acting in shareholders financial interests, we
may vote against the election of directors. We may support a relevant shareholder proposal if doing so reinforces the points made in our engagement or is aligned with our clients financial interests. We generally do not support shareholder
proposals that are legally binding on the company, seek to alter a companys strategy or direct its operations, or are unrelated to how a company manages risk or generates financial returns.
BlackRock is subject to legal and regulatory requirements in the U.S. that place restrictions and limitations on how we can interact with the companies in
which we invest on behalf of our clients, including our ability to submit shareholder proposals. We can vote on behalf of clients who authorize us to do so, on proposals put forth by others.
Corporate political activities
We seek to understand how companies ensure that their direct and indirect engagement in the policy making process is consistent with their public statements on
policy matters important to the companys long-term strategy. The board should be aware of the approach taken to corporate political activities as there can be
B-17
reputational risks arising from inconsistencies. Companies should, as a minimum, meet all regulatory disclosure requirements on political activities, and ideally, provide accessible and clear
disclosures to shareholders on policy positions, public policy engagement activities and political donations. To mitigate the risk of inconsistencies, companies can usefully assess the alignment between their policy priorities and the policy
positions of the trade associations of which they are active members and any engagements undertaken by trade associations on behalf of members.
Generally, this is an engagement matter, although we may support a relevant shareholder proposal, or vote against directors, where a companys
disclosures are insufficient, or it becomes public that there is a material contradiction in a companys public policy positions and its policy engagement.
Sustainability, or environmental and social, considerations
We seek to understand how companies manage the risks and opportunities inherent in their business operations. In our experience, sustainability-related factors5 that are relevant to a companys business or material to its financial performance, are generally operational considerations embedded into day-to-day management systems. Certain sustainability issues may also inform long-term strategic planning, for example, investing in product innovation in anticipation of changing consumer demand or adapting
supply chains in response to changing regulatory requirements.
We recognize that the specific sustainability-related factors that may be financially
material or business relevant will vary by company business model, sector, key markets, and time horizon, amongst other considerations. From company disclosures and our engagement, we aim to understand how management is identifying, assessing and
integrating material sustainability-related risks and opportunities into their business decision-making and practices. Doing so helps us undertake a more holistic assessment of a companys potential financial performance and the likely
risk-adjusted returns of an investment.
We may vote against directors or support a relevant shareholder proposal if we have concerns about how a company
is managing or disclosing its approach to material sustainability-related risks that may impact financial returns.
Key
stakeholders
In our view, companies should understand and take into consideration the interests of the various parties on whom they depend for their
success over time. It is for each company to determine their key stakeholders based on what is material to their business and long-term financial performance. For many companies, key stakeholders include employees, business partners (such as
suppliers and distributors), clients and consumers, regulators, and the communities in which they operate. Companies that appropriately balance the
5 By material sustainability-related risks and opportunities, we mean the drivers of risk and financial
value creation in a companys business model that have an environmental or social dependency or impact. Examples of environmental issues include, but are not limited to, water use, land use, waste management, and climate risk. Examples of
social issues include, but are not limited to, human capital management, impacts on the communities in which a company operates, customer loyalty, and relationships with regulators. It is our view that well-managed companies will effectively
evaluate and manage material sustainability-related risks and opportunities relevant to their businesses. Governance is the core means by which boards can oversee the creation of durable financial value over time. Appropriate risk oversight of
business-relevant and material sustainability-related considerations is a component of a sound governance framework.
B-18
interests of investors and other stakeholders are, in our experience, more likely to be financially resilient over time.
B-19
|
Climate and decarbonization investment objectives
Certain active BlackRock funds have climate and decarbonization objectives in addition
to financial objectives. Consistent with the objectives of those investment strategies, our stewardship activity in relation to the holdings in those funds differs in some respects from BAIS benchmark guidelines, which are described above.
Specifically, for those funds holdings, we look to investee companies to demonstrate that they are aligned with a decarbonization pathway that means their business model would be viable in a low-carbon
economy, i.e., one in which global temperature rise is limited to 1.5°C above pre-industrial levels. This approach is only taken following BlackRock receiving the explicit approval from the applicable fund
board. The decarbonization stewardship guidelines focus on companies which produce
goods and services that contribute to real world decarbonization or have a carbon intensive business model and face outsized impacts from the low carbon transition, based on reported and estimated scopes 1, 2, and 3 greenhouse gas emissions. These
companies should provide disclosures that set out their governance, strategy, risk management processes and metrics and targets relevant to decarbonization. These disclosures should include an explanation of the decarbonization scenarios a company
is using in its near- and long-term planning, as well as its scope 1, scope 2 and material scope 3 greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions and reduction targets for scope 1 and 2 emissions. As with the BAIS benchmark policies, we consider the climate-risk
reporting standard issued by the International Sustainability Standards Board, IFRS S2, a useful reference for such reporting.
Under these climate- and decarbonization-specific guidelines, BAIS may recommend a vote against directors or support for a relevant shareholder proposal if a
company does not appear to be adequately addressing or disclosing material climate-related risks. We may recommend supporting shareholder proposals seeking information relevant to a companys stated
low-carbon transition strategy and targets that the company does not currently provide and that would be helpful to investment decision-making. As under the BAIS benchmark approach, the active portfolio
managers are ultimately responsible for voting consistent with their investment mandate and fund objectives. |
B-20
Appendix 1: How we fulfil and oversee our active investment stewardship
responsibilities
Oversight
The Global Head of
BAIS has primary oversight of and responsibility for the teams activities, including voting in accordance with the BlackRock Active Investment Stewardship Global Engagement and Voting Guidelines (the Guidelines), which require the
application of professional judgment and consideration of each companys unique circumstances, as well as input from active investors. BAIS is independent from BlackRock Investment Stewardship in our engagement and voting activities, reporting
lines, and oversight.
The Active Investment Stewardship Oversight Committee, comprised of senior representatives of the active investment, legal and risk
teams, reviews and advises on amendments to BAIS Global Engagement and Voting Guidelines. The Committee also considers developments in corporate governance, related public policy, and market norms and how these might influence BAIS
policies and practices. The Committee does not determine voting decisions, which are the responsibility of BAIS and the relevant active equity investors.
In addition, there is a standing advisory group of senior active investors who counsel BAIS on complex or high-profile votes before a recommendation is
finalized and escalated to the portfolio managers with holdings in the company under consideration. This group also formally reviews any revisions to the Engagement and Voting Guidelines proposed by BAIS as part of its annual review.
BAIS carries out engagement with companies in collaboration with active investment colleagues, executes proxy votes, and conducts vote operations (including
maintaining records of votes cast) in a manner consistent with the Guidelines. BAIS also conducts research on corporate governance issues and participates in industry discussions to contribute to and keep abreast of important developments in the
corporate governance field. BAIS may use third parties for certain of the foregoing activities and performs oversight of those third parties (see Use and oversight of third-party vote services providers below).
Voting guidelines and vote execution
BlackRock votes on
proxy issues when our clients authorize us to do so. We carefully consider the voting items submitted to funds and other fiduciary account(s) (Fund or Funds) for which we have voting authority. BlackRock votes (or refrains from voting) for each Fund
for which we have voting authority based on our evaluation of the alignment of the voting items with the long-term economic interests of our clients, in the exercise of our independent business judgment, and without regard to the relationship of the
issuer (or any shareholder proponent or dissident shareholder) to the Fund, the Funds affiliates (if any), BlackRock or BlackRocks affiliates, or BlackRock employees (see Conflicts management policies and procedures, below).
When exercising voting rights, BAIS will normally vote on specific proxy issues in accordance with the Guidelines, although portfolio managers have the
right to vote differently on their holdings if they determine doing so is more aligned with the investment objective and financial interests of clients invested in the funds they manage.
The Guidelines are not intended to be exhaustive. BAIS applies the Guidelines on a
case-by-case basis, in the context of the individual circumstances of each company and the specific issue under review. As such, the Guidelines do not indicate how BAIS
will vote in every instance. Rather, they reflect our view about corporate governance issues generally, and provide insight into how we typically approach issues that commonly arise
B-21
on corporate ballots. The Guidelines are reviewed annually and updated as necessary to reflect changes in market practices, developments in corporate governance and feedback from companies and
clients. In this way, BAIS aims to maintain policies that explain our approach to governance practices most aligned with clients long-term financial interests.
In certain markets, proxy voting involves logistical issues which can affect BAIS ability to vote such proxies, as well as the desirability of voting
such proxies. These issues include, but are not limited to: i) untimely notice of shareholder meetings; ii) restrictions on a foreigners ability to exercise votes; iii) requirements to vote proxies in person; iv) share-blocking
(requirements that investors who exercise their voting rights surrender the right to dispose of their holdings for some specified period in proximity to the shareholder meeting); v) potential difficulties in translating the proxy; vi) regulatory
constraints; and vii) requirements to provide local agents with unrestricted powers of attorney to facilitate voting instructions. We are not supportive of impediments to the exercise of voting rights such as share-blocking or overly burdensome
administrative requirements.
BlackRock votes proxies in these situations on a best-efforts basis. In addition, BAIS may determine that it is
generally in the interests of BlackRocks clients not to vote proxies (or not to vote our full allocation) if the costs (including but not limited to opportunity costs associated with share-blocking constraints) associated with exercising a
vote are expected to outweigh the benefit the client would derive by voting on the proposal.
Voting Choice
BlackRock offers Voting Choice, a program that provides eligible clients with more opportunities to participate in the proxy voting process where
legally and operationally viable.
Voting Choice is currently available for eligible clients invested in certain institutional pooled funds in the U.S.,
UK, and Canada that use systematic active equity (SAE) and multi-asset strategies. In addition, institutional clients in separately managed accounts (SMAs) are eligible for BlackRock Voting Choice regardless of their investment strategies.6
As a result, the shares attributed to BlackRock in company share registers may be voted differently
depending on whether our clients have authorized BAIS to vote on their behalf, have authorized BlackRock to vote in accordance with a third-party policy, or have elected to vote shares in accordance with their own policy. Our clients have
greater control over proxy voting because of Voting Choice. BlackRock does not disclose client information, including a clients selection of proxy policy, without client consent.
Use and oversight of third-party vote services providers
Third-party vote services providers or proxy research firms - provide research and recommendations on proxy votes, as well as voting infrastructure. As
mentioned previously, BlackRock contracts primarily with the vote services provider ISS and leverages its online platform to supply research and support voting, record keeping, and reporting processes. We also use Glass Lewis research and
analysis as an input into our voting process. It is important to note that, although proxy research firms provide important data and analysis, BAIS does not rely solely on their information or follow their voting recommendations. A companys
disclosures,
6 With Voting Choice, SMAs have the ability to select from a set of voting policies from third-party proxy advisers the policy that best aligns with their views and preferences. BlackRock can then use
its proxy voting infrastructure to cast votes based on the clients selected voting policy.
B-22
our past engagements and voting, investment colleagues insights and our voting guidelines are important inputs into our voting decisions on behalf of clients.
Given the large universe of actively held companies, BAIS employs the proxy services provider to streamline the voting process by making voting
recommendations based on BAIS voting guidelines when the items on a shareholder meeting agenda are routine. Agenda items that are not routine are referred back to BAIS to assess, escalate as necessary to the relevant portfolio managers and
vote. BAIS reviews and can override the recommendations of the vote services provider at any time prior to the vote deadline. Both BAIS and the vote services provider actively monitor securities filings, research reports, company announcements, and
direct communications from companies to ensure awareness of supplemental disclosures and proxy materials that may require a modification of votes.
BAIS
closely monitors the third-party vote services providers we contract with to ensure that they are meeting our service level expectations and have effective policies and procedures in place to manage potential conflicts of interest. Our oversight of
service providers includes regular meetings with client service teams, systematic monitoring of vendor operations, as well as annual due diligence meetings in accordance with BlackRocks firmwide policies.
Conflicts management policies and procedures
BAIS
maintains policies and procedures that seek to prevent undue influence on BlackRocks proxy voting activity. Such influence might stem from any relationship between the investee company (or any shareholder proponent or dissident shareholder)
and BlackRock, BlackRocks affiliates, a Fund or a Funds affiliates, or BlackRock employees. The following are examples of sources of perceived or potential conflicts of interest:
|
● |
|
BlackRock clients who may be issuers of securities or proponents of shareholder resolutions
|
|
● |
|
BlackRock business partners or third parties who may be issuers of securities or proponents of shareholder
resolutions |
|
● |
|
BlackRock employees who may sit on the boards of public companies held in Funds managed by BlackRock
|
|
● |
|
Significant BlackRock, Inc. investors who may be issuers of securities held in Funds managed by BlackRock
|
|
● |
|
Securities of BlackRock, Inc. or BlackRock investment funds held in Funds managed by BlackRock
|
|
● |
|
BlackRock, Inc. board members who serve as senior executives or directors of public companies held in Funds
managed by BlackRock |
BlackRock has taken certain steps to mitigate perceived or potential conflicts including, but not limited to, the
following:
|
● |
|
Adopted the Guidelines which are designed to advance our clients long-term economic interests in the
companies in which BlackRock invests on their behalf |
|
● |
|
Established a reporting structure that separates BAIS from employees with sales, vendor management, or business
partnership roles. In addition, BlackRock seeks to ensure that all engagements with corporate issuers, dissident shareholders or shareholder proponents are managed |
B-23
|
consistently and without regard to BlackRocks relationship with such parties. Clients or business partners are not given special treatment or differentiated access. BAIS prioritizes
engagements based on factors including, but not limited to, our need for additional information to make a voting decision or our view on the likelihood that an engagement could lead to positive outcome(s) over time for the economic value of the
company. Within the normal course of business, BAIS may engage directly with BlackRock clients, business partners and/or third parties, and/or with employees with sales, vendor management, or business partnership roles, in discussions regarding our
approach to stewardship, general corporate governance matters, client reporting needs, and/or to otherwise ensure that proxy-related client service levels are met |
|
● |
|
Determined to engage, in certain instances, an independent third-party voting service provider to make proxy
voting recommendations as a further safeguard to avoid potential conflicts of interest, to satisfy regulatory compliance requirements, or as may be otherwise required by applicable law. In such circumstances, the independent third-party voting
service provider provides BlackRock with recommendations, in accordance with the Guidelines, as to how to vote such proxies. BlackRock uses an independent third-party voting service provider to make proxy voting recommendations for shares of
BlackRock, Inc. and companies affiliated with BlackRock, Inc. BlackRock may also use an independent third-party voting service provider to make proxy voting recommendations for: |
|
○ |
|
public companies that include BlackRock employees on their boards of directors |
|
○ |
|
public companies of which a BlackRock, Inc. board member serves as a senior executive or a member of the board of
directors |
|
○ |
|
public companies that are the subject of certain transactions involving BlackRock Funds |
|
○ |
|
public companies that are joint venture partners with BlackRock, and |
|
○ |
|
public companies when legal or regulatory requirements compel BlackRock to use an independent third-party voting
service provider |
In selecting an independent third-party voting service provider, we assess several characteristics, including but not
limited to: independence, an ability to analyze proxy issues and make recommendations in the economic interest of our clients in accordance with the Guidelines, reputation for reliability and integrity, and operational capacity to accurately deliver
the assigned recommendations in a timely manner. We may engage more than one independent third-party voting service provider, in part to mitigate potential or perceived conflicts of interest at a single voting service provider. The Active Investment
Stewardship Oversight Committee appoints and reviews the performance of the independent third-party voting service providers, generally on an annual basis.
Securities lending
When so authorized, BlackRock acts as
a securities lending agent on behalf of Funds. Securities lending is a well-regulated practice that contributes to capital market efficiency. It also enables funds to generate additional returns while allowing fund providers to keep fund expenses
lower.
With regard to the relationship between securities lending and proxy voting, BlackRock cannot vote shares on loan and may determine to recall them
for voting, as guided by our fiduciary duty as an asset manager to our clients in helping them achieve their investment goals. While this has occurred in a limited number of
B-24
cases, the decision to recall securities on loan as part of BlackRocks securities lending program in order to vote is based on an evaluation of various factors that include, but are not
limited to, assessing potential securities lending revenue alongside the potential long-term financial value to clients of voting those securities (based on the information available at the time of recall consideration). BAIS works with active
portfolio managers, as well as colleagues in the Securities Lending and Risk and Quantitative Analysis teams, to evaluate the costs and benefits to clients of recalling shares on loan.
In almost all instances, BlackRock anticipates that the potential long-term financial value to clients of voting shares would not warrant recalling securities
on loan. However, in certain instances, BlackRock may determine, in our independent business judgment as a fiduciary, that the value of voting outweighs the securities lending revenue loss to clients and would therefore recall shares to be voted in
those instances.
Periodically, BlackRock reviews our process for determining whether to recall securities on loan in order to vote and may modify it as
necessary.
Reporting and vote transparency
BAIS is
committed to transparency in the stewardship work we do on behalf of clients. We inform clients about our engagement and voting policies and activities through direct communication and disclosure on our website.
B-25
Want to know more?
blackrock.com/stewardship | ContactActiveStewardship@blackrock.com
The document is provided for information purposes only and is subject to change. Reliance upon this information is at the sole discretion of the reader.
Prepared by BlackRock, Inc.
©2024 BlackRock, Inc. All rights reserved. BLACKROCK is a trademark of BlackRock, Inc., or its subsidiaries in the United States and elsewhere. All other
trademarks are those of their respective owners.
B-26
PART C
Other Information
Item 25. |
Financial Statements And Exhibits |
The agreements included or incorporated by reference as exhibits to this Registration Statement contain representations and warranties by each of the parties
to the applicable agreement. These representations and warranties were made solely for the benefit of the other parties to the applicable agreement and (i) were not intended to be treated as categorical statements of fact, but rather as a way
of allocating the risk to one of the parties if those statements prove to be inaccurate; (ii) may have been qualified in such agreement by disclosures that were made to the other party in connection with the negotiation of the applicable
agreement; (iii) may apply contract standards of materiality that are different from materiality under the applicable securities laws; and (iv) were made only as of the date of the applicable agreement or such other
date or dates as may be specified in the agreement.
The Registrant acknowledges that, notwithstanding the inclusion of the foregoing cautionary
statements, it is responsible for considering whether additional specific disclosures of material information regarding material contractual provisions are required to make the statements in this Registration Statement not misleading.
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Financial Statements |
|
|
|
|
Part A: The annual report to the Trusts shareholders for the fiscal year ended December 31,
2024 (the 2024 Annual Report) is incorporated by reference. |
|
|
|
|
Part B: Audited financial statements and financial highlights for the fiscal year ended December 31,
2024 and related Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm are incorporated herein by reference to the 2024 Annual Report. |
|
|
(2) |
|
Exhibits |
|
|
(a)(1) |
|
Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust, dated of June 10, 2003, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (a) to Pre-Effective Amendment No. 1 to the Registrants Registration Statement on Form N-2 filed on June 20, 2003. |
|
|
(a)(2) |
|
Certification Evidencing Amendment to the Trusts Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust, dated February
11, 2011, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (a)(2) to Pre-Effective Amendment No.
1 to the Registrants Registration Statement on Form N-2 filed on April 30, 2014. |
|
|
(b)(1) |
|
Amended and Restated Bylaws, dated October 28, 2010, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Registrants Report on Form 8-K filed on October 29, 2010. |
|
|
(b)(2) |
|
Amendment No.
1 to Amended and Restated Bylaws is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (b)(2) to the Registrants Registration Statement on Form N-2 filed on January 27, 2022. |
|
|
(c) |
|
Inapplicable |
|
|
(d) |
|
Form of Specimen Stock Certificate is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (d)
to Pre-Effective Amendment No. 1 to the Registrants Registration Statement on Form N-2 filed on June 20, 2003. |
|
|
(e) |
|
Automatic Dividend Reinvestment Plan is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (e) to the Registrants Registration Statement on Form N-2 filed on March 14, 2014. |
|
|
(f) |
|
Inapplicable |
C-1
|
|
|
(g)(1) |
|
Investment Management Agreement between the Registrant and BlackRock Advisors, LLC is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (g)(1) to the Registrants
Registration Statement on Form N-2 filed on March 14, 2014. |
|
|
(g)(2) |
|
Sub-Investment Advisory Agreement between the Registrant and BlackRock International Limited
is incorporated by reference to Attachment G.1b.iii to the Registrants Annual Report for Registered Investment Companies on Form N-CEN filed on June 2, 2020. |
|
|
(g)(3) |
|
Sub-Investment Advisory Agreement between the Registrant and BlackRock (Singapore) Limited is
incorporated by reference to Attachment G.1b.iii to the Registrants Annual Report for Registered Investment Companies on Form N-CEN filed on June 2, 2020. |
|
|
(g)(4) |
|
Amended and Restated Master Advisory Fee Waiver Agreement
is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (g)(4) to the Registration Statement on Form N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
|
|
(g)(5) |
|
Amendment No. 1 to Amended and Restated Master Advisory Fee Waiver Agreement
is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (g)(5) to the Registration Statement on Form N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
|
|
(g)(6) |
|
Amendment No. 2 to Amended and Restated Master Advisory Fee
Waiver Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (g)(6) to the Registration Statement on Form N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
|
|
(g)(7) |
|
Amendment No. 3 to Amended and Restated Master Advisory Fee
Waiver Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (g)(7) to the Registration Statement on Form N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
|
|
(g)(8) |
|
Amendment No. 4 to Amended and Restated Master Advisory Fee
Waiver Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (g)(8) to the Registration Statement on Form N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
|
|
(g)(9) |
|
Form of Amendment No. 5 to Amended and Restated Master Advisory Fee
Waiver Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (g)(9) to the Registration Statement on Form N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
|
|
(g)(10) |
|
Form of Amendment No.
6 to Amended and Restated Master Advisory Fee Waiver Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (g)(8) to the Registration Statement on Form N-2
of BlackRock 2037 Municipal Target Term Trust, filed on July 28, 2022. |
|
|
(g)(11) |
|
Form of Amendment No.
7 to Amended and Restated Master Advisory Fee Waiver Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (g)(9) to Post-Effective Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form N-2
of BlackRock Alpha Strategies Fund (File No. 333-273507), filed on July 26, 2024. |
|
|
(h) |
|
To be filed by amendment. |
|
|
(i) |
|
Form of BlackRock Fixed-Income Complex Third Amended and Restated Deferred Compensation Plan is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (i)
to the Registration on Form N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
|
|
(j) |
|
Form of Master Custodian Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (j) to the Registration on Form N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
C-2
|
|
|
|
|
(k)(1) |
|
Form of Amended and Restated Transfer Agency and Service Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (k)(1) to the Registration on Form
N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
|
|
(k)(2) |
|
Form of Administration and Accounting Services Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (k)(2) to the Registration on Form N-2 of BlackRock Multi-Sector Income Trust, filed on January 12, 2022. |
|
|
(k)(3) |
|
Form of Eleventh Amended and Restated Securities Lending Agency Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (h)(13) of Post-Effective
Amendment No. 86 to the Registration on Form N-1A of BlackRock Funds V (File No. 333- 224371), filed on
January 27, 2025. |
|
|
(l) |
|
Opinion and Consent of Counsel to be filed by amendment. |
|
|
(m) |
|
Inapplicable |
|
|
(n) |
|
Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm Consent to be filed by amendment. |
|
|
(o) |
|
Inapplicable |
|
|
(p) |
|
Inapplicable |
|
|
(q) |
|
Inapplicable |
|
|
(r) |
|
Code of Ethics of the Registrant, BlackRock Investments, LLC, BlackRock Advisors, LLC, BlackRock Fund Advisors, BlackRock International Limited,
BlackRock (Singapore) Limited and BlackRock Asset Management North Asia Limited is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit (p)(1) of Post-Effective Amendment No. 51 to the Registration Statement on
Form N-1A of BlackRock ETF Trust II (File No. 333-236575), filed on December 30, 2024. |
|
|
(s) |
|
Calculation of Filing Fee Tables filed herewith |
|
|
(t) |
|
Power of Attorney is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (t) to the Registration Statement on Form N-2 of BlackRock Corporate High Yield Fund, Inc. (File No. 333-284646) as filed with the Commission on January 31,
2025. |
Item 26. |
Marketing Arrangements |
The information contained under the section entitled Plan of Distribution in the Prospectus is incorporated by reference, and any information
concerning any underwriters will be contained in the accompanying Prospectus Supplement, if any.
Item 27. |
Other Expenses Of Issuance And Distribution |
The following table sets forth the estimated expenses to be incurred in connection with the offering described in this Registration Statement:
|
|
|
|
|
Registration fee |
|
$ |
[5,835 |
|
NYSE listing fee |
|
|
2,500 |
|
Accounting fees and expenses |
|
|
2,300 |
|
Legal fees and expenses |
|
|
110,000 |
|
C-3
|
|
|
|
|
FINRA fee |
|
|
6,217 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
126,852 |
](1) |
|
(1) |
Estimate is based on the aggregate estimated expenses to be incurred during a three year shelf
offering period. |
Item 28. |
Persons Controlled By Or Under Common Control With The Registrant |
None.
Item 29. |
Number Of Holders Of Shares |
As of February 28, 2025:
|
|
|
Title Of Class |
|
Number Of Record Holders |
Common Shares of Beneficial Interest |
|
28 |
Article V of the Registrants Agreement and Declaration of Trust provides as follows:
5.1 No Personal Liability of Shareholders, Trustees, etc. No Shareholder of the Trust shall be subject in such capacity
to any personal liability whatsoever to any Person in connection with Trust Property or the acts, obligations or affairs of the Trust. Shareholders shall have the same limitation of personal liability as is extended to stockholders of a private
corporation for profit incorporated under the Delaware General Corporation Law. No Trustee or officer of the Trust shall be subject in such capacity to any personal liability whatsoever to any Person, other than the Trust or its Shareholders, in
connection with Trust Property or the affairs of the Trust, save only liability to the Trust or its Shareholders arising from bad faith, willful misfeasance, gross negligence (negligence in the case of those Trustees or officers who are directors,
officers or employees of the Trusts investment advisor (Affiliated Indemnitees)) or reckless disregard for his duty to such Person; and, subject to the foregoing exception, all such Persons shall look solely to the Trust Property
for satisfaction of claims of any nature arising in connection with the affairs of the Trust. If any Shareholder, Trustee or officer, as such, of the Trust, is made a party to any suit or proceeding to enforce any such liability, subject to the
foregoing exception, he shall not, on account thereof, be held to any personal liability. Any repeal or modification of this Section 5.1 shall not adversely affect any right or protection of a Trustee or officer of the Trust existing at the
time of such repeal or modification with respect to acts or omissions occurring prior to such repeal or modification.
5.2
Mandatory Indemnification. (a) The Trust hereby agrees to indemnify each person who at any time serves as a Trustee or officer of the Trust (each such person being an indemnitee) against any liabilities and
expenses, including amounts paid in satisfaction of judgments, in compromise or as fines and penalties, and reasonable counsel fees reasonably incurred by such indemnitee in connection with the defense or disposition of any action, suit or other
proceeding, whether civil or criminal, before any court or administrative or investigative body in which he may be or may have been involved as a party or otherwise or with which he may be or may have been threatened, while acting in any capacity
set forth in this Article V by reason of his having acted in any such capacity, except with respect to any matter as to which he shall not have acted in good faith in the reasonable belief that his action was in the best interest of the Trust or, in
the case of any criminal proceeding, as to which he shall have had reasonable cause to believe that the conduct was unlawful, provided, however, that no indemnitee shall be indemnified hereunder against any liability to any person or any expense of
such indemnitee arising by reason of (i) willful misfeasance, (ii) bad faith, (iii) gross negligence (negligence in the case of Affiliated Indemnitees), or (iv) reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of his
position (the conduct referred to in such clauses (i) through (iv) being sometimes referred to herein as disabling conduct). Notwithstanding the foregoing, with respect to any action, suit or other proceeding
C-4
voluntarily prosecuted by any indemnitee as plaintiff, indemnification shall be mandatory only if the prosecution of such action, suit or other proceeding by such indemnitee (1) was
authorized by a majority of the Trustees or (2) was instituted by the indemnitee to enforce his or her rights to indemnification hereunder in a case in which the indemnitee is found to be entitled to such indemnification. The rights to
indemnification set forth in this Declaration shall continue as to a person who has ceased to be a Trustee or officer of the Trust and shall inure to the benefit of his or her heirs, executors and personal and legal representatives. No amendment or
restatement of this Declaration or repeal of any of its provisions shall limit or eliminate any of the benefits provided to any person who at any time is or was a Trustee or officer of the Trust or otherwise entitled to indemnification hereunder in
respect of any act or omission that occurred prior to such amendment, restatement or repeal.
(b) Notwithstanding the
foregoing, no indemnification shall be made hereunder unless there has been a determination (i) by a final decision on the merits by a court or other body of competent jurisdiction before whom the issue of entitlement to indemnification
hereunder was brought that such indemnitee is entitled to indemnification hereunder or, (ii) in the absence of such a decision, by (1) a majority vote of a quorum of those Trustees who are neither interested persons of the
Trust (as defined in Section 2(a)(19) of the 1940 Act) nor parties to the proceeding (Disinterested Non-Party Trustees), that the indemnitee is entitled to indemnification hereunder, or
(2) if such quorum is not obtainable or even if obtainable, if such majority so directs, independent legal counsel in a written opinion concludes that the indemnitee should be entitled to indemnification hereunder. All determinations to make
advance payments in connection with the expense of defending any proceeding shall be authorized and made in accordance with the immediately succeeding paragraph (c) below.
(c) The Trust shall make advance payments in connection with the expenses of defending any action with respect to which
indemnification might be sought hereunder if the Trust receives a written affirmation by the indemnitee of the indemnitees good faith belief that the standards of conduct necessary for indemnification have been met and a written undertaking to
reimburse the Trust unless it is subsequently determined that the indemnitee is entitled to such indemnification and if a majority of the Trustees determine that the applicable standards of conduct necessary for indemnification appear to have been
met. In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be met: (i) the indemnitee shall provide adequate security for his undertaking, (ii) the Trust shall be insured against losses arising by reason of any lawful advances,
or(iii) a majority of a quorum of the Disinterested Non-Party Trustees, or if a majority vote of such quorum so direct, independent legal counsel in a written opinion, shall conclude, based on a review of
readily available facts (as opposed to a full trial-type inquiry), that there is substantial reason to believe that the indemnitee ultimately will be found entitled to indemnification.
(d) The rights accruing to any indemnitee under these provisions shall not exclude any other right which any person may have or
hereafter acquire under this Declaration, the By-Laws of the Trust, any statute, agreement, vote of stockholders or Trustees who are disinterested persons (as defined in Section 2(a)(19) of
the 1940 Act) or any other right to which he or she may be lawfully entitled.
(e) Subject to any limitations provided by
the 1940 Act and this Declaration, the Trust shall have the power and authority to indemnify and provide for the advance payment of expenses to employees, agents and other Persons providing services to the Trust or serving in any capacity at the
request of the Trust to the full extent corporations organized under the Delaware General Corporation Law may indemnify or provide for the advance payment of expenses for such Persons, provided that such indemnification has been approved by a
majority of the Trustees.
5.3 No Bond Required of Trustees. No Trustee shall, as such, be obligated to give any bond
or other security for the performance of any of his duties hereunder.
5.4 No Duty of Investigation; Notice in Trust
Instruments, etc. No purchaser, lender, transfer agent or other person dealing with the Trustees or with any officer, employee or agent of the Trust shall be bound to make any inquiry concerning the validity of any transaction purporting to be
made by the Trustees or by said officer, employee or agent or be liable for the application of money or property paid, loaned, or delivered to or on the order of the Trustees or of said officer, employee or agent. Every obligation, contract,
undertaking, instrument, certificate, Share, other security of the Trust, and every other act or thing whatsoever executed in connection with the Trust shall be conclusively taken to have been executed or done by the executors thereof only in their
capacity as Trustees under this Declaration or in
C-5
their capacity as officers, employees or agents of the Trust. Every written obligation, contract, undertaking, instrument, certificate, Share, other security of the Trust made or issued by the
Trustees or by any officers, employees or agents of the Trust in their capacity as such, shall contain an appropriate recital to the effect that the Shareholders, Trustees, officers, employees or agents of the Trust shall not personally be bound by
or liable thereunder, nor shall resort be had to their private property for the satisfaction of any obligation or claim thereunder, and appropriate references shall be made therein to this Declaration, and may contain any further recital which they
may deem appropriate, but the omission of such recital shall not operate to impose personal liability on any of the Trustees, Shareholders, officers, employees or agents of the Trust. The Trustees may maintain insurance for the protection of the
Trust Property, its Shareholders, Trustees, officers, employees and agents in such amount as the Trustees shall deem adequate to cover possible tort liability, and such other insurance as the Trustees in their sole judgment shall deem advisable or
is required by the 1940 Act.
5.5 Reliance on Experts, etc. Each Trustee and officer or employee of the Trust shall,
in the performance of its duties, be fully and completely justified and protected with regard to any act or any failure to act resulting from reliance in good faith upon the books of account or other records of the Trust, upon an opinion of counsel,
or upon reports made to the Trust by any of the Trusts officers or employees or by any advisor, administrator, manager, distributor, selected dealer, accountant, appraiser or other expert or consultant selected with reasonable care by the
Trustees, officers or employees of the Trust, regardless of whether such counsel or expert may also be a Trustee.
Registrant has also
entered into an agreement with Trustees and officers of the Registrant entitled to indemnification under the Agreement and Declaration of Trust pursuant to which the Registrant has agreed to advance expenses and costs incurred by the indemnitee in
connection with any matter in respect of which indemnification might be sought pursuant to the Agreement and Declaration of Trust to the maximum extent permitted by law.
Reference is also made to:
|
|
|
Sections 10 and 11 of the Registrants Investment Management Agreement, a form of which is filed as
Exhibit (g)(1) of this Registration Statement. |
Additionally, the Registrant and the other funds in the BlackRock
Fixed-Income Complex jointly maintain, at their own expense, E&O/D&O insurance policies for the benefit of its Trustees, officers and certain affiliated persons. The Registrant pays a pro rata portion of the premium on such insurance
policies.
5.6 Indemnification of Shareholders. If any Shareholder or former Shareholder shall be held personally
liable solely by reason of its being or having been a Shareholder and not because of its acts or omissions or for some other reason, the Shareholder or former Shareholder (or its heirs, executors, administrators or other legal representatives or in
the case of any entity, its general successor) shall be entitled out of the assets belonging to the Trust to be held harmless from and indemnified to the maximum extent permitted by law against all loss and expense arising from such liability. The
Trust shall, upon request by such Shareholder, assume the defense of any claim made against such Shareholder for any act or obligation of the Trust and satisfy any judgment thereon from the assets of the Trust.
Item 31. |
Business And Other Connections Of Investment Advisor |
BlackRock Advisors, LLC, a limited liability company organized under the laws of Delaware (the Advisor), acts as investment adviser to the
Registrant. The Registrant is fulfilling the requirement of this Item 31 to provide a list of the officers and directors of the Advisor, together with information as to any other business, profession, vocation or employment of a substantial nature
engaged in by the Advisor or those officers and directors during the past two years, by incorporating by reference the information contained in the Form ADV of the Advisor filed with the commission pursuant to the Investment Advisers Act of 1940
(Commission File No. 801-47710).
Item 32. |
Location Of Accounts And Records |
Omitted pursuant to the Instruction of Item 32 of Form N-2.
C-6
Item 33. |
Management Services |
Not Applicable
(3) |
The securities being registered will be offered on a delayed or continuous basis in reliance on Rule 415
under the Securities Act of 1933. Accordingly, the Registrant undertakes: |
|
(a) |
to file, during any period in which offers or sales are being made, a post-effective amendment to this
Registration Statement: |
(1) to include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of the Securities Act of 1933;
(2) to reflect in the prospectus any facts or events after the effective date of the Registration Statement (or the most recent
post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information set forth in the Registration Statement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any increase or decrease in volume of securities
offered (if the total dollar value of securities offered would not exceed that which was registered) and any deviation from the low or high end of the estimated maximum offering range may be reflected in the form of prospectus filed with the
Commission pursuant to Rule 424(b) if, in the aggregate, the changes in volume and price represent no more than 20% change in the maximum aggregate offering price set forth in the Calculation of Registration Fee table in the effective
registration statement.
(3) to include any material information with respect to the plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the
Registration Statement or any material change to such information in the Registration Statement.
|
(b) |
that for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective
amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof; |
|
(c) |
to remove from registration by means of a post-effective amendment any of the securities being registered which
remain unsold at the termination of the offering; and |
|
(d) |
that, for the purpose of determining liability under the Securities Act of 1933 to any purchaser:
|
C-7
(1) if the Registrant is relying on Rule 430B [17 CFR 230.430B]:
(A) Each prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(3) shall be deemed to be part of the registration
statement as of the date the filed prospectus was deemed part of and included in the registration statement; and
(B)
Each prospectus required to be filed pursuant to Rule 424(b)(2), (b)(5), or (b)(7) as part of a registration statement in reliance on Rule 430B relating to an offering made pursuant to Rule 415(a)(1)(i), (x), or (xi) for the purpose of
providing the information required by Section 10(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 shall be deemed to be part of and included in the registration statement as of the earlier of the date such form of prospectus is first used after effectiveness
or the date of the first contract of sale of securities in the offering described in the prospectus. As provided in Rule 430B, for liability purposes of the issuer and any person that is at that date an underwriter, such date shall be deemed to be a
new effective date of the registration statement relating to the securities in the registration statement to which that prospectus relates, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering
thereof. Provided, however, that no statement made in a registration statement or prospectus that is part of the registration statement or made in a document incorporated or deemed incorporated by reference into the registration statement or
prospectus that is part of the registration statement will, as to a purchaser with a time of contract of sale prior to such effective date, supersede or modify any statement that was made in the registration statement or prospectus that was part of
the registration statement or made in any such document immediately prior to such effective date; or
(2) if the
Registrant is subject to Rule 430C [17 CFR 230.430C]: Each prospectus filed pursuant to Rule 424(b) under the Securities Act of 1933 as part of a registration statement relating to an offering, other than registration statements relying on Rule 430B
or other than prospectuses filed in reliance on Rule 430A, shall be deemed to be part of and included in the registration statement as of the date it is first used after effectiveness. Provided, however, that no statement made in a registration
statement or prospectus that is part of the registration statement or made in a document incorporated or deemed incorporated by reference into the registration statement or prospectus that is part of the registration statement will, as to a
purchaser with a time of contract of sale prior to such first use, supersede or modify any statement that was made in the registration statement or prospectus that was part of the registration statement or made in any such document immediately prior
to such date of first use.
|
(e) |
that for the purpose of determining liability of the Registrant under the Securities Act of 1933 to any
purchaser in the initial distribution of securities: The undersigned Registrant undertakes that in a primary offering of securities of the undersigned Registrant pursuant to this Registration Statement, regardless of the underwriting method used to
sell the securities to the purchaser, if the securities are offered or sold to such purchaser by means of any of the following communications, the undersigned Registrant will be a seller to the purchaser and will be considered to offer or sell such
securities to the purchaser: (1) any preliminary prospectus or prospectus of the undersigned Registrant relating to the offering required to be filed pursuant to Rule 424 under the Securities Act of 1933; (2) free writing prospectus relating to
the offering prepared by or on behalf of the undersigned Registrant or used or referred to by the undersigned Registrant; (3) the portion of any other free writing prospectus or advertisement pursuant to Rule 482 under the Securities Act of
1933 relating to the offering containing material information about the undersigned Registrant or its securities provided by or on behalf of the undersigned Registrant; and (4) any other communication that is an offer in the offering made by
the undersigned Registrant to the purchaser. |
C-8
|
(a) |
For the purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from
the form of prospectus filed as part of a registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in the form of prospectus filed by the Registrant under Rule 424(b)(1) under the Securities Act of 1933 shall be deemed to be part of the
Registration Statement as of the time it was declared effective. |
|
(b) |
For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment
that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of the securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.
|
(5) |
The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes that, for purposes of determining any liability under the
Securities Act of 1933, each filing of the Registrants annual report pursuant to Section 13(a) or Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 that is incorporated by reference into the registration statement shall be deemed
to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof. |
(6) |
Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to
directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public
policy as expressed in the Securities Act of 1933 and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer
or controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the
opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act of 1933 and will
be governed by the final adjudication of such issue. |
(7) |
The Registrant undertakes to send by first class mail or other means designed to ensure equally prompt
delivery within two business days of receipt of a written or oral request, any prospectus or Statement of Additional Information. |
C-9
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933 and the Investment Company Act of 1940, the Trust has duly caused this Registration
Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of New York, and the State of New York, on the 21st day of March, 2025.
|
|
|
BLACKROCK LIMITED DURATION
INCOME TRUST |
|
|
By: |
|
/s/ John M. Perlowski |
|
|
John M. Perlowski |
|
|
President and Chief Executive Officer |
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration Statement has been signed by the following
persons in the capacities indicated and on the 21st day of March, 2025.
|
|
|
|
|
Signature |
|
Title |
|
|
|
/s/ John M. Perlowski |
|
|
|
Trustee, President and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer) |
(John M. Perlowski) |
|
|
|
/s/ Trent Walker |
|
|
|
Chief Financial Officer |
(Trent Walker) |
|
|
|
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer) |
|
|
|
CYNTHIA L. EGAN* |
|
|
|
Trustee |
(Cynthia L. Egan) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LORENZO A. FLORES* |
|
|
|
Trustee |
(Lorenzo A. Flores) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
STAYCE D. HARRIS* |
|
|
|
Trustee |
(Stayce D. Harris) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
J. PHILLIP HOLLOMAN* |
|
|
|
Trustee |
(J. Phillip Holloman) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
R. GLENN HUBBARD* |
|
|
|
Trustee |
(R. Glenn Hubbard) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
W. CARL KESTER* |
|
|
|
Trustee |
(W. Carl Kester) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CATHERINE A. LYNCH* |
|
|
|
Trustee |
(Catherine A. Lynch) |
|
|
|
|
C-10
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ARTHUR P. STEINMETZ* |
|
|
|
Trustee |
(Arthur P. Steinmetz) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ROBERT FAIRBAIRN* |
|
|
|
Trustee |
(Robert Fairbairn) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*By: /s/ Janey Ahn |
|
|
|
|
(Janey Ahn, Attorney-In-Fact) |
|
|
|
|
C-11
EXHIBIT INDEX
C-12
Exhibit (s)
Calculation of Filing Fee Tables
FORM N-2
(Form Type)
BLACKROCK LIMITED
DURATION INCOME TRUST
(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in its Charter)
Table 1: Newly Registered and Carry Forward Securities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Security Type |
|
Security Class Title |
|
Fee Calculation or Carry Forward Rule |
|
Amount Registered |
|
Proposed Maximum Offering Price Per Unit |
|
Maximum Aggregate Offering Price |
|
Fee Rate |
|
Amount of Registration Fee |
|
Carry Forward Form Type |
|
Carry Forward File Number |
|
Carry Forward Initial effective date |
|
Filing Fee Previously Paid In Connection with Unsold Securities to
be Carried Forward |
|
Newly Registered Securities |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fees to Be
Paid |
|
Equity |
|
Common Shares of Beneficial Interest |
|
457(o) |
|
|
|
|
|
$1,000,000 |
|
$153.10 |
|
$153.10 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other |
|
Rights to Purchase Common Shares of Beneficial Interest(1) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fees Previously
Paid |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carry Forward Securities |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carry Forward
Securities |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total Offering Amounts |
|
|
|
$1,000,000 |
|
|
|
$153.10 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total Fees Previously Paid |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$0 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total Fee Offsets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net Fee Due |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$153.10 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
No separate consideration will be received by the Registrant. Any shares issued pursuant to an offering of
rights to purchase shares of beneficial interest, including any shares issued pursuant to an over-subscription privilege or a secondary over-subscription privilege, will be shares registered under this Registration Statement. |
BlackRock Limited Durati... (NYSE:BLW)
Historical Stock Chart
From Apr 2025 to May 2025
BlackRock Limited Durati... (NYSE:BLW)
Historical Stock Chart
From May 2024 to May 2025